En32ser 1
En32ser 1
En32ser 1
com
QSS-32 series
Service Manual
CHAPTER DESCRIPTION
3.Mode
4.Troubleshooting
5.Operation sequence
6.Electrical parts
8.Appendix
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
SCREW
System program:
• QSS-32 series: Ver. 4
• QSS-32 PRO series: Ver. 4
• S-900SA/S-1700SA: Ver. 4
• QSS-32 DLS series: Ver. 2
! It is prohibited to show, provide, lend or transfer this manual to the others except the service personnel.
! The contents of this manual are subject to change without notice.
! Illustrations in this manual may vary depending on the model or manufacturing lot.
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
Microsoft, MS-DOS and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other
countries.
"UNLHA(32).DLL" is Mr. Micco's free software.
DIGITAL ICE is a trademark of Kodak.
Memory Stick is a trademark of Sony Corporation.
MultiMediaCard™ is a trademark of Infineon Technologies AG company in Germany and licensed to MMCA (MultiMediaCard
Association).
This software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group.
Other product and company names mentioned here in may be the trademarks of their respective owners. Symbols of
trademarks, ™ and ®, are not added.
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
System configuration
The machine configurations of the systems are as follows.
iii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
Explanation of manual
Description for each specification
This manual contains the maintenance procedure for all the specifications.
The procedure for each specification may differ.
For the different procedures depending on the specifications
The specification mark is mentioned for the procedure.
Specification Mark
Normal specification [N]
SM specification [SM]
There is no specification mark for the procedure which is same for all the specifications.
Definitions of the marks and symbols used in this manual are as follows:
The Important symbol indicates operations or procedures requiring caution, instructions and supplementary explanations
that need to be followed.
The pointing finger symbol indicates the manual or section where you can find additional information.
The Note symbol indicates functions or instructions which are convenient if you know.
iv
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
The names of the processing solutions in this manual are indicated as shown below. Some types of processing solutions may
have other names.
v
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
vi
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Notes to service personnel
System configuration ............................................................................................................................. iii
Explanation of manual ...........................................................................................................................iv
Description for each specification ..................................................................................................iv
About the chapters .........................................................................................................................iv
Marks and symbols used in this manual ........................................................................................iv
Abbreviations for processing solutions used in this manual ............................................................v
vii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
viii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
3. Mode
Passwords .............................................................................................................................. 30500
Passwords .............................................................................................................................................................30500
Passwords (DLS specification) .............................................................................................................................30600
Mode structure chart .............................................................................................................. 31000
Mode structure chart (Order Display) ...................................................................................................................31000
Mode structure chart (Judgment Display) ............................................................................................................31010
Mode structure chart (Menu display) ...................................................................................................................31020
Mode structure chart (Setup) ................................................................................................................................31030
Mode structure chart (Processor Setting) [N] .......................................................................................................31040
Mode structure chart (Processor Setting) [SM] ....................................................................................................31040
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [N] ...................................................................................................31050
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [SM] ................................................................................................31050
Mode structure chart (Maintenance) .....................................................................................................................31060
Mode structure chart (Net Order) .........................................................................................................................31500
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner) ......................................................................... 31610
Mode structure chart (Order Display) [Stand Alone Scanner] .............................................................................31610
Mode structure chart (Judgment Display) [Stand Alone Scanner] .......................................................................31620
Mode structure chart (Menu Display) [Stand Alone Scanner] .............................................................................31630
Mode structure chart (Setup) [Stand Alone Scanner] ...........................................................................................31640
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [Stand Alone Scanner] ....................................................................31650
Mode structure chart (Maintenance) [Stand Alone Scanner] ...............................................................................31660
Mode structure chart (Net Scan Mode) [Stand Alone Scanner] ...........................................................................31670
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer) ............................................................................ 31710
Mode structure chart (Order Display) [Stand Alone Printer] ...............................................................................31710
Mode structure chart (Judgment Display) [Stand Alone Printer] .........................................................................31720
Mode structure chart (Menu Display) [Stand Alone Printer] ...............................................................................31730
Mode structure chart (Setup) [Stand Alone Printer] .............................................................................................31740
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [N] [Stand Alone Printer] ................................................................31760
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [SM] [Stand Alone Printer] .............................................................31760
Mode structure chart (Maintenance) [Stand Alone Printer] .................................................................................31770
ix
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
x
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xi
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4. Troubleshooting
Error and attention message regulation ................................................................................... 4001
Classification of errors and attention messages ......................................................................................................4001
Suffix number display .............................................................................................................................................4002
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring ............ 4190
Symptoms caused by poor wiring connection(s) (scanner section) [S-4] ..............................................................4190
Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring (scanner section) [S-2/3] ..........................................................4200
Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring (desk section) ...........................................................................4201
Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring (printer section) ........................................................................4202
Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring (processor) ...............................................................................4203
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse .................................................... 4240
Symptoms caused by fuse blowout (scanner section) [S-4] ...................................................................................4240
Symptoms caused by fuse blowout (scanner section) [S-2/S-3] ............................................................................4250
Symptoms result from blowout of fuse (desk section) ...........................................................................................4251
Symptoms result from blowout of fuse (printer section) ........................................................................................4252
Symptoms result from blowout of fuse (processor section) ...................................................................................4253
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart ................................................................................. 4302
The message, Laser temperatures are being adjusted. does not disappear from the order display. ........................4302
An abnormal print is made .....................................................................................................................................4304
Checking for media drive defect .............................................................................................................................4305
PC does not start properly. ......................................................................................................................................4306
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print ...................................................................... 4400
BGR uneven colors or white strips (film advance direction) .................................................................................4400
Line like a bar code (film advance direction) .........................................................................................................4401
Light density line (white) (paper advance direction) ..............................................................................................4450
Monochrome line (perpendicular to paper advance direction) ...............................................................................4451
Light color is appeared in unexposure position ......................................................................................................4452
Stripped pattern like a wavy line ............................................................................................................................4453
Diagnosis appendix: FB scanner ............................................................................................. 4500
List of FB scanner's error message (for EPSON type) ...........................................................................................4500
Diagnosis appendix: Scanner adjustment chart ....................................................................... 4600
About the scanner adjustment chart ........................................................................................................................4600
DLS Error Messages ................................................................................................................ 4900
DLS Error Messages ...............................................................................................................................................4900
xii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xiii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xiv
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xv
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xvi
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xvii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xviii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xix
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xx
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xxi
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xxii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xxiii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xxiv
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
5. Operation sequence
Starting up/Closing down Operation ...................................................................................... 50500
Startup sequence ...................................................................................................................................................50500
Startup sequence (DLS specification) ..................................................................................................................50501
Startup sequence for PC ........................................................................................................................................50510
ARCNET communication ....................................................................................................... 50520
ARCNET communication flow ............................................................................................................................50520
How to use the fiber cutter ....................................................................................................................................50520
How to use the aspirator .......................................................................................................................................50520
xxv
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
6. Electrical parts
Position of electrical parts (desk section) ............................................................................... 61000
Desk section (positions of PCBs and electrical parts) ..........................................................................................61000
xxvi
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xxvii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xxviii
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
xxix
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
8. Appendix
Periodically replaced parts ..................................................................................................... 80110
List of Maintenance/Periodically Replaced Parts/Consumable Parts (Desk Section) ..........................................80110
List of Maintenance/Periodically Replaced Parts/Consumable Parts (Scanner Section) .....................................80110
List of Maintenance/Periodically Replaced Parts/Consumable Parts (Printer Section) .......................................80110
List of Maintenance/Periodically Replaced Parts/Consumable Parts (Processor Section) [N] ...........................80110
List of Maintenance/Periodically Replaced Parts/Consumable Parts (Processor Section) [SM] ........................80110
List for checking/replacing (service personnel) [N] .............................................................................................80110
List for checking/replacing (service personnel) [SM] ..........................................................................................80110
Positions of paper jam release labels .................................................................................... 80210
Positions of paper jam release labels ....................................................................................................................80210
Service personnel tool list ...................................................................................................... 80310
Service personnel tool list [N] ..............................................................................................................................80310
Service personnel tool list [SM] ...........................................................................................................................80310
Operation keyboard correspondence list ............................................................................... 81010
Operation keyboard correspondence list ..............................................................................................................81010
Operation keyboard correspondence list (DLS specification) ..............................................................................81020
Condition list for replenishment solution sensors ................................................................... 81510
Condition list for replenishment solution sensors [SM] .......................................................................................81510
Contents in the QSS Service Manual (additional volume) ..................................................... 88000
Contents in the QSS Service Manual (additional volume) ...................................................................................88000
Table of wiring diagrams ........................................................................................................ 89000
Table of wiring diagrams ......................................................................................................................................89000
Table of wiring diagrams ........................................................................................................ 89010
Wiring diagram table [S-4] ...................................................................................................................................89010
xxx
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
1000
1000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10010
Description of warning (signal words)
Description of warning (signal words)
• Signal words identify the level of injuries that can potentially occur.
• The signal words used in this manual and found on labels, DANGER, WARNING and CAUTION, are assigned according to the
level of potential risk.
This indicates situations that if not immediately avoided could result in serious injury or death.
This indicates situations that if not avoided could result in serious injury or death.
This indicates situations that if not avoided could result in non-life threatening injury. It is also used to indicate situations
which may cause damage to physical property.
SIGNALWORD
10010 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10020
Location of warning labels
Location of warning labels
The following shows the locations and types of warning labels and the parts number on this machine. Heed the clearly indicated warnings
and operate safely without accidents. If the warning labels on the machine become illegible or peel off, contact your place of purchase and
exchange them with new labels.
Though the machine appearance of some models may be different from figures, locations of warning labels are same as shown in figures.
13
1
G068043
1
;;;
;; ;;
;;
;;;
;; ;;
;;;
;; ;;
;; ;;;
;;; ;;;
;;;
;; ;;; ;;;; ;
;;;
;; ;; ;;;;;
;;;;
;; ;;; ;;;;
;
;;;;
;;
;;;;
;;
;;;;
;;
;
3 4 3 1
1
G068044
10020 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10020
Location of warning labels
135/240 AFC-II
G071691
14
G050548
15
G061413
1 2
A023349-01 A023200-01
3 4
A022523-01 A022531-01
10020 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10020
Location of warning labels
5 6
A022509-01
8
A234350-01
9 10
A022536-01 A023202-01
11 12
A515330-01 A227560-01
10020 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10020
Location of warning labels
13
A063381-01
10020 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10030
For safe operation
For safe operation
! General precautions
IMPORTANT
• Ground wires (green and yellow) are connected to the covers and units of the machine.
For reassembly, be sure to connect the ground wires as they were.
• Be sure to perform an operation check after replacing or adjusting any parts (or units).
• This machine uses non-pharmaceutical poison and toxic processing solutions which are dangerous to drink in. Direct
contact with processing solutions may irritate eyes.
When handling processing solutions, wear safety goggles.
If a processing solution has been ingested accidentally, immediately rinse the mouth out with water, and drink one or
two cups of water. Contact a physician as soon as possible, and then vomit the solution according to the physician's
instructions.
If processing solution gets into eyes, immediately rinse them under running water for at least 15 minutes, and then
contact a physician.
• Direct contact with processing solutions may irritate the skin and may cause an allergic reaction.
When handling processing solutions, be sure to wear rubber gloves and clothing for workwear, to avoid direct contact.
If there is a possibility of direct or indirect exposure to a processing solution, wash with soap and rinse with lots of
water, after completion of work.
• Processing solution stains on your clothing may result in discoloration or fading. When handling processing solutions,
wear clothing for workwear.
10030 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10030
For safe operation
• If any case you have to take care of wiring for the power such as moving the machine, ask a qualified professional
electrician for work. Do not forget to ground the machine.
• Be careful for your hands, hair, clothes, etc., not to be caught under the gear, chain, belt, roller, fan and other rotating
parts.
Do not remove the cover unless it is specified.
Be sure to turn off the circuit breaker and main power supply of this machine before performing any work.
Keep away your hands from the machine during operation.
If your hand or the like is caught and you cannot move, ask someone around you to turn off the circuit breaker at once.
• The lamp for light source, processing solution heater, dryer heater, and motor generate an intense heat.
If you directly touch them during operation or right after operation, you may get burnt.
When replacement of parts or maintenance is performed, make sure that the temperature is fully lowered. Cool the
lamp for light source for 15 minutes or more after turning off the lamp.
After the temperature is fully lowered, turn off the circuit breaker and main power supply of this machine and perform
the operation.
Each cooling time of heaters and motors differs depending on the status of operation that has been performed.
If you have got burnt, cool the burn with flowing water and contact a physician as soon as possible.
10030 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10030
For safe operation
• There is a danger of hands being caught by the open/close covers or doors, or by the movable units.
When opening and closing covers or doors, be sure to hold them firmly.
10030 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10040
For safe operation
If an electronically charged human body touches electronic parts such as PCBs, it may adversely affect the electronic parts.
When handling the electronic parts, be sure to use static-dissipative tools to prevent the components on the PCB from being damaged due
• When using the static-dissipative tool, be sure to turn off the circuit breaker of the unit and the main power supply, and
wait 10 seconds or more to carry out operation.
10040 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10050
For safe operation
Laser Precautions
5 1
5 1
2
2 3
3 4 4
G068048
1 2
3 4
10050 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10050
For safe operation
10050 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10060
For safe operation
1 2 G070355
1 2
10060 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
10060
For safe operation
10060 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
2000
2000 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
2000
2000 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20010
Removing covers
Removing covers
2
6
20010 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20010
Removing covers
20010 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20020
Removing covers
6
9
11
10 2
20020 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20020
Removing covers
13
Holder (2)
12
20020 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20030
Removing covers
3 G068522
20030 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20040
Removing covers
135/240 AFC-II
2
Screws (top cover)
Connecting PCB 2 3
Cable guide
4 5
120 AFC-II
5
2
3 1
4 G051071
20040 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20040
Removing covers
1
3
4 G052612
135/240 MMC-II
1
2 G052613
20040 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20040
Removing covers
135 AFC-II
1 3
5
Rewinding detection unit
Rewinding unit 4
G057592
135/240 AMC-II
1
2 G060694
20040 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20040
Removing covers
20040 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20050
Removing covers
20050 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20110
Adjusting the belt tension
Adjusting the belt tension
18
16,17
20
15
12
13
11
10 22
7,8
9
5
6
2 3
G069803
IMPORTANT
• All views of belts are from the side of printer doors.
3 Paper supply motor B/C belt 638±136 g 1.0 mm Paper supply motor B/C
(6.3±1.3N)
4 Paper magazine motor C belt 412 to 637 g 1.5 mm Paper magazine motor
(4.0 to 6.3N) C
20110 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20110
Adjusting the belt tension
7 Paper supply arm motor (left) 255±48 g 5.0 mm Paper supply arm motor
belt (2.5±0.5N) (left)
16 Paper advance arm motor (right) 280±60 g 5.0 mm Paper advance arm
belt (belt width: 10 mm) (2.7±0.6N) motor (right)
17 Paper advance pressure change Paper advance pressure
motor (left) belt (belt width: 10 change motor (left)
mm)
16 Paper advance arm motor (right) 383±46 g 8.0 mm Paper advance arm
belt (belt width: 8 mm) (3.8±0.5N) motor (right)
17 Paper advance pressure change Paper advance pressure
motor (left) belt (belt width: 8 change motor (left)
mm)
20110 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20110
Adjusting the belt tension
20110 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20120
Adjusting the belt tension
G070006
*1. Remove all the print receiving trays, then adjust tension on the sorter chain belt.
*2. The procedure for adjusting the conveyor motor timing belt is shown below:
20120 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20120
Adjusting the belt tension
Adjust the timing belt so that part A is 15.4±0.9 mm by moving the conveyor motor in the direction indicated by the arrow.
20120 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20125
Adjusting the belt tension
Colorimeter
No. Name Force Deflection Adjusting point Illustration
1 Paper advance motor belt 163±30 g 1.0 mm Attaching position of the
(1.6±0.3N) tension pulley
NOTE
• There are two types of belt tensions for the colorimeter unit. The strength differs depending on the belt positions.
20125 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20130
Adjusting the belt tension
135/240 AFC-II
3
4
2
135/240 AFC-II
No. Name Force Deflection Adjusting point Illustration
1 Film feed belt (135 insertion 0.77±0.17N 0.5 mm Attaching position of the
section) (79±17 g) tension pulley
2 Film feed motor drive belt 1.73±0.39N 0.5 mm Mounting position of the
(176±40 g) motor
G051067
20130 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20130
Adjusting the belt tension
Winding drive belt (110 AFC- 0.66±0.15N 1.0 mm Attaching position of the
II) (67±15 g) tension pulley
3 Film feed motor drive belt 1.16±0.24N 1.0 mm Mounting position of the
(118±24.5 g) motor
135 AFC-II
G057664
135 AFC-II
No. Name Force Deflection Adjusting point Illustration
1 Film feed belt 0.28±0.08N 0.5 mm Attaching position of the
(28.5±8.3 g) tension pulley
2 Film feed motor drive belt 1.16±0.24N 1.0 mm Mounting position of the
(118±24 g) motor
20130 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20130
Adjusting the belt tension
135/240 AMC-II
2
G060695
135/240 AMC-II
No. Name Force Deflection Adjusting point Illustration
1 Loading arm drive belt 0.083±0.015N 2.0 mm Mounting position of the
(8.5±1.5 g) motor
20130 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20310
Display monitor section
Display monitor section
J/P171
J/P176
J/P172
Mouse
Keyboard
G068525
3. Remove the monitor fixing angle bracket. 1. Carry out the monitor setup.
(two screws) ☞ 32530
Monitor fixing angle bracket
G068524
20310 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20320
Display monitor section
Replacing the display monitor (DLS 2. Remove the monitor table cover. (two
screws)
specification)
Touch monitor
Power supply connector
! Procedure RGB cable
Serial connector
PC rear cover
Rear cover
Monitor table cover
G072414
RGB connector
G072416
20320 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20610
Scanner section
Scanner section
Removing the scanner unit [S-2/S-3] 5. Remove the scanner unit. (three adjusting
screws)
NOTE
There are different scanner removal procedures for S-2/S-3 and
S-4. • Depending on the unit, the adjusting screw may be
changed to the hex. nut.
• For S-4 details, refer to the following:
Viewed from right side
• Refer to ☞ Removing the scanner unit [S-4].
Film ready J/P60
lamp
! Precautions for scanner unit Adjusting
replacement screws
! Procedure
J/P67
1. Remove the film carrier.
2. Remove the scanner top cover and the
scanner front cover. P120 G068521
☞ 20030
3. Disconnect the connector(s). ! Adjustment after reattaching
J/P60 (Scanner unit)
J/P61 (Scanner unit) 1. Attach the film ready lamp. (one screw)
J/P62 (Scanner unit)
J/P67 (Scanner unit)
2. Adjust the swing and tilt/light axis.
J/P68 (Scanner unit) ☞ 37000
J/P69 (Scanner unit) 3. Carry out the light source registration.
P120 (Relay connector) ☞ 37010
4. Remove the film ready lamp. (one screw) 4. Carry out the focus adjustment.
☞ 37020
5. Update the light source.
☞ 37030
20610 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20610
Scanner section
Removing the scanner unit [S-4] 6. Remove the scanner unit. (four screws)
Viewed from right side
J/P62
! Precautions for scanner unit Film ready
J/P61
lamp
replacement
IMPORTANT
• If you replaced the scanner unit, items shown below J/P60
are necessary in returning the defective unit.
! Procedure
20610 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20610
Scanner section
20610 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20620
Scanner section
IMPORTANT
• If the shield finger has not been attached to the
scanner base panel, attach the shield finger of LED
light source unit in the position specified below, then
attach the LED light source unit.
Number sticker LED light source unit
Shield finger attachment position
G074595
! Procedure
20620 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20620
Scanner section
filter solenoid used last time for the LED light source solenoid in the direction of an arrow. Then,
unit. adjust the clearance between the rotating
1. Remove the ND filter solenoid from the LED plate and pin of the ND filter solenoid to
light source unit. (two screws) become 0 to 0.3 mm. (two screws)
G076398
ND filter: ON
G076395
Spring
ND filter: OFF
G076399
5. Adjust the position of the ND filter solenoid 2. Carry out the focus adjustment.
while pressing the part A of the ND filter ☞ 37020
20620 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20620
Scanner section
3. Update the light source. Removing the LED light source unit
☞ 37030
[S-4]
IMPORTANT
• If an electrostatically charged human body touches the
LED light source unit, it may adversely affect the built-in
electrical parts (LED element).
Use the static-dissipative tool as you work with the
electrical parts such as PCBs.
! Procedure
ND filter solenoid
LED light source unit connector
G078476
20620 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20620
Scanner section
! Warning when replacing the LED light 4. Attach the ND filter solenoid to the new LED
source unit light source unit and tighten it up temporarily.
(two screws)
Spring
ND filter solenoid
G076397
G076395
G076398
20620 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20620
Scanner section
ND filter: ON
G076399
20620 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20650
Scanner section
20650 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20650
Scanner section
135 AFC
Sensor Sensitivity
Adjustment
DX Sensor Standard
Adjustment
☞ 35060
20650 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20700
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
Replacing the film carrier 3. Carry out the light source registration.
☞ 37010
4. Carry out the focus adjustment of the
! Replacing the 135/240 AFC-II scanner.
☞ 37020
IMPORTANT
IMPORTANT
• Carry out the adjustments below for each 135 and
240 lane. • For the 110 AFC-II, carry out the focus
adjustment for each magnification rate.
1. Attach the 135/240 AFC-II. 5. Carry out the Scanning Position Auto
G052617
! Replacing the 110 AFC-II
3. Carry out the light source registration.
1. Attach the 110 AFC-II. ☞ 37010
2. Carry out the sensor sensitivity adjustment. 4. Carry out the focus adjustment of the
scanner.
☞ 35020 ☞ 37020
20700 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20700
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
20700 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20710
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
G068371
20710 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20710
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
10. Remove the advance unit. (six screws) 12. Open the sensor PCB wiring cover to the
Screw A
direction indicated by the arrow, and remove
Screw B
the flat cable. (Loosen one screw out of
three.)
Screw C
NOTE
• The end of the wiring cover can be opened by
removing a screw out of three.
Wiring cover
Advance unit
G068373
11. Turn over the advance unit with the film feed G054662
motor on.
Advance unit ! Precautions when reattaching
• Reattach the flat cable carefully to the correct direction.
☞ 68200
• Reattach the advance unit by turning over it with the
advance motor on. Be careful not to give pressure to the
flat cable.
• When reattaching the advance unit, reattach it while
Lay pushing it to the arrow direction (the reference surfaces).
down.
IMPORTANT
• The lengths of the advance unit screws are
different. Be sure to attach the appropriate
Lift. screw.
Refer to Step 10.
• Screw A (Socket head bolt M3 × 4)
• Screw B (Socket head bolt M3 × 8)
• Screw C (Socket head bolt M3 × 6)
G054661
IMPORTANT
• When the advance unit is turned over, be Rail Rail
careful not to apply excessive load to the flat
cable.
G068377
20710 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20710
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
20710 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20720
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
PCB cover
G068372
Noise reducing
plate
G057593
20720 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20730
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
Replacing and adjusting the spool 6. Remove the guide plate. (two screws)
key motor Guide plate
! Procedure
G068371
Motor unit
G068374
20730 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20740
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
! Procedure
5. Remove the cartridge limit switch. (one 8. Remove the light lock door drive axis. (one
E-ring)
screw)
IMPORTANT
IMPORTANT
• When removing the light lock door drive axis,
• When removing the cartridge limit switch, be
be careful not to lose the spring.
careful not to lose the detection pin.
6. Remove the guide plate. (two screws) Spring Light lock door
drive axis
7. Remove the cartridge guide. (two screws)
IMPORTANT
E-ring
• When removing the cartridge guide, be
careful not to lose the spring for the lock
plate.
Cartridge guide
G051099
Cartridge guide
G074328
Cartridge guide
G053517
20740 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20750
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
! Procedure
G052463
20750 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20760
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
G078467
IMPORTANT
• The type not equipped with the magnetic preamplifier PCB is no longer manufactured. To replace this type of
magnetic head unit, it is necessary to replace it with the magnetic head unit which is equipped with the magnetic
preamplifier PCB.
• For replacing the magnetic head unit which is not equipped with the magnetic preamplifier PCB, prepare all the parts as detailed
below and replace all of them completely.
! Replacing the type of unit which is not equipped with the magnetic preamplifier PCB
NOTE
• Replacing methods are different between the R/W type and the R type.
20760 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20760
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
! Replacing the type of unit which is not equipped with the magnetic preamplifier PCB
Sensor PCB
J/P1015
G078329
20760 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20760
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
Mini clamps
Screws
G078330
Shield plate
Angle bracket
G067399
20760 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20760
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
NOTE
• You do not need to remove the advance unit because it has no write head.
Mini clamps
Screws J/P1040
Screws
J/P1042
Upper guide (1) cover Magnetic head PCB Magnetic head PCB attaching plate
G078327
20760 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20760
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
Shield plate
Angle bracket
! Replacing the type of unit which is equipped with the magnetic preamplifier PCB
Sensor PCB
J/P1015
G078329
3. Remove the magnetic head cover and the magnetic preamplifier PCB. (two screws)
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not lose small parts.
4. Disconnect the connectors (J/P1041 and J/P1042) of the magnetic preamplifier PCB. [There is no
J/P1041 in 135/240 AFC-ll (R).]
20760 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20760
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
20760 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20760
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
Reference surfaces
Angle bracket
G078325
• Fix the wiring of connector (J/P1043) to the hole (which was used for mounting the mini clamp) with the mini band. (1)
Mini band
G078323
20760 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20780
Film carrier section (135/240 AFC-II)
! Procedure
Holder
Leave one
tooth of the
gear open.
Idle gear 2
Idle gear 1
Cartridge guide
G051100
20780 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
20850
Manual Mount Carrier Section (135/240 MMC-II)
Manual Mount Carrier Section (135/240 MMC-II)
MMC auto focus section adjustment swing is within the tolerance level. (four
screws)
IMPORTANT
IMPORTANT
• Adjust the LM guide installation block so as
• Carry out this adjustment when the auto focus error not to give pressure to the LM guide.
occurs, or when the worm wheel does not swing within
the tolerance level of 4 mm (± one tooth) after adjusting 5. After adjusting it within the tolerance level,
the position of the emission lamp and detection sensor. carry out the focus adjustment.
☞ 37020
! Procedure 6. To check the operation, scan the mount in
Bearing holder
G060704
20850 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
21110
Desk section
Desk section
G068538
Colorimeter unit
G068540
• When replacing the colorimeter, remember that the
colorimeter, the calibration plate, and the FD for
calibration make a set. Replace them as one set.
• When replacing the calibration plate, remember that the
calibration plate and the FD for calibration data make a
G068536
set. Replace them as one set.
4. Attach the colorimeter unit.
! Replacing the colorimeter unit 5. Upgrade the colorimeter unit.
☞ 35600
1. Remove the rear cover. 6. Follow the procedures in Replacing the
☞ 20050 calibration plate.
2. Disconnect the connector(s). ☞ Replacing the calibration plate
J/P156 (Relay connector) 7. Adjust the colorimeter unit.
J/P157 (Relay connector)
☞ 35100
21110 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
21110
Desk section
2. Remove the colorimeter top cover. (2) Insert the FD for calibration data into the
(two screws) floppy disk drive.
Colorimeter top cover. (3) Click YES: OK.
Data of colorimeter and data in the calibration
data FD are displayed.
(4) Click YES: OK.
Register the data in the FD to the colorimeter.
(5) Click YES: OK.
Confirm the registration.
Connector
2. Check if updating has been performed
properly.
Fixing plate
NOTE
• Check that the colorimeter data and the calibration
plate data are the same.
6. Follow the procedures in Replacing the (4) Remove the FD for calibration data from the
calibration plate. floppy disk drive.
☞ Replacing the calibration plate
21110 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
21120
Desk section
Adjusting the height of the 5. Remove the colorimeter mount and turn it
over. (three screws)
colorimeter
IMPORTANT
• Do not damage the cable(s) since the
IMPORTANT adjustment is carried out with the
• Carry out the height adjustment securely if colorimeter of connector(s) connected.
the colorimeter unit is replaced.
Cable Colorimeter mount
! Procedure
J/P188 G072362
Hexagonal screwdriver
21120 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
21120
Desk section
7. Make sure that the height of colorimeter 2. Set the colorimeter mount to the positioning
leading end is align with the back face of the holes and attach by pushing it in the direction
colorimeter mount, and then turn the leading indicated by the arrow. (three screws)
end control holder approximately 30 degree Positioning holes
to the lowering direction (clockwise).
NOTE
• This changes the standard value (0) of the height
of colorimeter leading end from the base of the
colorimeter mount to - 0.1 mm. One revolution
(360 degree) of the leading end control holder
makes 1 mm movement.
Colorimeter mount
IMPORTANT
• If the colorimeter leading end is out of back
face of the colorimeter mount, it may damage
the calibration plate or test prints.
G074587
21120 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
21150
Desk section
! Procedure
35±5 g
Film
Brush
G051138
21150 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
22000
Paper magazine section
Paper magazine section
Checking the paper magazine of the reel plate and nut plate. Refer to
Step 7.
Check item
Paper Check that paper is neat in shape.
magazine Check that paper guides are attached securely.
Check that the reel plate is closed securely.
! Procedure
0.3 mm
102
114
117
120
IMPORTANT
152
G072384
22000 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
22000
Paper magazine section
5. Set the spindle to the paper magazine. 7. Check the condition of reel plate and nut
plate.
6. Check that the deformation of the magazine
reel plate is within 0.3 mm inside from the Dark room type magazine
paper guide.
IMPORTANT
• Set a scale onto the reel plate and turn the
spindle to check the deformation of the reel
plate.
• When the deflection of paper magazine reel
G074530
NOTE
• Do not loosen or tighten the screws at the side
with the dents since they are fixed.
Scale
Dark room type magazine
Dents
Scale
0.3 mm
Inside
G072370
G074436
IMPORTANT
• If there is nothing wrong with the condition of
reel plate and nut plate, and the reel plate's
deflection is 0.3 mm or more, replace the reel
plate.
22000 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
22100
Paper magazine section
Adjusting the zigzagging of the Example: When the first test print is misaligned in the left.
paper magazine mount First test print 0.5 mm Second test print
! Procedure
A
A
IMPORTANT
• The zigzagging of the magazine mount must be
adjusted for each paper magazine A, B and C.
Paper advance
direction
A
G072367
IMPORTANT
• Measure the dimension shown below before
Paper advance adjusting the positioning pin for magazine mount B.
direction
G072383
22100 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
22100
Paper magazine section
It will help you to restore after adjustment of the • When the adjusting screw is turned 360
positioning pin. degree, the positioning pin moves
approximately 0.7 mm.
Scale
G072374
IMPORTANT
• When the fixing screws on the positioning pin
are to be tighten, push and secure the pin in
the directions indicated by arrows 1 and 2.
Magazine mount B
G072379
22100 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
22100
Paper magazine section
5. Adjust the position of the magazine mount B It will help you to restore after adjustment of the
so that the gap under magazine B is 0.5 mm positioning pin.
when magazine B is set on the positioning
pin. (two adjusting screws and two nuts)
6. Tighten screw(s) on the magazine mount B.
(four screws)
Loosen this screw.
Adjusting screw and nut
IMPORTANT
• When the fixing screws on the positioning pin
are to be tighten, push and secure the pin in
the directions indicated by arrows 1 and 2.
22100 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
22100
Paper magazine section
• When the adjusting screw is turned 360 6. Tighten screw(s) on the magazine mount C.
degree, the positioning pin moves (three screws)
approximately 0.7 mm.
Screws
IMPORTANT
• Measure the dimension shown below before
adjusting the positioning pin for magazine mount A.
It will help you to restore after adjustment of the
positioning pin.
Nut Adjusting
Hexagonal screwdriver
G072376
Scale
Measure here.
Positioning pin
G072373
22100 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
22100
Paper magazine section
1. Loosen the fixing screw on the positioning 5. Adjust the position of the magazine mount A
pin for the magazine mount A. (Loosen two so that the positioning pin goes into the hole
fixing screws.) smoothly.
2. Adjust the positioning pin for the magazine 6. Tighten screw(s) on the magazine mount A.
mount A. (one adjusting screw and one nut) (three screws)
When the first test print Adjust the positioning pin to the
is misaligned in the right. right. (Turn the positioning pin
Step 2 counterclockwise.)
When the first test print Adjust the positioning pin to the
IMPORTANT
• When the fixing screws on the positioning pin
are to be tighten, push and secure the pin in
the directions indicated by arrows 1 and 2.
• When the adjusting screw is turned 360
degree, the positioning pin moves
approximately 0.7 mm.
Magazine mount A
G072369
Fixing screws
Positioning pin
Nut
Hexagonal screwdriver
Adjusting screw
G072368
22100 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25610
Paper supply unit
Paper supply unit
Upper rail
Paper supply
unit
Lower rail
G068526
IMPORTANT
• Set the paper supply unit on the lower rail and
then set it on the upper rail.
25610 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25620
Paper supply unit
Removal and the right angle 6. Remove the mounting angle bracket. (one
screw)
adjustment of the cutter unit
! Procedure
Cutter unit
Adjusting the position of the sensor holder
1. Reattach the cutter cover. (two screws)
2. Attach the mounting angle bracket. (one
screw)
3. Fix the sensor holder temporarily. (two
screws)
4. Position the sensor holder so that it is 0 to
0.5 mm lower than the cutter lower blade.
(two screws)
NOTE
• Usually, if the cutter lower blade is contacted and
J/P134 the sensor holder is attached, it becomes within
J/P135 and J/P364 the above standard range. Finally, confirm the
G068527 standard dimension of the sensor holder and cutter
4. Remove the sensor holder. (two screws) lower blade.
Sensor holder
Cutter unit
G068528
25620 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25620
Paper supply unit
Contact
0 to 0.5
mm
Sensor
Nut
G068530
Cutter lower blade
IMPORTANT
Cutter unit front front face
• To adjust the right angle of the cutter unit,
Sensor holder move the cutter unit positioning plate pushing
onto the reference surface of the paper
supply unit.
Cutter unit positioning plate
G068532
" Point
Check the right angle of the paper cut section by
matching up with cut edges as shown illustration
below.
Paper The first print
advance
direction
A B
Paper
emulsion
side
25620 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25620
Paper supply unit
25620 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25630
Paper supply unit
! Procedure
Detection
plate
Cam Detection
(vertical plate
Cam (vertical
position) position)
Paper supply pressure change sensor
Direction A Paper advance rollers
Set-
screw G068544
25630 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25630
Paper supply unit
failure may occur if you process paper with the position of the detection plate in the
the paper advance length of 82.5 mm. direction indicated by the arrow.
Paper supply pressure change sensor Paper supply pressure change sensor
G078434 G078435
3. Check the center part of the paper (around 6. Repeat Checking after adjustments from
the position of 450 mm) for the banding in ☞ 1 through ☞ 5 to adjust the position of the
case printing several gray prints with the detection plate of the paper supply unit so
paper advance length of 914 mm. that no banding or paper jam occurs.
4. Check if paper is advanced properly in case
of printing with paper advance length of 82.5 ! Supplement
mm.
5. If paper jam occurs in case of printing with 1. There are two types of cams for the paper
supply unit, which are new and old types.
the paper advance length of 82.5 mm, adjust
The new type has more allowance with regard to
banding and paper jam.
G078436
25630 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25630
Paper supply unit
Mark
G078437
25630 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25640
Paper supply unit
Adjusting the paper hold timing of 2.35±0.5 mm away from the edge of the
paper hold sensor. (one set-screw)
the paper hold motor Hexagonal screwdriver
Detection plate
Cam
! Procedure
Cam
Pressure
Guide pin
25640 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25650
Paper supply unit
! Procedure
Correction value
printing unit
Adjusting screw
G070033
25650 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25660
Paper supply unit
Removing paper supply unit A 2. Attach paper supply unit A pushing it in the
direction indicated by the arrows 1 and 2. (six
screws)
! Procedure
J/P321
Paper supply
unit A
Paper supply
unit A
G068534
25660 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25810
Exposure advance unit
Exposure advance unit
Removing the exposure advance 7. Remove the exposure advance unit. (four
screws)
unit
! Procedure
25810 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25820
Exposure advance unit
! Procedure
Pressure guide
G072366
25820 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25830
Exposure advance unit
Banding adjustment for the pressure of the pressure roller at the inlet
side in the exposure advance unit. ☞ The
exposure advance unit banding at the area 24 to 27 mm from the
paper rear end
24 to 27 mm
Pressure roller
at the exit side
Pressure roller at the inlet
side
G072396
25830 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25830
Exposure advance unit
5. Loosen the nut on the exposure advance unit and 2.5 mm, the banding may appear on the
exit roller. (Loosen one nut.) area 32 mm from the paper leading end.
6. Adjust the exit roller adjusting screw so that Exit roller adjusting screw
Exit roller nut
the pressure of the pressure guide at the exit
side in the exposure advance unit is equable
at the left and right. (one adjusting screw)
Pressure roller at Exit roller adjusting screw
the exit side Exit roller nut
Inlet roller
adjusting screw 2.0 to 2.5 mm
Inlet roller
fixing screw G072395
25830 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25830
Exposure advance unit
the test print and check that the differences ! The banding at the area 24 to 27 mm from the
are within 0.2 mm. paper rear end
Paper advance direction
1. Turn the cam on the exposure advance unit
to release the pressure of the pressure roller
A
at the exit side.
Left Right
NOTE
• There is another method to check the difference.
Cut the paper at the center and put them together
to check the difference.
11. If the difference of right and left measured
values is 0.2 mm or more, carry out the
Exposure Advance Adjustment.
Pressure roller
Refer to 36080 ☞ Adjusting the paper zigzagging in at the exit side
the exposure advance unit.
NOTE
• If the difference of right and left measured value is
within 0.2 mm, the zigzagging adjustment is Cam
G072399
completed.
2. Release the pressure of the pressure roller
12. Check the Arm Unit 1 Zigzagging at the exit side and set the paper. Make fine
Correction. adjustments of the cam in the exposure
☞ 36060 advance unit so that the pressure release
amount of the pressure roller at the inlet side
is the thickness of about one sheet of paper.
25830 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25830
Exposure advance unit
Cam
G072397
25830 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25910
Exposure advance unit
Banding shooting
Test Print 17 mm
32 mm
55 mm 55 mm
210 mm G072388
42.9 mm
Arm
62.8 mm
72 mm
17 mm
Exposure position
17 mm
79 mm
25910 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25910
Exposure advance unit
! Banding shooting
Print condition Banding position Status Corrective action Refer to
All At the area 0 to 11 mm The bumper rubber for the laser Attach the bumper -
from the paper leading control box is detached. rubber.
end
At the area 32 mm from The pressure of the exit side Adjust the ☞ 25830
the paper leading end pressure roller in the exposure zigzagging of the
advance unit is inequable. exposure advance
unit.
25910 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
25910
Exposure advance unit
25910 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26510
Paper Advance Unit 1
Paper Advance Unit 1
3. Open the paper advance unit 1. 3. Tighten four screws of paper advance unit 1
temporarily.
4. Disconnect the connector(s). NOTE
J/P333 (Relay connector)
• Attach two screws if you removed them in step 1
J/P334 (Relay connector)
of Attaching position.
5. Remove paper advance unit 1 in the arrow Loosen these screws.
direction.
Paper Advance Unit 1
26510 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26510
Paper Advance Unit 1
4. Tighten the screw(s) pushing paper advance 2. Execute Test Operation for the Paper Stop
unit 1 in the direction of the arrow. (four Position Correction via F: Functions of
screws) Paper Advance Unit Correction.
Positioning pins Confirm the dimension between the front ends of arm
unit 2 and paper is from 3.0±0.5 mm.
Paper
Advance Unit
1
G068452
When the original paper advance unit 1 is
reattached
3. If an adjustment is necessary, perform Paper
Advance Unit Correction.
1. It is not necessary to adjust. ☞ 36010
26510 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26550
Paper Advance Unit 2
Paper Advance Unit 2
J/P412
J/P413
Wiring
J/P323 G068548
J/P410
Positioning
pin
Paper
Advance Unit Paper Advance Unit 2
2
Positioning pin
G068505
26550 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26560
Paper Advance Unit 2
! Procedure
G068550
26560 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26560
Paper Advance Unit 2
Cam Cam
Detection plate
Detection
plate
Paper Advance Paper Advance
Pressure Change Pressure Change
Sensor (Left) Sensor (Right)
Hexagonal
Hexagonal screwdriver
screwdriver
3.6±0.5 mm
Paper Advance
Pressure
Paper Advance Cam
Cam Change Sensor
Pressure (Right)
Change Sensor
(Left)
G069800
26560 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26570
Paper Advance Unit 2
Adjusting the arm position Adjusting the position of the arm (left)
1. Carry out adjustment so that the dimension
between the lower guide of the arm unit and
! Procedure the rail is 53.9±0.2 mm. (one screw)
Plate
53.9±0.2 mm
Rail
G069798
26570 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26610
Processor loading unit
Processor loading unit
Removing the processor loading 5. Remove the processor loading unit. (four
screws)
unit
Positioning pin
! Procedure
Processor
loading unit
Positioning pin
G068509
26610 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26710
Laser unit
Laser unit
Removing the laser unit 8. Disconnect the ground wire. (one screw)
PCB cover 2
Wiring cover
! Precautions for laser unit replacement
G068513
IMPORTANT
• Raise the AOM driver and remove it, then
place on the processor top cover.
26710 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26710
Laser unit
• Operate with extreme care for wiring to the 14. Disconnect the connector(s). (one screw)
laser unit, laser control PCB and laser I/O J/P1532 (Laser I/O PCB)
PCB. J/P1539 (Laser I/O PCB)
J/P1540 (Laser I/O PCB)
J/P1513 (Laser control PCB)
AOM driver unit
J/P1515 (Laser control PCB)
J/P1516 (Laser control PCB)
J/P1517 (Laser control PCB)
J/P1526 (Relay connector)
J/P1525 (Relay Connector)
J/P1642
J/P1637
J/P1632 G068515
G068517
IMPORTANT
• Remove the laser control box. Turn it over
and place on the processor top cover.
• Take extreme care of wiring of the laser
control PCB and laser I/O PCB.
G068516
26710 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26710
Laser unit
16. Remove three bumper mounts and a bumper 2. Attach the laser unit pushing the unit in the
angle bracket. (two screws) direction of the arrow (contact face). (four
screws)
IMPORTANT
Contact faces
• This is required only when you replace the
laser unit with new one.
Bumper mount
PCB cover 1
G072359
Laser unit
! Adjustment after reattaching and setup
G068514
When the original laser unit is reattached
! Adjusting the attaching position 1. Carry out the daily setup.
1. Attach the laser unit. When a new laser unit is attached
1. Attach three bumper mounts and a bumper
angle bracket to the new laser unit. (two
screws)
NOTE
• No position adjustment is needed for the bumper
mount(s) and the bumper angle bracket.
26710 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26710
Laser unit
Bumper mount
26710 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26810
Zigzag adjustment
Zigzag adjustment
Check item
☞ 22100
NOTE
All Check if leveling of the machine is completed
correctly. • If difference between part A on the first test
print and the second test print is within 0.5 mm,
Magazine Check that the shutter open/close arm works you do not have to adjust it.
mount properly. (When the printer door is closed, the
shutter open/close arm moves 10 mm and more Example: When the first test print skews to the right
! Procedure
A
1. Check the condition of the paper magazine.
A
☞ 22000
2. Adjust the zigzagging of the exposure
advance unit.
☞ 36060
IMPORTANT
• Carry out arm unit 1 zigzagging correction
for each paper magazine A, B and C.
Rear end
G068467 • Make test prints via Test Print
NOTE Confirmation 1/2 to check the zigzagging
• There is another method to check the difference. amounts (A - C) of two prints are within the
Cut the paper at the center and put them together tolerance level in the following table.
to check the difference between 0 mm-line and When they are within the tolerance level,
254 mm-line. the adjustment is not necessary.
26810 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
26810
Zigzag adjustment
A
457.0 mm width C are between 119.5 mm or
G068463
NOTE
• After master correction of the exposure center
correction, carry out Exposure Center
Correction (for each Paper Magazine) again if
you are also using another paper magazine.
B
B
C
☞ 36070
IMPORTANT
• Carry out the master correction of the
exposure center correction for each paper
magazine A, B and C.
• Make a test print via Test Print
Confirmation with Master Value to check
26810 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27230
Drive section
Drive section
Backlash adjustment of the dryer counterclockwise turn and tighten the lock
nut.
rack
Adjusting bolt
Plate of the drive unit
Gear of the dryer rack
! Procedure
Gear A
IMPORTANT
• The backlash adjustment is required when you
replace the dryer rack.
Dryer rack
Plate
Screws
Lock nut
G069808
Drive unit
G069807
27230 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27260
Drive section
rack
! Procedure
0.5 mm or less
G052783
Loosen these screws. Connector 5. Loosen the screws on the lock plate which
Dryer rack secures the dryer rack. (two screws)
G071634
4. Adjust the connection so that the clearance 6. Adjust the position of the lock plate that
of the connectors is 0.5 mm or less. (two secures the dryer rack so that the lock works
screws) smoothly when setting the dryer rack. (two
screws)
IMPORTANT
• Pressing the connector strongly may damage Lock plate
the connector. If the clearance is too much
great, an error may occur.
27260 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27270
Drive section
! Procedure
Drive motor
Drive motor
G076385
27270 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27410
Order classification section
Order classification section
! Procedure
G050751
G050752
27410 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27420
Order classification section
Removing the print conveyor unit 6. Remove the conveyor guide. (three nuts)
Conveyor guide
! Procedure
G068387
Dryer door
G068389
Holder 1
G068385
Screwdriver
8. Disconnect the connector(s).
J/P711: Conveyor motor
J/P778: Conveyor unit sensor
IMPORTANT
• Put the connector(s) in the square hole when
you attach the print conveyor unit.
G068384
27420 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27420
Order classification section
9. Lift up the print conveyor unit in the direction 2. Adjust the position of the conveyor guide so
indicated by the arrow and remove it. that it does not contact with the roller(s) of
Square hole the dryer section. (three nuts)
Roller
Stay 2
Screwdriver
G068384
27420 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27430
Order classification section
Replacing the print receiving tray 2. Press the end of receiving tray (3) with your
thumb, and remove receiving tray (2) in the
direction indicated by the arrow.
! Procedure Print sorter unit
Tray rail
G053522
27430 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27430
Order classification section
G050390
27430 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27440
Order classification section
! Procedure
G050757
G050758
27440 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27810
Replenishment package unit
Replenishment package unit
Replacing the replenisher pump and the rating plate will not be determined
properly.
the water supply pump [SM] IN
Caps
(Do not remove this.)
! Procedure
Tray units
1. Push. G050874
G050875
27810 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27810
Replenishment package unit
27810 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27810
Replenishment package unit
IMPORTANT
• Make sure that the difference between the
measured value and the output amount
entered in the machine is within ±3%. If the
difference is not within ±3%, check for
damage or clogging of the pipes. When there
is still no problem relating to those items, air
must be remained in the pumps. Exhaust air,
and measure output amount securely again.
• When the output amount for each
replenishment package is measured, the
remaining amount of each solution varies.
3. Replace the replenisher pipe and the water
supply pipe to their original position.
4. Mark the label with a new pump output
amount.
(The label is affixed to the inside of processor door 1.)
5. Attach the sub-tank top cover and processor
cover 1 as they were.
IMPORTANT
• Do not leave the air exhaust tool without cleaning
after use. Otherwise the syringe packing may be
damaged.
Be sure to clean the tool before storing.
27810 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27820
Replenishment package unit
Replacing the probe [SM] 6. Remove the probe nut and the probe.
BF-B BF-A
! Procedure
Probe nut
Probe
O-ring
Probe holder
G050893
G050891
7. Assemble the new probe, then tighten the
probe nut securely using the probe replacing
4. Disconnect the tray unit connectors. jig.
J/P601: Tray unit A
J/P600: Tray unit B IMPORTANT
• The O-ring is attached to the new probe.
5. Remove the tray units.
• The probe (including the O-ring) should be
2. Lift it up. used properly for each solution.
Tray unit B
For CD-C solution, use the whole black
probe and the O-ring marked with a white dot.
For other solutions, use the probe which the
resin part is brown and the O-ring marked
with a green dot.
• The probe replacing jig is a service tool. Refer
to Service personnel tool list.
☞ 80310
1. Press the lever.
8. Reassemble the parts as they were.
Tray unit A
G050892
27820 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27830
Replenishment package unit
Adjusting the sensitivity of the 4. Remove the protection cover of the SM I/O
PCB.
replenisher solution sensor [SM] (one screw)
Protection cover
! Procedure
Sensor arrangement
G050898
G050895
Clockwise Increases the amount of light.
27830 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
27830
Replenishment package unit
Replenishment package
Replenishment
Probe
solution
Replenishment solution sensor
(LED)
G050897
3000
3. Mode
3 Mode
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [N] ................................................................................................31050
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [SM] .............................................................................................31050
Mode structure chart (Maintenance) ..................................................................................................................31060
Mode structure chart (Net Order) ......................................................................................................................31500
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner) ...................................................................... 31610
Mode structure chart (Order Display) [Stand Alone Scanner] ..........................................................................31610
Mode structure chart (Judgment Display) [Stand Alone Scanner] ....................................................................31620
Mode structure chart (Menu Display) [Stand Alone Scanner] ..........................................................................31630
Mode structure chart (Setup) [Stand Alone Scanner] ........................................................................................31640
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [Stand Alone Scanner] .................................................................31650
Mode structure chart (Maintenance) [Stand Alone Scanner] ............................................................................31660
Mode structure chart (Net Scan Mode) [Stand Alone Scanner] ........................................................................31670
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer) ......................................................................... 31710
Mode structure chart (Order Display) [Stand Alone Printer] ............................................................................31710
Mode structure chart (Judgment Display) [Stand Alone Printer] ......................................................................31720
Mode structure chart (Menu Display) [Stand Alone Printer] ............................................................................31730
Mode structure chart (Setup) [Stand Alone Printer] ..........................................................................................31740
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [N] [Stand Alone Printer] .............................................................31760
Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [SM] [Stand Alone Printer] ..........................................................31760
Mode structure chart (Maintenance) [Stand Alone Printer] ..............................................................................31770
DLS mode structure chart .................................................................................................... 32000
DLS mode structure chart ..................................................................................................................................32000
QSS mode structure chart (Order Display) ........................................................................................................32010
QSS mode structure chart (Menu display) ........................................................................................................32020
QSS mode structure chart (Setup) .....................................................................................................................32030
QSS mode structure chart (Processor Setting) [N] ............................................................................................32040
QSS mode structure chart (Processor Setting) [SM] .........................................................................................32040
QSS mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [N] ........................................................................................32050
QSS mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [SM] .....................................................................................32050
QSS mode structure chart (Maintenance) ..........................................................................................................32060
3000 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
3000
3 Mode
Pump Output Amount Setting [SM] ..................................................................................................................33030
Total Replenishment Amount Display [N] ........................................................................................................33040
Total Replenishment Amount Display [SM] .....................................................................................................33040
Correction Setting [SM] ....................................................................................................................................33060
Processor Standard Setting ................................................................................................. 33500
Thermosensor Calibration .................................................................................................................................33500
Refilling Water Amount Setting [N] .................................................................................................................33510
Refilling Water Amount Setting [SM] ..............................................................................................................33510
Cleaning Water Amount Setting ........................................................................................................................33580
Dryer Lane Select Operation Setting .................................................................................................................33590
Drive Motor Revolution Count Setting .............................................................................................................33600
Operator Selections ............................................................................................................. 34500
Operator Selections [N] .....................................................................................................................................34500
Operator Selections [SM] ..................................................................................................................................34500
3000 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
3000
3 Mode
Input Check (Processor) [SM] ...........................................................................................................................35220
Output Check (Input Section) ............................................................................................................................35300
Output Check (Printer) ......................................................................................................................................35310
Output Check (Processor) [N] ...........................................................................................................................35320
Output Check (Processor) [SM] ........................................................................................................................35320
Reading and Writing Data .................................................................................................................................35400
Reading and Writing Data [Stand Alone Scanner] ............................................................................................35410
Procedures for Backup & Restore Software ......................................................................................................35450
System Version Check .......................................................................................................................................35500
System update for each control PCB (CPU) .....................................................................................................35600
Operation Information .......................................................................................................................................35700
Machine Specification [N] .................................................................................................................................35800
Machine Specification [SM] ..............................................................................................................................35800
Machine Specification [Stand Alone Scanner] ..................................................................................................35810
Self-diagnostic ...................................................................................................................................................35920
Media Drive Self-diagnostic ..............................................................................................................................35920
Printer Mechanical Adjustment ............................................................................................ 36000
Paper sensor adjustment ....................................................................................................................................36000
Paper Advance Unit Correction .........................................................................................................................36010
Exposure Magnification Correction ..................................................................................................................36020
Exposure Position Adjustment ..........................................................................................................................36030
Exposure Magnification Fine Adjustment .........................................................................................................36040
Paper Advance Length Correction ....................................................................................................................36050
Arm Unit 1 Zigzagging Correction ...................................................................................................................36060
Exposure Center Correction ..............................................................................................................................36070
Exposure Advance Adjustment .........................................................................................................................36080
Paper pressure operation correction ..................................................................................................................36090
WB width correction .........................................................................................................................................36100
Compact Archive Unit Adjustment ....................................................................................... 36700
Compact Archive Unit Initialization .................................................................................................................36700
Compact Archive Unit Capacity Check ............................................................................................................36710
Scanner Unit Adjustment ..................................................................................................... 37000
Swing and Tilt/Light Axis Adjustment [S-2/S-3] ..............................................................................................37000
Swing and Tilt/Light Axis Adjustment [S-4] ....................................................................................................37000
Light Source Registration ..................................................................................................................................37010
Focus Adjustment ..............................................................................................................................................37020
Light Source Update ..........................................................................................................................................37030
3000 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
3000
3 Mode
3000 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
30500
Passwords
Passwords
Passwords
! Explanation
3. Mode
When it is in service mode, Service Mode is displayed
on each display.
NOTE
• After password input display appears, input the password
within 10 seconds.
If the display disappears while you are entering the
password, start it over again.
IMPORTANT
• Do not eject the floppy disk while the LED of the
floppy disk drive is ON. (It may damage the floppy
disk drive or the floppy disk.)
30500 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
30600
Passwords
Passwords (DLS specification) 2. Insert the service personnel floppy disk into
the floppy disk drive on the Menu display.
3. Press the key, and then press the
! Explanation key.
DLS mode and QSS mode need their own service personnel 4. Enter the password (2260).
passwords respectively. When it is in service mode, Service Mode is displayed
For DLS mode, the password is used to proceed to the key on each display.
operator mode. For QSS mode, the password makes it
possible to display the service personnel mode and perform NOTE
each setting. • After password input display appears, input the password
NOTE within 10 seconds.
If the display disappears while you are entering the
• Quitting the application is performed at the close down
password, start it over again.
checks in the QSS mode.
IMPORTANT
! Service personnel password in DLS mode
3. Mode
• Do not eject the floppy disk while the LED of the
floppy disk drive is ON. (It may damage the floppy
1. Select Service Operator from the disk drive or the floppy disk.)
Administration menu and press OK.
The password input display appears. ! Deleting the service personnel password
S072403
2. Press the key while the key is
pressed on the Menu display to bring up the
2. Enter the password (2260) and press OK. Password Deletion display.
Key Operator mode appears.
NOTE 3. Enter 0 six times slowly, and then press the
• Service personnel floppy disk is unnecessary.
key.
NOTE
! Proceeding to the QSS mode • After deleting the password, it is set to the initial
value (0123).
1. Select QSS Menu in the Administration The Password Deletion display does not appear if
the password is not registered.
menu.
The Password Deletion display is appeared only
It proceeds to the QSS mode.
when deleting the password which has been
NOTE registered.
• The DLS mode can proceed to the QSS Menu
from either Operator mode or Key Operator ! Proceeding to the DLS mode
mode.
IMPORTANT
1. Select NO in the initial menu display of QSS
mode or PASS in the menu display.
• To display the Windows taskbar, it is It proceeds to the DLS mode.
necessary to proceed to the QSS mode from
Key Operator mode.
30600 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31000
Mode structure chart
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S0000-00-SM04
Order Display
Item Reference
F Menu
Scanner Lamp ON/OFF
Processor Drive ON/OFF
Rewind Paper
Media Copy
Start Adobe Photoshop
Net Order Mode ☞ 31500
Start Bravo Utility Refer to the Bravo
Service Manual.
Help Display
31000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31010
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S0250-00-SM32
Judgment Display
Item Reference
Screen Saver
Print Size Change
Print Size Copy
DSA
1 Frame Magnification
Cancel 1 Frame Magnification
Setting
Print Image Fine Adjustment
Top-Bottom Information
Change
Top-Bottom Information Copy
Help Display
Image Rotation (only 1 Frame)
[-1] Image Rotation
[N] Correction Value, Counts
and DSA Hold
[Y] Y-correction Copy
[M] M-correction Copy
[C] C-correction Copy
[D] Density Correction Copy
[REPT] Print Counts Copy
[+1] DSA Copy
[PASS] Passed frame copy
Panorama Shutter ON/OFF
31010 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31010
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
Reading Test Print Correction
Value
Color Conversion
Photometry Memory
Frame Selection
Change of Front Print Setting
Cropping Operations Copy
Auto Red Eye Correction
Change
Scene Correction
Copy Scene Correction
Copy Correction Data
3. Mode
Auto Correction Change
31010 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31020
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S0003-00-SM00
S0019-01-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Menu display
Item Reference
Close Down Checks Quit the Close Down Checks
Quit The Application
Power OFF
Pricing Sheet Reissue
31020 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31020
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
*1
Daily Totals Print Details Print Out Daily Totals
Daily Totals Export
Details for Input Media Extra Print Out Daily Totals
Charge Daily Totals Export
Details for JPEG Print Out Daily Totals
Daily Totals Export
Details for Index Print Print Out Daily Totals
Daily Totals Export
Media Copy Details Print Out Daily Totals
Daily Totals Export
Reset Daily Totals
Total Counter Reset
3. Mode
Daily Totals Export
Total Counter 2
Daily Setup
Emulsion Number Change
AFC Cleaning
Cleaning of Arm Unit 1
Extension Setup ☞ 31030
Processor Settings ☞ 31040
Operator Selections ☞ 31050
IX Data Settings Imprint Setting
Lab ID
Photofinishing Data Utilization
Noritsu-eNET Setting (SP1) Serial Number/Model Number Refer to Noritsu-eNET
setting system program
Network setting Setting Manual.
Dial-up setting
Upload configuration
Version check
e-mail setting
Price Setting Print Price Setting
Input Media Extra Charge
Setting
Index Print Price Setting
JPEG Price Setting
Standard Price Setting
Option Registration Option
Media
Option Software
Password Registration
Maintenance ☞ 31060
*1. If pricing unit is not registered as an option, selecting this item is not available.
31020 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31030
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S1000-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Setup
Item Reference
Laser Setup Paper Specification Registration/Setup ☞ 32510
F Profile Chart Output (SP1)
F Printer Profile Calibration
F Print Check
F Black Balance Adjustment
F Black Balance Adjustment (Manual)
F Setup Switch
Magazine Registration/Setup ☞ 32520
F Paper Specification Registration/Setup
Paper Setup
Print Channel Print Channel Selection Setting
Cut
Copy
Paste
Export
31030 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31030
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
Scanner Setup Scanner Slope Correction (Negative) Master Data
Scanner Slope
For each film size
Reference Slope
DX Slope
Scanner Slope Correction (Positive) Master Data
Scanner Slope
For each film size
Scanner Slope
Parameters (Negative) Parameter 1 ☞ 32590
Parameter 2
Parameter 3
3. Mode
Service Parameter (SP1) ☞ 32500
Light Source Update
Light Source Registration (SP1) ☞ 37010
Area Registration (SP1) ☞ 32570
Flatbed Scanner Setup
Master Data Paper Temperature Correction
Key Difference Ratio Setting
DSA
Monitor Setup ☞ 32530
Data Initialization (SP1) All Data ☞ 32550
Main
Auto Film Carrier
Image Processing
Printer
Processor
Colorimeter Unit
Pricing Unit
LASER
Correction Data for Brightness of the
Edge of Image Field
Scanner
Initial Setup (SP1)
Create Template Package Edit Edit Existing Format
New
New (Use division wizard)
31030 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31040
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S4000-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Processor Settings
Item Reference
Processing Solution
Temperature Setting
Standard Replenishment
Amount Setting
F Manual Replenishment
Pump Output Amount Setting ☞ 33030
F Pump Output Amount
Measurement
F Initial Replenishment
Operation (SP1)
Total Replenishment Amount ☞ 33040
Display
Dryer Temperature Setting
Processor Standard Setting Thermosensor Calibration ☞ 33500
(SP1) Refilling Water Amount Setting ☞ 33510
Cleaning Water Amount Setting ☞ 33580
Dryer Lane Select Operation Setting ☞ 33590
Drive Motor Revolution Count Setting ☞ 33600
F: Drive Motor Revolution Count
Auto Adjustment
31040 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31040
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S4200-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Processor Settings
Item Reference
Processing Solution
Temperature Setting
Standard Replenishment
Amount Setting
Pump Output Amount Setting ☞ 33030
F Pump Output Amount
Measurement
F Initial Replenishment
Operation (SP1)
Total Replenishment Amount ☞ 33040
Display (SP2)
F Package Capacity
Setting (SP1)
F SM Forced
Replenishment Amount
Setting (SP1)
Dryer Temperature Setting
Correction Setting (SP2) ☞ 33060
31040 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31040
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
Processor Standard Setting Thermosensor Calibration ☞ 33500
(SP1) Refilling Water Amount Setting ☞ 33510
Cleaning Water Amount Setting ☞ 33580
Dryer Lane Select Operation Setting ☞ 33590
Drive Motor Revolution Count Setting ☞ 33600
FDrive Motor Revolution Count Auto
Adjustment
3. Mode
31040 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31050
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S2000-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
! Operator Selections
Judgment Operation
Item Reference
Hold Key Reset
240 Print Counts User Advice (Camera Data)
PJP/AUTO/PPI Automatic Order
Reprint Automatic Order
Sort Function by Each Frame
No. of Frames Setting of the Film Strip (135/120/110)
No. of Frames Setting of the Film Strip (240)
Judgment Display Specification
Display Design
Number of Display Items Switch
Color of PASS Frame
Color Selection of Print Frame Display
Color Selection of Frame Display
Color Selection of Print Frame for 1 Frame Magnification Display
Color Selection of Print Frame for 1 Frame Magnification Resetting
Selecting Judgment Type for the Input Media
Image Change of Judgment Display Screen Saver
31050 1/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31050
Mode structure chart
Print Operation
Item Reference
Magazine Auto Change
Remaining Paper Amount Display
Paper Leading Edge Advance
Color Selection of Print Blank of Positive
Color Selection of Print Blank except Positive
PPI Image Decision Time
Net Order Mode
Spooler Place
Spooler Capacity
Spooler Used Space
3. Mode
Data to be sorted
Sort Order
Accept to receive orders in Normal Mode
Auto Printing Start
Wait time for printing
Display/Operation
Item Reference
Buzzer Volume*1 F Buzzer Test
Keyboard Buzzer*1
Buzzer Menu*1
*1. If you set the buzzer menu to other than Normal, you can not set the buzzer volume or keyboard sound.
Additional
Item Reference
Select the Type of Daily Totals reset
Film Carrier Rear Edge Fixed Dimension Frame Number
Frame No. Detect Error Correction (Negative)
Frame No. Detect Error Correction (Positive)
135 Negative Film Inserting Direction Detection Function
135/240 AMC Auto Focus
120 AFC Diffuser ☞ 34500
Paper Temperature Correction
Correction
Item Reference
DIGITAL ICE Technology Correction
DIGITAL ICE Technology Correction
Digital Masking Function
Positive Film Contrast Correction (120)
Positive Film Contrast Correction (others)
Positive Film Color Correction (120)
Positive Film Color Correction (others)
Judgment Image Sharpness Correction
CCD Noise Suppression
JPEG Block Noise Removal
Over Negative/Under Positive Frame Correction
31050 2/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31050
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
Photometry Memory Function
Image Save
Item Reference
Saving Passed Images
Output Media Image Format
Arrangement by Output Media Frame Number
d-Storage*1
Retention Period
CD-R/RW
Writing Folder Format
Automatic writing to the CD-R external writing system*2
3. Mode
Viewer Software Selection
DPOF File Output
HD
Destination Folder Selection
Auto Media Output
*1. The d-Storage appears if you register d-Storage TYPE2 in Option Registration.
*2. Automatic writing to the CD-R external writing system is available if you register CD-R external writing system or Bravo in Option
Registration.
Viewer
Item Reference
Simple Viewer Software Selection
Viewer Software for Windows
Viewer Software for Macintosh
Selection of Deluxe Viewer Software
Shop Data
Front
Item Reference
240
Imprinting Selection
Imprinting User Advice (Camera Data)
Media
DPOF Printing Specification
Exif Printing Specification
Front Print Letter Color
Edge Color of Front Print Character
Front Print Font Size
Background Color of Front Print Text
31050 3/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31050
Mode structure chart
Index
Item Reference
Hold of Index Print Counts
Archive Code Print
Reprint Code Print
135/120/110/Media
Index Print Specification
Prints of Order Number and Date
Print Date Setting
Minimum Index Print Frame Number
Arrangement by Frame Number
Index Print of Passed Frame
3. Mode
Index Print Background Color
240
Index Print Specification
Print of Title
Print Date Setting
Index Print Background Color
Print Counts for each Print Type Display
Print Type Frame Display
Print Type Display Position
Contact Print
Item Reference
Frame F Reading the contact print
Background Color frame
Number of Blank Frames on Long Roll Film
Line Feed per Film Strip
Line Space
NOTE
• The Contact Print tab appears by installing the software for making the contact print in option registration.
Contents of Imprint
Item Reference
Copyright Mark F Input Contents of
Imprint
CVP/Back Print Data F CVP Imprinting
Selection
Index/Logo Data
F Reading Logo Data
PU/Store Name
PU/Telephone Number
Processor
Item Reference
Replenishment Unit
Dryer Pre-heat
Drive, Dryer Manual ON Switch (SP1)
Error Occurrence Selection*1 ☞ 34500
Replenishment Error (SP1)
31050 4/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31050
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
Refilling Water Error (SP1)
Circulation Pump Error (SP1)
Order Classification Section Error (SP1)
*1. For the SM specification, refer to ☞ Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [SM].
Archive
Item Reference
Archive Selection
Archive Mode
Saving Passed Images*1
Preferred Code*3
Compact Archive Unit Type 2*2
3. Mode
Compact Archive Unit Output Setting*2
Output Image Quality
Output Image Size
*1. Appears if you select the Compact Archive Unit TYPE1 in Option Registration.
*2. Appears if you select the Compact Archive Unit TYPE2 in Option Registration.
*3. Appears if you select both the Compact Archive Unit and the d-Storage in Option Registration at the same time.
NOTE
• The Archive tab appears if you set Compact Archive in Option Registration.
Lens Aberration
Item Reference
Lens Aberration
Name
Insufficient Brightness of the Edge of
Image Field
Correction Strength
Aspect Ratio
Chromatic Aberration
Strength (Vertical)
Strength (Horizontal)
Deflection
Strength (Vertical)
Strength (Horizontal)
*1. Appears if you set Pricing Unit Type to Print at the Option Registration screen.
31050 5/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31050
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S2000-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Display items can be supplemented by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
! Operator Selections
Processor
Item Reference
Replenishment Unit
Dryer Pre-heat
Drive, Dryer Manual ON Switch (SP1)
Error Occurrence Selection ☞ 34500
Replenishment Error (SP1)
Replenishment Package Error (SP1)
Refilling Water Error (SP1)
Circulation Pump Error (SP1)
Order Classification Section Error (SP1)
31050 6/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31060
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S3000-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Maintenance
Item Reference
Various Adjustment Film Carrier Unit Adjustment ☞ 35000
☞ 35010
☞ 35020
☞ 35030
☞ 35040
☞ 35050
☞ 35060
Colorimeter Calibration
F Confirming the Colorimeter
and Calibration Plate Data
F Updating the Calibration Plate
Data
Colorimeter Unit Adjustment (SP1) ☞ 35100
F Test Paper Advance
F Paper Advance Test
F Cleaning Operation
Printer Mechanical Adjustment Paper Sensor Adjustment ☞ 36000
F Paper Sensor LED Light
Intensity Adjustment
Paper Advance Unit Correction ☞ 36010
(SP1)
F Arm Unit 2 (Left)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation
F Arm Unit 2 (Left)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation Confirmation
31060 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31060
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
F Arm Unit 2 (Right)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation
F Arm Unit 2 (Right)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation Confirmation
F Test Operation for the
Paper Stop Position
Correction
F Paper Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation Confirmation
3. Mode
Exposure Magnification ☞ 36020
Correction (SP1)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Exposure Position Adjustment ☞ 36030
(SP1)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Exposure Magnification Fine ☞ 36040
Adjustment (SP1)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
31060 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31060
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
Paper Advance Length ☞ 36050
Correction (SP1)
F Test Paper Advance
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Paper Advance
Confirmation (Paper
Magazine A)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Rewind
F Test Paper Advance
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Paper Advance
3. Mode
Confirmation (Paper
Magazine B)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
F Rewind
F Test Paper Advance
(Paper Magazine C)
F Test Paper Advance
Confirmation (Paper
Magazine C)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
Arm Unit 1 Zigzagging ☞ 36060
Correction
F Test Print 1 (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
1 (Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print 2 (Magazine
A)
F Test Print Confirmation
2 (Paper Magazine A)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Rewind
F Test Print 1 (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
1 (Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print 2 (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
2 (Paper Magazine B)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
F Rewind
F Test Print 1 (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
1 (Paper Magazine C)
31060 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31060
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
F Test Print 2 (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
2 (Paper Magazine C)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
Exposure Center Correction ☞ 36070
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A) without
Correction Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
3. Mode
with Master Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
with Master and Paper
Magazine Values
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Rewind
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B) without
Correction Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B) with
Master Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B) with
Master and Paper
Magazine Values
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
F Rewind
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C) without
Correction Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C) with
Master Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C) with
Master and Paper
Magazine Values
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
Exposure Advance Adjustment ☞ 36080
(SP1)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
31060 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31060
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
3. Mode
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller
Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Exit Roller Test
Print (Paper Magazine
A)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Exit Roller Test
Print (Paper Magazine
B)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Exit Roller Test
Print (Paper Magazine
C)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
Paper Pressure Operation ☞ 36090
Correction
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
31060 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31060
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
WB Width Correction ☞ 36100
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
3. Mode
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Scanner Unit Adjustment (SP1) Swing and Tilt/Light Axis ☞ 37000
Adjustment
Light Source Registration ☞ 37010
Focus Adjustment ☞ 37020
F Magnification Change
F Focus Auto Adjustment
F Result
Light Source Update ☞ 37030
Laser Unit Adjustment ☞ 37300
Compact Archive Unit Adjustment Compact Archive Unit ☞ 36700
Initialization
F Initialization of the
Compact Archive Unit
(SP1)
F Defragmentation of the
Compact Archive Unit
Compact Archive Unit Capacity ☞ 36710
Check (SP1)
Process Control Strip
Input Check Input Section ☞ 35200
Printer ☞ 35210
Processor ☞ 35220
Output Check Input Section ☞ 35300
Printer ☞ 35310
Processor ☞ 35320
Reading and Writing Data All Data Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy ☞ 35400
Disk)
Reading Data (Floppy Disk ->
CPU)
Format Floppy Disk
Reading Laser Record (Floppy
Disk -> CPU) (SP1)
Writing All Data (CPU ->
Media) (SP1)
Reading All Data (Media ->
CPU) (SP1)
31060 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31060
Mode structure chart
Item Reference
Service Data (SP1) Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy
Disk)
Reading Data (Floppy Disk ->
CPU)
Format Floppy Disk
Reading Laser Record (Floppy
Disk -> CPU)
Writing All Data (CPU ->
Media)
Reading All Data (Media ->
CPU)
System Version Check Accessories ☞ 35500
Profile Data (SP1)
3. Mode
DLL/Driver (SP1)
Software Upgrade Software Upgrade (CD-ROM) ☞ 35600
Software Upgrade (NET)
Software Upgrade (HD) (SP1)
Operation Information Error Record ☞ 35700
Daily Setup History
Laser Operation Record (SP1)
Machine Specification (SP2) ☞ 35800
F Program Timer Setting
F Machine Information
Self-diagnostic (SP1) Image Path Check ☞ 35920
Media Drive Self-diagnostic
31060 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31500
Mode structure chart
3. Mode
S0000-00-SM00
Order Display
Item Reference
Net Folder Registration
Receipt Record
31500 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31610
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
3. Mode
S0000-00-SM01
Order Display
Item Reference
F Menu
Scanner Lamp ON/OFF
Media Copy
Start Adobe Photoshop
Net Scan Mode ☞ 31670
Help Display
31610 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31620
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
3. Mode
S0000-00-SM02
Judgment Display
Item Reference
Screen Saver
Print Image Fine Adjustment
Top-Bottom Information Copy
Image Rotation (only 1 Frame)
[Y] Y-correction Copy
[M] M-correction Copy
[C] C-correction Copy
[D] Density Correction Copy
Panorama Shutter ON/OFF
Color Conversion
DSA
Top-Bottom Information
Change
Help Display
[-1] Image Rotation
[N] Correction Value, Counts
and DSA Hold
[REPT] Print Counts Copy
[+1] DSA Copy
[PASS] Passed frame copy
Photometry Memory
Copy Scene Correction
Scene Correction
Auto Correction Change
31620 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31630
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
3. Mode
S0003-00-SM01
S0019-01-SM01
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Menu display
Item Reference
Close Down Checks Quit the Close Down Checks
Quit The Application
Power OFF
Pricing Sheet Reissue*1
Daily Totals*1
Daily Setup
AFC Cleaning
31630 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31630
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
Item Reference
Extension Setup ☞ 31640
Operator Selections ☞ 31650
IX Data Settings Photofinishing Data Utilization
Noritsu-eNET Setting (SP1) Serial Number/Model Number Refer to Noritsu-eNET
setting system program
Network setting Setting Manual.
Dial-up setting
Upload configuration
Version check
e-mail setting
*1
Price Setting
Option Registration Option
3. Mode
Media
Option Software
Password Registration
Maintenance ☞ 31660
*1. This function cannot be used in the Stand Alone Scanner.
31630 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31640
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
3. Mode
S1000-00-SM01
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Setup
Item Reference
Print Channel Print Channel Selection Setting
Cut
Copy
Scanner Setup Scanner Slope Correction (Negative) Master Data
Scanner Slope
For each film size
Reference Slope
DX Slope
Scanner Slope Correction (Positive) Master Data
Scanner Slope
For each film size
Scanner Slope
Parameters (Negative) Parameter 1 ☞ 32590
Parameter 2
Parameter 3
Service Parameter (SP1) ☞ 32500
Light Source Update
Light Source Registration (SP1) ☞ 37010
Area Registration (SP1) ☞ 32570
Flatbed Scanner Setup
Master Data Paper Temperature Correction
Key Difference Ratio Setting
DSA
Monitor Setup ☞ 32540
31640 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31640
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
Item Reference
Data Initialization (SP1) All Data ☞ 32560
Main
Auto Film Carrier
Image Processing
Pricing Unit
Scanner
Create Template Package Edit Edit Existing Format
New
New (Use division wizard)
3. Mode
31640 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31650
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
3. Mode
S2000-00-SM02
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
! Operator Selections
Judgment Operation
Item Reference
Hold Key Reset
240 Print Counts User Advice (Camera Data)*1
PJP/AUTO/PPI Automatic Order
Judgment Display Specification
Display Design
Number of Display Items Switch
Color of PASS Frame
Color Selection of Frame Display
Selecting Judgment Type for the Input Media
Image Change of Judgment Display Screen Saver
Print Operation
Item Reference
Auto Calculation of Print Channel Scanning Magnification
PPI Image Decision Time
31650 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31650
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
Display/Operation
Item Reference
*1
Buzzer Volume F Buzzer Test
Keyboard Buzzer*1
Buzzer Menu*1
*1. If you set the buzzer menu to other than Normal, you cannot set the buzzer volume or keyboard sound.
Additional
Item Reference
Select the Type of Daily Totals reset
Film Carrier Rear Edge Fixed Dimension Frame Number
Frame No. Detect Error Correction (Negative)
3. Mode
Frame No. Detect Error Correction (Positive)
135 Negative Film Inserting Direction Detection Function
135/240 AMC Auto Focus
120 AFC Diffuser ☞ 34500
Correction
Item Reference
DIGITAL ICE Technology Correction
DIGITAL ICE Technology Correction
Digital Masking Function
Digital Masking Unit
Positive Film Contrast Correction (120)
Positive Film Contrast Correction (others)
Positive Film Color Correction (120)
Positive Film Color Correction (others)
Judgment Image Sharpness Correction
CCD Noise Suppression
JPEG Block Noise Removal
Over Negative/Under Positive Frame Correction
Photometry Memory Function
Image Save
Item Reference
Saving Passed Images
Arrangement by Output Media Frame Number
d-Storage*1
Retention Period
CD-R/RW
Writing Folder Format
Automatic writing to the CD-R external writing system*2
Viewer Software Selection
DPOF File Output
HD
Destination Folder Selection
Auto Media Output
*1. The d-Storage appears if you register d-Storage TYPE2 in Option Registration.
*2. Automatic writing to the CD-R external writing system is available if you register CD-R external writing system or Bravo in Option
Registration.
31650 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31650
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
Viewer
Item Reference
Simple Viewer Software Selection
Viewer Software for Windows
Viewer Software for Macintosh
Selection of Deluxe Viewer Software
Shop Data
Archive
Item Reference
Archive Selection
Archive Mode
3. Mode
Saving Passed Images*1
Preferred Code*3
Compact Archive Unit Type 2*2
Compact Archive Unit Output Setting*2
Output Image Quality
Output Image Size
*1. Appears if you select the Compact Archive Unit TYPE1 in Option Registration.
*2. Appears if you select the Compact Archive Unit TYPE2 in Option Registration.
*3. Appears if you select both the Compact Archive Unit and the d-Storage in Option Registration at the same time.
NOTE
• The Archive tab appears if you set Compact Archive in Option Registration.
Lens Aberration
Item Reference
Lens Aberration
Name
Insufficient Brightness of the Edge of
Image Field
Correction Strength
Aspect Ratio
Chromatic Aberration
Strength (Vertical)
Strength (Horizontal)
Deflection
Strength (Vertical)
Strength (Horizontal)
31650 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31660
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
3. Mode
S3000-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Maintenance
Item Reference
Various Adjustment Film Carrier Unit Adjustment ☞ 35000
☞ 35010
☞ 35020
☞ 35030
☞ 35040
☞ 35050
☞ 35060
Scanner Unit Adjustment (SP1) Swing and Tilt/Light Axis ☞ 37000
Adjustment
Light Source Registration ☞ 37010
Focus Adjustment ☞ 37020
Magnification Change
Focus Auto Adjustment
Result
Light Source Update ☞ 37030
Compact Archive Unit Adjustment Compact Archive Unit ☞ 36700
Initialization
Initialization of the
Compact Archive Unit
Defragmentation of the
Compact Archive Unit
Compact Archive Unit Capacity Check ☞ 36710
Input Check Input Section ☞ 35200
Output Check Input Section ☞ 35300
31660 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31660
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
Item Reference
Reading and Writing Data All Data Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy ☞ 35410
Disk)
Reading Data (Floppy Disk ->
CPU)
Format Floppy Disk
Writing All Data (CPU ->
Media) (SP1)
Reading All Data (Media ->
CPU) (SP1)
Service Data (SP1) Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy
Disk)
Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy
Disk)
3. Mode
Format Floppy Disk
Writing All Data (CPU ->
Media)
Reading All Data (Media ->
CPU)
System Version Check Accessories ☞ 35500
Profile Data (SP1)
DLL/Driver (SP1)
Software Upgrade Software Upgrade (CD-ROM) ☞ 35600
Software Upgrade (NET)
Software Upgrade (HD) (SP1)
Operation Information Error Record ☞ 35700
Machine Specification (SP2) ☞ 35810
Program Timer Setting
Machine Information
Self-diagnostic (SP1) ☞ 35920
31660 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31670
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Scanner)
3. Mode
S0000-00-SM06
31670 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31710
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
3. Mode
S0000-00-SM03
Order Display
Item Reference
Menu
Processor Drive ON/OFF
Rewind Paper
Media Copy
Start Adobe Photoshop
Net Order Mode ☞ 31500
Start Bravo Utility Refer to the Bravo
Service Manual.
Help Display
31710 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31720
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
3. Mode
S0250-00-SM32
Judgment Display
Item Reference
Screen Saver
Print Size Change
Print Size Copy
DSA
1 Frame Magnification
Cancel 1 Frame Magnification
Setting
Print Image Fine Adjustment
Top-Bottom Information
Change
Top-Bottom Information Copy
Help Display
Image Rotation (only 1 Frame)
[-1] Image Rotation
[N] Correction Value, Counts
and DSA Hold
[Y] Y-correction Copy
[M] M-correction Copy
[C] C-correction Copy
[D] Density Correction Copy
[REPT] Print Counts Copy
[+1] DSA Copy
[PASS] Passed frame copy
Reading Test Print Correction
Value
31720 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31720
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Color Conversion
Frame Selection
Photometry Memory
Change Front Print Setting
Cropping Operations Copy
Auto Red Eye Correction
Change
Scene Correction
Copy Scene Correction
Copy Correction Data
Auto Correction Change
3. Mode
31720 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31730
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
3. Mode
S0003-00-SM02
S0019-01-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Menu display
Item Reference
Close Down Checks Quit the Close Down Checks
Quit The Application
Power OFF
Pricing Sheet Reissue*1
Daily Totals
Daily Setup
Emulsion Number Change
31730 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31730
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Cleaning of Arm Unit 1
Extension Setup ☞ 31740
Processor Settings ☞ 31040
Operator Selections ☞ 31760
Noritsu-eNET Setting (SP1) Serial Number/Model Number Refer to Noritsu-eNET
setting system program
Network setting Setting Manual.
Dial-up setting
Upload configuration
Version check
e-mail setting
Price Setting*1
3. Mode
Option Registration Option
Media
Option Software
Password Registration
Maintenance ☞ 31770
*1. This function cannot be used in the Stand Alone Printer.
31730 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31740
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
3. Mode
S1000-00-SM02
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Setup
Item Reference
Laser Setup Paper Specification Registration/Setup ☞ 32510
Profile Chart Output
Printer Profile Calibration
Print Check
Black Balance Adjustment
Black Balance Adjustment (Manual)
Setup Switch
Magazine Registration/Setup ☞ 32520
Paper Specification Registration/Setup
Paper Setup
Print Channel Print Channel Selection Setting
Cut
Copy
Paste
Export
Flatbed Scanner Setup
Master Data Paper Temperature Correction
Key Difference Ratio Setting
DSA
Monitor Setup ☞ 32530
31740 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31740
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Data Initialization (SP1) All Data ☞ 32561
Main
Image Processing
Printer
Processor
Colorimeter Unit
Pricing Unit
LASER
Correction Data for Brightness of the
Edge of Image Field
Initial Setup (SP1)
Create Template Package Edit Edit Existing Format
3. Mode
New
New (Use division wizard)
31740 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31760
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
3. Mode
S2000-00-SM03
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
! Operator Selections
Judgment Operation
Item Reference
Hold Key Reset
PJP/AUTO/PPI Automatic Order
Sort Function by Each Frame
Judgment Display Specification
Display Design
Number of Display Items Switch
Color of PASS Frame
Color Selection of Print Frame Display
Color Selection of Frame Display
Color Selection of Print Frame for 1 Frame Magnification Display
Color Selection of Print Frame for 1 Frame Magnification Resetting
Selecting Judgment Type for the Input Media
Image Change of Judgment Display Screen Saver
Print Operation
Item Reference
Magazine Auto Change
Remaining Paper Amount Display
31760 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31760
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Paper Leading Edge Advance
Color Selection of Print Margin except Positive Film
PPI Image Decision Time
Net Order Mode
Spooler Place
Spooler Capacity
Spooler Used Space
Data to be sorted
Sort Order
Accept to receive orders in Normal Mode
Auto Printing Start
Wait time for printing
3. Mode
Display/Operation
Item Reference
Buzzer Volume*1 Buzzer Test
Keyboard Buzzer*1
Buzzer Menu*1
*1. If you set the buzzer menu to other than Normal, you cannot set the buzzer volume or keyboard sound.
Additional
Item Reference
Select the Type of Daily Totals reset
Paper Temperature Correction
Correction
Item Reference
Judgment Image Sharpness Correction
JPEG Block Noise Removal
Image Save
Item Reference
Saving Passed Images
Output Media Image Format
d-Storage*1
Retention Period
CD-R/RW
Writing Folder Format
Automatic writing to the CD-R external writing system*1
Viewer Software Selection
DPOF File Output
HD
Destination Folder Selection
Auto Media Output
31760 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31760
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Viewer
Item Reference
Simple Viewer Software Selection
Viewer Software for Windows
Viewer Software for Macintosh
Selection of Deluxe Viewer Software
Shop Data
Front
Item Reference
Media
DPOF Printing Specification
3. Mode
Exif Printing Specification
Front Print Letter Color
Edge Color of Front Print Character
Front Print Font Size
Background Color of Front Print Text
Index
Item Reference
Hold of Index Print Counts
Archive Code Print*1
Reprint Code Print*1
135/120/110/Media
Index Print Specification
Prints of Order Number and Date
Print Date Setting
Minimum Index Print Frame Number
Frame(s)
Index Print of Passed Frame
Index Print Background Color
Contents of Imprint
Item Reference
Copyright Mark Input Contents of
Imprint
CVP/Back Print Data CVP Imprinting
Selection
Index/Logo Data
Reading Logo Data
PU/Store Name*1
PU/Telephone Number*1
Processor
Item Reference
Replenishment Unit
Dryer Pre-heat
Drive, Dryer Manual ON Switch
31760 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31760
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
*1
Error Occurrence Selection ☞ 34500
Replenishment Error (SP1)
Refilling Water Error (SP1)
Circulation Pump Error (SP1)
Order Classification Section Error (SP1)
*1. For the SM specification, refer to ☞ Mode structure chart (Operator Selections) [SM] [Stand Alone Printer].
Archive
Item Reference
Archive Selection
Archive Mode
3. Mode
Saving Passed Images
Preferred Code
Compact Archive Unit Type 2
Compact Archive Unit Output Setting
Output Image Quality
Output Image Size
Lens Aberration
Item Reference
Lens Aberration
Name
Insufficient Brightness of the Edge of
Image Field
Correction Strength
Aspect Ratio
Chromatic Aberration
Strength (Vertical)
Strength (Horizontal)
Deflection
Strength (Vertical)
Strength (Horizontal)
*1. Appears if you set Pricing Unit Type to Print at the Option Registration screen.
31760 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31760
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
3. Mode
S2000-00-SM03
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Display items can be supplemented by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
! Operator Selections
Processor
Item Reference
Replenishment Unit
Dryer Pre-heat
Drive, Dryer Manual ON Switch
Error Occurrence Selection ☞ 34500
Replenishment Error (SP1)
Replenishment Package Error (SP1)
Refilling Water Error (SP1)
Circulation Pump Error (SP1)
Order Classification Section Error (SP1)
31760 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31770
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
3. Mode
S3000-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Maintenance
Item Reference
Various Adjustment Colorimeter Calibration
Confirming the Colorimeter
and Calibration Plate Data
Updating the Calibration Plate
Data
Colorimeter Unit Adjustment (SP1) ☞ 35100
Test Paper Advance
Paper Advance Test
Cleaning Operation
Printer Mechanical Adjustment Paper Sensor Adjustment ☞ 36000
Paper Sensor LED Light
Intensity Adjustment
Paper Advance Unit Correction ☞ 36010
(SP1)
Arm Unit 2 (Left)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation
Arm Unit 2 (Left)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation Confirmation
Arm Unit 2 (Right)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation
Arm Unit 2 (Right)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation Confirmation
31770 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31770
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Test Operation for the
Paper Stop Position
Correction
Paper Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation Confirmation
Exposure Magnification ☞ 36020
Correction (SP1)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
Test Print (Paper
3. Mode
Magazine C)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Exposure Position Adjustment ☞ 36030
(SP1)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Exposure Magnification Fine ☞ 36040
Adjustment (SP1)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Paper Advance Length ☞ 36050
Correction (SP1)
Test Paper Advance
(Paper Magazine A)
Test Paper Advance
Confirmation (Paper
Magazine A)
31770 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31770
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
Rewind
Test Paper Advance
(Paper Magazine B)
Test Paper Advance
Confirmation (Paper
Magazine B)
Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
Rewind
Test Paper Advance
(Paper Magazine C)
3. Mode
Test Paper Advance
Confirmation (Paper
Magazine C)
Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
Rewind
Arm Unit 1 Zigzagging ☞ 36060
Correction
Test Print 1 (Paper
Magazine A)
Test Print Confirmation
1 (Paper Magazine A)
Test Print 2 (Magazine
A)
Test Print Confirmation
2 (Paper Magazine A)
Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
Rewind
Test Print 1 (Paper
Magazine B)
Test Print Confirmation
1 (Paper Magazine B)
Test Print 2 (Paper
Magazine B)
Test Print Confirmation
2 (Paper Magazine B)
Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
Rewind
Test Print 1 (Paper
Magazine C)
Test Print Confirmation
1 (Paper Magazine C)
Test Print 2 (Paper
Magazine C)
Test Print Confirmation
2 (Paper Magazine C)
Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
Rewind
31770 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31770
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Exposure Center Correction ☞ 36070
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A) without
Correction Value
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
with Master Value
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
with Master and Paper
Magazine Values
Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
3. Mode
Rewind
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B) without
Correction Value
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B) with
Master Value
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B) with
Master and Paper
Magazine Values
Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
Rewind
Test Print (Paper
Magazine C) without
Correction Value
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C) with
Master Value
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C) with
Master and Paper
Magazine Values
Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
Rewind
Exposure Advance Adjustment ☞ 36080
(SP1)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
31770 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31770
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller
Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
Exposure Advance
Pressure Exit Roller Test
3. Mode
Print (Paper Magazine
A)
Exposure Advance
Pressure Exit Roller Test
Print (Paper Magazine
B)
Exposure Advance
Pressure Exit Roller Test
Print (Paper Magazine
C)
Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
Rewind
Paper Pressure Operation ☞ 36090
Correction
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
Rewind
WB Width Correction ☞ 36100
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
31770 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31770
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Laser Unit Adjustment (SP2) ☞ 37300
Compact Archive Unit Adjustment*1 ☞ 36700
Compact Archive Unit Capacity Check*1 ☞ 36710
3. Mode
Process Control Strip
Input Check Input Section ☞ 35200
Printer ☞ 35210
Processor ☞ 35220
Output Check Input Section ☞ 35300
Printer ☞ 35310
Processor ☞ 35320
Reading and Writing Data All Data Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy ☞ 35400
Disk)
Reading Data (Floppy Disk ->
CPU)
Format Floppy Disk
Reading Laser Record (Floppy
Disk -> CPU) (SP1)
Writing All Data (CPU ->
Media) (SP1)
Reading All Data (Media ->
CPU) (SP1)
Service Data (SP1) Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy
Disk)
Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy
Disk)
Format Floppy Disk
Reading Laser Record (Floppy
Disk -> CPU)
Writing All Data (CPU ->
Media)
Reading All Data (Media ->
CPU)
System Version Check Accessories ☞ 35500
Profile Data (SP1)
DLL/Driver (SP1)
Software Upgrade Software Upgrade (CD-ROM) ☞ 35600
Software Upgrade (NET)
Software Upgrade (HD) (SP1)
Operation Information Error Record ☞ 35700
Daily Setup History
Laser Operation Record (SP1)
Machine Specification (SP2) ☞ 35800
31770 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
31770
Mode structure chart (Stand Alone Printer)
Item Reference
Program Timer Setting
Machine Information
Self-diagnostic (SP1) ☞ 35920
*1. This function cannot be used in the Stand Alone Printer.
3. Mode
31770 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32000
DLS mode structure chart
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S072402
Operator display
Item Reference
Order Picture Package
Custom
Preview Density & Color
Filter
Lighting Correction
Zoom & Crop
Red Eye Correction
Dust & Scratch
Borders & Text
Order Status WIP
Archive
System Status Printer ☞ Printer Status display
Scanner
Media Input
Media Output
System
Output Metering
Help
Manage Operator
Key Operator
Service Operator
QSS Menu
32000 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32000
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S072405
32000 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32000
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S072406
32000 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32010
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S072404
Order Display
Item Reference
F Menu
Scanner Lamp ON/OFF
Processor Drive ON/OFF
Rewind Paper
Help Display
32010 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32020
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S0003-00-SM00DLS
S0019-01-SM00DLS
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Menu display
Item Reference
Close Down Checks*1 Quit the Close Down Checks
Quit The Application
Power OFF
Daily Totals Totals of paper processing
Daily Setup
Emulsion Number Change
AFC Cleaning
32020 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32020
DLS mode structure chart
Item Reference
Cleaning of Arm Unit 1
Extension Setup ☞ 31030
Processor Settings ☞ 31040
Operator Selections ☞ 31050
Option Registration Option
Option Software
Password Registration
Maintenance ☞ 31060
*1. When the service personnel password (2260) has been entered, the value of Total Counter in Daily Totals can be reset.
3. Mode
32020 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32030
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S1000-00-SM00DLS
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Setup
Item Reference
Laser Setup Paper Specification Registration/Setup ☞ 32510
F Setup Switch
Magazine Registration/Setup ☞ 32520
F Paper Specification Registration/Setup
Scanner Setup Parameters (Negative) Service Parameter (SP1) ☞ 32500
Light Source Update
Light Source Registration (SP1) ☞ 37010
Area Registration (SP1) ☞ 32570
Master Data Paper Temperature Correction
Data Initialization (SP1) All Data ☞ 32550
Main
Auto Film Carrier
Image Processing
Printer
Processor
Colorimeter Unit
LASER
Correction Data for Brightness of the
Edge of Image Field
Scanner
Initial Setup (SP1)
32030 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32040
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S4000-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Processor Settings
Item Reference
Processing Solution
Temperature Setting
Standard Replenishment
Amount Setting
F Manual Replenishment
Pump Output Amount Setting ☞ 33030
(SP1)
F Pump Output Amount
Measurement
F Initial Replenishment
Operation (SP1)
Total Replenishment Amount ☞ 33040
Display (SP2)
Dryer Temperature Setting
Processor Standard Setting Thermosensor Calibration ☞ 33500
(SP1) Refilling Water Amount Setting ☞ 33510
Cleaning Water Amount Setting ☞ 33580
Dryer Lane Select Operation Setting ☞ 33590
Drive Motor Revolution Count Setting ☞ 33600
F: Drive Motor Revolution Count
Auto Adjustment
32040 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32040
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S4200-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Processor Settings
Item Reference
Processing Solution
Temperature Setting
Standard Replenishment
Amount Setting
Pump Output Amount Setting ☞ 33030
(SP2)
F Pump Output Amount
Setting
F Initial Replenishment
Operation (SP1)
Total Replenishment Amount ☞ 33040
Display (SP2)
F Package Capacity
Setting (SP1)
F SM Forced
Replenishment Amount
Setting (SP1)
Dryer Temperature Setting
Correction Setting (SP2) ☞ 33060
Processor Standard Setting Thermosensor Calibration ☞ 33500
(SP1) Refilling Water Amount Setting ☞ 33510
Cleaning Water Amount Setting ☞ 33580
Dryer Lane Select Operation Setting☞ 33500 ☞ 33590
Drive Motor Revolution Count Setting ☞ 33600
F: Drive Motor Revolution Count Auto
Adjustment
32040 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32050
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S2000-00-SM00DLS
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
! Operator Selections
Print Operation
Item Reference
Remaining Paper Amount Display
Paper Leading Edge Advance
Display/Operation
Item Reference
Buzzer Volume F Buzzer Test
Additional
Item Reference
Film Carrier Rear Edge Fixed Dimension Frame Number
Frame No. Detect Error Correction (Negative)
Frame No. Detect Error Correction (Positive)
135 Negative Film Inserting Direction Detection Function
Paper Temperature Correction
Processor
Item Reference
Replenishment Unit
Dryer Pre-heat
Drive, Dryer Manual ON Switch (SP1)
Error Occurrence Selection ☞ 34500
Replenishment Error (SP1)
Refilling Water Error (SP1)
Circulation Pump Error (SP1)
Order Classification Section Error (SP1)
32050 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32050
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S2000-00-SM01DLS
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Display items can be supplemented by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
! Operator Selections
Processor
Item Reference
Replenishment Unit
Dryer Pre-heat
Drive, Dryer Manual ON Switch (SP1)
Error Occurrence Selection ☞ 34500
Replenishment Error (SP1)
Replenishment Package Error (SP1)
Refilling Water Error (SP1)
Circulation Pump Error (SP1)
Order Classification Section Error (SP1)
32050 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32060
DLS mode structure chart
3. Mode
S3000-00-SM00
• SP1: Mode can be selected by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
• SP2: Data can be changed by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
Maintenance
Item Reference
Various Adjustment Film Carrier Unit Adjustment ☞ 35000
☞ 35010
☞ 35020
☞ 35030
☞ 35040
☞ 35060
Colorimeter Calibration
F Confirming the Colorimeter
and Calibration Plate Data
F Updating the Calibration Plate
Data
Colorimeter Unit Adjustment (SP1) ☞ 35100
F Test Paper Advance
F Paper Advance Test
F Cleaning Operation
Printer Mechanical Adjustment Paper Sensor Adjustment ☞ 36000
F Paper Sensor LED Light
Intensity Adjustment
Paper Advance Unit Correction ☞ 36010
(SP1)
F Arm Unit 2 (Left)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation
F Arm Unit 2 (Left)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation Confirmation
32060 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32060
DLS mode structure chart
Item Reference
F Arm Unit 2 (Right)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation
F Arm Unit 2 (Right)
Receive Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation Confirmation
F Test Operation for the
Paper Stop Position
Correction
F Paper Stop Position
Correction Test
Operation Confirmation
3. Mode
Exposure Magnification ☞ 36020
Correction (SP1)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Exposure Position Adjustment ☞ 36030
(SP1)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Exposure Magnification Fine ☞ 36040
Adjustment (SP1)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
32060 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32060
DLS mode structure chart
Item Reference
Paper Advance Length ☞ 36050
Correction (SP1)
F Test Paper Advance
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Paper Advance
Confirmation (Paper
Magazine A)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Rewind
F Test Paper Advance
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Paper Advance
3. Mode
Confirmation (Paper
Magazine B)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
F Rewind
F Test Paper Advance
(Paper Magazine C)
F Test Paper Advance
Confirmation (Paper
Magazine C)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
Arm Unit 1 Zigzagging ☞ 36060
Correction
F Test Print 1 (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
1 (Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print 2 (Magazine
A)
F Test Print Confirmation
2 (Paper Magazine A)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Rewind
F Test Print 1 (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
1 (Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print 2 (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
2 (Paper Magazine B)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
F Rewind
F Test Print 1 (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
1 (Paper Magazine C)
32060 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32060
DLS mode structure chart
Item Reference
F Test Print 2 (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
2 (Paper Magazine C)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
Exposure Center Correction ☞ 36070
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A) without
Correction Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
3. Mode
with Master Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
with Master and Paper
Magazine Values
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Rewind
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B) without
Correction Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B) with
Master Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B) with
Master and Paper
Magazine Values
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
F Rewind
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C) without
Correction Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C) with
Master Value
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C) with
Master and Paper
Magazine Values
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
Exposure Advance Adjustment ☞ 36080
(SP1)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
32060 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32060
DLS mode structure chart
Item Reference
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller
Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller
Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
3. Mode
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller
Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Exit Roller Test
Print (Paper Magazine
A)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Exit Roller Test
Print (Paper Magazine
B)
F Exposure Advance
Pressure Exit Roller Test
Print (Paper Magazine
C)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
Paper Pressure Operation ☞ 36090
Correction
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine A)
F Loading (Paper
Magazine B)
32060 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32060
DLS mode structure chart
Item Reference
F Loading (Paper
Magazine C)
F Rewind
WB Width Correction ☞ 36100
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine A)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine B)
F Test Print (Paper
Magazine C)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine A)
F Test Print Confirmation
3. Mode
(Paper Magazine B)
F Test Print Confirmation
(Paper Magazine C)
Scanner Unit Adjustment (SP1) Swing and Tilt/Light Axis ☞ 37000
Adjustment
Light Source Registration ☞ 37010
Focus Adjustment ☞ 37020
F Magnification Change
F Focus Auto Adjustment
F Result
Light Source Update ☞ 37030
Laser Unit Adjustment ☞ 37300
Process Control Strip
Input Check Input Section ☞ 35200
Printer ☞ 35210
Processor ☞ 35220
Output Check Input Section ☞ 35300
Printer ☞ 35310
Processor ☞ 35320
Reading and Writing Data All Data Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy ☞ 35400
Disk)
Reading Data (Floppy Disk ->
CPU)
Format Floppy Disk
Reading Laser Record (Floppy
Disk -> CPU) (SP1)
Writing All Data (CPU ->
Media) (SP1)
Reading All Data (Media ->
CPU) (SP1)
Service Data (SP1) Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy
Disk)
Writing Data (CPU -> Floppy
Disk)
Format Floppy Disk
Reading Laser Record (Floppy
Disk -> CPU)
Writing All Data (CPU ->
Media)
32060 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32060
DLS mode structure chart
Item Reference
Reading All Data (Media ->
CPU)
System Version Check Accessories ☞ 35500
Profile Data
DLL/Driver
Software Upgrade Software Upgrade (CD-ROM) ☞ 35600
Software Upgrade (HD) (SP1)
Operation Information Error Record ☞ 35700
Daily Setup History
Laser Operation Record (SP1)
Machine Specification (SP2) ☞ 35800
F Program Timer Setting
3. Mode
F Machine Information
Self-diagnostic (SP1) ☞ 35920
32060 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32500
Setup
Setup
3. Mode
! Auto Red Eye Correction Judgment Rate
(Tungsten) (Initial value: 0) (Input range: −99 to
+99)
The strength of the auto red eye correction judgement for the
film that was shot under a tungsten light can be adjusted.
In the case of the film that was shot under a tungsten light, the
area other than eyes may be corrected incorrectly because face
is reddish.
G074621 NOTE
NOTE • As the setting value gets smaller, the auto red eye
• Only the Digital Masking Silverization Assessment Level is correction for the film that was taken under a weaker
shown onscreen for DLS specification systems. tungsten light will not be carried out.
Adjust the DSA contrast. Use this function to collect the correction pattern data at
When the setting value is set to 0 or 10, it is adjusted by the customer's shop. The correction data of PJP is output to
default value. When the setting value is set to 1, the whole C:\Noritsukoki\QSS-32_33\Tmp\ANALYSER.TXT.
area of DSA auto contrast (AC), high light area (ACh) and 0 Not output to the file.
shadow area (ACs) are adjusted by the tenth part of the default
1 Output to the file.
value.
With the setting value of 2, 3⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅10, the default value
goes like 2/10, 3/10⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅10/10. ! Tungsten Negative Correction Rate (Initial
NOTE value: 80) (Input range: 0 to 99)
• For example, if the value of 2 is not sufficient but the Set the correction rate when the scanner judges that the
value of 3 is too much in adjusting the contrast, set the negative that was taken under a tungsten light. A setting value
value to 5 for DSA Contrast Difference Ratio and set the of 80 corresponds to no correction. The smaller the value, the
value to 5 for AC. This means the value of DSA Contrast greater the correction.
Difference Ratio is set to 0 and that of AC is set to 2.5.
32500 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32500
Setup
! Digital Masking Silverization Judgment Level If image cannot be read, change the setting value to -2 and
(Initial value: 0) (Input range: -75 to +25) repeat the same procedure.
3. Mode
IMPORTANT
! CF (Initial value: 80) (Input range: 0 to 99) • Do not change the setting. This function is not in
use.
Correction rate for the color failure can be set.
The setting of small value makes a color failure occurs easily ! Basic Color Correction Switch (Initial value: 0)
but pure colors can be obtained. (Input range: 0 to 1)
The default value is 80. 1 The negative color correction used before upgrading
99 the software (same as Ver. 2.02)
0 The negative color correction after upgrading the
software
32500 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32500
Setup
Detail of effect
A As against the color correction: 0, standard color
correction: 0, the change of the color to the yellow tone
under the same scene can be controlled.
B As against the correction of A, the change of the color to
the yellow tone under the same scene can be controlled.
C As against the correction of A, the color failure can be
controlled. However, the effect of 1CH decreases.
D As against the correction of A, the color correction at the
under scene can be controlled.
E As against the correction of B, the color correction at the
under scene can be controlled.
F As against the correction of C, the color correction at the
under scene can be controlled.
3. Mode
32500 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32510
Setup
Paper Specification
Registration/Setup
3. Mode
Unexposed length of leading end: 12 mm
S1028-00-SM00
Selection
A maximum of three available paper types can be set.
G068484
32510 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32510
Setup
! Functions Make two sheets of 22-step setup prints and one sheet of 20-
step test print.
! Profile Chart Output
Make five test prints for creating the printer profile.
NOTE
• The service personnel password (2260) is required to
display this.
9.5 mm
89mm
9.5 mm
3. Mode
9.5 mm
89mm
9.5 mm
9.5 mm
89mm G068484
! Print Check
9.5 mm
9.5 mm
When a problem occurs, sample images 1 to 7 are printed.
Then, the machine can be checked using the sample prints.
89mm
Sample 1: Print for CMS and gamma checks
A print of sample image with the CMS setting ON.
9.5 mm
14.5 mm
Sample 2: Print for CMS and gamma checks
A print of sample image with the CMS setting OFF
89mm
Sample 3: Letter confirmation print
14.5 mm A print of letter image.
32510 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32510
Setup
3. Mode
G068486
G063985
! Setup Switch
When the setup switch is ON, high density section is
calculated and setup to be the most appropriate Dmax.
When the setup switch is OFF, setup within the range of the
colorimeter specification (Dmax: 2.2 D or less).
IMPORTANT
• If you change the setup switch, it is necessary to
carry out the operation from the initial setup again.
32510 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32520
Setup
Magazine Registration/Setup The test print is one sheet of gray 22-step setup print.
3. Mode
G068485
IMPORTANT
• To carry out Magazine Registration/Setup, Paper
Specification Registration/Setup of the paper
type needs to be completed.
NOTE
• The test prints are printed 3 times at most.
S1035-00-SM00
! Functions
! Explanation
The paper magazine to be used is registered and the paper ! Paper Specification Registration/Setup
gamma setup is carried out. Paper Specification Registration/Setup is linked, and Paper
Specification Registration/Setup can be carried out.
Setup OK The magazine is registered for setup and
its paper specification is also registered.
☞ 32510
Setup − The magazine is registered for setup and
its paper specification is not registered.
Magazine OK The magazine not for setup is registered
Registration and the magazine registration setup is
completed.
Magazine − The magazine not for setup is registered
Registration and the magazine registration setup is not
completed.
− The magazine not for setup is not
registered and the magazine registration
setup is not completed.
32520 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32530
Setup
Brightness adjustment
Monitor setup
3. Mode
! Brightness Adjustment
Carry out the following adjustment using the hard key (button)
of the display monitor.
1. Make setting for color temperature according
to the value displayed on the monitor.
S1030-00-SM00
2. Set the contrast to the maximum.
! Explanation 3. Adjust the brightness so that the difference
of the density between the BGR digital
The display monitor can be adjusted basically and
values 0, 0, 0 and 10,10,10 can barely be
mechanically. Also display monitor color can be adjusted to
the print color according to the operating environment of the
recognized.
machine.
! Monitor Setup
IMPORTANT
• Before carrying out the monitor setup, check if the 1. Make a test print.
color can be recognized at your working place. If
NOTE
necessary, change the environment of the working
place. • When Only Color Adjustment Pattern is
selected, one test print for adjustment is made.
! Brightness Adjustment When All is selected, seven prints including a test
print for adjustment are made.
Carry out the basic adjustment using the hard key (button) of
the display monitor. 2. According to the instructions on the display,
adjust the monitor color so that the sample
IMPORTANT
• The brightness adjustment is required according to
the operating environment.
! Monitor Setup
Make a test print and adjust the monitor color by visual check.
32530 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32530
Setup
3. Mode
Color pallet
S1241-02-SM00
S1241-02-SM01
Color pallet
Compare the sample image on the display with the test
print. You can adjust the monitor color by selecting the
color pallet using the mouse.
Image selection section
Compare the sample image on the display with the test
print. You can adjust the monitor color by selecting the
sample image.
REPT: Data Initialization
The monitor calibration data is initialized.
N: Check
Images which is adjusted and not adjusted are
displayed.
32530 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32540
Setup
Brightness adjustment
Monitor setup
3. Mode
! Brightness Adjustment
Carry out the following adjustment using the hard key (button)
of the display monitor.
1. Make setting for color temperature according
to the value displayed on the monitor.
2. Set the contrast to the maximum.
3. Adjust the brightness so that the difference
S1030-00-SM00
! Monitor Setup
Color can be visually adjusted.
IMPORTANT
• In case of the Stand Alone Scanner, any sample
print cannot be made. Therefore, the color matching
cannot be performed. The sample image can be
adjusted so that it seems as standard color.
Color pallet
S1241-02-SM00
32540 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32540
Setup
3. Mode
Image selection section
S1241-02-SM01
Color pallet
By selecting the color pallet with the mouse, you can
adjust the monitor color so that the sample image on
the monitor seems to be the standard color.
Image selection section
By selecting a sample image, you can adjust the
monitor color so that the sample image on the monitor
seems to be the standard color.
REPT: Data Initialization
The monitor calibration data is initialized.
N: Check
Images which is adjusted and not adjusted are
displayed.
ORDER: Save profile
The monitor profile data that matches the setting is
made and overwritten the data.
D: Detail Setting
Detail setting screen is displayed and the selected
image can be corrected in detail.
3. After all adjustments are finished, select
Save Profile. A new monitor profile is made
and the data is overwritten.
32540 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32550
Setup
Data Initialization
3. Mode
S1022-00-SM00
! Explanation
The data which is saved in the PC can be initialized.
IMPORTANT
• Before initializing the data, backup the data (data writing).
If the data has been initialized by mistake, the data can be restored to the original by reading out the backup floppy
disk data or the backup media. However, be sure to update the light source when reading out data from the floppy
disk.
☞ 35400
• If there is a backup data of the service personal level, each data can be written individually.
• In case of the backup data of the user level, each data cannot be written individually.
32550 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32550
Setup
3. Mode
Misreg240_4
Misreg240_5 (*1)
Misreg240_7
Misreg240_8
Misreg240_9
Misreg110_1
Misreg110_9
Misreg110_11
Misreg2B_1
MisregMMC_3
MisregMMC_5 (*1)
MisregMMC_7
MisregMMC_8
MisregAMC_3
MisregAMC_5 (*1)
MisregAMC_7
MisregAMC_8
MisregCROP_1.Izh
MisregMFC_1.Izh
MisregMFC_2.Izh
MisregMFC_4.Izh
MisregMFC_6.Izh
MisregMFC_7.Izh
MisregMFC_8.Izh
MisregMFC_9.Izh
• (*1) This is the data which has not been used after upgrading the system program.
32550 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32550
Setup
3. Mode
BkData1400 NMC Setting
BkData1700 Each Slope Correction
Image Processing BKData0400 Image Processing PCB Setting
Auto film carrier BkData0300 Adjustment data of AFC
Printer BkData2700 Each data of Printer
Processor BkData0900 Each data of Processor
Colorimeter BkData1000 Each data of Colorimeter
Pricing Unit BkData1100 Price setting data except the print
price setting
Basic price setting data
Total data
LASER BkData2100 Each data of Laser
Correction data for brightness roi_SHD.bin Correction data for brightness of the
of the Edge of Image Field Edge of Image Field
Scanner Bk0300_SCN Area Registration
Light Axis Adjustment
Light Source Registration
Focus Adjustment
Parameter (negative)
BkData2900 Each data relating to D-ICE control
PCB
Misreg135_1 Erasing Scratch data
Misreg135_2
Misreg135_4 (*1)
Misreg135_6
Misreg135_8
Misreg135_9
Misreg240_1
Misreg240_4
Misreg240_5 (*1)
Misreg240_7
Misreg240_8
Misreg240_9
Misreg110_1
Misreg110_9
Misreg110_11
Misreg2B_1
MisregMMC_3
32550 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32550
Setup
3. Mode
MisregMFC_7.Izh
MisregMFC_8.Izh
MisregMFC_9.Izh
• (*1) This is the data which has not been used after upgrading the system program.
32550 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32560
Setup
3. Mode
S1022-00-SM01
! Explanation
The data which is saved in the PC can be initialized.
IMPORTANT
• Before initializing the data, backup the data (data writing).
If the data has been initialized by mistake, the data can be restored to the original by reading out the backup floppy
disk data or the backup media. However, be sure to update the light source when reading out data from the floppy
disk.
☞ 35400
• If there is a backup data of the service personal level, each data can be written individually.
• In case of the backup data of the user level, each data cannot be written individually.
32560 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32560
Setup
3. Mode
Misreg135_1 Erasing Scratch data
Misreg135_2
Misreg135_4 (*1)
Misreg135_6
Misreg135_8
Misreg135_9
Misreg240_1
Misreg240_4
Misreg240_5 (*1)
Misreg240_7
Misreg240_8
Misreg240_9
Misreg110_1
Misreg110_9
Misreg110_11
Misreg2B_1
MisregMMC_3
MisregMMC_5 (*1)
MisregMMC_7
MisregMMC_8
MisregAMC_3
MisregAMC_5 (*1)
MisregAMC_7
MisregAMC_8
MisregCROP_1.Izh
MisregMFC_1.Izh
MisregMFC_2.Izh
MisregMFC_4.Izh
MisregMFC_6.Izh
MisregMFC_7.Izh
MisregMFC_8.Izh
MisregMFC_9.Izh
• (*1) This is the data which has not been used after upgrading the system program.
32560 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32560
Setup
3. Mode
Auto film carrier BkData0300 Adjustment data of AFC
*1
Pricing Unit BkData1100 Price setting data except the print
price setting
Basic price setting data
Total data
Scanner Bk0300_SCN Area Registration
Light Axis Adjustment
Light Source Registration
Focus Adjustment
Parameter (negative)
BkData2900 Each data relating to D-ICE control
PCB
Misreg135_1 Erasing Scratch data
Misreg135_2
Misreg135_4 (*1)
Misreg135_6
Misreg135_8
Misreg135_9
Misreg240_1
Misreg240_4
Misreg240_5 (*1)
Misreg240_7
Misreg240_8
Misreg240_9
Misreg110_1
Misreg110_9
Misreg110_11
Misreg2B_1
MisregMMC_3
MisregMMC_5 (*1)
MisregMMC_7
MisregMMC_8
MisregAMC_3
MisregAMC_5 (*1)
MisregAMC_7
MisregAMC_8
32560 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32560
Setup
3. Mode
Basically, data are initialized when initialization is executed.
Some data are not initialized, which are listed below.
32560 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32561
Setup
3. Mode
S1022-00-SM02
! Explanation
The data which is saved in the PC can be initialized.
IMPORTANT
• Before initializing the data, backup the data (data writing).
If the data has been initialized by mistake, the data can be restored to the original by reading out the backup floppy
disk data or the backup media.
☞ 35400
• If there is a backup data of the service personal level, each data can be written individually.
• In case of the backup data of the user level, each data cannot be written individually.
32561 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32561
Setup
3. Mode
BkData2100 Laser related data
roi_SHD.bin Correction Data for Brightness of
the Edge of Image Field
32561 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32570
Setup
3. Mode
2. Click YES: Enter.
NOTE
• The Area Registration starts automatically.
3. When you continue the operation to set
another film carrier, repeat the steps above.
S1047-00-SM00 4. After carrying out Area Registration, the
focus adjustment is required.
! Explanation ☞ 37020
Register the valid range of CCD.
IMPORTANT
• After carrying out Area Registration, the focus
adjustment is required.
☞ 37020
! Attached Film Carrier
The film carrier which is attached is displayed.
When the film carrier is not attached or attached improperly, −
− − − − is displayed.
! Registration
When the film size has already been registered, ON is
displayed. When it is not registered, OFF is displayed.
32570 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32590
Setup
3. Mode
Set the judgement level of area to skip the fogged negative.
! Explanation
Set the reference to judge the scanned film.
! Panorama Film Judgment Rate (Initial value: 0)
(Input range: −10 to 5)
! Under-exposed Negative Skip Rate (Initial
value: 0) (Input range: 0 to 99) Set the judgement level of 135 negative panorama frame.
Set the judgement level to skip the under-exposed negative.
The smaller the value is, the easier the
-10 detection as panorama is carried out.
The smaller the value is, the lower the skip
0
rate becomes.
99 The larger the value is, the higher the skip IMPORTANT
rate becomes. • The different effect can be obtained by combining
with the setting of Basic Color Correction Switch
of Service Parameters.
☞ 32500
32590 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
32590
Setup
! Scanner Graduation Correction Switch • It is slow at bringing up the PJP display after
(Negative except for 120) (initial value: ON) scanning the images and also it takes time to show
the next display.
In the case of 135, 240 or 110 negative film, the correcting
procedure of Shadow Area and Highlight Area are switched. NOTE
ON The contrast is corrected by frame with scene • For detecting the face of figure, the face sensing
judgement. technology OKAO Vision by OMRON Corporation is
adopted.
OFF The image is printed as if it is printed using the
analog machine. • The shots on which this correction does not work or
difficult to work are as follows.
! Scanner Graduation Correction Switch (120 When the shot is a portrait in profile or the image size of the
negative) (initial value: OFF) portrait is too small (less than 20 X 20 pixels as a rough standard)
When anything other than a person is shot (the subject is an
In the case of 120 negative film, the correcting procedure of
animal, a scenery, etc.)
Shadow Area and Highlight Area are switched.
When the shot is made in the over/under exposed condition, and
3. Mode
ON The contrast is corrected by frame with scene its subject has no contrast on the face
judgement.
OFF The image is printed as if it is printed using the
analog machine.
IMPORTANT
• When a specific under scene is scanned several
times by setting 1 or 2 or 3 for Basic Density
Correction Switch, the density values read by the
scanner may be uneven.
Selecting 0 for Basic Density Correction Switch
makes the density values even, but correction is not
performed for the shot under electronic flash or
backlighted.
• Highly accurate correction can be obtained with the
large value. But it is slow at calculating the
correction value and takes longer time for the
images to appear after inserting the films.
• The calculation of the correction value is performed
not only for the scene you want but also the every
scanned scene.
32590 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33030
Setup
! Display
Bringing up the display
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Processor Settings → Pump
Output Amount Setting
3. Mode
S4003-00-SM00
! Explanation
! Functions
33030 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33030
Setup
3. Mode
S4202-00-SM00
! Explanation
! Functions
33030 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33040
Setup
! Display
Bringing up the display
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Processor Settings → Total
Replenishment Amount Display
3. Mode
S4203-01-SM00
! Explanation
33040 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33040
Setup
3. Mode
range: 0.0 to 999.9 mL)
In the case of 3201
SM Forced
Replenishment Amount
CD-A 58.1
CD-B 58.1
CD-C 83.0
BF-A 41.7
BF-B 60.5
STB 30.0
# Revolution Count
The number of pump revolution when each pump
operates replenishment with the value input in
Forced Replenishment Amount Setting is
displayed.
33040 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33060
Setup
3. Mode
S4205-00-SM00
! Explanation
! Correction Setting
The amount of replenish and water supply can be increased
depending on the paper process amount.
33060 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33500
Processor Standard Setting
Processor Standard Setting
Thermosensor Calibration
3. Mode
S3005-00-SM00
! Explanation
NOTE
• It can be set by entering the service personnel password
(2260).
! Correction Value
When the measured temperature is entered, the correction
value, subtracting the displayed temperature from the
measured temperature, will be automatically entered.
! Displayed Temperature
The processing solution temperature measured by the
thermosensor is displayed.
33500 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33510
Processor Standard Setting
3. Mode
S4008-00-SM00
! Explanation
! Process Specification
The process specification which has been registered in the
machine specification is displayed.
☞ 35800
! Refilling Water Amount Setting (Initial value:
Refer to the table below.) (Input range: 0.0 to
999.9 ml)
Refilling Refilling
Water Water
Amount Amount
Setting 1 Setting 2
CD-W 186.0 79.5
BF-W 185.0 56.0
STB1-W 360.0 71.4
STB2-W 139.0 71.8
STB3-W 130.0 79.4
STB4-W 202.0 71.5
33510 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33510
Processor Standard Setting
Refilling Water Amount Setting [SM] Water Level is set to ON. (For automatic refilling
water during start up checks and normal
processing.)
! Display
# Refilling Water Amount Setting 2
Bringing up the display Set the refilling water amount with Refilling Water
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Processor Settings → Processor Level ON. This setting is valid when the Refilling
Standard Setting → Refilling Water Amount Setting Water Level 2 of Correction Setting has been set
to Standard. (For automatic refilling during start
up checks.)
3. Mode
Setting 2 (Standard).
33510 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33580
Processor Standard Setting
3. Mode
S4009-00-SM00
! Explanation
33580 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33590
Processor Standard Setting
3. Mode
S4011-00-SM00
! Explanation
33590 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
33600
Processor Standard Setting
3. Mode
S4012-00-SM00
! Explanation
! Functions
33600 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
34500
Operator Selections
Operator Selections
NOTE IMPORTANT
• There are only [N] and [SM]specification for the Stand Alone • Normally, use with ON.
Printer.
• In case of the Stand Alone Scanner, only the display ! Order Classification Section error
(Additional) appears. Errors related to order classification section can be set
ON/OFF.
! Onscreen Display (Processor) Error message does not appear when this setting is OFF.
3. Mode
Bringing up the display
IMPORTANT
• Normally, use with ON.
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Operator Selections →
Processor
! Onscreen Display (Additional)
Bringing up the display
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Operator Selections →
Additional
S2000-00-SM06
! Explanation
Only the function modes which are exclusive to the service
S2000-00-SM05
mode are explained.
! 120 AFC Diffuser
! Drive, Dryer Manual ON Switch
The 120 AFC diffuser can be set to "Used" or "Not in use".
Processor drive and Processor dryer operate continuously.
This operates even when processing is not carried out. Setting Details
IMPORTANT Used If the 120 AFC diffuser is in use
• Normally, use with OFF. Using the 120 AFC diffuser increases
scanner accumulation time by a factor of
! Replenishment error 2.5.
Not in use If the 120 AFC diffuser is not in use
Errors related to replenishment can be set ON/OFF.
Scanner accumulation time is normal
Error message does not appear when this setting is OFF.
IMPORTANT
• Normally, use with ON.
34500 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
34500
Operator Selections
IMPORTANT
• Perform the following adjustments after changing
the 120 AFC diffuser setting from "In use" to "Not in
3. Mode
use" or vice versa.
Item Reference
Light Source Registration ☞ 37010
Focus Adjustment ☞ 37020
Light Source Update ☞ 37030
! Explanation
Only the function modes which are exclusive to the service
mode are explained.
! Replenishment error
Errors related to replenishment can be set ON/OFF.
Error message does not appear when this setting is OFF.
IMPORTANT
• Normally, use with ON.
34500 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
34500
Operator Selections
3. Mode
34500 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35000
Maintenance
Maintenance
3. Mode
Film inserting
direction
35000 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35000
Maintenance
! LED Light Intensity Value (Input range: 0 to 1. Select Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
255) Adjustment.
This adjustment is automatically carried out.
The sensor sensitivity is adjusted to the auto gain standard
value at the lightest area on a blank film which is obtained by NOTE
changing the light intensity value of all DX sensors. Each • A film is not used for adjustment.
sensor other than DX sensor is adjusted so that the sensor
sensitivity becomes the constant level without negative. ! Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment
! DX Sensor Gain Value (without Film) (Input
1. Select Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment.
3. Mode
range: 0 to 255)
This adjustment is automatically carried out.
The gain value (without film) of each DX sensor is displayed.
NOTE
• A film is not used for adjustment.
! Functions
! DX Sensor Standard Adjustment
! Scanning Position Auto Correction
Using a film, the difference between the prescanning position 1. Select DX Sensor Standard Adjustment.
and the actual scanning position can automatically be
adjusted.
! Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment 2. Insert the film into the film carrier.
Adjustment for the sensitivity at the detection side of each NOTE
sensor and the sensor LED light intensity can be carried out • Use the film containing two frames or more, of
simultaneously. which base density is light.
3. Remove the ejected film.
! DX Standard Adjustment
The standard adjustment of the 135 DX sensor and 240 DX
4. The adjustment is complete, and the
correction value is input automatically.
sensor can be carried out.
! DX Code Reading
! DX Code Reading
DX code reading test for either the 135 lane or 240 lane can be 1. Select DX Code Reading.
carried out.
2. Load the film to the film carrier.
! DX Sensor Level Display 3. Remove the ejected film.
The gain value of each DX sensor is displayed. 4. The reading is complete, and the result is
displayed.
! Adjustment NOTE
• Only the reading code, reading count and frame
! Scanning Position Auto Correction No. are displayed.
• The frame code, such as ##E, is displayed as the
1. Select Scanning Position Auto Correction. display frame No.
This adjustment is automatically carried out.
• A maximum of 80 frames can be displayed. (a
maximum of 80 frames for the half size)
35000 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35000
Maintenance
S3099-00-SM02
3. Mode
S3099-00-SM02
NOTE
• The A/D value is the gain value detected at real time.
• The gain value (without film) indicates the fixed value
obtained by standard adjustment.
35000 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35010
Maintenance
Film Carrier Unit Adjustment (120 ! Scanning Position Correction 1 (Initial value:
100 %) (Input range: 95.00 to 105.00 %)
AFC-II)
The correction amount of the difference between the
prescanning position and the actual scanning position is
Bringing up the display displayed.
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Maintenance → Various Adjustment
→ Film Carrier Unit Adjustment ! Loading Sensor Gain Value (Input range: 0 to
255)
The loading sensor sensitivity gain value is displayed.
3. Mode
255)
The ready sensor sensitivity gain value is displayed.
! Adjustment
Film inserting
direction
1. Select Scanning Position Auto Correction.
This adjustment is automatically carried out.
NOTE
Direction of misalignment Print • A film is used for adjustment.
when the minus correction is
carried out G057680
35010 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35010
Maintenance
3. Mode
• A film is not used for adjustment.
35010 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35020
Maintenance
Film Carrier Unit Adjustment (110 ! Loading Sensor Gain Value (Initial value: 200)
(Input range: 0 to 255)
AFC-II)
The loading sensor sensitivity gain value is displayed.
3. Mode
The sensor sensitivity is adjusted to the auto gain standard
value at the lightest area on a blank film which is obtained by
changing the light intensity value of all DX sensors. Each
sensor other than DX sensor is adjusted so that the sensor
sensitivity becomes the constant level without negative.
! Functions
Film inserting
! Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment
direction
35020 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35020
Maintenance
3. Mode
35020 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35030
Maintenance
Lens unit
3. Mode
G068477
S3201-00-SM00
NOTE
• Functions appears when the service personnel password is
entered.
• Carry out the adjustment with the 135/240 MMC-II attached
to the machine.
G068478
! Emission Lamp and Detection Sensor Position
Adjustment 4. Select Emission Lamp and Detection Sensor
Position Adjustment [Remove the Top
Adjust the standard position of the emission lamp and
Cover].
detection sensor for auto focus.
NOTE
• Use three types of adjustment jigs for Emission
! Adjustment Lamp and Detection Sensor Position Adjustment.
• These are the service personnel tools. Refer to
! Emission Lamp and Detection Sensor Position
Service personnel tool list.
Adjustment
☞ 80310
1. Remove the top cover. Emission adjustment
chart
☞ 20040
35030 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35030
Maintenance
3. Mode
Adjustment
screwdriver
Projection
Marks
G052616
35030 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35030
Maintenance
6. Adjust the position of the AF emission (2) Adjust the attaching position of the AF
sensor. emission sensor PCB so that the filament
image is in the center. (Loosen two screws.)
(1) Insert the emission adjustment chart into the AF emission
Loosen these screws.
MMC-II. sensor PCB
IMPORTANT
• The emission adjustment chart jolts.
Attach the chart so that it comes to the
center of the mount carrier.
3. Mode
G052620
G052617
NOTE
• Check if the filament image on the
emission adjustment chart is in the center
of the emission adjustment chart. When the
filament image is in the center, the
adjustment is not necessary.
IMPORTANT
• Set the scanner adjustment chart
(mount) with the target triangle marks
at the far side.
(2) Adjust the attaching position of the AF
detection sensor to bring the worm wheel to
35030 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35030
Maintenance
the position marked when the height of the • The worm wheel may come near the
mount carrier was adjusted. (Loosen two marked position due to a rotation of the
screws. Two adjusting screws) worm wheel. In this case, return the
worm wheel to the position before the
Screws
rotation.
• Turn the adjusting screws every 180°
alternately. Turning one adjusting
screw fully at a time may cause the
screw to be blocked.
• When the worm wheel does not swing
within the tolerance level (about 4 mm),
adjust the auto focus section.
☞ 20850
IMPORTANT
3. Mode
• The worm wheel may come near the
marked position due to a rotation of the
AF detection sensor Adjusting screws worm wheel. In this case, return the
worm wheel to the position before the
G052622
rotation.
IMPORTANT • Turn the adjusting screws every 180°
• The tolerance level of swing is about alternately. Turning one adjusting
within 4 mm (corresponds to one screw fully at a time may cause the
tooth). screw to be blocked.
(3) Remove the scanner adjustment chart
(mount) from the MMC-II.
8. Attach the top cover, lens unit and lens unit
guide.
35030 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35040
Maintenance
G068479
3. Mode
3. Remove the mount advance guide. (one
screw)
S3327-00-SM00
NOTE
• Functions appears when the service personnel password is
entered.
• Adjust the 135/240 AMC-II attached to the machine.
! Functions
Mount advance guide
! Emission Lamp and Detection Sensor Position
Adjustment G068480
Adjust the standard position of the emission lamp and 4. Remove the condensing lens unit guide. (two
detection sensor for auto focus. screws)
! Adjustment
35040 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35040
Maintenance
Height adjustment
jig
3. Mode
G060680
G060705
G060677
IMPORTANT
(2) Turn the AF motor worm gear through the
adjusting hole on the mount carrier sensor • Put the mark on the worm wheel as in
light-tight plate, and adjust a height of the the illustration.
mount carrier so that it fits with the height • Put the marks on the front edge of the
adjustment jig. worm wheel tooth and on the block
section which is above the tooth.
NOTE
• Turning the worm gear clockwise moves NOTE
the mount carrier upward, whereas turning • The marks are used for position adjustment
of the AF detection sensor.
(4) Remove the height adjustment jig from the
AMC-II.
35040 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35040
Maintenance
7. Adjust the position of the AF emission 8. Adjust the position of the AF detection
sensor. sensor.
(1) Insert the emission adjustment chart into the (1) Set the scanner adjustment chart (mount) to
AMC-II. the AMC-II.
IMPORTANT Scanner adjustment chart (mount)
3. Mode
Target
triangle
marks
Filament
image
G060687
IMPORTANT
• Set the scanner adjustment chart
(mount) with the target triangle marks
at the far side.
(2) Adjust the attaching position of the AF
detection sensor to bring the worm gear to the
position marked when the height of the
mount carrier was adjusted. (Loosen two
G060678
screws. Two adjusting screws)
NOTE
Loosen these screws.
• Check if the filament image on the
emission adjustment chart is in the center
of the emission adjustment chart. When the
filament image is in the center, the
adjustment is not necessary.
(2) Adjust the attaching position of the AF
emission sensor PCB so that the filament
image is in the center. (Loosen two screws.)
Screwdriver
Emission sensor PCB
35040 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35040
Maintenance
IMPORTANT
• The tolerance level of swing is about
within 4 mm (corresponds to one
tooth).
3. Mode
One tooth each for
left and right
(Approx. 2 mm)
G060706
• Check that the marked tooth of the
gear swings 2 mm each for left and
right referring to the mark on the block
section.
IMPORTANT
• The worm wheel may come near the
marked position due to a rotation of the
worm wheel. In this case, return the
worm wheel to the position before the
rotation.
• Turn the adjusting screws every 180°
alternately. Turning one adjusting
screw fully at a time may cause the
screw to be blocked.
(3) Remove the scanner adjustment chart
(mount) from the AMC-II.
9. Attach the top cover, condensing lens, mount
advance guide, and condensing lens guide.
35040 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35050
Maintenance
3. Mode
• Use a film of which the image appears properly.
• Set the film and the machine automatically starts
Scanning Position Auto Correction.
4. Set the film to the attachment and press the
Yes key.
NOTE
S3390-00-SM01
• When the machine completes Scanning Position
Auto Correction, Complete appears.
! Explanation
Film inserting
direction
! Functions
35050 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35060
Maintenance
3. Mode
! 135 Loading Sensor Gain Value (Input range: 0
to 255)
The loading sensor sensitivity gain value is displayed.
35060 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35060
Maintenance
3. Mode
Sensors for Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment
135 AFC-II 135 Loading Sensor, 135 Perforation
Sensor, 135 Ready Sensor, and 135
DX Sensors 1, 2, 3, and 4
S3099-00-SM02
! Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment 2. Insert the film into the film carrier.
NOTE
Adjustment for the sensitivity at the detection side of each
sensor and the sensor LED light intensity can be carried out • Use the film containing two frames or more, of
simultaneously. which base density is light.
3. Remove the ejected film.
! DX Sensor Standard Adjustment
4. The adjustment is complete, and the
The 135 DX sensor standard adjustment can be done. correction value is input automatically.
! DX Code Reading ! DX Code Reading
The DX Code Reading test can be done.
1. Select DX Code Reading.
! DX Sensor Level Display
2. Load the film to the film carrier.
The gain value of each DX sensor is displayed.
3. Remove the ejected film.
! Adjustment 4. The reading is complete, and the result is
displayed.
! Scanning Position Auto Correction NOTE
• Only the reading code, reading count and frame
1. Select Scanning Position Auto Correction. No. are displayed.
This adjustment is automatically carried out. • The frame code, such as ##E, is displayed as the
display frame No.
NOTE
• A film is used for adjustment. • A maximum of 80 frames can be displayed. (a
maximum of 80 frames for the half size)
! Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment
35060 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35060
Maintenance
S3099-00-SM02
3. Mode
S3099-00-SM02
NOTE
• The A/D value is the gain value detected at real time.
• The gain value (without film) indicates the fixed value
obtained by standard adjustment.
35060 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35100
Maintenance
Paper
3. Mode
S3088-00-SM00
! Explanation
Correct the paper stop position and feed error so that each Paper Advance Unit 2
step, such as 20-step, 22-step test prints, can be measured
G068474
correctly by the colorimeter.
NOTE
3. Draw the first line on the paper at 116 mm
away from the test paper edge, then the
• It can be set by entering the service personnel password
(2260).
second line at 201 mm away from the first
position.
! Paper Front End Advance Length Correction
(Initial value: 0.0) (Input range: -5.0 to +0.5 mm)
Correct the feed error of the colorimeter unit roller from the
paper front end to the measurement position.
35100 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35100
Maintenance
First line
3. Mode
G068476
! Colorimeter cleaning
35100 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35200
Maintenance
S3128-00-SM00
3. Mode
! Explanation
A buzzer will sound if sensors, limit switches or other devices at the cursor position turn DARK or ON.
IMPORTANT
• The momentary operation cannot be displayed on the input check display because there is a time lag of approx. 0.5
seconds.
NOTE
• In case of the Stand Alone Scanner, the colorimeter unit is not loaded in the input section.
• For the Stand Alone Printer, film carrier section, LED light source unit and scanner unit are not equipped to the input section.
Film Carrier Section (135/240 AFC-135)
No. Display Status
1 ON/OFF 135 Lane Limit Switch ON When the 135 lane is detected.
2 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 1 When the film carrier is attached.*1
3 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 2
4 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 3
5 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 4
6 ON/OFF Film Carrier Lock Sensor ON When the film carrier is locked.
7 DARK/LIGHT Rewinding Sensor LIGHT When the film jam is detected.
8 DARK/LIGHT 135 Loading Sensor DARK When the film is detected.
9 DARK/LIGHT 135 Ready Sensor DARK When the film is detected.
10 DARK/LIGHT 135 Perforation Sensor LIGHT When the perforation is detected.
11 DARK/LIGHT 135 DX Sensor 1 DARK When the DX code is detected.*2
12 DARK/LIGHT 135 DX Sensor 1 (Film Detection) DARK When the film is detected.*2
13 DARK/LIGHT 135 DX Sensor 2 DARK When the DX code is detected.
14 DARK/LIGHT 135 DX Sensor 3 DARK When the DX code is detected.*2
15 DARK/LIGHT 135 DX Sensor 3 (Film Detection) DARK When the film is detected.*2
16 DARK/LIGHT 135 DX Sensor 4 DARK When the DX code is detected.
17 ### Attached Film Carrier Displays the attached film carrier.
Film carrier Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code
detector 1 detector 2 detector 3 detector 4
135/240 AFC OFF ON OFF OFF
Not attached ON ON ON ON
*2. This one sensor detects both the DX code and the Film.
35200 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35200
Maintenance
3. Mode
11 DARK/LIGHT VEI Sensor LIGHT When the VEI is at the fourth
position
12 ON/OFF IPI Limit Switch ON When the undeveloped cartridge is
set.
13 ON/OFF Cartridge Limit Switch ON When the cartridge is set.
(Turns ON when both switches 1 and
2 detect the cartridge.)
14 DARK/LIGHT 240 DX Sensor 1 DARK When the DX code is detected.*2
15 DARK/LIGHT 240 DX Sensor 1 (Film Detection) DARK When the film is detected.*2
16 DARK/LIGHT 240 DX Sensor 2 DARK When the DX code is detected.
17 ### Attached Film Carrier Displays the attached film carrier.
Film carrier Film Carrier Code Film Carrier Code Film Carrier Code Film Carrier Code
Detector 1 Detector 2 Detector 3 Detector 4
135/240 AFC OFF ON OFF OFF
Not attached ON ON ON ON
*2. This one sensor detects both the DX code and the Film.
35200 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35200
Maintenance
Film carrier Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code
detector 1 detector 2 detector 3 detector 4
120 AFC OFF OFF ON ON
Not attached ON ON ON ON
3. Mode
Film Carrier Section (110 AFC)
No. Display Status
1 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 1 When the film carrier is attached.*1
2 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 2
3 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 3
4 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 4
5 ON/OFF Film Carrier Lock Sensor ON When the film carrier is locked.
6 DARK/LIGHT Loading Sensor DARK When the film is detected.
7 DARK/LIGHT Ready Sensor DARK When the film is detected.
8 DARK/LIGHT Perforation Sensor LIGHT When the perforation is detected.
9 ON/OFF DIP Switch 2-1 OFF Displays the dip switch status of the
10 ON/OFF DIP Switch 2-2 OFF AFC/Scanner control PCB. ☞ 65000
Turn OFF all.
11 ON/OFF DIP Switch 2-3 OFF
12 ON/OFF DIP Switch 2-4 OFF
13 ### Attached Film Carrier Displays the attached film carrier.
Film carrier Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code
detector 1 detector 2 detector 3 detector 4
110 AFC ON ON OFF ON
Not attached ON ON ON ON
35200 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35200
Maintenance
Film carrier Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code
detector 1 detector 2 detector 3 detector 4
135/240 ON OFF ON ON
MMC
Not attached ON ON ON ON
3. Mode
Film Carrier Section (135/240 AMC-II)
No. Display Status
1 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 1 When the film carrier is attached.*1
2 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 2
3 ON/OFF Film Carrier Code Detector 3
4 DARK/LIGHT Mount Carrier Home Sensor DARK When the mount carrier is detected.
5 ON/OFF Film Carrier Lock Sensor ON When the film carrier is locked.
6 DARK/LIGHT Mount Carrier Sensor (Upper) DARK When the mount carrier is detected.
7 DARK/LIGHT Mount Carrier Sensor (Lower) DARK When the mount carrier is detected.
8 ON/OFF Mount Sensor ON When the mount is detected.
9 DARK/LIGHT Insertion Sensor 1 DARK When the mount is not set.
10 DARK/LIGHT Insertion Sensor 2 DARK When the mount is not set.
11 ON/OFF Mount Sensor (Inlet) ON When the mount is detected.
12 DARK/LIGHT Mount Elevator Sensor DARK When the mount carrier is detected.
13 ON/OFF Ejection Sensor ON When the mount is detected.
14 ON/OFF DIP Switch 2-1 OFF Displays the dip switch status of the
15 ON/OFF DIP Switch 2-2 OFF AFC/Scanner control PCB. ☞ 65000
Turn OFF all.
16 ON/OFF DIP Switch 2-3 OFF
17 ON/OFF DIP Switch 2-4 OFF
18 ### Attached Film Carrier Displays the attached film carrier.
Film carrier Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code
detector 1 detector 2 detector 3
135/240 AMC-II OFF ON ON
Not attached ON ON ON
35200 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35200
Maintenance
3. Mode
20 ### Attached Film Carrier Displays the attached film carrier.
*1. Film Carrier Code Detector
Film carrier Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code
detector 1 detector 2 detector 3 detector 4
135/240 AFC ON OFF OFF OFF
Not attached ON ON ON ON
Film carrier Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code Film carrier code
detector 1 detector 2 detector 3 detector 4
MFC ON ON ON OFF
Not attached ON ON ON ON
35200 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35200
Maintenance
3. Mode
120 (6 × 6) ON ON ON OFF OFF
120 (6 × 7) OFF OFF OFF ON OFF
120 (6 × 8) ON OFF OFF ON OFF
120 (6 × 9) OFF ON OFF ON OFF
Crop Card ON ON ON ON ON
Adjusting OFF ON ON ON ON
Attachment
*1. Displays the detection status of capacity booster A. The following messages will appear when pressing the F key on the Order Display to pass
through the Input Check display in starting up the machine.
• When the detection of ON has changed to -, the attention message No.1920 Capacity Booster Key cannot be detected. Make sure
connecting conditions. appears.
• When the detection of - has changed to ON, the attention message No.1921 Capacity Booster Key is detected. appears.
Colorimeter unit
No. Display Status
1 DARK/LIGHT Paper Sensor 1 DARK When the paper is detected.
35200 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35200
Maintenance
3. Mode
35200 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35210
Maintenance
3. Mode
S3245-00-SM00
! Explanation
A buzzer will sound if sensors, limit switches or other devices at the cursor position turn DARK or ON.
IMPORTANT
• The momentary operation cannot be displayed on the input check display because there is a time lag of approx. 0.5
seconds.
Paper Supply Unit (Paper Magazine Code)
No. Display Status
1 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor B1 (Right) DARK When the pin is detected.
2 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor B2 DARK When the pin is detected.
3 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor B3 DARK When the pin is detected.
4 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor B4 DARK When the pin is detected.
5 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor B5 DARK When the pin is detected.
6 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor B6 DARK When the pin is detected.
7 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor B7 (Left) DARK When the pin is detected.
8 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor C1 (Lower) DARK When the pin is detected.
9 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor C2 DARK When the pin is detected.
10 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor C3 DARK When the pin is detected.
11 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor C4 DARK When the pin is detected.
12 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor C5 DARK When the pin is detected.
13 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor C6 DARK When the pin is detected.
14 DARK/LIGHT Paper Magazine Code Sensor C7 (Upper) DARK When the pin is detected.
15 ### Attached Paper Magazine B Displays the attached paper magazine.
16 ### Attached Paper Magazine C Displays the attached paper magazine.
35210 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35210
Maintenance
3. Mode
*1
18 OK/- Capacity booster B OK When the capacity booster A is
attached
*1. Displays the detection status of capacity booster B. The following attention messages appear when closing the Input Check display on the
starting up of the machine.
• When the detection of ON has changed to -, the attention message No.1920 Capacity Booster Key cannot be detected. Make sure
connecting conditions. appears.
• When the detection of - has changed to ON, the attention message No.1921 Capacity Booster Key is detected. appears.
35210 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35210
Maintenance
Engine Section
Display Status
1 ON/OFF Interlock Switch (Printer Top Cover) ON When the cover is closed.
2 Synchronous/Asy Polygon Mirror Synchronous Synchr Normal
nchronous onous When the polygon mirror rotates
properly
Asynch Abnormal
3. Mode
ronous When the polygon mirror does not
rotate properly
When entering the input check, the polygon mirror is ON.
The polygon mirror driver outputs the signal which indicates the stability of the polygon mirror rotation.
3 Synchronous/Asy Laser Synchronous Sensor Synchr When the polygon mirror is
nchronous onous synchronous and either of R/G/B
laser or all lasers is/are emitting
Asynch When the polygon mirror
ronous asynchronous
When the polygon mirror is
synchronous and either of R/G/B
laser or all lasers is/are not emitting
When entering the input check, the polygon mirror and R/G/B laser are ON.
When either of R/G/B laser is not emitting, it depends on the timing of measurement and the laser light intensity
whether synchronous or asynchronous appears.
When checking if there are any problems in the laser output, check with the output check. ☞ 35310
4 OK/No Good G Laser Light Source Status OK The laser and G/B laser drivers are
B Laser Light Source Status normal.
No The laser unit is deteriorated.
Good The G/B laser driver is not connected
properly, or is damaged.
The laser light intensity depends on the electric current applied to the laser diode. When the laser diode is being
deteriorated, add the electric current to acquire the specified amount of output. No Good is displayed when the
current value exceeds the limitation.
5 ##.#°C R Laser Thermosensor Displays the temperature of the R laser.
6 ##.#°C Laser Unit Thermosensor Displays the temperature of the laser unit.
7 ##### Polygon Mirror Frequency 1380±7 When the polygon mirror rotates
properly
- When the polygon mirror does not
rotate properly
8 ON/OFF DIP Switch 61-1 OFF Displays the dip switch setting of the
9 ON/OFF DIP Switch 61-2 OFF laser control PCB. ☞ 66010
Turn OFF all.
10 ON/OFF DIP Switch 61-3 OFF
11 ON/OFF DIP Switch 61-4 OFF
12 ON/OFF DIP Switch 61-5 OFF
13 ON/OFF DIP Switch 61-6 OFF
14 ON/OFF DIP Switch 61-7 OFF
15 ON/OFF DIP Switch 61-8 OFF
16 ON/OFF G Laser Judgment Signal 1 OFF
17 ON/OFF G Laser Judgment Signal 2 OFF
18 ON/OFF B Laser Judgment Signal 1 OFF
35210 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35210
Maintenance
Display Status
19 ON/OFF B Laser Judgment Signal 2 OFF
20 ON/OFF G Laser Ready Status (SP1) *1 ON When the G/B-SHG laser is normal
21 ON/OFF B Laser Ready Status (SP1) *1
ON (ready for printing)
NOTE
• When B laser judgement signal 1, 2 and G laser judgement signal 1, 2 are all off: Laser unit (Type A1)
• When B laser judgement signal 1, 2 and G laser judgement signal 1, 2 are all on: Laser unit (Type B1)
Paper Advance Section (Paper Advance Section 1)
Display Status
1 DARK/LIGHT Paper Sensor 1 DARK When the paper is detected.
2 DARK/LIGHT Lane Select Sensor (Left) DARK When the arm is detected.
3. Mode
3 DARK/LIGHT Lane Select Sensor (Right) DARK When the arm is detected.
4 DARK/LIGHT Arm Sensor (Left) DARK When the arm is detected.
5 DARK/LIGHT Arm Sensor (Right) DARK When the arm is detected.
6 DARK/LIGHT Paper Sensor 2 (Left) DARK When the paper is detected.
7 DARK/LIGHT Paper Sensor 2 (Center) DARK When the paper is detected.
8 DARK/LIGHT Paper Sensor 2 (Right) DARK When the paper is detected.
9 ON/OFF Interlock Switch (Printer Top Cover) ON When the cover is closed.
10 ON/OFF Interlock Switch (Printer Door 1) ON When the cover is closed.
11 ON/OFF Interlock Switch (Printer Door 2) ON When the cover is closed.
12 ON/OFF Printer Door 3 Sensor ON When the cover is closed.
13 ON/OFF DIP Switch 3-1 OFF Displays the dip switch status of the
14 ON/OFF DIP Switch 3-2 OFF printer control PCB. ☞ 66000
Turn OFF all.
15 ON/OFF DIP Switch 3-3 OFF
16 ON/OFF DIP Switch 3-4 OFF
35210 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35220
Maintenance
! Display
Bringing up the display
Menu → Extension → Maintenance → Input Check → Processor
3. Mode
S3090-00-SM00
! Explanation
A buzzer will sound if sensors, limit switches or other devices at the cursor position turn DARK or ON.
IMPORTANT
• The momentary operation cannot be displayed on the input check display because there is a time lag of approx. 0.5
seconds.
Processor Section
No. Display Status
1 ON/OFF Processing Solution Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
2 ON/OFF CD Replenishment Solution Level Sensor OFF When the replenishment solution is
run out.
3 ON/OFF BF Replenishment Solution Level Sensor OFF When the replenishment solution is
run out.
4 ON/OFF STB Replenishment Solution Level Sensor OFF When the replenishment solution is
run out.
5 ON/OFF CD Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
6 ON/OFF BF Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
7 ON/OFF STB 1 Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
8 ON/OFF STB 2 Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
9 ON/OFF STB 3 Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
10 ON/OFF STB 4 Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
11 ON/OFF Refilling Water Tank Level Sensor OFF When the solution level is too low.
12 ON/OFF Processing Solution Safety Thermostat ON When the solution safety thermostat
operates normally
13 ON/OFF Interlock Switch (Processor Top Cover) ON When the cover is closed.
14 ON/OFF Rack Stopper Sensor ON When the rack stopper is set.
15 ON/OFF CD Effluent Float Switch ON When the effluent is full.
16 ON/OFF BF Effluent Float Switch ON When the effluent is full.
17 ON/OFF STB Effluent Float Switch ON When the effluent is full.
35220 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35220
Maintenance
3. Mode
If the errors occur at two or more pumps simultaneously, the error is displayed in the order from CD.
*2. Displays only when the digital flowmeter is registered as options.
Dryer Section
No. Display Status
1 ON/OFF Dryer Safety Thermostat OFF When the dryer safety thermostat is
turned off.
2 ON/OFF Interlock Switch (Dryer Cover) ON When the cover is closed.
3 DARK/LIGHT Print Sensor (Left) DARK When the paper is detected.
4 DARK/LIGHT Print Sensor (Center) DARK When the paper is detected.
5 DARK/LIGHT Print Sensor (Right) DARK When the paper is detected.
6 DARK/LIGHT Dryer Lane Select Sensor DARK When the paper is detected.
35220 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35220
Maintenance
! Display
Bringing up the display
Menu → Extension → Maintenance → Input Check → Processor
3. Mode
S3090-00-SM00
! Explanation
A buzzer will sound if sensors, limit switches or other devices at the cursor position turn DARK or ON.
IMPORTANT
• The momentary operation cannot be displayed on the input check display because there is a time lag of approx. 0.5
seconds.
Processor Section (1)
No. Display Status
1 ON/OFF Processing Solution Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
2 ON/OFF CD Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
3 ON/OFF BF Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
4 ON/OFF STB 1 Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
5 ON/OFF STB 2 Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
6 ON/OFF STB 3 Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
7 ON/OFF STB 4 Refilling Water Level OFF When the solution level is too low.
8 ON/OFF Processing Solution Safety Thermostat ON Normal
9 ON/OFF Interlock Switch (Processor Top Cover) ON When the cover is closed.
10 ON/OFF Rack Stopper Sensor ON When the rack stopper is set.
11 ON/OFF CD Effluent Float Switch ON When the effluent is full.
12 ON/OFF BF Effluent Float Switch ON When the effluent is full.
13 ON/OFF STB Effluent Float Switch ON When the effluent is full.
14 ON/OFF DIP Switch 1 OFF Displays the dip switch status of the
15 ON/OFF DIP Switch 2 OFF processor control PCB. ☞ 66200
Turn OFF all.
16 ON/OFF DIP Switch 3 OFF
17 ON/OFF DIP Switch 4 OFF
18 CLOSE/OPEN Starter Jumper Setting CLOSE When the jumper of power PCB 2 is
connected.
19 ### Pump Rotation Detector When an error occurs.*1
20 50/60 Power Supply Frequency (Hz) Displays the frequency.
21 #.## CD Flow Amount Displays the CD circulation amount.*2
22 ### Drive Motor Revolution Count
35220 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35220
Maintenance
3. Mode
9 DARK/LIGHT CD-B Replenishment Solution Sensor LIGHT When the replenishment solution level is
normal.
10 DARK/LIGHT CD-C Replenishment Solution Sensor LIGHT When the replenishment solution level is
normal.
11 DARK/LIGHT BF-A Replenishment Solution Sensor LIGHT When the replenishment solution level is
normal.
12 DARK/LIGHT BF-B Replenishment Solution Sensor LIGHT When the replenishment solution level is
normal.
13 DARK/LIGHT STB Replenishment Solution Sensor LIGHT When the replenishment solution level is
normal.
14 ON/OFF Replenishment Package Sensor P-1 ON When the replenishment package is set.
15 ON/OFF Replenishment Package Sensor P-2 ON When the replenishment package is set.
16 ON/OFF Water Supply Tank Level Sensor OFF When the solution level is too low.
Dryer Section
No. Display Status
1 ON/OFF Dryer Safety Thermostat OFF When the dryer safety thermostat is
turned off.
2 ON/OFF Interlock Switch (Dryer Cover) ON When the cover is closed.
3 DARK/LIGHT Print Sensor (Left) DARK When the paper is detected.
4 DARK/LIGHT Print Sensor (Center) DARK When the paper is detected.
5 DARK/LIGHT Print Sensor (Right) DARK When the paper is detected.
6 DARK/LIGHT Dryer Lane Select Sensor DARK When the paper is detected.
35220 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35300
Maintenance
3. Mode
S3126-00-SM00
! Explanation
Check the operation of the motor, buzzer and LED etc. at the cursor.
NOTE
• In case of the Stand Alone Scanner, the colorimeter unit is not loaded in the input section.
• For the Stand Alone Printer, film carrier section, LED light source unit and scanner unit are not equipped to the input section.
Film Carrier Section (135/240 AFC - 135)
No. Display Operation
1 Film Ready Lamp (Red) Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
2 Film Ready Lamp (Green) Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
3 Film Feed Motor Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
4 Film Feed Motor Cooling Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
5 Panorama Shutter Solenoid Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
35300 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35300
Maintenance
3. Mode
2 Film Ready Lamp (Green) Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
3 Film Feed Motor Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
35300 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35300
Maintenance
3. Mode
No. Display Operation
1 ND Filter Solenoid Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
2 LED Cooling Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
3 LED Heater (High) Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
4 LED Heater (Medium) Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
5 LED Heater (Low) Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
6 B LED Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
7 G LED Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
8 R1 LED Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
9 IR LED Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
10 LED Thermosensor Displays the temperature of the LED unit.
NOTE
• ND Filter Solenoid, LED Cooling Fan, LED Heater (High), LED Heater (Medium), LED Heater (Low), B LED, G LED, R1
LED, IR LED and LED thermosensor are built in the LED light source unit.
• The heater of the LED light source unit can be changed in the three levels for (H), (M) or (L).
Scanner Unit [S-2/S-3]
No. Display Operation
1 Zoom motors 1, 2 Press the YES/START key to make Zoom 1 Pre-Home
Sensor and Zoom 2 Pre-Home Sensor repeat
DARK/LIGHT.
2 IRIS Motor Press the YES/START key to make the IRIS Sensor repeat
the DARK/LIGHT cycle once.
35300 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35300
Maintenance
Colorimeter Unit
No. Display Operation
1 Paper Advance Motor Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
2 Pressure Change Solenoid Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
3. Mode
35300 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35310
Maintenance
3. Mode
S3246-00-SM00
! Explanation
Check the operation of the motor, buzzer and LED etc. at the cursor.
Paper Supply Unit (Paper Supply Section 1)
No. Display Operation
1 Paper Advance Motor 1 Press the YES/START key to operate once.
2 Paper Supply Motor B/C Press the YES/START key to operate once.
3 Cut Motor Press the YES/START key to operate once.
4 Paper Magazine Motor B Press the YES/START key to operate once.
5 Paper Magazine Motor C Press the YES/START key to operate once.
6 Paper Magazine Lamp B/C Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
7 Paper Supply Pressure Change Motor Press the YES/START key to turn pressure/pressure release
repeatedly.
8 Paper Sensor LED Power Supply OFF Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
35310 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35310
Maintenance
3. Mode
repeatedly.
5 Paper Sensor LED Power Supply OFF Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
Engine Section
No. Display Operation
1 Polygon Mirror OFF Press the YES/START key to stop the polygon mirror.
Press the NO/STOP key to start the operation of the polygon
mirror.
2 Laser Unit Cooling Fan 1,2 ON Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
3 Laser Unit Heater ON Press the YES/START key for Laser Unit Heater ON.
Press the NO/STOP key to turn off the laser unit heater.
4 R Laser Output ON Press the YES/START key to turn ON the R laser output.
Press the NO/STOP key to turn OFF the R laser output.
5 G Laser Output ON Press the YES/START key to turn ON the G laser output.
Press the NO/STOP key to turn OFF the G laser output.
6 B Laser Output ON Press the YES/START key to turn ON the B laser output.
Press the NO/STOP key to turn OFF the B laser output.
7 G Laser Reset (SP1) *1 Press the YES/START key to reset the G laser.
8 B Laser Reset (SP1) *1 Press the YES/START key to reset the B laser.
Display Status
Synchronous/Asy Polygon Mirror Synchronous Synchron When the polygon mirror rotates properly and is
nchronous ous stable
• When entering the output check
• When turning ON the polygon mirror
Asynchro When the polygon mirror does not rotate
nous properly
• When turning OFF the polygon mirror
35310 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35310
Maintenance
Display Status
Synchronous/Asy Laser Synchronous Sensor Synchron When either of R/G/B laser is emitting
nchronous ous • When the polygon mirror is synchronous
and either of R/G/B laser output is turned
ON
Asynchro When all the R/G/B lasers are not emitting
nous • When entering the output check
• When the polygon mirror asynchronous
• When the R/G/B laser output are all OFF
This part checks the output condition of each R/G/B laser.
Since the Synchronous Check cannot be carried out in the same condition as the usual printing operation even if
all the R/G/B lasers light, a problem may occur in the usual operation with no trouble at the Output Check.
OK/No Good G Laser Light Source Status OK The laser and G/B laser drivers are normal.
B Laser Light Source Status
3. Mode
No Good The laser unit is deteriorated.
The G/B laser driver is not connected properly,
or is damaged.
##.#°C Displays the temperature of the R laser.
##.#°C Laser Unit Thermosensor Displays the temperature of the laser unit.
##### Polygon Mirror Frequency 1380±7 When Laser Synchronous Sensor of Output
Check is Synchronous
- When Laser Synchronous Sensor of Output
Check is Synchronous
35310 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35320
Maintenance
! Display
Bringing up the display
Menu → Extension → Maintenance → Output Check → Processor
3. Mode
S3210-00-SM00
! Explanation
Check the operation of the motor, buzzer and LED etc. at the cursor.
Processor Section (1)
No. Display Operation
1 Drive Motor + Drive Cooling Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
2 CD Heater Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
3 BF Heater Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
4 STB Heater Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
5 CD Cooling Water Solenoid Valve Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
6 BF Cooling Water Solenoid Valve Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
7 STB Cooling Water Solenoid Valve Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
8 CD Replenisher Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
9 BF Replenisher Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
10 STB Replenisher Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
11 Tank Cooling Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
12 Cleaning Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
13 Exhaust Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
14 Processor Condition Lamp (Green) Press the YES/START key to turn on, and the NO/STOP
key to turn off.
15 Processor Condition Lamp (Red) Press the YES/START key to turn on, and the NO/STOP
key to turn off.
35320 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35320
Maintenance
3. Mode
5 STB 3-W Refilling Water Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
6 STB 4-W Refilling Water Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
Dryer Section
No. Display Operation
1 Dryer Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
2 Dryer Heater 1 Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
3 Dryer Heater 2 Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
4 Dryer Heater 3 Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
5 Dryer selection Solenoid Press the YES/START key to operate once.
35320 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35320
Maintenance
! Display
Bringing up the display
Menu → Extension → Maintenance → Output Check → Processor
3. Mode
S3210-00-SM00
! Explanation
Check the operation of the motor, buzzer and LED etc. at the cursor.
Processor Section (1)
No. Display Operation
1 Drive Motor + Drive Cooling Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
2 CD Heater Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
3 BF Heater Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
4 STB Heater Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
5 CD Cooling Water Solenoid Valve Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
6 BF Cooling Water Solenoid Valve Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
7 STB Cooling Water Solenoid Valve Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
8 Tank Cooling Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
9 STB 1-W Refilling Water Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
10 STB 2-W Refilling Water Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
11 STB 3-W Refilling Water Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
12 Cleaning Pump Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
13 Exhaust Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
14 Processor Condition Lamp (Green) Press the YES/START key to turn on, and the NO/STOP
key to turn off.
15 Processor Condition Lamp (Red) Press the YES/START key to turn on, and the NO/STOP
key to turn off.
16 Signal Lamp Press the YES/START key to turn on, and the NO/STOP
key to turn off.
35320 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35320
Maintenance
3. Mode
10 Circulation Pump Stand-by Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
Dryer Section
No. Display Operation
1 Dryer Fan Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
2 Dryer Heater 1 Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
3 Dryer Heater 2 Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
4 Dryer Heater 3 Press the YES/START key to start, and the NO/STOP key to
stop.
5 Dryer selection Solenoid Press the YES/START key to operate once.
35320 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35400
Maintenance
Reading and Writing Data This function is very useful when creating a print
channel using the data of other machine.
It is possible to read User Setting data from the
Bringing up the display INITIAL DATA1 or Back Up DATA that is saved in
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Maintenance → Reading and Writing the user level.
Data • Data related to the input section is written to INITIAL
DATA1.
• Data related to the printer and exposure is written to
INITIAL DATA2.
• Data related to the processor section is written to
INITIAL DATA3.
• Data related to the scanner and film carrier are
written to INITIAL DATA4.
• When the Reading Data is carried out in the user
level, the data cannot be read individually. All the
3. Mode
data is read from a floppy disk.
• Be sure to update the light source when having
performed Reading Data from the floppy disk
written the data of Back Up DATA of user level or
Back Up DATA of service personnel level.
☞ 6. Scanner data (Dctrl.lzh)
NOTE
• For the Stand Alone Printer, there is not the INITIAL
S3075-00-SM00 DATA4 FD.
Back Up DATA FD
! Explanation
Main (*1) Main.lzh
! 1. Writing Data (CPU → Floppy Disk), Reading Image Processing (*1) Image.lzh
Data (Floppy Disk → CPU) Pricing Unit (*1) Pu.lzh
The data can be read or written individually when the service Printer (*2) Printer.lzh
personnel password (2260) has been entered. Colorimeter unit (*2) Color.lzh
Data can be saved via the close down checks. (User level) LASER (*2) Laser.lzh
When carrying out Reading Data/Writing Data via Service
Correction Data for Brightness roi_SHD.lzh
Data, four floppy disks are required to save the data for each
of the Edge of Image Field (*2)
input, printer, processor, and scanner section.
Processor (*3) Proc.lzh
NOTE
• The FDs shown below are required. Auto Film Carrier (*4) Afm.lzh
Scanner (*4) Dctrl.lzh
User level Service personnel level
Misreg135_1.lzh
Back Up DATA INITIAL DATA1
Misreg135_2.lzh
INITIAL DATA2
Misreg135_4.lzh (*5)
INITIAL DATA3
Misreg135_6.lzh
INITIAL DATA4
Misreg135_8.lzh
Misreg135_9.lzh
IMPORTANT Misreg240_1.lzh
• When Writing Data is carried out in the user level, Misreg240_4.lzh
the individual data is written in the same manner as Misreg135_5.lzh (*5)
that in the service level.
Misreg240_7.lzh
• When Writing Data is carried out via Service Data,
Misreg240_8.lzh
Data which is to be written to the Back Up DATA of
user level is separated to the FDs of INITIAL Misreg240_9.lzh
DATA1, INITIAL DATA2, INITIAL DATA3, and Misreg110_1.lzh
INITIAL DATA4. Misreg110_9.lzh
• When the Reading Data is carried out via Service Misreg110_11.lzh
Data, User Setting Data appears. The Operator
Selections, IX Data Settings (except serial Misreg2B_1.lzh
number) and Print Channel Setting (except image MisregMMC_3.lzh
data) are read after reading the User Setting Data. MisregMMC_5.lzh (*5)
35400 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35400
Maintenance
3. Mode
backup
MisregMFC_8.Izh
idphoto.ini*1 ID photo data
MisregMFC_9.Izh
Template*1 Frame data set in the print
• (*1) Data which is to be written to INITIAL DATA1 for channel setting
Service Data. Client.mdb*1 Customer information in the
• (*2) Data which is to be written to INITIAL DATA2 for edit data
Service Data. PackExData.ini*1 Package frame information set
• (*3) Data which is to be written to INITIAL DATA3 for by user
Service Data. SplitSize.ini*1 Tiling data
• (*4) Data which is to be written to INITIAL DATA4 for ToneCurve.ini *1
Data of the tone curve shape in
Service Data. the Edit Mode
• (*5) This item is not contained in the backup depending PuFormatData.ini*1 Data that recorded the coupon
on the version of the system program. print standard format and the
NOTE insertion image path
• (*5) of the list is the data which has not been used PuFormatExData.ini*1 Data that recorded the coupon
after the upgrading the system program. print format which the user
If upgrading, the data cannot be deleted created and the insertion image
automatically. So the data which has not been used path
after the upgrading may still be contained in the PuPrt*1 All the image data inserted in
backup. the coupon print is saved in this
holder.
IMPORTANT
• The data relating to the auto film carrier (Auto gain *1. Not saved as backup data for DLS specification.
standard value and Frame stop position correction)
is stored in the EEP-ROM of the AFC/Scanner ! 5. Data unable to back up
control PCB. Therefore, it cannot be saved to a The following data cannot be saved in the Reading and
floppy disk. Writing Data. When replacing the HDD or PC main unit, be
sure to save the following data beforehand.
! 2. Format Floppy Disk
Data name Save to
Format (Initialize) floppy disks. Data can only be written onto
Image data C:\Image
a floppy disk which has been formatted.
Image saved Data in Edit C:\EditData
IMPORTANT mode
• Available floppy disk: 3.5 inch type 2 HD
• Floppy disks must be 1.44 MB format but not 1.2 MB IMPORTANT
format. • The saving destination of Image data may be
changed. When you back up, check the destination
! 3. Reading the laser history (floppy disk → on the Operator Selections display.
CPU)
If an error occurs on the laser, read the data to analyze it. ! 6. Scanner data (Dctrl.lzh)
When replacing the laser control PCB, read the data that is Among the scanner data written in the floppy disk, the data
saved using function of writing data. updated by the Light Source Update is pressed and saved with
setting the data other than that of the maximum/minimum
magnification to 0.
35400 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35400
Maintenance
IMPORTANT
• When having read the floppy disk data made a
backup, the Light Source Update is necessary after
reading the data. For this reason, the software is set
as follows.
Software contents (after reading FD data)
Set to be updated the light source automatically after the daily
setup.
Set the attention message urging you to update the light source to
occur by switching the film carrier.
3. Mode
NOTE
• The reason why the Light Source Update is necessary is
that the Light Source Update data saved on the side of
QSS at that point will be available and will not be
updated to the normal data even though the backup data
has been read normally.
And also, the second reason is that the FD data made a
backup remains as initial value after initializing the data.
• The reason why the data updated by the Light Source
Update is set to 0 in writing to FD is to reduce the storage
capacity and to save in one FD.
! Functions
! Path Setting
When reading and writing data, carry out the path setting to
save to the media except FD.
Only the media type set as Input/Output in option registration
can be carried out the path setting.
NOTE
• It can be set by entering the service personnel password
(2260).
*1. Reading the laser operation record is not available from reading
all data or service data but available from reading the laser
history (floppy disk → CPU).
35400 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35410
Maintenance
Reading and Writing Data [Stand • Data related to the scanner and film carrier are
written to INITIAL DATA4.
Alone Scanner] • When the Reading Data is carried out in the user
level, the data cannot be read individually. All the
Bringing up the display data is written to a floppy disk.
It is possible to read User Setting data from the
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Maintenance → Reading and Writing
INITIAL DATA1 or Back Up DATA that is saved in
Data
the user level.
• Be sure to update the light source when having
performed Reading Data from the floppy disk
written the data of Back Up DATA of user level or
Back Up DATA of service personnel level.
☞ 4. Scanner data (Dctrl.lzh)
Back Up DATA FD
Main (*1) Main.lzh
3. Mode
Image Processing (*1) Image.lzh
Pricing Unit (*1) Pu.lzh
Auto Film Carrier (*4) Afm.lzh
Scanner (*4) Dctrl.lzh
Misreg135_1.lzh
Misreg135_2.lzh
Misreg135_4.lzh (*5)
S3075-00-SM00
Misreg135_6.lzh
! Explanation Misreg135_8.lzh
Misreg135_9.lzh
! 1. Writing Data (CPU → Floppy Disk), Reading Misreg240_1.lzh
Data (Floppy Disk → CPU) Misreg240_4.lzh
The data can be read or written individually when the service Misreg135_5.lzh (*5)
personnel password (2260) has been entered. Misreg240_7.lzh
Data can be saved via the close down checks. (User level) Misreg240_8.lzh
When carrying out Reading Data/Writing Data via Service
Data, two floppy disks are required to save the data for each Misreg240_9.lzh
input and scanner section. Misreg110_1.lzh
NOTE Misreg110_9.lzh
• The FDs shown below are required. Misreg110_11.lzh
User level Service personnel level Misreg2B_1.lzh
35410 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35410
Maintenance
IMPORTANT ! Functions
• The data relating to the auto film carrier (Auto gain
standard value and Frame stop position correction) ! Path Setting
3. Mode
is stored in the EEP-ROM of the AFC/Scanner
control PCB. Therefore, it cannot be saved to a When reading and writing data, carry out the path setting to
floppy disk. save to the media except FD.
Only the media type set as Input/Output in option registration
! 2. Format Floppy Disk can be carried out the path setting.
NOTE
Format (Initialize) floppy disks. Data can only be written onto
a floppy disk which has been formatted. • It can be set by entering the service personnel password
(2260).
IMPORTANT
• Available floppy disk: 3.5 inch type 2 HD ! Data that will not be replaced by
• Floppy disks must be 1.44 MB format but not 1.2 MB backup data
format.
Basically, all data are replaced by backup data if read or
! 3. Writing All Data (CPU → Media), Reading All written.
Data (Media → CPU) Some data are not replaced however, which are listed below.
Backup the data to the media except FD. Data that are not replaced
The data to backup is as follows. Data of total counter, daily totals counter, daily sales totals, order
number, archive number, total counter 2
Data Contents
BkData####.dat The data saved with the usual
backup
35410 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35450
Maintenance
Procedures for Backup & Restore 2. The Backup Preferences display appears.
Software
IMPORTANT
• To backup at the recovery when installing, backup the
QSS system data, as well.
☞ 35400
! Backup data
Backup data
DLS system data minilab folder
Index logo data Logos folder
3. Mode
NOTE
• When the data other than above is to be saved, it can be
added optionally.
S072409
35450 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35450
Maintenance
8. The Backup Process display appears. 4. Make sure that the check boxes of Restore
Registry? and Restore archive database
index file? have not been checked.
When the check boxes have been checked, remove the
checks.
IMPORTANT
• When the Restore archive database index
file? check box is checked, the archive
database index file is returned to the setting
data which have been saved. The changed
data after saving become invalid.
IMPORTANT
• When restoring the data after carrying out
recovery of the IPW, be sure to put a check
3. Mode
mark to the Restore archive database index
file? check box.
5. Click Start Restore.
6. The Restore Process display appears.
S072410
! Restore procedure
S072411
35450 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35500
Maintenance
! Accessories
# CPU
The name of each control PCB is displayed.
NOTE
• For DLS specification, pricing unit, NMC and
NMC2 do not appear.
3. Mode
S3059-01-SM00
S3059-01-SM01
S3059-01-SM02
35500 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35500
Maintenance
# Version # Communication
The system program version number saved on all The communication status of all control PCBs is
control PCBs is displayed. displayed.
IMPORTANT OK: Communicating
-: Not communicating, not registered as an option,
• You can check the type of the laser unit by
not connected.
checking the version name of the LASER.
3. Mode
Type 0 Not displayed The versions of DLL and SYS file (driver) are displayed.
Type 1 # # # # L1 NOTE
*1 • It is displayed only when the service personnel password
Type 2 # # # # L2
(2260) has been entered.
Type 3*2 # # # # L3
*1. If you use LED light source kit 2 and LED light
source unit type 2, it is necessary to upgrade the
version as mentioned below.
Specification Version
For QSS specification 2.0 or later
For DLS specification 1.0 or later
Specification Version
For QSS specification 2.02 or later
For the Stand Alone Scanner 2.01 or later
specification
For DLS specification 1.02 or later
Specification Version
For QSS specification 4 or later
For the Stand Alone Scanner 4 or later
specification
For DLS specification Not corresponded
NOTE
• If there is an error such as the system program
cannot be executed or read, the boot flash version is
displayed.
35500 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35600
Maintenance
System update for each control PCB The software upgrade is carried out individually for each
control PCB (CPU).
(CPU) NOTE
• It is displayed only when the service personnel password
(2260) has been entered.
IMPORTANT
• This section explains the procedure for updating the
system of each control PCBs.
! Operation
For details about how to perform Software Upgrade,
refer to Updating the QSS software in Installation 1. Before upgrading, backup the system data.
procedures of the QSS software. ☞ 35400
☞ 88000 IMPORTANT
• When the external PC compatible with the CT-1 or QSS
• This backup data is stored just incase that the
printer driver has been connected, do not receive the
version upgrade would be failed, and used for
order or make prints before or during software
returning to the previous version.
upgrading. Upgrading may not be performed normally.
3. Mode
• When the CD-R external writing system has been 2. When Software Upgrade (CD-ROM) is
connected, be sure not to turn on/off the power supply selected, set the program CD.
just before or during upgrading. Upgrading may not be Each control PCB (CPU) is upgraded.
performed normally.
IMPORTANT
Bringing up the display • Data reading after upgrading is not necessary
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Maintenance → Software Upgrade as upgrading does not initialize the system
data.
Do not read the backup data of the previous
version after upgrading is successfully ended
as it may malfunction.
However, since the procedure differs
depending on the versions, be sure to refer to
the REPLACEMENT INSTRUCTION for
details.
3. Backup the system data after upgrading.
☞ 35400
IMPORTANT
• Be sure to backup the system data of the new
version, and be careful not to mix the backup
data of the previous version with the new one.
! Data
S3060-00-SM00
35600 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35600
Maintenance
3. Mode
*3. In case of the Stand Alone Printer, this does not appear.
35600 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35700
Maintenance
3. Mode
S3322-00-SM00
S3063-00-SM00 IMPORTANT
• In case of the Stand Alone Scanner, this does not
! Explanation appear.
• In case of the QSS-Kids, this does not appear.
! Error Record
NOTE
The error record is displayed in order from the latest one • The date when the data is reset is displayed on the lower
which has occurred. left part of the display.
The latest 20 errors can be checked.
NOTE
• Up to 500 errors can be checked when the service
personnel password (2260) has been entered.
Any older data than the latest 500 errors will be deleted.
35700 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35800
Maintenance
The described place varies depending on the specifications. See Processing solution name
below for the description for each specification. CD BF STB
• For SM specification, refer to ☞ Machine Specification P1 P2 PS
[SM]. P1 P2 P3
CD BF TCS
! Display PS1 PS2 PS3
Bringing up the display PJ1 PJ2 PJ3
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Maintenance → Machine
Specification ! Language (Initial value: ENGLISH)
The language loaded by the system program can be set.
3. Mode
ENGLISH KOREAN
JAPANESE PEKINESE
FRENCH TAIWANESE
GERMAN DANISH
ITALIAN GREEK
SPANISH DUTCH
PORTUGUESE FINNISH
RUSSIAN SWEDISH
INDONESIAN -
35800 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35800
Maintenance
! Display
Bringing up the display
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Maintenance → Machine
Specification
3. Mode
S3066-00-SM01
NOTE
• It can be set by entering the service personnel password
(2260).
! Explanation
35800 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35800
Maintenance
3. Mode
The language loaded by the system program can be set.
ENGLISH KOREAN
JAPANESE PEKINESE
FRENCH TAIWANESE
GERMAN DANISH
ITALIAN GREEK
SPANISH DUTCH
PORTUGUESE FINNISH
RUSSIAN SWEDISH
INDONESIAN -
! Installation Date
The installation date of the machine can be checked and set.
35800 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35810
Maintenance
! Functions
3. Mode
! Program Timer Setting
At the installation, set the date/time.
! Machine information
The machine type information is displayed.
S3066-00-SM02
NOTE
• It can be set by entering the service personnel password
(2260).
! Explanation
35810 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35920
Maintenance
Self-diagnostic scanned image though the scanned image saved to the storage
media was normal.
3. Mode
Put a check mark for Film Series Image Path and perform the
following checks, if the following errors occur or there is lack
of uniformity on the scanned image.
IMPORTANT
• 6642:D-ICE Control PCB error.
• 6822−10, 11, 21: Image Processing PCB Image
data operation error.
Diagnosis
Image Correction PCB Solo Check
Image Correction PCB Connection Check
S3348-00-SM00 D-ICE PCB Memory Check
Image Path Check D-ICE PCB Internal Image Path Check
Scanner -> D-ICE PCB Input Section
D-ICE PCB -> Main PC
D-ICE PCB -> Image Processing PCB (Input Memory)
Image Processing PCB (Input Memory) -> Main PC
Image Processing PCB -> Main PC
Photometry Section Dirt Check
NOTE
• The Film Series Image Path is not displayed for the
Stand-alone Printer.
Failed portion display
! Test Print
Put a check mark for Test Print and perform the following
checks, if an abnormal print is made from the scanned image
though the scanned image saved to the storage media was
normal.
S3408-00-SM00 NOTE
• Also perform the checks in the following conditions.
! Explanation • Lines and noises are seen on the print.
• The color on the print is not good. (Black and white are
! Image Path Check not good.)
Transfer the data in each data path to judge the failure part by • The color on the print gets worse by performing the
the CRC check or data comparison. setup.
35920 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35920
Maintenance
• The color on the print does not become better by ! Test Print Check Result
performing the setup.
Check the test print and put a checkmark to either of Good or
Diagnosis No Good of Test Print Check Result. Then the result of the
Image Correction PCB Solo Check diagnostics appears.
Image Correction PCB Connection Check
! Save Result
Main PC -> Image Processing PCB (Input Memory)
Image Processing PCB (Input Memory) -> Image The result of Image Path Check can be saved in a file.
Processing PCB (Expanded Memory) IMPORTANT
Image Processing PCB (Expanded Memory) -> Laser • The test result should be saved in
Control PCB C:\NoritsuKoki\QSS-
Test Print Check Result ##\LogData\DiagLogImgPass.Log.
Main PC -> Image Processing PCB (Expanded Memory) • Only one file is available to save the result.
Main PC -> Image Processing PCB (Composite Memory)
! Clear Result
3. Mode
Image Composition
Main PC -> Image Processing PCB (Expanded Memory) Delete the result of Image Path Check.
Image Correction
! Result
AOM Setup Value
The result of the test is displayed after Image Path Check is
completed.
NOTE
NOTE
• The Test Print is not displayed for the Stand-alone
• The AOM setup value may be displayed as Unknown in
Scanner.
the following condition.
• When making the test print, Dairy Setup or Initial Setup
! Media Series Image Path/Film Series Image
has not been performed for the selected paper.
Path/Test Print
Put a checkmark for all the Media Series Image Path, Film ! Checking procedure
Series Image Path and Test Print, and perform the following
checks when you are not sure what the problem is. 1. Select a Test Item.
NOTE
NOTE
• The diagnosis contains all the results of Media Series
• When a checkmark is given to the Test Print,
Image Path, Film Series Image Path and Test Print.
select a test print image.
! Test Print Image selection 2. The dialog for the Image Path Check
appears by clicking Start Test. Click YES to
Select the image to transfer from the images for checking the
start the test.
laser or the files.
NOTE 3. The parts with the problems are shown in the
• Available files are 24-bit BMP and 32-bit BMP files Failed portion display.
only.
Causes of the problem
35920 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35920
Maintenance
3. Mode
Failed to diagnose.*1
R Laser Deterioration
G Laser Deterioration
B Laser Deterioration
R Laser Failure
G Laser Failure
B Laser Failure
Setup failure S3406-00-SM00
! Drive
The media drive with the check mark is performed the writing
test.
! Name
Displays the name of media drive.
35920 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
35920
Maintenance
3. Mode
Can set how many tests are performed to write the data set to The media is write protected.
Data Size into the media drive. Capacity error.
Data Comparison error.
! Data Size (MB) (Initial value: 10) (input range: 1
to 500) Failed to read and write.
Can set the data size to perform the writing test to the media
drive.
! Execution Time
Displays the time required for performing the writing test to
the media drive.
NOTE
• The Execution Time varies depending on the number of
drives with the check marks, Executed Counts and Data
Size.
! Save Result
The result of Media Drive Self-diagnostic can be saved in a
file.
IMPORTANT
• The test result of writing to the media drive is saved
in C:\NoristuKoki\QSS-
##\LogData\DiagLogMedia.Log
• Only one file is available to save the writing test
result of the media drive.
! Clear Result
Delete the result of Media Drive Self-diagnostic.
! Checking procedure
35920 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36000
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
Paper sensor adjustment • The paper end sensor A is not displayed when the triple
magazine unit is not attached.
3. Mode
not been input.
• After Paper Sensor LED Light Intensity
Adjustment is completed normally, OK is
displayed.
OK: When the LED light intensity of each sensor
is from 1 to 169
• After Paper Sensor LED Light Intensity
Adjustment is not completed normally, − is
S3370-00-SM00
displayed.
NOTE −: When the LED light intensity of each sensor is
• The LED light intensity value of each sensor can be checked 0 or 170 or more
and set by inputting the service personnel password (2260).
! Explanation
! Functions
36000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36010
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
Paper Advance Unit Correction ! Arm Unit 2 (Left) Receive Stop Position
Correction Test Operation Confirmation
Bringing up the display The input correction value is validated and the arm unit 2 is
moved to the arm unit 2 (left) receive stop position.
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Maintenance → Various Adjustment
→ Printer Mechanical Adjustment → Paper Advance Unit
Correction ! Arm Unit 2 (Right) Receive Stop Position
Correction Test Operation
The input correction value is invalidated and the arm unit 2 is
moved to the arm unit 2 (right) receive stop position.
3. Mode
! Test Operation for the Paper Stop Position
Correction
The input correction value is invalidated and the paper is
advanced to the arm unit 2.
! Functions
36010 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36010
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
guide in paper advance unit 1 and front end 8. Input the correction value so that the
of arm unit 2 becomes 55.3±0.5 mm. dimension between the front ends of arm unit
2 and paper becomes 3.0±0.5 mm.
Paper Advance
Unit 1
Paper Advance Unit 1
55.3±0.5 mm
Arm unit 2
(upper)
Paper
3. Mode
Upper
paper
guide
G068451
NOTE
• Positive correction makes the arm unit move away Arm unit 2
from paper advance unit 1 and negative correction
makes it move close.
4. After inputting the correction value, execute
Arm Unit 2 (Left) Receive Stop Position 3.0±0.5 mm
Correction Test Operation via F:
Functions, then check that the value is G068452
36010 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36020
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
G066121
• A piece of paper with the advance length of 100 mm is
printed.
• The print pattern of the test print made with Test Print
3. Mode
(Confirmation) is as same as that made with Test Print
but of which color of the center line on the test prints
differ. (Red)
• The paper width, 〈A ####(#)〉 is printed as the CVP
imprinting.
! Adjustment
36020 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36030
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Mode
Input the number of the image where the cyan line aligns with
the magenta line on the test print BLOCK-D2.
! Functions
36030 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36030
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
part where the cyan line aligns with the the part where the cyan line aligns with the
yellow line. yellow line on the test print BLOCK-D2.
Magenta line Magenta line
Yellow line
Cyan lines
3. Mode
Cyan line Yellow line
G068456
G068454 IMPORTANT
IMPORTANT • Check the line using the loupe.
• Check the line using the loupe. • Loupe is a service personnel tool. Refer to
• Loupe is a service personnel tool. Refer to Service personnel tool list.
Service personnel tool list. ☞ 80310
☞ 80310 7. Input each checked number.
4. Check BLOCK-C 0i and input the offset 8. Carry out Test Print (Confirmation) of
value of main scanning and make a Test Functions.
Print again if there is no part where the cyan
line aligns with the magenta/yellow line on 9. Check that the lines (cyan, magenta and
the test print BLOCK-B. yellow) of the column 0a to 0h in BLOCK-B
make the straightest line comparing with the
Minus correction
other columns.
Check area
Plus correction
G068455
G068457
36030 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36030
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
Check area
3. Mode
G068458
Y
G068459
36030 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36040
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Mode
G066121
• A piece of paper with the advance length of 178 mm is
printed.
• The paper width, 〈A ####(#)〉 is printed as the CVP
imprinting.
! Adjustment
S3329-00-SM00
1. Check that the Exposure Zoom Rate
Correction and Exposure Position
NOTE
Adjustment have been complete.
• It can be set by entering the service personnel password
(2260).
☞ 36020
☞ 36030
! Explanation 2. Carry out Test Print of F: Functions.
IMPORTANT
This mode is used to correct dot displacement for each laser of
B, G and R on the both sides of a print. • Check line 160 usually.
• When you do not have the paper of 178 mm
IMPORTANT
width or more, make a test print with the
• When the exposure magnification fine adjustment is maximum paper size which you used, then
carried out for any one of magazine A, B or C, it is
complete.
• When you do not have the paper of 178 mm width or
more, make a test print with the maximum paper
size which you used, then measure the dimension of
the most outside line of it.
! Functions
36040 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36040
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
check the dimension of the most outside line • When correcting the magenta line to the left, input
of it. + correction value.
4. Input the correction value.
5. Carry out Test Print (Confirmation) of
Functions.
6. Check the magenta and yellow lines make a
straight line with cyan line in the vertical
direction at 0 on the test print again.
7. Carry out the Exposure Position Adjustment
again.
☞ 36030
3. Mode
1 dot
+correction −correction
G068460
IMPORTANT
• Check the line using the loupe.
• Loupe is a service personnel tool. Refer to
Service personnel tool list.
☞ 80310
3. Carry out the correction so that the magenta
and yellow lines make a straight line with
cyan line in the vertical direction at 0 on the
test print.
IMPORTANT
• Check line 160 usually.
• When you do not have the paper of 178 mm
width or more, make a test print with the
maximum paper size which you used, then
check the dimension of the most outside line
of it.
• If there is no image where magenta and cyan
lines make one line, carry out the fine
adjustment by 0.1 dot.
• Check the line with the most outside chart of
the test print.
NOTE
• When correcting the magenta line to the right,
input minus correction value.
36040 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36050
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Mode
! Rewind
The paper is rewound.
! Adjustment
! Test Paper Measurement Value (2nd) (Initial Papers Paper Advance Unit 2
value: 200.0 mm) (Input range: 180.0 to 220.0
mm)
G068461
The second test paper is for the correction of the advance
roller feed error.
5. Measure each test paper length of the first
and second paper which are removed.
36050 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36050
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Mode
Measurement Valued (1st, 2nd) to the initial values and
adjust them again.
36050 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36060
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
G066121
• The advance length of the test print is 457.0 mm.
• The paper width, 〈A ####(#)〉 is printed as the CVP
imprinting.
3. Mode
NOTE
• The advance length of the test print is 914.0 mm.
• The paper width, [A ####(#)] is printed as the CVP
imprinting.
36060 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36060
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
4. Set the paper magazine to be carry out arm Check that the difference of dimension of lines A
unit 1 zigzagging correction to magazine and C (on the second test print) is within the
mount A/B/C. tolerance level in the following table.
IMPORTANT
• Input the correction value in millimeter (mm). IMPORTANT
• Use a scale to measure the dimensions of • If the difference of dimensions of lines A and
lines A and C on the test print. C (on the second test print) is out of the
3. Mode
tolerance level, input the correction value to
NOTE A−C.
• When the measured values of the test print are line
A>C Plus correction
A: 121 mm and C: 120 mm, for example, see the
below. A<C Minus correction
• Line A (121 mm) − Line C (120 mm) = Correction
NOTE
value A − C (1 mm)
• When correcting 1.0 mm in (A-C), the zigzagging
Line A
of approx. 1.0 mm can be corrected on the test
print.
9. Check that the difference of dimension
A
Line C
G068462
36060 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36060
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
Line AA
Line A (120 mm)
A
B
3. Mode
C
IMPORTANT
• If the differences of dimensions of lines A and
C (on the first and second test prints) are out
of the tolerance level, check the zigzag
adjustment of the magazine mount.
☞ 22100
36060 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36070
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Mode
Validate Master (Exposure Center Correction Value) and
make a test print.
Input the length from the left end to the center line on the
leading end of the test print. ! Adjustment
36070 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36070
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
4. Check that Exposure Zoom Rate 5. Carry out Test Print Confirmation with
Correction has been completed. Master value of F: Functions.
☞ 36020 6. Measure dimension B from the left end to the
5. Set the paper magazine to carry out Master center line on the test print.
(Exposure Center Correction Value) to
IMPORTANT
magazine mount A/B/C.
• When measuring the test print, use the front
6. Select paper magazine A/B/C. end of the test print.
7. Carry out Test Print without Correction Center line
Value of F: Functions. Front end of the test print
IMPORTANT
• Make a test print with the maximum paper
size which you use.
8. Measure the length from the left end to the
3. Mode
center line and the length from the center line
to the right end on the leading end of the test
print.
Left end of the paper Right end of the paper
Center line
A
G068464
36080
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
Exposure Advance Adjustment A piece of paper with the advance length of 457 mm is
printed.
NOTE
Bringing up the display
• The paper width, [A ####(#)] is printed as the CVP
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Maintenance → Various Adjustment imprinting.
→ Printer Mechanical Adjustment → Exposure Advance
Adjustment ! Test Print Confirmation (Paper Magazine
A/B/C)
Validate the correction value that is entered for Exposure Start
Position Correction and Exposure Advance Motor Speed
Correction and then make a test print.
A piece of paper with the advance length of 457 mm is
printed.
NOTE
• The arrow is printed in purple on the print made as a test
3. Mode
print.
G066121
• The paper width, 〈A ####(#)〉 is printed as the CVP
S3316-00-SM00 imprinting.
NOTE
• Enter the service personnel password (2260) to bring up this ! Exposure Advance Pressure Inlet Roller Test
display. Print (Paper Magazine A/B/C)
Paper is advanced by the exposure advance unit inlet roller,
! Explanation and then a test print is made.
NOTE
Exposure Start Position Correction and Exposure Advance
Motor Speed Correction are carried out. • A piece of paper with the advance length of 305.0 mm is
Zigzagging due to the pressure of the inlet roller and exit roller printed.
of exposure advance unit is corrected.
! Exposure Advance Pressure Exit Roller Test
IMPORTANT Print (Paper Magazine A/B/C)
• If the exposure advance adjustment is carried out
for any one of magazine A, B or C, the correction is Paper is advanced by the exposure advance unit exit roller,
complete. and then a test print is made.
NOTE
! Paper Front End - 0 mm-line Test Paper • A piece of paper with the advance length of 305.0 mm is
Measurement Value (Initial value: 25.4 mm) printed.
(Input range: 22.4 to 28.4 mm)
! Loading (Paper Magazine A/B/C)
The Exposure Start Position is corrected.
Measure the length between the test paper front end and 0 The paper is loaded.
mm-line, then input measured value.
! Rewind
! 0 mm-line - 254 mm-line Test Paper
The paper which is being loaded is rewound.
Measurement Value (Initial value: 254.0 mm)
(Input range: 244.4 to 264.4 mm)
! Adjustment
The Exposure Advance Motor Speed is corrected.
Measure the length between 0 mm-line and 254 mm-line of
the test paper and input measured value.
Exposure Advance Adjustment
1. Select and execute Test Print (Paper
! Functions Magazine A, B or C) via F:Functions.
2. Measure the length between the paper front
! Test print (Paper Magazine A/B/C) end and 0 mm-line of the test print, then
Invalidate the correction value that is entered for Exposure input the measured value in Paper Front
Start Position Correction and Exposure Advance Motor Speed End - 0 mm-line Test Paper Measurement
Correction and then make a test print. Value.
36080 1/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36080
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Measure the length between 0 mm-line and Adjusting the paper zigzagging in the exposure
254 mm line of the test print, then input the advance unit
value in 0 mm-line - 254 mm-line Test
Paper Measurement Value.
1. Select and execute Exposure Advance
Pressure Inlet Roller Test Print (Paper
Paper Front End - 0 mm-line Test Paper Measurement Value Magazine A, B or C) via F:Functions.
Paper advance direction
IMPORTANT
A • Print the test print with the maximum paper
width which has been used.
2. Measure the lengths between 0 mm-line and
254 mm-line of right and left edges of the test
print and check that the difference is within
0.2 mm.
Paper advance direction
3. Mode
A
Left Right
Rear end
G068466
36080 2/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36080
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
4. Remove the pressure guide. (two locks) 6. Loosen the fixing screw of the exposure
Paper Advance Unit 1 advance unit inlet roller. (Loosen one fixing
Locks screw.)
7. Loosen the nut of the exposure advance unit
inlet roller. (Loosen one nut.)
8. Adjust the adjusting screw of the exposure
advance unit inlet roller. (one adjusting
screw)
Exit roller adjusting screw
Exit roller nut
3. Mode
Exit roller fixing
screw
G068468
36080 3/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36080
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Mode
Screwdriver
• When adjusting the pressure roller at the exit side in
the exposure advance unit, check the followings
since the banding may be found at the area 32 mm
from the paper leading end.
1. Turn the cam in the exposure advance unit to
release the pressure of the pressure roller at
the exit side and set the paper.
Left Right
Pressure roller
at the exit side
Cam G072398
36080 4/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36080
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Mode
Leading
Rear end
end
G074601
• When adjusting the pressure roller at the inlet side 2. Release the pressure of the pressure roller
in the exposure advance unit, check the followings at the exit side and set the paper. Make fine
since the banding may be occurred at the area 24 to adjustments of the cam in the exposure
27 mm from the paper rear end. advance unit so that the pressure release
amount of the pressure roller at the inlet side
is the thickness of about one sheet of paper.
36080 5/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36080
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Mode
Pressure roller at
the inlet side
Cam
G072397
IMPORTANT
• If the pressure adjustment is required,
perform ☞ 6 to ☞ 8 of Exposure Advance
Unit Zigzagging Adjustment.
4. Make some gray prints in the Print mode to
see if the banding occurs at the area 24 to 27
mm from the paper rear end.
Leading
end Rear end
24 to 27 mm
G074602
NOTE
• Any paper size is acceptable.
36080 6/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36090
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
G066121
• The paper width, 〈A ####(#)〉 is printed as the CVP
imprinting.
! Rewind
3. Mode
The paper which has been loaded is rewound.
! Adjustment
36090 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36090
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
3. Mode
Paper advance direction
G068471
10 11 12 13
Test print with no
banding
Print No.
36090 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36100
Printer Mechanical Adjustment
G066121
• A piece of paper with the advance length of 216 mm and
the margin of 5.0 mm is printed.
• The paper width, 〈A ####(#)〉 is printed as the CVP
3. Mode
imprinting.
! WB width correction
36100 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36700
Compact Archive Unit Adjustment
Compact Archive Unit Adjustment
Compact Archive Unit Initialization sequentially. This reduces the time for the hard disk drive
to access the data.
• Carry out Defrag regularly to improve the performance
Bringing up the display of the computer.
Menu: 2260 → Extension → Maintenance → Various Adjustment
→ Compact Archive Unit Adjustment → Compact Archive Unit
Initialization
! Procedure
3. Mode
S3401-00-SM00
! Explanation
G069963
The compact archive unit can be initialized or optimized.
3. Click Start.
IMPORTANT Initialization starts.
• The backup data of the compact archive unit is not IMPORTANT
made.
• You cannot change the setting of Capacity,
• If the data in the compact archive unit was initialized File system, Allocation unit size, and Enable
accidentally, it cannot be recovered. Compression on the format dialog.
• If you select the Enable Compression, it takes
! Functions approx. 35 minutes.
• If you select Quick Format, it finishes in a few
! Initialization of the Compact Archive Unit of seconds.
The image data which is saved in the hard disk drive of the
compact archive unit can be initialized. ! Defragmentation of the Compact Archive Unit
NOTE
• The service personnel password (2260) is required to
1. Click F: Functions.
display this.
36700 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36700
Compact Archive Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
G069964
IMPORTANT
• If the fragments is 7%, it takes approx. 25
minutes for defragmentation.
NOTE
• After finishing the defragmentation,
Defragmentation Complete is sometimes
displayed. When the message is displayed, select
Close.
36700 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36710
Compact Archive Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
Capacity
All capacity of the drive which is selected is displayed.
Free Space
Free space of the drive which is selected is displayed.
! Save Data
You can check the data saved in the compact archive.
NOTE
• Appears when Compact Archive Unit TYPE2 is
selected.
You can set the size of the capacity used for the compact
archive unit and that of the space used for Hold on save.
S3402-00-SM01 Size to be used for Compact Archive Unit
Set the size of space in the hard disk to be used for the
! Explanation compact archive unit.
Setting from 0.1 GB up to 80% of the hard disk drive capacity
You can check the compact archive unit capacity.
is available.
36710 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
36710
Compact Archive Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
36710 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
Scanner Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
is graphed out simultaneously.
! Display
Adjust the graph display area.
! Explanation
! Light Axis Adjustment
Adjust the vertical and horizontal tilt of the scanner unit.
! Threshold (input range: 0 to 4096)
For the waveform selected in Graph of Display, Number of
Pixels Exceeding the Threshold, in which the part over the
threshold is added up, is displayed.
37000 1/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
! Light Axis Adjustment Check 3. Adjust the scanner unit position so that the
upper value of waveform comes to the center
Carry out light axis adjustment check.
of trapezoidal graph.
NOTE
(Loosen the three adjusting screws and three fixing
• Check that the difference between the right and left nuts.)
values of Number of Pixels Exceeding the Threshold in
NOTE
the graph for the light axis check is within 4 pixels.
• Depending on the unit, the adjusting screw may be
changed to the hex. nut.
! Result
Same position
The result is displayed as OK or No Good.
3. Mode
Check the swing and tilt adjustment.
NOTE
• Change the focus value continuously, check if the focus
best positions are equal at the front and rear.
After completing, the result is displayed on the pop-up
display.
! Result
The result is displayed as OK or No Good.
NOTE
• After the Swing and Tilt Adjustment Check, if the
Trapezoidal graph
deviation of front and rear focus best position is 6 or less, S3396-01-SM01
OK appears. Fixing nuts
Adjusting
! Resolution
screws
The resolution of the waveform selected in Graph of Display
is calculated and displayed for each B, G, and R.
37000 2/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
IMPORTANT 1 2
3. Mode
S3396-01-SM02
G072392 7. Adjust the light axis of scanner unit so that
4. When the upper value of waveform on the the difference between the Number of
trapezoidal graph comes to the Pixels Exceeding the Threshold for 0 to
approximately center of four displays after 2670 and 2670 to 5340 becomes within 4
adjusting the scanner unit position, attach and the Result becomes OK.
the scanner adjustment chart to the AFC. (Loosen the three adjusting screws and three fixing
nuts.)
IMPORTANT
• For precautions for handling the scanner IMPORTANT
adjustment chart, refer to ☞ 4600. • Press the scanner unit against left back side
to adjust.
5. Set the AFC securely in the machine. • Adjust the adjusting screw so that the
6. Carry out adjustment using the scroll bar, waveform of swing and tilt, and light axis can
Display Area, Threshold, and Display be seen on the display.
Area Setting so that the relation between
Adjusting screw 1 Fixing nut
the waveforms and the horizontal red lines in
both right and left graphs is shown as Fixing nut
follows. Adjusting screw
37000 3/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
NOTE
screws, then click Light Axis Adjustment • When performing Display Area Setting,
Check. only the image 2 shown in the display
NOTE moves right and left.
• When the Result is OK, carry out swing and tilt • When performing Light Axis Adjustment
adjustment. of Display Area (Horizontal), the
• When the Result is No Good, carry out light axis waveforms 1 and 2 shown in the display
adjustment again. are enlarged or reduced.
9. Carry out swing and tilt adjustment. (3) Adjust the Threshold so that the middle of
☞ Adjustment of swing and tilt (when replacing or the peak of the waveform and the red line
readjusting the scanner unit)Reference which indicate the threshold cross the
positions of 1 and 2 shown in the display.
IMPORTANT
1 2
• After adjusting the light axis, the swing and tilt
adjustment is required.
IMPORTANT
• This is the procedure for only checking the light axis
of the scanner unit.
37000 4/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
checking the Light Axis Adjustment of the The range of the blue lines The range of the blue lines
120 AFC-II and 110 AFC-II is not required. The range of the red lines
Film carrier to be set Difference of G values
when checking the
light axis adjustment
135/240 AFC-II (135 lane) ±37 pixels
120 AFC-II ±28 pixels
110 AFC-II ±28 pixels
3. Mode
scanner adjustment chart is being adhered,
the chart gets damaged because the AFC
initial-activated operation starts.
S3396-01-SM02
! Adjustment of swing and tilt (when
replacing or readjusting the scanner IMPORTANT
unit) • If the waveform cannot be seen, check for the
position to which the scanner adjustment
This is the procedure for replacing or readjusting the scanner chart is attached and for Light Axis
unit. Adjustment.
Follow the procedure and adjust the scanner unit until the ☞ Light Axis Adjustment (when replacing or
result becomes OK. readjusting the scanner unit)
IMPORTANT 5. Adjust the resolution of the right and left
• OK appears when the value is 6/54 step or less. graphs to the approx. maximum.
• When only checking the swing and tilt of scanner (Loosen the two adjusting screws and two fixing nuts.)
unit, refer to ☞ Checking the swing and tilt (when IMPORTANT
only checking).
• Press the scanner unit against back side to
adjust.
1. Remove the scanner top cover and the • Depending on the unit, the adjusting screw
scanner front cover. may be changed to the hex. nut.
☞ 20030
2. Adhere the scanner adjustment chart to the Fixing nut
AFC. Adjusting
screws
IMPORTANT
• For precautions for handling the scanner
adjustment chart, refer to ☞ 4600.
3. Set the AFC securely in the machine. Fixing nuts
37000 5/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
the position between the vertical lines and the ! Checking the swing and tilt (when only
waveforms correctly again.
checking)
NOTE
• The resolution displays how much percentage the This is the procedure for checking whether the swing and tilt
height of the 8 small waveforms shares the height of the scanner unit is normal or not. Carry out the adjustment
of the 3 large waveforms. when the swing and tilt is not normal.
3. Mode
NOTE
1 135/240 AFC-II (135 lane)
• When the result is OK, the swing and tilt
adjustment is completed. 2 120 AFC-II
When it is No Good, return to ☞ 5 to carry out 3 110 AFC-II
the swing and tilt adjustment according to the
instructions on the display. This correction means
the rotation of the adjusting screw. IMPORTANT
7. Fix the scanner unit. • For precautions for handling the scanner
adjustment chart, refer to ☞ 4600.
8. After the adjustment, carry out Light Axis 2. Set the AFC securely in the machine.
Adjustment Check of Light Axis
Adjustment. If the waveform is shifted, re- 3. Carry out adjustment using the scroll bar and
adjustment is required. Standard Position so that the relation
☞ Light Axis Adjustment (when replacing or between the waveforms and the vertical red
readjusting the scanner unit) and blue lines in both right and left graphs is
9. Remove the scanner adjustment chart from shown as follows.
the AFC.
(1) Using the scroll bar, adjust the position so
IMPORTANT that the waveform of graph can be seen.
• If the adjustment mode is finished while the
scanner adjustment chart is being adhered,
(2) Using Standard Position, carry out
adjustment so that the three waveforms are in
the chart gets damaged because the AFC
between the red lines and the fine waveforms
initial-activated operation starts.
are in the center of the blue lines.
10. Attach the scanner top cover and scanner The range of the blue lines The range of the blue lines
front cover.
The range of the red lines
11. When it takes 20 minutes or more for the
light axis adjustment and swing and tilt
adjustment of the scanner unit, the ND filter
solenoid heats and malfunctions may occur.
When the ND filter solenoid is OFF, cool it about ten
minutes, then carry out the light source registration.
12. Carry out the light source registration.
☞ 37010
13. Carry out the focus adjustment.
☞ 37020
IMPORTANT
• After adjusting the swing and tilt, the light
source registration is required.
S3396-01-SM02
37000 6/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
• When the value of the 135/240 AFC-II (135
lane) is less than the following value,
checking the Swing and Tilt Adjustment of
the 120 AFC-II and 110 AFC-II is not
required.
Film carrier to be set Difference of G
values when
checking the swing
and tilt adjustment
135/240 AFC-II (135 lane) 27/54 step S3396-01-SM02
! Explanation
The scanner's Swing and Tilt/Light Axis are adjustable.
IMPORTANT
• The order of priority of the film carriers which are
used for the swing and tilt adjustment and light
axis adjustment is as follows.
Priority Film carrier to be set
1 135/240 AFC-II (135 lane)*1
2 120 AFC-II
3 110 AFC-II
*1. For the 135/240 AFC-II, use the 135 lane to carry out
Swing and Tilt Adjustment.
! Graph
When the image is scanned, the A/D value of each CCD pixel
is graphed out simultaneously.
37000 7/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
adjustment graph can be set. If the display area is NOTE
narrowed, the horizontal axis is magnified. • Although No Good may be displayed onscreen when
using S-4, the system is functioning normally as long as
# Display Area (Vertical) (Initial value: 3500) the value does not exceed that shown in the Light Axis
(Input range: 1 to 4096) Adjustment Confirmation Table.
The display area of the graph vertical-axis can be
set. If the display area is narrowed, the vertical-axis ! Swing and Tilt Adjustment
is magnified.
! Swing and Tilt Adjustment Check
# Graph
You can check the G value difference and swing and tilt
Each graph is displayed by selecting the check
adjustment at the same time.
boxes of B, G, R, and IR.
NOTE
IMPORTANT • Change the focus value continuously, check if the focus
• When the Light Axis Adjustment and Swing best positions are equal at the front and rear.
and Tilt Adjustment are carried out, be sure to After completing, the result is displayed on the pop-up
do at G only. display.
Check the value to see if it has dropped below that shown
! Focus value (initial value: 1302) (input range: − in the table below.
245 to +1561) Swing and Tilt Adjustment Confirmation Table
If necessary, the focus value can be changed. Film carrier to be set Difference of G
values when
checking the swing
! Light Axis Adjustment
and tilt adjustment
! Threshold value (Initial value: 600) (Input 135/240 AFC-II (135 lane) 27/54 step
range: 0 to 4096) 120 AFC-II 27/54 step
110 AFC-II 24/54 step
For the waveform selected in Graph of Display, Number of
Pixels Exceeding the Threshold, in which the part over the
threshold is added up, is displayed.
! Result
! Light Axis Adjustment Check The result is displayed as OK or No Good.
You can check G value differences and light axis adjustment NOTE
at the same time. • Although No Good may be displayed when using S-4,
NOTE the system is functioning normally as long as the value is
less than that shown in the Swing and Tilt Adjustment
• Confirm that the difference expressing the Number of
Confirmation Table.
Pixels Exceeding the Threshold on the left and right of
! Resolution
The resolution of the waveform selected in Graph of Display
is calculated and displayed for each B, G, and R.
37000 8/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
IMPORTANT
• This is the procedure for only checking the light axis
of the scanner unit.
3. Mode
Priority Film carrier to be set
1 135/240 AFC-II (135 lane)
S3396-01-SM02
2 120 AFC-II
3 110 AFC-II 4. Verify that the difference in the TAGNumber
of Pixels Exceeding the ThresholdTAG
between TAG0 to 2670TAG and TAG2670 to
IMPORTANT 5340TAG is within the range shown on the
• For handling the scanner adjustment chart, TAGLight Axis Adjustment Confirmation
refer to ☞ 4600. TableTAG.
NOTE
2. Set the AFC securely in the machine.
• You need not check the Light Axis Adjustment
3. Carry out adjustment using the scroll bar, of the 120 AFC-II and 110 AFC-II if the value of
Display Area, Threshold, and Display the 135/240 AFC-II (135 lane) is less than the
Area Setting so that the relation between value shown on the Light Axis Adjustment
the waveforms and the horizontal red lines in Confirmation Table.
both right and left graphs is shown as Light Axis Confirmation Table
follows.
Film carrier to be set Difference of G values
when checking the
(1) Carry out adjustment using the scroll bar so light axis adjustment
that only the largest waveform for the light
135/240 AFC-II (135 lane) ±37 pixels
axis adjustment (1 pixel side) can be seen.
120 AFC-II ±28 pixels
(2) Carry out adjustment using the scroll bar, 110 AFC-II ±28 pixels
Light Axis Adjustment of Display Area
(Horizontal) and Display Area Setting so
that only the largest waveform for the light IMPORTANT
axis adjustment (5340 pixel side) can be seen • If the difference of Number of Pixels
in the display below. Exceeding the Threshold is more than the
value shown in the Light Axis Adjustment
NOTE Confirmation Table, theScanner unit, the
• When performing Display Area Setting, AFC-II, and/or the Scanner adjustment
only the image 2 shown in the display chart may be defective.
moves right and left.
• When performing Light Axis Adjustment
5. Remove the scanner adjustment chart from
of Display Area (Horizontal), the the AFC.
waveforms 1 and 2 shown in the display IMPORTANT
are enlarged or reduced.
• If the adjustment mode is finished while the
(3) Adjust the Threshold so that the middle of scanner adjustment chart is being adhered,
the peak of the waveform and the red line the chart gets damaged because the AFC
which indicate the threshold cross the initial-activated operation starts.
positions of 1 and 2 shown in the display.
37000 9/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37000
Scanner Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
the 135/240 AFC-II (135 lane) is less than the
2 120 AFC-II value shown on the Swing and Tilt Adjustment
3 110 AFC-II Confirmation Table.
Swing and Tilt Adjustment Confirmation Table
IMPORTANT Film carrier to be set Difference of G
• For handling the scanner adjustment chart, values when
refer to ☞ 4600. checking the swing
and tilt adjustment
2. Set the AFC securely in the machine. 135/240 AFC-II (135 lane) 27/54 step
3. Carry out adjustment using the scroll bar and 120 AFC-II 27/54 step
Standard Position so that the relation 110 AFC-II 24/54 step
between the waveforms and the vertical red
and blue lines in both right and left graphs is IMPORTANT
shown as follows. • If the difference of Resolution is more than
the values in the Swing and tilt adjustment
(1) Using the scroll bar, adjust the position so check table, Scanner unit, AFC-II, and
that the waveform of graph can be seen. Scanner adjustment chart may be
defective.
(2) Using Standard Position, carry out
adjustment so that the three waveforms are in 6. Remove the scanner adjustment chart from
between the red lines and the fine waveforms the AFC.
are in the center of the blue lines.
IMPORTANT
The range of the blue lines
• If the adjustment mode is finished while the
scanner adjustment chart is being adhered,
The range of the red lines the chart gets damaged because the AFC
initial-activated operation starts.
S3396-01-SM02
37000 10/10
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37010
Scanner Unit Adjustment
! Registration
3. Mode
When the film size has already been registered, ON is
displayed. When it is not registered, OFF is displayed.
IMPORTANT IMPORTANT
• Because the CCD valid range of the MMC-II and • The light source registration for other than the crop
AMC-II are calculated with 135 lane of 135/240 card is executed at the attachment for adjusting.
AFC-II or 135 AFC-II, there are limits to carry out
Light Source Registration and Area Registration.
• When installing the machine, replacing the scanner
unit or carrying out Swing and Tilt/Light Axis
Adjustment of scanner unit, be sure to carry out
Light Source Registration of MMC-II and AMC-II
or Area Registration, after carrying out Light
Source Registration with 135 lane of 135/240
AFC-II and 135 AFC-II or Area Registration
NOTE
• For another film carrier, carry out light source
registration for each film size.
• After carrying out Light source Registration or Area
Registration, the focus adjustment is required.
37010 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37010
Scanner Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
Crop card attachment
G078428
37010 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37020
Scanner Unit Adjustment
! Focus Value
Enter the focus value.
! Resolution
The resolution of the waveform selected in Graph of Display
is calculated and displayed for each B, G, and R.
3. Mode
! Functions
! Magnification Change
Changes the magnification rate of the scanner zoom lens.
37020 1/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37020
Scanner Unit Adjustment
2. Adjust the scroll bar and Standard Position filter solenoid heats and malfunctions may
so that the relation between the waveform of occur.
the graph and the longitudinal red and blue When the ND filter solenoid is OFF, cool it about ten
lines in the graphs is shown as follows. minutes, then carry out the light source update.
8. Carry out Light Source Update.
(1) Using the scroll bar, adjust the position so ☞ 37030
that the waveform of graph can be seen.
(2) Using the Standard Position key, carry out ! Adjustment procedure (for 135/240
adjustment so that the three waveforms are
MMC-II and 135/240 AMC-II)
between the blue lines and the fine
waveforms are between the red lines.
IMPORTANT
The range of the blue lines The range of the red lines • For the focus adjustment of 135/240 AMC-II and
135/240 MMC-II, adjusting with each magnification
rate from ×0.720 to ×1.251 must be carried out all at
3. Mode
once.
• If you closed the mode or moved the stop position of
the scanner adjustment chart before finishing the
adjustment with all magnification rate, adjust it from
×0.720.
• Focus for S-2/S-3 and S-4 is automatically adjusted
to a different rate of magnification.
Adjustment procedures for 135/240 MMC-II and
135/240 AMC-II are the same as those for S-2/S-3.
Scanner types Magnification
S-2/S-3 ×0.720 to ×1.251
S-4 ×0.621 and ×1.344
37020 2/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37020
Scanner Unit Adjustment
or out of the area, adjust it with Adjust (L) between the blue lines and the fine
and Adjust (R). waveforms are between the red lines.
Waveform B, G, R for the light axis check The range of the blue lines The range of the red lines
3. Mode
Waveform B, G, R for the focus adjustment
S3230-01-SM01
S3230-01-SM02
IMPORTANT
5. Adjust the focus value so that the resolution
• For the 135/240 MMC-II and 135/240 of the graph is approx. maximum.
AMC-II, the waveform may not be
shown because the positioning of the 6. Carry out Focus Auto Adjustment.
scanner adjustment chart (mount)
which is set to the MMC is not decided.
IMPORTANT
In this case, adjust the mount carrier by • If the message The measurement failed.
pressing Adjust (L) and Adjust (R). appears, carry out the focus adjustment again
while the waveform is displayed in the graph.
NOTE
• Adjust (L) and Adjust (R) buttons can be
7. Select the next magnification rate using
used only when the magnification rate is
Magnification Change in Functions.
×0.720. 8. Carry out Focus Auto Adjustment.
IMPORTANT
• For the focus adjustment of 135/240 AMC-II
and 135/240 MMC-II, adjusting with each
magnification rate from ×0.720 to ×1.251
must be carried out all at once.
9. When it takes 20 minutes or more for the
focus adjustment of the scanner unit, the ND
filter solenoid heats and malfunctions may
occur.
Adjust (L) and Adjust (R) When the ND filter solenoid is OFF, cool it about ten
minutes, then carry out the light source update.
10. Carry out Light Source Update.
☞ 37030
S3230-01-SM01
(2) Restore the value in Display Area ! Adjustment procedure (for other than
(Horizontal) to 250 to show only the the MFC: crop card attachment)
waveform for the focus adjustment.
(3) Using the Standard Position key, carry out IMPORTANT
adjustment so that the three waveforms are • For other than the crop card attachment of MFC, it is
always necessary to carry out Area Registration for
each attachment before carrying out Focus
adjustment. ☞ 32570
37020 3/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37020
Scanner Unit Adjustment
• For the focus adjustment of MFC, the adjustment for or out of the area, adjust it with Adjust (L)
all magnification rate from ×0.621 to ×1.344 is and Adjust (R).
required.
• If you closed the mode or moved the position of the Waveform B, G, R for the light axis check
scanner adjustment chart before finishing the
adjustment with all magnification rate, adjust for all
again from ×0.621.
3. Mode
135F attachment
IMPORTANT
• In the case of the MFC:135 F
attachment, waveform of the scanner
adjustment chart may not appear. In
this case, adjust the attachment
position by pressing Adjust (L) and
Adjust (R).
NOTE
• Adjust (L) and Adjust (R) buttons can be
used only when the magnification rate is
×0.621.
G078433
37020 4/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37020
Scanner Unit Adjustment
between the blue lines and the fine 2. Set the scanner adjustment chart to the
waveforms are between the red lines. MFC: crop card attachment and press Yes.
The range of the blue lines The range of the red lines Scanner adjustment chart
3. Mode
G078431
the MFC: crop card attachment) (2) Using the Standard Position key, carry out
adjustment so that the three waveforms are
IMPORTANT
• Focus adjustment for the MFC: crop card
attachment requires adjusting magnification of
×0.621 only.
37020 5/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37020
Scanner Unit Adjustment
The range of the blue lines The range of the red lines
3. Mode
S3230-01-SM02
37020 6/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37030
Scanner Unit Adjustment
IMPORTANT
• For other than the crop card, update the light source
3. Mode
at the attachment for adjustment.
• For the crop card, update the light source at the crop
card attachment.
S1046-00-SM01
! Explanation
The light source amount changes every day due to the
operating environment. Correct the changed light source
intensity value in Light Source Update.
NOTE
• Be sure to update the light source after the focus Crop card attachment
adjustment for the scanner unit or after reading data from
the backup FD.
! Registration
When the film size has already been registered, ON is
displayed. When it is not registered, OFF is displayed.
37030 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37030
Scanner Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
37030 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37300
Laser Unit Adjustment
Laser Unit Adjustment
3. Mode
! Laser Unit Thermosensor Display Section
The temperature of the laser unit temperature sensor is
displayed.
NOTE
• The laser unit control temperature is adjusted to become
S3271-00-SM00 within the controlled temperature by using the laser unit
heater and the laser unit cooling fan 1, 2 which are
equipped in the laser unit.
! Explanation
• The laser unit control temperature becomes within the
Laser Unit Thermosensor controlled temperature, and then controlling temperature
of the R laser will start.
R Laser Thermosensor
• When the displayed temperature is within the following
range, it is normal.
R laser
Condition Details
r
ase
r
se
la
Bl
Laser unit cooling fans 1 and 2: When the laser unit temperature
ON sensor exceeds 30°C.
Laser unit cooling fans 1 and 2: When the laser unit temperature
OFF sensor lowers to 27°C or less.
Laser unit heater: ON When the laser unit temperature
sensor lowers to 25°C or less.
Laser unit heater: OFF When the laser unit temperature
sensor exceeds 26°C.
37300 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37500
Operation Information
Operation Information
! Explanation
If a problem occurs while the QSS is running, the operation
status when the problem occurs is recorded to HDD as a
Logdata file.
IMPORTANT
• Usually the Logdata file is stored automatically,
however it can be stored manually too. Select the
file to save, if necessary.
• The Logdata file is stored automatically in the
following conditions.
• When an error occurs:
3. Mode
• When an abnormality occurs in the system program:
S0100-WIN-SM00
• Up to 10 Logdata files that are stored automatically
are saved. When the number of Logdata files
2. Bring up the Start menu and select
exceeds 10, the files will be overwritten from the Accessories via Programs.
oldest one. 3. Select Windows Explorer.
• If the problem occurs several times, or another
problem occurs subsequently, it records the time 4. Select C:\NKData\LogData in the Local
and the contents of the problem. Disc:C via My Computer.
NOTE
5. Select the necessary Logdata file.
• If a problem occurs in the software, save the information NOTE
shown below with the Logdata and memory data. • The Logdata files that are stored automatically are
• Status when the problem occurs saved in compressed.
• Operation before the problem occurs • The file name is used from Logdata00.lzh to
Logdata09.lzh.
• With or without a error, its kind
• Select the necessary file referring to the saved
• Save the paper which is used when the problem time of Logdata file.
occurs.
• Any other things you realized 6. Press the C key while pressing the Ctrl key
with the file selected.
Copy the Logdata using the shortcut key.
! How to obtain
7. Press the V key while pressing the Ctrl key.
! To obtain Logdata recorded automatically Paste the Logdata using the shortcut key.
when the problem occurs
8. The file creating time and the contents about
NOTE the problem are recorded in the Copy of
• This is the data not included in saving at the same time. File.
Save the data if necessary, for example, when the 9. Save the Logdata to the storage media.
situation in which the problem occurs cannot be recurred.
☞ 37520 NOTE
• The size of the Logdata is large, therefore save it
1. Press the Windows key on the keyboard if to a storage media which has a large capacity such
as MO.
QSS software works.
NOTE ! To obtain Logdata at present
• For DLS specification, switch the DLS display to
the key operator mode or service operator mode NOTE
and then move to the QSS menu. It displays the • This is the data included in saving at the same time.
taskbar and makes the Windows key selectable. ☞ 37520
37500 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37500
Operation Information
1. Press the L key while pressing the Ctrl key 9. The file creating time and the contents about
and the Alt key on the keyboard when the the problem are recorded in the Copy of
problem occurs. File.
NOTE 10. Save the Logdata to the storage media.
• For specifications other than DLS, the operation
NOTE
can be performed using only the Alt key and the L
key. • The size of the Logdata is large, therefore save it
to a storage media which has a large capacity such
as MO.
IMPORTANT
• Be sure to carry out this operation
immediately after the problem occurs. The
correct information cannot be recorded after
changing the mode or performing other
operations.
2. Press the Windows key on the keyboard if
3. Mode
QSS software works.
NOTE
• For DLS specification, switch the DLS display to
the key operator mode or service operator mode
and then move to the QSS menu. It displays the
taskbar and makes the Windows key selectable.
S0100-WIN-SM00
37500 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37510
Operation Information
NOTE
• This is the data included in saving at the same time.
☞ 37520
! Explanation
If a problem occurs during the QSS operation, the operation
status at present can be recorded as a memory data file.
IMPORTANT
• The memory data is from the each CPU.
• The recorded memory data is not the one recorded
automatically when the problem occurs.
3. Mode
Be sure to save the data when the problem occurs.
S1146-02-SM00
• If the problem occurs several times, or another
problem occurs subsequently, it records the time 2. Press Memory data inhale.
and the contents of the problem. The display to select CPU appears.
NOTE
• If a problem occurs in the software, save the information
shown below with the Logdata and memory data.
• Status when the problem occurs
• Operation before the problem occurs
• With or without a error, its kind
• Save the paper which is used when the problem
occurs.
• Any other things you realized
! Saving procedure
S1146-06-SM01
37510 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37510
Operation Information
IMPORTANT
• The acquired file should be named the store
name, date and the running number.
• Example: Noritsu12-24-01
Noritsu (store name) 12 (month) -24 (day) -01
(running number)
3. Mode
37510 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37520
Operation Information
! START
Saves the memory data and Logdata to the files.
! CANCEL
Closes the Read All Memory Data & Save LogData display
and returns to the QSS display.
! Saving procedure
3. Mode
1. Press the Ctrl key, the Alt key and the Y key
on the keyboard when the problem occurs.
The Read All Memory Data & Save LogData display
appears.
NOTE
G074617 • For specifications other than DLS, the saving
display appears pressing only the Alt key and the
! Explanation Y key.
! Save in
Shows the saving destination of the memory data and Logdata
files.
37520 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37520
Operation Information
3. Mode
G074618
IMPORTANT
• When closing the Read All Memory Data &
Save LogData display forcibly using
Ctrl+Alt+Delete, the QSS and PC operations
may be unstable.
• If starting the memory data and Logdata
saving function during the QSS process
(printing, outputting to the media, etc.), the
QSS process and saving data at the same
time may be unstable.
3. When finishing saving the memory data and
Logdata, the screen returns to the QSS
display.
4. End
37520 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37530
Operation Information
3. Mode
S1146-02-SM01
! Explanation
Since communication of each control PCB cannot be performed when No. 6901 ARCNET communication error. occurs, it cannot
go into the System Version Check display from Extension.
When No. 6901 ARCNET communication error. occurs, If System Version Check is used in the following procedure, it can go into
the System Version Check display easily.
! Procedure
37530 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37530
Operation Information
3. Mode
S1146-02-SM01
4. The System Version Check display appears by clicking System Version Check.
S3059-01-SM00
5. Confirm the Version and Communication on the System Version Check display.
# Communication
The communication status of all control PCBs is displayed.
OK: Communicating
-: Not communicating, not registered as an option, not connected.
IMPORTANT
• Since communication data has collected on the ARCNET circuit when ARCNET communication error.
occurs, therefore, by the time OK is displayed, this thing will have time.
# Version
The system program version number saved on all control PCBs is displayed.
Version is displayed.: It is communicating.
Version is not displayed.: Not communicating, not registered as an option, not connected.
IMPORTANT
• As a result of main CPU's performing an ARCNET communication demand to each control PCB, when
main CPU receives the communication OK signal which each control PCB sent, the version of each control
PCB is displayed.
• If OK is displayed on Communication field, a version will remain displayed even if communication is
become - after that.
6. Perform the diagnosis of ARCNET communication error.
☞ 50520
37530 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
37600
Operation Information
! Explanation
Save the log file of DLS software when a problem occurs
during the operation.
IMPORTANT
• It is also necessary to save Logdata and memory
data of QSS.
☞ 37520
NOTE
• If a problem occurs in the software, save the following
information at the same time.
3. Mode
• Status when the problem occurs
• Operation before the problem occurs
• With or without a error, its kind
• Save the paper which is used when the problem
occurs.
• Any other things you realized
! Saving procedure
37600 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
38000
Flatbed execution display
Flatbed execution display
3. Mode
S0100-FB-SM00
! Explanation
It appears when selecting scanner as an input media on the
order display of QSS and pressing .
It does not appear with the check mark for auto color
correction.
IMPORTANT
• This display appears when using the FB scanner
(EPSON type) which is prepared by customers.
38000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4. Troubleshooting
4 Troubleshooting
Symptoms result from blowout of fuse (processor section) ................................................................................4253
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart .............................................................................. 4302
The message, Laser temperatures are being adjusted. does not disappear from the order display. ....................4302
An abnormal print is made ..................................................................................................................................4304
Checking for media drive defect .........................................................................................................................4305
PC does not start properly. ..................................................................................................................................4306
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print ................................................................... 4400
BGR uneven colors or white strips (film advance direction) ..............................................................................4400
Line like a bar code (film advance direction) ......................................................................................................4401
Light density line (white) (paper advance direction) ...........................................................................................4450
Monochrome line (perpendicular to paper advance direction) ............................................................................4451
Light color is appeared in unexposure position ...................................................................................................4452
Stripped pattern like a wavy line .........................................................................................................................4453
Diagnosis appendix: FB scanner ........................................................................................... 4500
List of FB scanner's error message (for EPSON type) ........................................................................................4500
Diagnosis appendix: Scanner adjustment chart .................................................................... 4600
About the scanner adjustment chart .....................................................................................................................4600
DLS Error Messages ............................................................................................................. 4900
DLS Error Messages ............................................................................................................................................4900
System Error messages (No. 3-) ........................................................................................... 4910
No. 3-1 WIP Partition is Half Full .....................................................................................................................4910
No. 3-2 WIP Partition is Three Quarters Full ....................................................................................................4910
No. 3-3 WIP Partition Is Full .............................................................................................................................4910
No. 3-4 WIP Partition Is Full .............................................................................................................................4910
No. 3-6 Order Failed Image Analysis ................................................................................................................4911
Archive Error messages (No. 6-) ........................................................................................... 4920
No. 6-1 Insufficient Store-It Disk Space ...........................................................................................................4920
4000 1/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 12-13 Print Creation Error ..........................................................................................................................4975
No. 12-14 Order Queuing Failed .......................................................................................................................4975
No. 12-40 Error Preparing a Print .....................................................................................................................4977
Media Output Error messages (No. 13-) ............................................................................... 4980
No. 13-12 CD Authoring Complete ..................................................................................................................4980
No. 13-13 CD Authoring Complete ..................................................................................................................4980
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver ...................................................................... 40101
No. 101 Start the QSS and enter the Net Scan mode. .....................................................................................40101
No. 103 The QSS is already connected to another QSS TWAIN driver. Would you like to search for another
QSS? ...................................................................................................................................................................40101
No. 107 48 bit image may not correspond, depending on application. Would you like to enable the setting?
............................................................................................................................................................................40107
No. 110 Error/Attention has occurred in the QSS. Check the QSS. ..............................................................40107
No. 115 The COM port for the external controller is already occupied by another application. Confirm the use
condition of the COM port. ...............................................................................................................................40108
No. 116 Failed to open the COM port for the external controller. ..................................................................40108
No. 117 Would you like to stop processing? ...................................................................................................40109
No. 502 Failed to connect with the QSS. Would you like to search the QSS? .............................................40110
No. 504 This version does not match the QSS. ...............................................................................................40110
No. 505 Communication has been disconnected. The QSS TWAIN driver will be closed. .........................40111
No. 508 A QSS TWAIN driver has been started. Multiple QSS TWAIN drivers cannot be started together.
............................................................................................................................................................................40111
No. 512 Error/Attention has occurred in the QSS. Quit the process. .............................................................40112
No. 513 Language version of message data is incorrect. Messages are displayed in English. ......................40113
No. 514 There is insufficient memory. ............................................................................................................40113
4000 2/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 0704[SM] Press the [YES/START] key to initialize the remaining amount of the Replenishment Package.
............................................................................................................................................................................40704
No. 0705-####[SM] Replace the Replenishment Package with a new one.P-# ..............................................40704
4000 3/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 1028 More than 3 correction keys of low, middle or high density area. Execute correction? ................41028
No. 1029 The measurement failed. Measure it again. .....................................................................................41028
No. 1030 Wait until printing is complete. .......................................................................................................41030
No. 1031 Paper Specification Registration Setup was not completed. ...........................................................41030
No. 1032 One moment please. . . .....................................................................................................................41032
No. 1035 Paper Magazine Registration Setup is not completed. ....................................................................41034
No. 1038 Paper type for the magazine is not set. ............................................................................................41038
No. 1039 Paper type specification is not set. ...................................................................................................41038
No. 1040 Press the [ORDER] key. ..................................................................................................................41040
No. 1041 Unable to accept additional processing at this time. The order will be counted. Wait until the output
process is complete. ...........................................................................................................................................41040
No. 1043 Laser temperature is being adjusted. One moment please. . . .........................................................41042
No. 1047-#### Close printer door. ..................................................................................................................41046
No. 1048 Press the [ORDER] key. Wait until output has completed. ............................................................41048
No. 1052-#### The Paper Magazine is out of paper. Paper Magazine C ......................................................41052
No. 1053 Would you like to feed the leading edge of paper? Paper Magazine C ..........................................41052
No. 1065 Would you like to continue? ............................................................................................................41064
No. 1067 Attach the Paper Magazine. Paper Magazine C .............................................................................41066
No. 1068 Replace the Paper Magazine. Paper Magazine C ...........................................................................41068
No. 1072 Paper color intensity is low. Execute correction? ...........................................................................41072
No. 1074-#### Sensors may be dirty. .............................................................................................................41074
No. 1080 Unable to accept additional processing at this time. Press the [ORDER] key. ..............................41080
No. 1081 The Paper Magazine is out of paper. ...............................................................................................41080
Attention message: Scanner ............................................................................................... 41302
No. 1302 Would you like to stop scanning? ....................................................................................................41302
No. 1305 Photometry Section may be dirty. ...................................................................................................41304
No. 1306 Update the light source. If film remains in the Film Carrier, remove it. ........................................41306
No. 1313 The Focus Adjustment was not completed yet. ...............................................................................41312
No. 1314 Light source evenness is out of allowable range. ............................................................................41314
No. 1315-#### LED Light Source temperature is being adjusted.process cannot be continued. ...................41314
No. 1316 Focus Adjustment failed. .................................................................................................................41316
No. 1317 Failed to perform the Scan Position Auto Correction. ....................................................................41316
No. 1319 Scanner type was changed. The system will be restarted. ..............................................................41318
4000 4/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 1417 Close the Mount Insertion Cover. ....................................................................................................41416
No. 1420 Select the DX code. .........................................................................................................................41420
No. 1421 Confirm the stop position of all the frames to be processed. ...........................................................41420
No. 1422 Select the 135 lane. ..........................................................................................................................41422
No. 1423 Execute Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment. Remove the film from the Film Carrier. .........41423
No. 1424 Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment is being executed. ............................................................41423
No. 1425 Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment is complete. .....................................................................41423
No. 1426 Attach the 110 AFC. ........................................................................................................................41426
No. 1427 Execute Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment. If film remains in the Film Carrier, remove it. 41426
No. 1428 Remove the mount from the Film Carrier. ......................................................................................41428
No. 1429 Make sure that the mount is placed correctly. .................................................................................41428
No. 1430 Confirm the frame size. ...................................................................................................................41430
No. 1431 Attach the 120 AFC. ........................................................................................................................41430
No. 1432 Attach the MMC. .............................................................................................................................41432
No. 1433 Attach the AMC. ..............................................................................................................................41432
No. 1435 Insertion direction of film is different. Insert the film from the rear end (end with largest frame number).
............................................................................................................................................................................41434
No. 1438 Set the attachment. ...........................................................................................................................41438
No. 1439 Light Source was not updated. Would you like to scan? ................................................................41438
4000 5/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 1516 Data is too large to read. ..................................................................................................................41516
No. 1517 Invalid image format. Failed to read. ...............................................................................................41516
No. 1518 Output media is the same as Input media. Select different one. .....................................................41518
No. 1519 Data has been written to this media. Would you like to delete all the written files? .....................41518
No. 1520 Select the template. ..........................................................................................................................41520
No. 1521 Template information does not match to make the Album Print. ....................................................41520
No. 1522 Are you sure to print the previous frame except selected one? .......................................................41522
No. 1523 It was not registered as an option. ...................................................................................................41522
No. 1524 CD-R External Writing System is being output. .............................................................................41524
No. 1526 Cannot disconnect the USB flash memory. Do you want to try again? ..........................................41526
No. 1527 Write the data. Set the media. ..........................................................................................................41526
No. 1528 Registered Print Type of Print Channel is not for normal printing. ................................................41528
No. 1529 Failed to read the bar code. ..............................................................................................................41528
4000 6/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 1546 Data could not be written to the media. Confirm that the media capacity matches the Media Capacity
Setting. ...............................................................................................................................................................41546
No. 1547 Data was saved to the storage media. Remove the media. ..............................................................41546
No. 1548 Hard disk is full. Would you like to delete the image file(s)? ........................................................41548
No. 1549 Data is too small to read. .................................................................................................................41548
Attention message: Colorimeter .......................................................................................... 41550
No. 1550 Register the Calibration Plate Data. .................................................................................................41550
No. 1551 The calibration plate data is out of range. Register the data? ..........................................................41550
No. 1552-#### The paper in the Colorimeter is too short. It cannot be measured. .........................................41552
Attention message: Pricing unit ........................................................................................... 41600
No. 1601-#### Turn on the Pricing Unit or supply a pricing sheet. ...............................................................41600
No. 1603-#### The rest 2 order could be kept by the Pricing Unit. ...............................................................41602
No. 1604 Pricing Sheet Print Out Check .........................................................................................................41604
4000 7/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 1649 The Aspect Ratio of image size is incorrect. Failed to write. ..........................................................41648
No. 1650 Data is too small to read. .................................................................................................................41650
No. 1653 The output media size is too large. The data cannot be output to the External System. ................41652
No. 1657 Hold On Save could not be executed. Secure enough space, then restart processing. ...................41656
No. 1659 Calibrating... Would you like to stop the calibration? ....................................................................41658
Attention message: Software upgrade ................................................................................ 41800
No. 1801-#### Execute software upgrade. .....................................................................................................41800
Attention message: Main ..................................................................................................... 41900
No. 1900-#### It was not registered as an option. ..........................................................................................41900
No. 1901 Selected optional function is not available. If you need to use, Install it. ......................................41900
No. 1902 Adobe Photoshop is being used. To enter Menu, Quit the Adobe Photoshop. ...............................41902
No. 1903-#### Proceeding. One moment please. . . .......................................................................................41902
No. 1904-#### Proceeding. One moment please. . . .......................................................................................41904
No. 1905 Program Timer was not set. .............................................................................................................41904
No. 1909 Title was not set. ..............................................................................................................................41908
No. 1910 There is no frame. The format will be deleted. ...............................................................................41910
No. 1911 This Title data already exist. ............................................................................................................41910
No. 1912 There is no format. New format will be created. ............................................................................41912
No. 1913 This format is used in a Print Channel. Would you like to edit? ....................................................41912
No. 1914 The format has reached maximum capacity. No more data can be added. ....................................41914
No. 1920-#### Capacity Booster Key was not detected. Confirm the connection status. .............................41920
No. 1921-#### Capacity Booster Key was detected. ......................................................................................41920
No. 1922 Viewer Software was not found. Confirm the settings. ..................................................................41922
No. 1923 Set the destination of Media Output to other than External System. ...............................................41922
No. 1924 Set the paper width wider than 203 mm for the Long Print. ...........................................................41924
No. 1925 Would you like to quit the Net Scan Mode? ....................................................................................41924
No. 1926 Set the Media Print Paper Fitting in Frame Print to "Cut", "Overall" or "Real Size". ....................41926
No. 1927-#### Sort by Output Media Frame Number function cannot be used. ............................................41926
No. 1928 DPOF file output function cannot be used. .....................................................................................41928
No. 1933 Select an input media other than the Compact Archive Unit. .........................................................41932
4000 8/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 4014 The saved data cannot be read with this version. ............................................................................44014
No. 4015 Selected file already exists. ..............................................................................................................44014
No. 4017 The head and jaw position is opposite, or the selected area is too small. ........................................44016
No. 4018 Would you like to quit the Edit Mode? ...........................................................................................44018
No. 4019 If you Import, all customer information will be deleted. Are you sure you want to Import? ........44018
No. 4020-#### Failed to write the file. ...........................................................................................................44020
No. 4021 Failed to read the file. ......................................................................................................................44020
No. 4023 Image magnification ratio or reduction ratio is out of range. ..........................................................44022
No. 4024 Select the layer. ................................................................................................................................44024
No. 4025 This template has more than 16 layers. This template cannot be used. ..........................................44024
No. 4026 The image size is too large to insert. ...............................................................................................44026
No. 4027 The same data already exists. Would you like to overwrite? .........................................................44026
No. 4028 Failed to export the Image Save File. ..............................................................................................44028
No. 4029 The drive is empty. ..........................................................................................................................44028
No. 4030 Failed to delete the Exported Image Save Data. ..............................................................................44030
No. 4031 There is insufficient space left on the disk. .....................................................................................44030
No. 4032 Template size is too large to read. ...................................................................................................44032
No. 4033 Vertical templates cannot be used to make frame prints. Select a horizontal template. .................44032
No. 4034 A pupil could not be detected in the specified area. ........................................................................44034
No. 4035 Additional phrases could not be saved. ...........................................................................................44034
No. 4036 The image size is too small to insert. ...............................................................................................44036
No. 4037 The same file name already exists. Would you like to overwrite? .................................................44036
No. 4038 This file is CMYK data. Color cannot be converted correctly. Would you like to read the data? 44038
No. 4039 Image size during editing is too large. .............................................................................................44038
No. 4040 The database was not changed. Confirm the property of each field. ..............................................44040
No. 4041 A form larger than the print size cannot be used. ............................................................................44040
No. 4042 Single Form is not positioned. .........................................................................................................44042
No. 4043 A Single Form protrudes from the Print Area. ................................................................................44042
No. 4044 Single Form is overlapped. ..............................................................................................................44044
No. 4045 No more than three Single Form types can be positioned. ..............................................................44044
No. 4046 When the Paper Setting is changed, the current position information is canceled. .........................44046
No. 4047 The selected font was not found. .....................................................................................................44046
No. 4048 The image size is too small to make a Test Print. ...........................................................................44048
No. 4049 No more items can be added. ...........................................................................................................44048
4000 9/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 5516[N] The circulation pump has stopped. STB2 ..................................................................................45511
No. 5517[N] The circulation pump has stopped. STB3 ..................................................................................45511
No. 5518[N] The circulation pump has stopped. STB4 ..................................................................................45511
No. 5511[SM] The circulation pump has stopped. CD ...................................................................................45511
No. 5513[SM] The circulation pump has stopped. BF ....................................................................................45511
No. 5515[SM] The circulation pump has stopped. STB1 ...............................................................................45511
No. 5516[SM] The circulation pump has stopped. STB2 ...............................................................................45511
No. 5517[SM] The circulation pump has stopped. STB3 ...............................................................................45511
No. 5518[SM] The circulation pump has stopped. STB4 ...............................................................................45511
Error message: Processor 2 ................................................................................................ 45519
No. 5519 Thermosensor error. CD ..................................................................................................................45519
No. 5520 Thermosensor error. BF ...................................................................................................................45519
No. 5521 Thermosensor error. STB ................................................................................................................45519
No. 5522 Dryer Thermosensor error. ..............................................................................................................45522
No. 5524 Refilling water operation error. CD-W ............................................................................................45524
No. 5525 Refilling water operation error. BF-W ............................................................................................45524
No. 5526 Refilling water operation error. STB1-W ........................................................................................45524
No. 5527 Refilling water operation error. STB2-W ........................................................................................45524
No. 5528 Refilling water operation error. STB3-W ........................................................................................45524
No. 5529 Refilling water operation error. STB4-W ........................................................................................45524
No. 5530 The Processor Top Cover is open. ...................................................................................................45530
No. 5531 The dryer cover is open. ..................................................................................................................45530
No. 5532 The Processing Solution Safety Thermostat has activated. .............................................................45532
No. 5533 The Dryer Safety Thermostat has activated. ....................................................................................45532
No. 5534-#### Print Sorter Unit operation error. ...........................................................................................45534
No. 5535 Paper has jammed in the processor section. ....................................................................................45534
No. 5537 The Rack Stopper is not set. ............................................................................................................45536
No. 5538-#### Backup data error. Processor .................................................................................................45538
No. 5539 Print Conveyor Unit was removed. .................................................................................................45538
No. 5549-#### Drive Motor Revolution Count Auto Adjustment error. ........................................................45548
No. 5550 Drive Motor has stopped. ................................................................................................................45550
4000 10/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
Error message: Printer 1 ..................................................................................................... 46012
No. 6012-#### Paper did not load. Paper Magazine A ..................................................................................46012
No. 6013-#### Paper did not load. Paper Magazine B ..................................................................................46012
No. 6014-#### Paper did not rewind. Paper Magazine A ..............................................................................46014
No. 6015-#### Paper did not rewind. Paper Magazine B ..............................................................................46014
No. 6016-#### Paper Cutter operation error. ..................................................................................................46016
No. 6017-#### Paper has jammed in the printer section. ................................................................................46016
No. 6021-#### Paper remains in the printer section. ......................................................................................46020
No. 6049 Pressure Guide operation error. .......................................................................................................46048
No. 6054 The Initial Setup was not executed. .................................................................................................46054
No. 6056-#### Printer system error. ...............................................................................................................46056
No. 6069 The printer top cover is open. ..........................................................................................................46068
No. 6073-#### Synchronous Sensor error. .....................................................................................................46072
No. 6074 B Laser control error. .......................................................................................................................46074
No. 6075 G Laser control error. ......................................................................................................................46074
No. 6076-#### Polygon Mirror control error. .................................................................................................46076
No. 6077-#### Interlock error. ........................................................................................................................46076
No. 6081-#### Backup data error. Printer .....................................................................................................46080
No. 6082-#### Setup error. .............................................................................................................................46082
No. 6087 Laser Control PCB system error. .....................................................................................................46086
No. 6101-#### Paper Hold Motor operation error. .........................................................................................46100
No. 6104-#### Printer Door is open. ..............................................................................................................46104
No. 6105 B Laser light source status error. .....................................................................................................46104
No. 6106 G Laser light source status error. .....................................................................................................46104
No. 6107-#### R Laser temperature is out of range. ......................................................................................46107
No. 6112-#### Could not load the paper. Paper Magazine C ........................................................................46112
No. 6113-#### Paper did not rewind. Paper Magazine C ..............................................................................46112
No. 6134-#### Paper Supply Pressure Change Motor operation error. ..........................................................46134
No. 6135-#### Arm Unit 1 operation error. ....................................................................................................46134
No. 6136-#### Exposure Advance Pressure Change Motor 1 operation error. ..............................................46136
No. 6137-#### Exposure Advance Pressure Change Motor 2 operation error. ..............................................46136
4000 11/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 6159-#### Paper Sensor 2 (Center) error. ................................................................................................46158
No. 6160-#### Paper Sensor 2 (Right) error. ..................................................................................................46158
No. 6173 Printer Door 3 is open. It may be adversely affect print quality. ....................................................46172
No. 6177-#### Laser Unit temperature is out of range. ..................................................................................46176
No. 6179 B/G Laser Output Unit error. ...........................................................................................................46178
No. 6187 Setup calculation error. ....................................................................................................................46186
Error message: Scanner ...................................................................................................... 46302
No. 6303-#### Scanner Zoom 1 operation error. ............................................................................................46302
No. 6304-#### Scanner Zoom 2 operation error. ............................................................................................46304
No. 6305-#### Scanner Focus operation error. ...............................................................................................46304
No. 6306-#### Scanner IRIS operation error. .................................................................................................46306
No. 6309-#### Scanner change of light error. ................................................................................................46308
No. 6311-#### Scanner data error. ..................................................................................................................46310
No. 6319-#### Backup data error. Scanner AFC ...........................................................................................46318
No. 6321-#### Focus auto adjustment error. ..................................................................................................46320
No. 6322-#### Scanner input balance error. ...................................................................................................46322
No. 6324 F stop value range error. ..................................................................................................................46324
No. 6327-#### Scanner Light Source Section temperature adjustment error. ................................................46326
No. 6329-#### Analog setting communication error. .....................................................................................46328
No. 6330-#### Digital setting communication error. ......................................................................................46330
No. 6331-#### Line scanning communication error. ......................................................................................46330
No. 6332-#### Light Source adjustment error. ...............................................................................................46332
No. 6333-#### The Line Data is out of the Standard Range Error. ................................................................46332
No. 6336-#### Scanner Zoom operation error. ...............................................................................................46336
4000 12/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 6415-#### 135 DX Sensor 4 error. ...........................................................................................................46412
No. 6416-#### 240 DX Sensor 1 error. ...........................................................................................................46416
No. 6417-#### 240 DX Sensor 2 error. ...........................................................................................................46416
No. 6423 Auto focus error. ..............................................................................................................................46422
No. 6424-#### Mount Unit operation error. ...................................................................................................46424
No. 6425-#### Mount detection error. ............................................................................................................46424
No. 6426 The lane is out of position. ..............................................................................................................46426
No. 6429-#### System error. (AFC / Scanner control PCB) ..........................................................................46428
No. 6431 Auto focus error. ..............................................................................................................................46430
No. 6432-#### Mount Unit operation error. ...................................................................................................46432
No. 6433-#### Mount detection error. ............................................................................................................46432
No. 6434-#### Mount detection (inlet) error. .................................................................................................46434
No. 6435-#### Mount insertion operation error. ............................................................................................46434
No. 6436-#### Mount elevator operation error. ..............................................................................................46436
No. 6437-#### Mount eject operation error. ...................................................................................................46436
No. 6438-#### 135 Cleaning Leader has stopped. ..........................................................................................46438
No. 6439-#### The film strip is too short for processing. ..............................................................................46438
No. 6441-#### The 120 Cleaning Leader has stopped. ..................................................................................46440
No. 6442-#### The perforation of the film may be broken. ...........................................................................46442
No. 6443 Move Table operation error. ............................................................................................................46444
No. 6444 Cartridge is out of position. .............................................................................................................46444
Error message: Disk/Media ................................................................................................. 46502
No. 6503 Formatting could not be executed. ...................................................................................................46502
No. 6504 Backup data could not be read. ........................................................................................................46504
No. 6505 Backup data could not be written. ...................................................................................................46504
No. 6506-#### Hard disk is full. Delete the unnecessary image file(s). ........................................................46506
Error message: Colorimeter ................................................................................................ 46550
No. 6551-#### Paper has jammed in the Colorimeter Unit. ...........................................................................46550
No. 6552-#### Backup data error. Colorimeter Unit .....................................................................................46552
No. 6554-#### Calibration Plate advance error. .............................................................................................46554
4000 13/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4000
4 Troubleshooting
No. 6900-#### Main control system error. .....................................................................................................46900
No. 6901-#### ARCNET communication error. ............................................................................................46900
No. 6902-#### LVDS communication error. ..................................................................................................46902
No. 6903-#### Serial communication error. ...................................................................................................46902
No. 6906-#### Failed to change the mode. Enter to the next mode? .............................................................46906
No. 6907-#### The file was not found. ...........................................................................................................46906
No. 6908-#### Processing response error. ......................................................................................................46908
No. 6909-#### CPU was reset. Abort the process. ........................................................................................46908
No. 6913-#### System was shut down forcibly. Restart the system. ............................................................46912
No. 6916-#### PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB control error. ..............................................................................46916
No. 6918-#### Failed to start the DLS. ...........................................................................................................46918
No. 6922-#### Device control error. ...............................................................................................................46922
Error: Compact Archive Unit ................................................................................................ 48360
No. 8361 Archive File read error. ....................................................................................................................48360
No. 8362 Archive File write error. ..................................................................................................................48362
No. 8363 Compact Archive Unit processing error. .........................................................................................48362
No. 8364 Compact Archive Unit cannot be used. ...........................................................................................48364
Error message: Edit ............................................................................................................. 49000
No. 9000-#### Edit mode System error. ........................................................................................................49000
No. 9001-#### Edit mode Information file error. ..........................................................................................49000
No. 9002-#### Edit mode Image data error. ..................................................................................................49002
No. 9003-#### Edit mode Image read error. ..................................................................................................49002
4000 14/14
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4001
Error and attention message regulation
Error and attention message regulation
! Attention message
The message informed through the normal processing appears
as an attention message.
• When the replacement of consumable parts is necessary
• When the judgment of operator is necessary
• When a simple operation mistake has been made
! Error
The message informed when some abnormal error occurs
appears as an error.
• When there is something wrong with the machine
• When a serious operation mistake has been made,
performing the operation not allowed to be performed
4. Troubleshooting
! Error/Attention message number
Error/Attention message number are separated to main and
suffix numbers. In case of 1234-0001, 1234 is the main
number and 0001 is the suffix number.
Main number
It distinguishes the content of Error/Attention message.
Operator takes a corrective action judging with the content of
the main number and the countermeasure.
Main number
Error 0001 to 4999
Attention message 5000 to 9999
Suffix number
It distinguishes error occurring place and condition.
Service personnel figures out the error occurring condition
judging with the content of the suffix number and performs
the diagnosis.
NOTE
• For the content of suffix number, refer to Descriptions of
suffix number.
☞ 4002
4001 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4002
Error and attention message regulation
Suffix number display For example, 3 is for the multiple condition of 1 and 2,
and 5 is for that of 4 and 1.
! The types of suffix number display ! How to determine the condition from
the total of bit operation
The procedure for bringing up the suffix number is classified
in the following three types. This section describes the procedure of determining the target
• Without suffix number condition from the displayed suffix number without the
knowledge of the bit operation theory.
• Displaying the condition with suffix number
• Displaying the total of bit operation with suffix number
1. Divide the displayed suffix number into each
digit.
! Without suffix number
NOTE
When the occurring condition is single • When the displayed suffix number is 13, it is
Example 1 divided into 1 and 3.
4. Troubleshooting
! Displaying the condition with suffix number (Object table)
When the occurring condition is multiple and only one of
Suffix number display Suffix number (bit)
them is the object of the occurring cause, its suffix number
appears with four digits. F 8 4 2 1
E 8 4 2
Example 2
D 8 4 1
Suffix Condition C 8 4
number
B 8 2 1
0001 The sensor has not turned to DARK.
A 8 2
0002 The sensor has not turned to LIGHT.
9 8 1
8 8
! Displaying the total of bit operation with suffix
number 7 4 2 1
6 4 2
When the occurring condition is multiple and some of them
are possible to be the objects of the occurring cause, the total 5 4 1
of the target suffix numbers (bit) appears. 4 4
NOTE 3 2 1
• The bit operation value appears by hexadecimal digit. 2 2
Example 3 1 1
0
Suffix Condition
number NOTE
(bit)
• It can be calculated by replacing the suffix number
0001 The sensor 1 does not detect. of hexadecimal digit with decimal and assigning it
0002 The sensor 2 does not detect. from the larger number.
0004 The sensor 3 does not detect. 3. Add 0 to the second digit or later to make the
0008 The sensor 4 does not detect. number of digits same as the original one.
0010 The sensor 5 does not detect. NOTE
• 1→10 (second digit), 2 and 1 are remained (first
NOTE digit).
• When the sensors 1 and 3 of example 3 are the objects,
• For the second digit, add 0 once. For the third
0005 appears. When all the sensors are the objects, 001F
digit, add 0 two times.
appears.
• The suffix number (bit) assigned to each condition is
necessarily consisted of 1, 2, 4, 8 and 0.
As for the bit display, the other 3, 5, 6, 7... are used for
the multiple conditions.
4002 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4002
Error and attention message regulation
(Example of determining) with the decimal digit and three digits with the
hexadecimal digit.
13 4C0 Thus, the number of digits can be less when there are
↓ ↓ more combinations which can be expressed as one digit.
Divide into each digit.
NOTE
1 3 4 C (12) 0
• A to F of the hexadecimal digit are handled as a number
↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓
in the operation.
Replace with the suffix number of each condition.
(Conversion table)
1 2, 1 4 8, 4 Not in use
Return the number of digits by adding 0. Hexadecimal Decimal numeral Binary number
↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ numeral
10 2, 1 400 80, 40 Not in use 0 0 0
↓ ↓ 1 1 1
10, 2 and 1 400, 80 and 40 are the objects. 2 2 10
are the objects.
3 3 11
4 4 100
4. Check each condition by the target suffix 5 5 101
number (bit), and specify the occurring
6 6 110
condition.
4. Troubleshooting
7 7 111
NOTE
8 8 1000
• When the suffix number of 13 appears in the
condition of example 3, the numbers of 1, 2 and 9 9 1001
10 are the objects of the suffix numbers (bit). A 10 1010
From this, the occurring condition is recognized as B 11 1011
The sensors 1, 2 and 5 do not detect.
C 12 1100
Example 3 D 13 1101
Object Suffix Condition E 14 1110
number F 15 1111
(bit) 10 16 10000
$ 0001 The sensor 1 does not detect. FF 255 11111111
$ 0002 The sensor 2 does not detect. 3FF 1023 1111111111
0004 The sensor 3 does not detect.
0008 The sensor 4 does not detect.
Bit operation
$ 0010 The sensor 5 does not detect.
• When assigning sensor 1 of example 3 to the first digit
and sensor 2 to the second digit as in order, the bit
NOTE operation value is as follows in the case that only each
• To know more details of the bit operation mechanism, condition is ON.
refer to the following explanatory notes. This hexadecimal digit value is assigned as the bit of
single condition.
Digit When multiple conditions are the objects, the total bit
• Binary digit is the basic value of computer calculation assigned to each condition appears.
and expresses the state of ON and OFF of the signal.
Condition Suffix number (bit)
A digit of the binary digit is called as bit. It expresses two
types of numbers, 0 and 1, as one digit. Hexadecima Decimal Binary
When there are two types of bit (condition), it is l numeral numeral number
expressed by the binary digit with two digits and called as Sensor 1 1 1 1
2 bit. Sensor 2 2 2 10
• Decimal digit is generally used to express ten kinds of Sensor 3 4 4 100
numbers, 0 to 9, as one digit.
Sensor 4 8 8 1000
The combinations expressed as one digit are ten kinds.
Sensor 5 10 16 10000
• Hexadecimal digit is used to express 16 kinds of
numbers, 0 to F, as one digit. The combinations
expressed as one digit are 16 kinds.
• Each digit can be converted into other digits.
When there are ten types of conditions, it is 10 bit (ten
digits) by expressing with the binary digit, four digits
4002 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4002
Error and attention message regulation
4. Troubleshooting
4002 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4190
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
! Scanner section
Reference
☞ AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ AFC/scanner driver PCB
☞ Scanner power supply 1 (PS1) ☞ Scanner power supply 2 (PS2)
☞ Multi power supply (scanner) (PS3) ☞ PM driver (film feed motor) (PMD1)
☞ Scanner unit
4190 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4190
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
! AFC/scanner driver PCB
Refer to electrical circuit diagram ☞ 89010
4190 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4190
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
B LED does not light during Output Check.
J/P141 Connects to LED(G). No. 6332-0001 Light Source adjustment error. occurs during light source update.
G LED does not light during Output Check.
J/P142 Connects to LED(R1). No. 6322-0001 Scanner input balance error. occurs during light source update.
R1 LED does not light during Output Check.
J/P143 Connects to R LED(heater). Any malfunction does not occur on this condition.
J/P144 Connects to LED(IR). No. 6322-0004 Scanner input balance error. occurs during light source update.
4190 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4190
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
! Scanner unit
Refer to electrical circuit diagram ☞ 89010
4. Troubleshooting
J/P62 Connects the AFC/scanner The operation is not proceeded with the message, One moment please. . . while scanning.
J/P69 control PCB. The film ready lamp blinks in red.
No. 1400 Lock the Film Carrier. occurs.
No. 6336-0001 Scanner Zoom operation error. occurs.
IMPORTANT
• Zoom home sensor does not detect the scanner, causing zoom motor to overrun
and emit a strange sound. Zoom motor stops after a specified length of time.
The scanner will function normally if it is rebooted and initial operations are
performed after the connectors are plugged in properly.
J/P67 Connect to the AFC/scanner No. 6336-0002 Scanner Zoom operation error. occurs.
J/P68 driver PCB. No. 6336-0001 Scanner Zoom operation error. occurs.
4190 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4200
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
following explanation depending on the ARCNET communication feature.
! Scanner section
Reference
☞ AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ AFC/scanner driver PCB
☞ LED driver PCB ☞ Scanner power supply 1 (PS1)
☞ Scanner power supply 2 (PS2) ☞ Multi power supply (scanner) (PS3)
☞ PM driver (film feed motor) (PMD1) ☞ Scanner unit
4200 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4200
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
J/P29 Connects to the scanner unit. ☞ S 12-2 No. 6306-0002 Scanner IRIS operation error. occurs.
J/P30 Connects to the scanner unit. No. 6429-0001 System error. (AFC / Scanner control PCB) occurs.
(+5 V−2)
J/P34 Jumper ☞ S 1-5 The film ready lamp blinks in red.
The film carrier does not feed the film.
J/P35 Jumper The film ready lamp blinks in red.
The film carrier does not feed the film.
J/P38 Connects to the film ready ☞ S 12-1 The film ready lamp turns off.
lamp and film carrier lock No. 1400 Lock the Film Carrier. occurs.
sensor.
J/P40 Power supply cooling fan, Power supply cooling fan or control box cooling fan 1, 2 stops.
control cooling fan 1, 2
J/P41 Connects to the film carrier ☞ S 1-8 No. 1405-9F Remove the 135 film from the Film Carrier. occurs.
relay connector (+36 V−4).
J/P42 PM driver (film feed motor) ☞ S 1-3 The film ready lamp lights in green.
(+5 V−2, +36 V−4) The film carrier does not feed the film.
J/P43 Connects to the film cleaner ☞ S 1-5 The film cleaner stops operation.
(+24 V−2).
J/P46 Connects to the film carrier ☞ S 1-8 No malfunction occurs on this condition.
relay connector.
4200 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4200
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P92 ☞ CS 1-1☞ S No. 6327-0002 Scanner Light Source Section temperature adjustment
1-2 error. occurs.
J/P93 Supplies the power to ☞ S 1-2 No. 6327-0002 Scanner Light Source Section temperature adjustment
AFC/Scanner driver PCB error. occurs.
(+24 V−1), AFC/Scanner
control PCB (+24 V−1) and
LED driver PCB (+24 V−1).
! Scanner unit
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P60 Connecting to the LVDS and ☞ - System No. 6822-0011 Image Processing PCB Image data operation error.
D-ICE PCBs connection occurs.
diagram
4200 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4200
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
4200 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4201
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
! Desk section
Reference
☞ Image processing PCB ☞ Image correction PCB
☞ D−ICE control PCB ☞ D−ICE PCB
☞ DIMM ☞ Scratch mend PCB 2
☞ Scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] ☞ Scratch mend PCB 1 [J485]
☞ Data change-over PCB ☞ Colorimeter Control PCB
☞ Power PCB ☞ Desk power supply 1
☞ Desk power supply 2
4201 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4201
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
No. 6901-2008 ARCNET communication error. Processor Digital ICE
Control PCB occurs.
J/P51 Connects to the PC. ☞ CS 2-1☞ CS No. 6900-0001 Main control system error. occurs while printing.
2-2
J/P52 Connects to the buzzer. ☞ CS 2-1 The buzzer does not sound.
J/P53 Connects the ARCNET No. 1014 The system is being initialized, one moment please. . . occurs
printer control PCB. and the system program does not start.
No. 6901-2008 ARCNET communication error. Processor Digital ICE
Control PCB occurs.
J/P54 Connects the ARCNET No. 6901-0209 ARCNET communication error. Paper Supply Section
printer control PCB. Processor LASER occurs.
J/P71 ARCNET No. 1014 The system is being initialized, one moment please. . . occurs
Connects the AFC/scanner and the system program does not start.
control PCB. No. 6901-0010 ARCNET communication error. Scanner AFC occurs.
J/P72 ARCNET No. 1014 The system is being initialized, one moment please. . . occurs
Connects the AFC/scanner and the system program does not start.
control PCB. No. 6901-2000 ARCNET communication error. Digital ICE Control
PCB occurs.
J/P73 ARCNET No. 6901-2000 ARCNET communication error. Digital ICE Control
Connects the image PCB occurs.
processing PCB.
J/P74 ARCNET No. 1014 The system is being initialized, one moment please. . . occurs
Connects the image and the system program does not start.
processing PCB. No. 6901-0080 ARCNET communication error. Image Processing PCB
occurs.
J/P75 ARCNET No. 1014 The system is being initialized, one moment please. . . occurs
Connects the PC control unit. and the system program does not start.
No. 6901-2008 ARCNET communication error. Processor Digital ICE
Control PCB occurs.
J/P76 ARCNET No. 1014 The system is being initialized, one moment please. . . occurs
Connects the PC control unit. and the system program does not start.
No. 6901-2008 ARCNET communication error. Processor Digital ICE
Control PCB occurs.
J/P158 Inputs the power supply (+24 ☞ CS 1-3 The PC does not start automatically.
V-4) from printer I/O PCB 1. Any malfunction does not occur on this condition after starting up the PC
forcibly.
4201 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4201
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
! D−ICE PCB
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P45 Connects to D-ICE control ☞ CS 1-2 No. 6640-4000 System error. (D-ICE Control PCB) occurs.
PCB. No. 6643-0001 Digital Masking Unit operation error. occurs.
J/P436 Connects to LVDS and ☞ - System No. 6822-0011 Image Processing PCB Image data operation error.
scanner section. connection occurs.
diagram
J/P437 Power supply from disk ☞ CS 1-2 No. 6640-4000 System error. (D-ICE Control PCB) occurs.
power supply 1 (+5 V−1) No. 6643-0001 Digital Masking Unit operation error. occurs.
J/P438 Connects to the image ☞ CS 2-1 No. 6822-0011 Image Processing PCB Image data operation error.
processing PCB. occurs while scanning.
J/P480 Connects to DIMM. No. 6643-0001 Digital Masking Unit operation error. occurs.
J/P483 Connects to the scratch mend No. 6643-0001 Digital Masking Unit operation error. occurs.
PCB 2.
J/P484 Connects to the scratch mend No. 6643-0001 Digital Masking Unit operation error. occurs.
PCB1 [J484 A]
J/P485 Connects to the scratch mend No. 6643-0001 Digital Masking Unit operation error. occurs.
PCB1 [J484 A]
4. Troubleshooting
J/P486 Connects to the data change- No. 6643-0001 Digital Masking Unit operation error. occurs.
J/P487 over PCB.
! DIMM
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P480 Connects to D-ICE PCB. ☞ CS 2-1 No. 6643-0001 Digital Masking Unit operation error. occurs.
4201 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4201
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
! Power PCB
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P99 Supplies the power from the ☞ CS 1-1 The input section does not activate because power is not supplied to the desk
earth leakage circuit breaker. section.
J/P100 Jumper No malfunction occurs on this condition.
J/P101 Supplies the power to the The monitor is not turned on.
monitor and ATX power The PC does not start.
supply.
4. Troubleshooting
J/P102 Supplies the power to the ☞ CS 1-1☞ - The scanner section does not operate.
scanner section. System No. 6901-0010 ARCNET communication error. Scanner AFC occurs.
connection
diagram
J/P104 Supplies the power to the ☞ CS 1-1 No. 6901-2008 ARCNET communication error. Processor Digital ICE
desk power supply 1 and 2. Control PCB occurs.
No. 6903-0001 Serial communication error. Colorimeter Unit occurs.
No. 1014 The system is being initialized, one moment please. . . occurs
and the system program does not start.
The control unit cooling fan and D-ICE cooling fan do not rotate.
4201 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4201
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
4201 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4202
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
! Printer section
4. Troubleshooting
Reference
☞ Printer control PCB ☞ Laser control PCB
☞ Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ Printer I/O PCB 2
☞ Printer I/O PCB 3 ☞ Triple magazine PCB
☞ Laser I/O PCB ☞ B laser driver
☞ G laser driver ☞ CVP PCB
☞ Printer power supply 1 (PS1) ☞ Printer power supply 2 (PS2)
☞ Printer power supply 3 (PS3) ☞ Multi power supply (printer) (PS4)
☞ Laser power supply (PS5) ☞ B-AOM driver
☞ G-AOM driver ☞ R-AOM driver
4202 1/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4202
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
J/P223 ARCNET ☞ LP 2-3 No. 6901-0008 ARCNET communication error. Processor occurs.
Connects to the processor
control PCB.
J/P224 ARCNET No. 6901-0008 ARCNET communication error. Processor occurs.
Connects to the processor
control PCB.
4202 2/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4202
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
J/P233 Connects to the paper The paper advance unit cooling fan stops operation.
advance unit cooling fan.
J/P234 Connects to the printer I/O ☞ LP 1-2 The control box cooling fans 2, 3 and 4 stop operations.
PCB 3.
J/P235 Power supply from the ☞ LP 1-2 The counter, paper advance section cooling fan, inner cooling fan, control
printer power supply 3 (+24 box cooling fans 1, 2, 3, and 4 stop operations.
V)
J/P237 Supplies the power to the ☞ LP 1-1 No. 6136-0001 Exposure Advance Pressure Change Motor 1 operation
printer power supplies 1, 2 error. occurs.
and 3.
J/P238 Power supply from the No. 6136-0001 Exposure Advance Pressure Change Motor 1 operation
processor section error. occurs.
J/P239 Connects to the interlock No. 1047-0001 Close printer door. occurs.
switch (printer door 2).
J/P240 Connects to the interlock No. 1047-0001 Close printer door. occurs.
switch (printer door 1).
J/P241 Connects to the laser I/O No. 1026 Close the Printer Top Cover. occurs.
PCB.
J/P242 Connects to the printer I/O ☞ LP 1-2 No. 6016-0004 Paper Cutter operation error. occurs.
PCB 2 and paper end sensor
B.
J/P245 Connects to the printer ☞ LP 1-1 No. 1026 Close the Printer Top Cover. occurs.
control PCB.
J/P246 Connects to the triple ☞ LP 1-2 No. 6021-0001 Paper remains in the printer section. occurs.
magazine PCB.
J/P247 Power supply from the multi ☞ LP 1-2 No. 6136-0001 Exposure Advance Pressure Change Motor 1 operation
power supply (printer) (+5 error. occurs.
V)
J/P248 Connects to the exposure ☞ LP 3-6 No. 6136-0001 Exposure Advance Pressure Change Motor 1 operation
advance pressure change error. occurs.
motors 1 and 2.
J/P249 Connects to the exposure ☞ LP 3-5 No. 6017-0001 Paper has jammed in the printer section. occurs while
advance motors 1 and 2. printing.
J/P250 Connects to the paper ☞ LP 3-2 No. 6013-0001 Paper did not load. Paper Magazine B or No. 6112-0001
magazine motors 1 and 2. Could not load the paper. Paper Magazine C occurs while printing.
4202 3/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4202
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
! Printer I/O PCB 2
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P258 Connects to the cut motor. ☞ LP 3-3 No. 6016-0004 Paper Cutter operation error. occurs while printing.
J/P259 Connects to the paper hold ☞ LP 3-4 No.6101-0002 Paper Hold Motor operation error. occurs.
motor and paper hold
sensor.
J/P260 Connects to the paper No. 6134-0002 Paper Supply Pressure Change Motor operation error.
supply pressure change occurs.
motor and paper supply
pressure change sensor.
J/P261 Connects to the cut home ☞ LP 3-3 No. 6021-0004 Paper remains in the printer section. occurs.
sensor, cut end sensor and
paper loading sensor.
J/P262 Connects to the printer No. 6016-0004 Paper Cutter operation error. occurs.
control PCB.
J/P263 Connects to the printer I/O ☞ LP 1-2 No. 6016-0004 Paper Cutter operation error. occurs.
PCB 1.
J/P264 Connects to the printer I/O No. 6101-0001 Paper Hold Motor operation error. occurs.
PCB 1.
J/P265 Connects to the paper ☞ LP 3-4 No. 6017-0001 Paper has jammed in the printer section. occurs while
advance motor 1. printing.
J/P266 Connects to the paper No. 6135-0001 Arm Unit 1 operation error. occurs.
supply motor B/C and paper
supply arm motor (right).
J/P267 Connects to the paper ☞ LP 3-3 No. 6012-0002 Paper did not load. Paper Magazine A occurs while
supply motor A. printing.
J/P268 Connects to the paper ☞ LP 3-4 No. 6135-0001 Arm Unit 1 operation error. occurs.
supply arm motor (left).
4202 4/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4202
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
No. 6139-0001 Paper Advance Arm Motor (Right) operation error.
occurs.
J/P276 Connects to the control box ☞ LP 3-1 The control box cooling fans 2, 3 and 4 stop operations.
cooling fans 2, 3 and 4.
J/P277 Connects to the printer I/O ☞ LP 1-2 The control box cooling fans 2, 3 and 4 stop operations.
PCB 1.
J/P278 Connects to the paper ☞ LP 3-1 Paper magazine lamp B/C does not turn ON.
magazine lamp B/C.
J/P279 Connects to the printer ☞ LP 3-2 No. 6021-0009 Paper remains in the printer section. occurs.
control PCB.
J/P280 Connects to the printer No. 6021-0009 Paper remains in the printer section. occurs.
control PCB.
J/P281 Connects to the paper end No. 6021-0003 Paper remains in the printer section. occurs.
sensors B and C.
J/P282 Connects to the paper ☞ LP 3-10 No. 6021-0009 Paper remains in the printer section. occurs.
sensors 2 (left, center and
right).
J/P283 Connects to the paper sensor ☞ LP 3-7 No. 6021-0006 Paper remains in the printer section. occurs.
1 and pressure guide sensor.
J/P284 Connects to the zigzagging ☞ LP 3-5 No. 6021-0005 Paper remains in the printer section. occurs.
correction sensors (left and
right), exposure start sensor,
exposure advance pressure
change sensors 1 and 2.
J/P285 Power supply from the multi ☞ LP 1-2 No. 6021-0009 Paper remains in the printer section. occurs.
power supply (printer) (+5
V)
J/P286 Connects to the arm sensors ☞ LP 3-8 No. 6138-0002 Paper Advance Arm Motor (Left) operation error.
(left and right). occurs.
No. 6139-0002 Paper Advance Arm Motor (Right) operation error.
occurs.
J/P287 Connects to the lane select ☞ LP 3-10 No. 6142-0002 Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor (Left) operation
sensor (left) and paper error. occurs.
advance pressure change
sensor (left).
J/P288 Connects to the lane select No. 6143-0002 Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor (Right)
sensor (right) and paper operation error. occurs.
advance pressure change
sensor (right).
4202 5/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4202
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P1532 Connects to the laser unit. ☞ LP 3-11 The message does not change from Laser temperatures are being
adjusted. (R) after the message, Laser temperatures are being adjusted.
Approx.## disappeared.
J/P1533 Connects to the interlock ☞ LP 1-1☞ LP No. 1026 Close the Printer Top Cover. occurs.
switch (printer top cover). 3-13
J/P1534 Connects to the printer I/O No. 1026 Close the Printer Top Cover. occurs.
PCB 1.
J/P1535 Power supply from the multi ☞ LP 1-3 No. 6105 B Laser light source status error. occurs after the message,
power supply (printer) (+5 Laser temperatures are being adjusted. Approx.## disappeared.
V)
J/P1536 Connects to the laser control ☞ LP 3-11 The message does not change from Laser temperatures are being
PCB. adjusted. (R) after the message, Laser temperatures are being adjusted.
Approx.## disappeared.
J/P1538 Connects to the laser control The message does not change from Laser temperatures are being
PCB. adjusted. after the message, Laser temperatures are being adjusted.
Approx.## disappeared.
J/P1539 Connects to the laser unit. No. 6076-0001 Polygon Mirror control error. occurs after the message,
Laser temperatures are being adjusted. Approx.## disappeared.
J/P1540 Connects to the laser unit. ☞ LP 3-12 No malfunction occurs on this condition.
J/P1541 Power supply from the laser ☞ LP 1-3 No. 1026 Close the Printer Top Cover. occurs.
power supply (+24 V)
J/P1542 Connects to the B-AOM ☞ LP 3-13 The print whose color is blue only is made.
driver.
J/P1543 Connects to the G-AOM The print whose color is green only is made.
driver.
J/P1544 Connects to the R-AOM No. 6073 Synchronous Sensor error. occurs while printing, or white
driver. prints are made.
J/P1549 Connects to the B and G ☞ LP 3-14 No. 6105 B Laser light source status error. or No. 6106 G Laser light
laser drivers. source status error. occurs after the message, Laser temperatures are
being adjusted. Approx.## disappeared.
J/P1550 Power supply from the multi ☞ LP 1-3 The message does not change from Laser temperatures are being
power supply (printer) (+12 adjusted. (R) after the message, Laser temperatures are being adjusted.
V) Approx.## disappeared.
J/P1551 Connects to the laser unit ☞ LP 3-11 No malfunction occurs on this condition.
heater.
4202 6/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4202
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
! B laser driver
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P1653 Connects to the laser unit. ☞ LP 2-9 The print whose color is blue only is made.
J/P1654 Connects to the laser control No. 6105 B Laser light source status error. occurs after the message,
PCB. Laser temperatures are being adjusted. Approx.## disappeared.
J/P1655 Connects to the laser I/O No. 6105 B Laser light source status error. occurs after the message,
PCB. Laser temperatures are being adjusted. Approx.## disappeared.
! G laser driver
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P1663 Connects to the laser unit. ☞ LP 2-9 No. 6106 G Laser light source status error. occurs after the message,
Laser temperatures are being adjusted. Approx.## disappeared.
J/P1664 Connects to the laser control No. 6106 G Laser light source status error. occurs after the message,
PCB. Laser temperatures are being adjusted. Approx.## disappeared.
J/P1665 Connects to the laser I/O No. 6106 G Laser light source status error. occurs after the message,
PCB. Laser temperatures are being adjusted. Approx.## disappeared.
4. Troubleshooting
! CVP PCB
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P500 Connects to the printer ☞ LP 3-15 The CVP unit does not operate.
control PCB.
J/P501 Connects to the printer I/O ☞ LP 1-2 The CVP unit does not operate.
PCB 1.
J/P502 Connects to the dot head and ☞ LP 3-15 The CVP unit does not operate.
ribbon advance motor.
4202 7/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4202
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P433 Power supply from the ☞ LP 1-1 No. 1026 Close the Printer Top Cover. occurs.
processor section
J/P1614 Supplies the power to the No. 1026 Close the Printer Top Cover. occurs.
laser I/O PCB (+24 V).
J/P1615 Supplies the power to the No. 1026 Close the Printer Top Cover. occurs.
laser I/O PCB (+24 V).
! B-AOM driver
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P1631 Connects to the laser control ☞ LP 3-13 The print whose color is blue only is made.
PCB.
J/P1632 Connects to the laser unit. The print whose color is blue only is made.
J/P1633 Connects to the laser I/O The print whose color is blue only is made.
PCB.
J/P1634 Connects to the laser control The print whose color is blue only is made.
PCB.
! G-AOM driver
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P1636 Connects to the laser control ☞ LP 3-13 The print whose color is green only is made.
PCB.
J/P1637 Connects to the laser unit. The print whose color is green only is made.
J/P1638 Connects to the laser I/O The print whose color is green only is made.
PCB.
J/P1639 Connects to the laser control The print whose color is green only is made.
PCB.
4202 8/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4202
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
! R-AOM driver
Connector No. Wiring diagram Symptom
J/P1641 Connects to the laser control ☞ LP 3-13 No. 6073 Synchronous Sensor error. occurs while printing, or white
PCB. prints are made.
J/P1642 Connects to the laser unit. No. 6073 Synchronous Sensor error. occurs while printing, or white
prints are made.
J/P1643 Connects to the laser I/O No. 6073 Synchronous Sensor error. occurs while printing, or white
PCB. prints are made.
J/P1644 Connects to the laser control No. 6073 Synchronous Sensor error. occurs while printing, or white
PCB. prints are made.
4. Troubleshooting
4202 9/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4203
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
! Processor section
Reference
☞ Processor control PCB ☞ Processor I/O PCB
☞ Processor relay PCB ☞ Processor power supply 1 (PS1)
☞ Processor power supply 2 (PS2) ☞ Processor power supply 3 (PS3)
☞ Earth leakage circuit breaker 1 (NFB2) ☞ Earth leakage circuit breaker 2 (NFB3)
☞ Earth leakage circuit breaker 3 (NFB4)
4203 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4203
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
J/P677 Connects to the CD ☞ PP 3-1 No. 5509 The circulation amount has decreased. 0.0 L/min CD occurs.
circulation pump. No. 5511 The circulation pump has stopped. CD occurs.
J/P678 Connects to the BF No. 5511 The circulation pump has stopped. BF occurs.
circulation pump.
J/P679 Connects to the STB1 No. 5511 The circulation pump has stopped. STB1 occurs.
circulation pump.
J/P680 Connects to the STB2 No. 5511 The circulation pump has stopped. STB2 occurs.
circulation pump.
J/P681 Connects to the STB3 No. 5511 The circulation pump has stopped. STB3 occurs.
circulation pump.
J/P682 Connects to the STB4 No. 5511 The circulation pump has stopped. STB4 occurs.
circulation pump.
J/P683 Connects to the ☞ PP 3-4☞ PP No malfunction occurs on this condition.
replenishment pump and 3-5
water supply pump.
J/P685 Connects to the refilling ☞ PP 3-5 No malfunction occurs on this condition.
water pump.
J/P686 Connects to the drive motor ☞ PP 3-7 The drive motor cooling fan, tank cooling fans 1, 2 and 3 stop operations.
cooling fan, tank cooling fans
1, 2 and 3.
J/P687 Connects to the effluent float ☞ PP 3-6 No. 0503 Empty the Effluent Tank. CD BF STB occurs.
switch.
J/P688 Connects to the ☞ PP 3-5 No. 0500 Add water to the Refilling Water Tank. occurs.
replenishment solution level No. 0502 Add replenishment solution to the replenishment tank. CD
sensor and refilling water BF STB occurs.
tank level sensor.
J/P689 Connects to the processor ☞ PP 1-1 No malfunction occurs on this condition.
relay PCB (24 V).
J/P690 Power supply from processor ☞ PP 1-2 No. 0500 Add water to the Refilling Water Tank. occurs.
power supply 2 (+24 V) No. 0502 Add replenishment solution to the replenishment tank. CD
BF STB occurs.
No. 0503 Empty the Effluent Tank. CD BF STB occurs.
No. 5508 The processing solution level is too low. occurs.
No. 5532 The Processing Solution Safety Thermostat has activated.
occurs.
No. 5533 The Dryer Safety Thermostat has activated. occurs.
J/P694 Connects to the processor ☞ PP 3-10 The processor condition lamp does not turn on.
condition lamp.
4203 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4203
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
! Processor relay PCB
Connector No. Wiring Symptom
diagram
J/P641 Connects to the processor I/O ☞ PP 1-1 No malfunction occurs on this condition.
PCB (24 V).
J/P643 Supplies the power to the All the systems do not start.
processor power supplies 1, 2
and 3.
J/P644 Connects to the dryer fan. ☞ PP 3-8 The dryer fan does not rotate.
No. 5533 The Dryer Safety Thermostat has activated. occurs.
J/P646 Supplies the power to the ☞ -System Starts up the processor only
printer. connection
diagram☞ PP
1-1
J/P648 Connects to the processor ☞ PP 2-1 No. 0506 Close the Dryer Cover. occurs.
control PCB. No. 5508 The processing solution level is too low. occurs.
No. 5532 The Processing Solution Safety Thermostat has activated.
occurs.
No. 5533 The Dryer Safety Thermostat has activated. occurs.
J/P649 Connects to the power supply ☞ PP 3-3 The power supply cooling fan stops operation.
cooling fan.
J/P650 Connects to the processing ☞ PP 2-1 No. 5508 The processing solution level is too low. occurs.
solution float switch. No. 5532 The Processing Solution Safety Thermostat has activated.
occurs.
J/P651 Connects to the interlock ☞ PP 3-7 No. 0506 Close the Dryer Cover. occurs.
switch (dryer cover).
J/P652 Connects to the interlock No. 0507 Close the Processor Top Cover. occurs.
switch (processor top cover).
J/P653 Connects to the dryer safety ☞ PP 3-10 No. 5533 The Dryer Safety Thermostat has activated. occurs.
thermostat.
J/P654 Connects to the processor I/O ☞ PP 2-1☞ PP No. 5508 The processing solution level is too low. occurs.
PCB. 1-1 No. 5532 The Processing Solution Safety Thermostat has activated.
occurs.
No. 5533 The Dryer Safety Thermostat has activated. occurs.
J/P655 Connects to the drive motor. ☞ PP 3-7 No. 5550 Drive Motor has stopped. occurs.
4203 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4203
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
V) and processor I/O PCB
(+5 V).
4203 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4203
Diagnosis appendix for the failures: Symptom due to the connection failure of wiring
4. Troubleshooting
processor relay PCB
J/P797 Supplies the power to the ☞ PP 1-2 Starts up the processor only
processor relay PCB (+24 V).
J/P798 Supplies the power to the Starts up the processor only
processor relay PCB (+24 V).
4203 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4240
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
! Scanner section
Reference
4. Troubleshooting
☞ AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ Scanner power supply 1 (PS1)
☞ Scanner power supply 2 (PS2) ☞ Multi power supply (scanner) (PS3)
4240 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4240
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
4. Troubleshooting
4240 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4250
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
! Scanner section
4. Troubleshooting
Reference
☞ AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ LED driver PCB
☞ Scanner power supply 1 (PS1) ☞ Scanner power supply 2 (PS2)
☞ Multi power supply (scanner) (PS3)
4250 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4250
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
4. Troubleshooting
4250 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4251
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
! Desk section
Reference
☞ Keyboard switch PCB ☞ Power PCB
☞ Desk power supply 1 (PS2) ☞ Desk power supply 2 (PS3)
4. Troubleshooting
! Keyboard switch PCB
Fuse No. Wiring Symptom
diagram
F24 T3.15/125 V (ATX power ☞ CS 1-4 This fuse has not been checked since it cannot be removed.
supply protection)
! Power PCB
Fuse No. Wiring Symptom
diagram
FL1 T5 A/250 V (Surge ☞ CS 1-1 This fuse has not been checked since it cannot be removed.
protection)
FL2 T5 A/250 V (Surge This fuse has not been checked since it cannot be removed.
protection)
4251 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4252
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
! Printer section
Reference
☞ Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ Printer I/O PCB 3
☞ Laser I/O PCB ☞ CVP PCB
4. Troubleshooting
☞ Multi power supply (printer) ☞ Printer power supply 1 (PS1)
☞ Printer power supply 2 (PS2) ☞ Printer power supply 3 (PS3)
☞ Multi power supply (printer) (PS4) ☞ Laser power supply (PS5)
4252 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4252
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
! CVP PCB
Fuse No. Wiring diagram Symptom
F25 T3.15 A/125 V (DC +36 V−1 ☞ LP 1-2 The CVP unit does not operate.
power supply protection)
4. Troubleshooting
Fuse No. Wiring Symptom
diagram
F1 AC 200 V power supply ☞ LP 1-1 This fuse has not been checked since it cannot be removed.
protection
4252 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4253
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
! Processor section
Reference
☞ Processor I/O PCB ☞ Processor relay PCB
☞ Processor power supply 1 (PS1) ☞ Processor power supply 2 (PS2)
4. Troubleshooting
☞ Processor power supply 3 (PS3)
4253 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4253
Diagnosis appendix: Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
4. Troubleshooting
F14 T6.3 A/250 V (DC +24 V The system does not start.
power supply protection)
4253 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4302
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
The message, Laser temperatures are being adjusted. does not disappear
from the order display.
NOTE
• The message No. 1043 Laser temperature is being adjusted. One moment please... appears when some operation with exposure is
carried out while the message is displayed. ☞ 41042
• The messages for laser temperature adjustment in the order display appear in order of Laser temperatures are being
adjusted.Approx.##sec, Laser temperatures are being adjusted.(U), Laser temperatures are being adjusted.(R).
• Laser temperatures are being adjusted. If the message, (U) does not disappear, refer to ☞ Specifying the occurring cause: Laser
temperatures are being adjusted. (U) appears.
• Laser temperatures are being adjusted. If the message, (R) does not disappear, refer to ☞ Specifying the occurring cause: Laser
temperatures are being adjusted. (R) appears.
• Processable range of the laser unit is 23.0°C to 42.0°C.
• Processable range of the R laser is 27.7°C to 28.3°C.
• Measure the voltage of TP (ground) on each PCB for ground described in the flow chart.
! Specifying the occurring cause: Laser temperatures are being adjusted. (U) appears.
4. Troubleshooting
Laser temperatures are being adjusted. (U) appears.
YES
The display of Laser temperatures are being adjusted. has disappeared.
NO
Less than
23.0°C.
Check the temperature on the Laser Unit Thermosensoron the Input Check display. ☞ 35210
YES
The temperature on the Laser Unit Thermosensor goes down by 1°C or more in ten minutes.
NO
The voltage between the pin 3 (+) on the connector (J/P1522) of the laser control PCB and the ground is 1 V,
which means the laser sensor unit temperature sensor standard voltage. ☞ 66010
YES NO
4302 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4302
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
The voltage between the pin 7 (+) on the connector (J/P1512) of the laser control PCB is 0 V, which means the
laser unit cooling fan control is ON. ☞ 66010
YES NO
The voltage between the pins 1 (+) and 2 (−) on the connector (J/P1551) of the laser I/O PCB is 24 V, which
means the power to supply the laser unit cooling fan. ☞ 66060
YES NO
4. Troubleshooting
YES NO
YES NO
The voltage between the pins 17 (+) and 18 (−) on the connector (J/P1551) of the laser I/O PCB is 24 V, which
means the power supply to the laser unit heater.
YES NO
The voltage between the pin 13 (+) on the connector (J/P1538) of the laser I/O PCB and the ground is 24 V,
which means the laser unit heater control is OFF. ☞ 66060
YES NO
The voltage between the pin 13 (+) on the connector (J/P1512) of the laser control PCB and the ground is 24 V,
which means the laser unit heater control is OFF. ☞ 66010
YES NO
4302 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4302
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
The voltage between the pin 4 (+) on the connector (J/P1522) of the laser control PCB and the ground is over
0.45 V, which means the laser sensor unit temperature sensor measurement voltage. ☞ 66010
NO YES
Disconnect the connector (J/P1522) on the laser control PCB. The measured resistance value between pins
3 and 4 on the laser unit thermosensor side is less than 4 kΩ (resistance value of the laser unit thermosensor
). ☞ 66010
YES NO
Failure on the laser control PCB ☞ 66010 Failure in the laser unit ☞ 26710
4. Troubleshooting
The temperature on the Laser Unit Thermosensor goes up by 1°C or more in ten minutes. YES
NO
The voltage between the pin 3 (+) on the connector (J/P1522) of the laser control PCB and the ground is 1 V,
which means the laser sensor unit temperature sensor standard voltage. ☞ 66010
YES NO
The voltage between the pin 13 (+) on the connector (J/P1512) of the laser control PCB and the ground is 0 V,
which means the laser unit heater control is ON. ☞ 66010
YES NO
The voltage between the pin 13 (+) on the connector (J/P1538) of the laser I/O PCB and the ground is 0 V,
which means the laser unit heater control is ON. ☞ 66060
YES NO
The voltage between the pins 17 (+) and 18 (−) on the connector (J/P1551) of the laser I/O PCB is 24 V, which
means the power supply to the laser unit heater. ☞ 66060
YES NO
4302 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4302
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
The voltage between the pin 7 (+) on the connector (J/P1512) of the laser control PCB and the ground is 24 V,
which means the laser unit cooling fan control is OFF. ☞ 66010
YES NO
The voltage between the pins 1 (+) and 2 (−) on the connector (J/P1551) of the laser I/O PCB is 0 V, which
means the power to supply the laser unit cooling fan. ☞ 66060
YES NO
4. Troubleshooting
The voltage between the pin 4 (+) on the connector (J/P1522) of the laser control PCB and the ground is less
than 0.25 V, which means the laser sensor unit temperature sensor. ☞ 66010
NO YES
Disconnect the connector (J/P1522) on the laser control PCB. If the measured resistance value between pins 3
and 4 on the laser thermosensor side is more than 10 kΩ (resistance of the laser unit thermosensor ). ☞ 66010
YES NO
Failure on the laser control PCB ☞ 66010 Failure in the laser unit ☞ 26710
4302 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4302
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
! Specifying the occurring cause: Laser temperatures are being adjusted. (R) appears.
NO YES
The voltage between the pins 1 (+) and 3 (−) on the connector (J/P1511) of the laser control PCB is 1 V, which
4. Troubleshooting
means the R laser sensor unit temperature sensor standard voltage. ☞ 66010
YES NO
The voltage between TP2 and TP9 (+) that are test points on the laser I/O PCB is 1 V, which means standard
voltage of R laser thermosensor. ☞ 66060
YES NO
It is below
27.7°C.
Check the temperature of the R Laser Thermosensor on the Input Check display. ☞ 35210
It is over 28.3°C.
Disconnect the connector (J/P1532) on the laser control PCB. The measured resistance value between pins 7
and 8 on the R laser thermosensor side is less than 4.5 kΩ (resistance value of the R laser thermosensor ).
☞ 66010
YES NO
The voltage between TP2 and TP11 (+) that are test points on the laser I/O PCB is more than 350 mV
(measured voltage of R laser thermosensor).
YES NO
4302 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4302
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
The voltage between the pins 2 (+) and 3 (−) on the connector (J/P1511) of the laser control PCB is over 350
mV, which means R laser temperature sensor measurement voltage. ☞ 66010
YES NO
The voltage between the pins 4 (+) and 5 (−) on the connector (J/P1511) of the laser control PCB is over 2.5 V,
which means the Peltier control voltage when cooling. ☞ 66010
YES NO
4. Troubleshooting
The voltage between TP2 and TP12 (+) that are test points on the laser I/O PCB is over 2.5 V, which means the
Peltier control voltage when cooling. ☞ 66060
YES NO
The voltage between the pins 1 (+) and 2 (−) on the connector (J/P1540) of the laser I/O PCB is over 0 V and
less than 2 V, which means the Peltier control voltage when cooling. ☞ 66060
YES NO
Failure in the laser unit ☞ 26710 Failure on the laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
Disconnect the connector (J/P1532) on the laser control PCB. The measured resistance value between pins 7
and 8 on the R laser thermosensor side is over 5.4 kΩ (resistance value of the R laser thermosensor ).
YES NO
Reference
☞ 66060
YES NO
4302 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4302
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
The voltage between the pins 2 (+) and 3 (−) on the connector (J/P1511) of the laser control PCB is less than
350 mV, which means the R laser sensor unit temperature measurement voltage. ☞ 66010
YES NO
The voltage between the pins 4 (+) and 5 (−) on the connector (J/P1511) of the laser control PCB is less than
2.5 V, which means the Peltier control voltage when heating. ☞ 66010
YES NO
4. Troubleshooting
The voltage between TP2 and TP12 (+) that are test points on the laser I/O PCB is less than 2.5 V, which
means it is less than the Peltier control voltage when heating. ☞ 66060
YES NO
The voltage between the pins 1 (+) and 2 (−) on the connector (J/P1540) of the laser I/O PCB is over −2 V and
less than 0 V, which means the Peltier control voltage when heating. ☞ 66060
YES NO
Failure in the laser unit ☞ 26710 Failure on the laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
4302 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4304
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
The line appears inputting from the film. The line (irregular print) appears
in the setup print.
YES YES
The line appears inputting from the media. NO ☞ Inputting side is not good.
(around the scanner, D-ICE PCB
and around the AFC)
YES
4. Troubleshooting
YES
YES
Around the image processing PCB may not be ☞ Around the laser unit is not
good. good.
! Inputting side is not good. (around the scanner, D-ICE PCB and around the AFC)
Refer to the table below about an abnormal print which occurred because of around the scanner unit, D-ICE PCB and AFC.
4304 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4305
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
! Checking procedure
Floppy disk drive CD-ROM and CD- Zip drive MO drive DVD-RAM drive Five slots card
R/RW drive reader
4. Troubleshooting
Not settled.
Not settled.
Confirm that the Device status of each drive is become This device is working properly in the Device Manager.
• If not, each drive is not recognized.
Reinstall the driver or check the cable connection.
Not settled.
Not settled.
High-spec PC:
Check that these are recognized on the BIOS
display of SCSI when starting up the personal
Not settled. computer.
Check that the BIOS setting is correct.
4305 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4306
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
This describes the diagnosis when the PC does not start properly.
For details of terms used below or operations, refer to the startup sequence for PC. ☞ 50510
IMPORTANT
• The diagnosis below is for widely used PC (Windows 2000).
Any explanation for the extension PCB such as the PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB, which is used for the QSS only, is not
described here.
When the diagnosis is not effective to solve the problem, check the extension PCB used for the QSS only.
4. Troubleshooting
YES NO
YES NO
4306 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4306
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
YES
4. Troubleshooting
1
1. Replace the mother board.
4306 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4306
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
NO
NO YES
4. Troubleshooting
3. Replace the mother board.
NO YES
4306 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4306
Diagnosis appendix: Diagnosis flowchart
NO
NO YES
NO YES
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The error of STOP code is shown by STOP0xXXXXXXXXX.
• Countermeasure for the STOP code error may be shown on the Microsoft's website.
IMPORTANT
• Record the error No. if the STOP code error occurs.
The PC starts.
4306 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4400
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print
4. Troubleshooting
G057580
IMPORTANT
• Above sample image may be different from the actual one.
! Features of symptom
• The BGR moire like a sample print or white stripes is occurring only printing from the film.
• The BGR moire appears in the film advance direction but not always straight stripe, it may be bent a little or like a pattern.
NOTE
• Because it appears in the film advance direction, when the advance length is shorter than the paper width (horizontal feed), it
may appear perpendicular in paper advance direction.
• In BGR, colorful stripes with which the color mixed variously occurs.
IMPORTANT
• This symptom is similar to the Line like a bar code ☞ 4401, be careful of their difference.
• It may be confirmed on the monitor display at PJP.
! Explanation
When the dust around the slot for AFC scanning does not move together with a film, it occurs.
IMPORTANT
• When the dust does not move together with a film, the DIGITAL ICE and digital masking are not effective since the
position of dust is not specified.
! Check point
• Change the 135/240 AFC-II lane (135→240, 240→135) and check.
4400 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4400
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print
If it does not occur after changing the lane, the dust may attach to the previous lane. Clean the inside and outside of the AFC
again.
Clean slots (upper and lower), film path surface, protection glass of LED light source, condensing lens of AFC, insertion section,
rewinding section, each roller and etc. too.
IMPORTANT
• When cleaning the AFC, clean the both lanes of AFC.
• Confirm that the dust does not remain in the slots for scanning or between the rollers, and clean the front and rear
sides carefully.
• If this symptom occurs when changing the lane (135→240, 240→135), clean around the dust prevention glass of scanner.
• Clean around the AFC, scanner and film path surface.
4. Troubleshooting
4400 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4401
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print
4. Troubleshooting
G057581
IMPORTANT
• Above sample image may be different from the actual one.
! Features of symptom
• The moire like a sample print is occurred only printing from the film.
• The line is appeared in film advance direction.
NOTE
• Because it appears in the film advance direction, when the advance length is shorter than the paper width (horizontal feed), it
may appear perpendicular in paper advance direction.
• The line like a bar code and a pattern.
• The line (pattern) is regular and straight.
• The color is black or contained the BGR.
IMPORTANT
• This symptom is similar to the BGR colors mixing line ☞ 4400, be careful of their difference.
• It can be confirmed on the monitor display at PJP.
! Explanation
It is occurred by connector imperfect contact of the D-ICE PCB and abnormal of D-ICE PCB.
! Check point
• Reset the power supply.
• Check the connector contact around the D-ICE PCB.
D-ICE PCB: J/P45, 480, 483, 484A, 485, 486, and 487
• Replace D-ICE PCB and D-ICE control PCB. ☞ 64040
4401 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4450
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print
4. Troubleshooting
G057583
IMPORTANT
• Above sample image may be different from the actual one.
! Features of symptom
• The stripped pattern like a sample print occurs in all prints (printing from the film, media or setup print).
• The line appears parallel to the paper advance direction.
! Explanation
It occurs when the dust adheres to the laser dustproof glass of the laser unit, exposure advance unit or laser dustproof glass cover. Or,
it occurs due to the dust inside the laser unit.
! Check point
• Clean the glass surface of laser unit.
Refer to ☞ Cleaning the laser dustproof glass.
IMPORTANT
• When the line is not clear, the dust may adhere to the laser dustproof glass of the laser unit or inside of the laser
unit. When the line is clear, the dust may adhere around the pressure guide.
• Clean the laser dustproof glass cover.
• Clean around the exposure section of exposure advance unit.
• Replace the laser unit. ☞ 26710
4450 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4450
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print
G069089
2. Pull the knob to release the lock and remove the laser dustproof glass cover.
4. Troubleshooting
Knob Laser dustproof glass cover
G076407
3. Clean the laser dustproof glass with the enclosed cleaning sheet (soft cloth).
IMPORTANT
• When cleaning the laser dustproof glass, clean it with the soft cloth in the direction from far to near or from near
to far at one stroke.
• If cleaning several times, clean in the same direction. If wiping in the opposite direction, the dust which has
been removed adheres on the dustproof glass again. Use the different side of the cleaning cloth every time in
order not to adhere the removed dust again.
• Do not use the alcohol when cleaning. Using alcohol may affect the print quality.
Rear
G086408
4450 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4451
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print
4. Troubleshooting
G057579
IMPORTANT
• Above sample image may be different from the actual one.
! Features of symptom
• The stripped pattern like a sample print occurs in all prints (printing from the film, media or setup print).
• The monochrome line is appeared perpendicular in paper advance direction.
• The line appears at the same intervals.
! Explanation
Something noise may affect the laser unit. Or the inside of laser unit is abnormal.
! Check point
• Reset the power supply.
• Replace the B and G laser drivers. ☞ 66070
IMPORTANT
• B and G laser drivers are sharing the PCB.
• Replace the laser unit. ☞ 26710
4451 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4452
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print
4. Troubleshooting
G057585
IMPORTANT
• Above sample image may be different from the actual one.
! Features of symptom
• The light color is appeared in the unexposure position or low density position.
• The symptom like a sample print is occurred in all prints (printing from the film, media or setup print).
! Explanation
The chemical may deteriorate or laser light may leak because the inside the laser unit is abnormal.
! Check point
• Process the control strip and check the color of the white part. If the problem occurs, the chemical has deteriorated. Replace the
chemical.
• Shield the center of the laser dustproof glass cover of the laser unit with a splicing tape and make a setup print. If there is a
difference between the unexposed position shielded by the splicing tape and regular unexposed position, the abnormal print is
caused by leakage of laser beam.
IMPORTANT
• Be careful not to adhere dust or damage to the laser dustproof glass of the laser unit
• Replace the laser unit. ☞ 26710
4452 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4453
Diagnosis appendix: Example of abnormal print
4. Troubleshooting
G057584
IMPORTANT
• Above sample image may be different from the actual one.
! Features of symptom
• The stripped pattern like a sample print occurs in all prints (printing from the film, media or setup print).
• A stripped pattern like a wavy line.
• Appeared forward of the print.
! Explanation
Something noise may affect the laser unit. Or the inside of laser unit is abnormal.
! Check point
• Reset the power supply.
• Replace the B and G laser drivers. ☞ 66070
IMPORTANT
• B and G laser drivers are sharing the PCB.
• Replace the laser unit. ☞ 26710
4453 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4500
Diagnosis appendix: FB scanner
Diagnosis appendix: FB scanner
The following table shows the conditions and the corrective action when error messages appear.
4. Troubleshooting
There is insufficient memory. The memory of the personal computer is not Decrease the resolution or make the frame for
enough. image smaller.
There is nothing to scan. There is no copy on the copy deck. Place the copy correctly.
Cancel If the user interrupts the previewing or scanning Carry out the same previewing or scanning
Quit the process. operation operation again after deleting the message in
the message box.
There is insufficient space left on The hard disk space is not enough. Decrease the resolution or make the frame for
the hard disk. image smaller.
The copy may be improperly When the copy is protruded from the deck Place the copy on the deck not to protrude.
positioned.
When the copy is not protruded from it, release
the error message and enlarge or move the
image frame to fit the image.
Capturing communication error When using the FB scanner with QSS software Check the conditions shown on the left and
while using the FB scanner with another software then start the FB scanner execution display by
When the power of FB scanner is OFF pressing Preview again on the Order Display.
When the cable is not connected properly to USB
port 1 or SCSI2 which the FB scanner has been
connected to
All Data included the Tone Curve When the Setting Initialization button is clicked If you would like to initialize, select OK. If
and the Save Data are initialized. on the FB scanner execution display not, select Cancel.
Are you sure you want to initialize
them?
Cut Position Error When the upper left corner of brought area is Press the Preview button again.
recognized as placed in a wrong position (The
position of copy is not wrong.)
Cut Angle Error When the inner angle of brought area is not
recognized 90-degree (The angle of copy is not
wrong.)
DLL Load Completed When trying to load the DLL again although it is Quit the message display and execution display
already loaded of FB scanner by pressing the CLOSE button
DLL Load Failed When the DLL is not recognized as already and restart the FB scanner execution display by
installed pressing YES key in the order display.
When the installation of DLL is failed
The DLL was not loaded. When the DLL is not loaded
4500 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4500
Diagnosis appendix: FB scanner
IMPORTANT
• If the messages of DLL Load Completed, DLL Load Failed or The DLL was not loaded. appears repeatedly, the DLL
data may be damaged or broken. Reinstall the QSS software as a corrective action. ☞ 88000
NOTE
• DLL is a driver for running the FB scanner execution display on the Order Display of QSS.
Location: My Computer\C\Noritsukoki\QSS-32_33\Exe\NKC_ImageFBScan.dll
4. Troubleshooting
4500 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4600
Diagnosis appendix: Scanner adjustment chart
Diagnosis appendix: Scanner adjustment chart
IMPORTANT
• When the scanner adjustment chart itself is abnormal, if Swing and Tilt/Light Axis Adjustment or Focus Adjustment is
performed, fault may occur. Furthermore, since it cannot adjust normally, it may adversely affect the print quality.
• When you use the scanner adjustment chart, check whether there are any abnormalities in the scanner adjustment chart
referring to the display indicated below and the illustration of scanner adjustment chart.
• For handling the scanner adjustment chart, refer to ☞ Precautions for handling the scanner adjustment chart,
☞ Precautions for handling the scanner adjustment chart (for the 135/240 MMC-II and the 135/240 AMC-II).
! Normal scanner adjustment chart and display (swing and tilt/light axis adjustment)
Swing and Tilt/Light Axis Adjustment display
4. Troubleshooting
S3396-01-SM02
G078399
! Explanation
• As for the normal scanner adjustment chart, eight about 20µm slots and three about 100µm slots are contained for the swing and
tilt, and the triangle slot for the light axis is contained in the inner side.
4600 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4600
Diagnosis appendix: Scanner adjustment chart
S3230-01-SM00
4. Troubleshooting
For checking the focus
G071789
! Explanation
• As for the normal scanner adjustment chart, three about 100µm slots, eight about 20µm slots and three about 100µm slots are
contained for the focus adjustment.
4600 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4600
Diagnosis appendix: Scanner adjustment chart
S3396-01-SM04
4. Troubleshooting
Scanner adjustment chart
Dust adheres.
Dust adheres.
G078401
IMPORTANT
• Above sample image may be different from the actual one.
! Explanation
• Since dust has adhered to the slot section, a part of waveform has collapsed.
4600 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4600
Diagnosis appendix: Scanner adjustment chart
4. Troubleshooting
S3396-01-SM03
G078400
IMPORTANT
• Above sample image may be different from the actual one.
! Explanation
• Since the 20µm slot section for the Swing and Tilt confirmation is damaged, the mountain of waveform has decreased.
IMPORTANT
• Check if dust adheres on the scanner adjustment chart. If dust adheres, remove it with a blower brush before
attaching.
• Do not fold the scanner adjustment chart as it is thin.
• Position the scanner adjustment chart correctly. Otherwise, the scanner unit cannot be adjusted properly. Be sure to
press the upper and left parts of the chart to the AFC as shown below and secure the upper and lower parts using
tapes.
• Do not use the scanner adjustment chart wrong side out. Place the scanner adjustment chart so that the stamp mark
of the film size can be read.
4600 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4600
Diagnosis appendix: Scanner adjustment chart
• After using the scanner adjustment chart, put it into a card case.
• The scanner adjustment chart is a service personnel tool. Refer to Service personnel tool list.
☞ 80310
G050982
4. Troubleshooting
! Precautions for handling the scanner adjustment chart (for the 135/240 MMC-II and
the 135/240 AMC-II)
IMPORTANT
• Check if dust adheres on the scanner adjustment chart. If dust adheres, remove it with a blower brush before
attaching.
• Do not fold the scanner adjustment chart as it is thin.
• Do not use the scanner adjustment chart wrong side out. Place the scanner adjustment chart so that the stamp mark
of the film size can be read.
• Set the scanner adjustment chart (mount) for 135/240 MMC-II and adjust it.
• For the 135/240 AMC-II, attach the single adaptor and ejection stocker, then set the scanner adjustment chart (mount)
to adjust.
• The scanner adjustment chart is a service personnel tool. Refer to Service personnel tool list.
☞ 80310
4600 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4900
DLS Error Messages
DLS Error Messages
Followings are the error messages that tells Contact your service
provider.
NOTE
• Errors other than below, see the Online Help.
System Error messages (No. 3-)
No. Contents Reference
3-1 WIP Partition is Half Full ☞ 4910
3-2 WIP Partition is Three Quarters Full
3-3 WIP Partition Is Full
3-4 WIP Partition Is Full
3-6 Order Failed Image Analysis ☞ 4911
4. Troubleshooting
Uploading Error messages (No. 10-)
No. Contents Reference
10-9 Cannot Connect to Upload Host ☞ 4961
10-10 Error While Uploading Network
Order
10-11 Upload Server Cannot Recognize ☞ 4962
Customer Name
10-12 Cannot Connect to Upload Host
10-13 Upload Server Cannot Recognize ☞ 4963
Scan Location
10-14 Upload Server Cannot Recognize
Member ID
10-15 Upload Server Cannot Recognize ☞ 4964
Account ID
10-19 Connection Processing Failed ☞ 4965
10-20 Busy Modem
4900 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4910
System Error messages (No. 3-)
System Error messages (No. 3-)
☞ 88000
No. 3-1
WIP Partition is Half Full
No. 3-2
WIP Partition is Three Quarters Full
No. 3-3
WIP Partition Is Full
No. 3-4
WIP Partition Is Full
Condition
Condition
• The number of completed WIP orders to be retained is set
too high.
4. Troubleshooting
• Too many orders are active in the system, due to one or more
of the following reasons:
• The WIP contains many paused orders.
• A backlog of orders is waiting to be processed.
• The printer is not operational.
• A printer error occurred.
Diagnosis
1. Right-click My Computer and select Manage to bring up the
Computer Management display.
2. Selecting Disk Management shows each Disk condition.
S072418
3. The display shows WIP (V:). Check if it is Healthy.
4. The display shows WIP (V:), but if it is not Healthy, format
WIP (V:).
5. If the display does not show WIP (V:), carry out recovery.
☞ 88000
6. It it does not complete successfully, replace the hard disk and
execute the recovery.
4910 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4911
System Error messages (No. 3-)
No. 3-6
Order Failed Image Analysis
Condition
Condition
An error occurred on the software.
Check Point
1 Bring up the WIP display to execute either of
followings.
• Restart printing from the order
• Makeover the order.
• Erase the order and reprocess from the Order
display.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
1. Save the log data of DLS.
☞ 88000
2. Restart the system.
3. If it does not work out, reinstall the DLS software.
☞ 88000
4. If it does not work out, execute the recovery.
☞ 88000
4911 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4920
Archive Error messages (No. 6-)
Archive Error messages (No. 6-)
No. 6-1
Insufficient Store-It Disk Space
Condition
Condition
There is insufficient disk space for the archive system. This is
why archiving is unavailable.
Check Point
1 Delete unnecessary order.
Diagnosis
1. Restart the system.
2. Right-click My Computer and select Manage to bring up the
4. Troubleshooting
Computer Management display if it does not recover.
3. Selecting Disk Management shows each Disk condition.
S072418
4. The display shows Archive (U:). Check if it is Healthy.
5. The display shows Archive (U:), but if it is not Healthy,
format Archive (U:).
6. If the display does not show Archive (U:), carry out recovery.
☞ 88000
7. It it does not complete successfully, replace the hard disk and
execute the recovery.
☞ 88000
4920 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4961
Archive Error messages (No. 10-)
Archive Error messages (No. 10-)
Condition Condition
Condition Condition
• The network is not connected. • An error occurred while uploading to the upload services.
• The modem is not connected.
• The network configuration is not correct. Check Point
1 Have the key operator confirm that the network
Check Point configuration is correct.
1 Check the network and modem connections.
Diagnosis
2 Have the key operator confirm that the network
configuration is correct. 1. Check if the modem is set correctly.
2. Check that the modem is normal.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis 3. Confirm that the user's network configuration is correct.
1. Check if the modem is set correctly.
2. Check that the modem is normal.
3. Confirm that the user's network configuration is correct.
4961 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4962
Archive Error messages (No. 10-)
Check Point
Check Point
1 Confirm that the Customer Name is entered correctly.
1 Check the network and modem connections.
2 Have the key operator confirm that the network
2 Have the key operator confirm that the network
configuration is correct.
configuration is correct.
3 Restart the computer.
Diagnosis
1. Confirm that the user's network configuration is correct. Diagnosis
4. Troubleshooting
1. Confirm that the user's network configuration is correct.
4962 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4963
Archive Error messages (No. 10-)
Condition Condition
Condition Condition
• The Scan Location is missing. • The Member ID is missing.
• The Scan Location is not entered correctly. • The Member ID is not entered correctly.
Diagnosis Diagnosis
4. Troubleshooting
1. Confirm that the user's network configuration is correct. 1. Confirm that the user's network configuration is correct.
4963 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4964
Archive Error messages (No. 10-)
No. 10-15
Upload Server Cannot Recognize Scan
Location
Condition
Condition
• The Account ID is missing.
• The Account ID is not entered correctly.
Check Point
1 Confirm that the Account ID is entered correctly.
2 Have the key operator confirm that the network
configuration is correct.
Diagnosis
1. Confirm that the user's network configuration is correct.
4. Troubleshooting
4964 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4965
Archive Error messages (No. 10-)
Condition Condition
Condition Condition
• An error has occurred when uploading the image file to • System Cannot Communicate with Modem
Upload Server.
Check Point
Check Point
1 Upload the image file again after a while.
1 Upload the image file again.
Diagnosis
Diagnosis
1. Confirm that the user's network configuration is correct.
1. Confirm that the user's network configuration is correct.
2. Check if any problem occurs with the network cable.
4. Troubleshooting
4965 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4970
Archive Error messages (No. 12-)
Archive Error messages (No. 12-)
Condition Condition
Condition Condition
• Hard disk has an I/O problem. • Error in Hardware or Software Used for Communication
• Hard disk has no space.
• An error occurred on the software. Check Point
1 Restart the system.
Check Point
1 Restart the system. Diagnosis
1. Save the log data of DLS.
Diagnosis ☞ 88000
1. Save the log data of DLS. 2. Restart the system.
4. Troubleshooting
☞ 88000 3. If it does not work out, reinstall the DLS software.
2. Restart the system. ☞ 88000
3. If it does not work out, reinstall the DLS software.
☞ 88000
4970 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4972
Archive Error messages (No. 12-)
Condition Condition
Condition Condition
• The partition of print buffer has no efficient disk capacity. • Error While Sending the Image To Printer
• Hard disk has an I/O problem.
• An error occurred on the software. Check Point
1 Bring up the WIP display to execute either of
Check Point followings.
1 Restart printing on the WIP display. • Restart printing from the order
• Makeover the order.
Diagnosis • Erase the order and reprocess from the Order
display.
1. Save the log data of DLS.
4. Troubleshooting
☞ 88000
Diagnosis
2. Restart the system.
3. If it does not work out, reinstall the DLS software. Failed parts Manual No.
☞ 88000 PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
4972 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4974
Archive Error messages (No. 12-)
No. 12-11
Print Service Error
Condition
Condition
• A printer error occurred.
Check Point
1 Restart the system.
Diagnosis
1. Save the log data of DLS.
☞ 88000
2. Restart the system.
3. If it does not work out, reinstall the DLS software.
☞ 88000
4. Troubleshooting
4974 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4975
Archive Error messages (No. 12-)
Condition Condition
Condition Condition
• The print products which do not correspond to the system • Although a print request was sent, all the order frames have
have been selected. been denied.
• There is no necessary template for the index print. • An error occurred on the software.
4. Troubleshooting
1. Save the log data of DLS. • Erase the order and reprocess from the Order
☞ 88000 display.
2. Restart the system.
Diagnosis
3. If it does not work out, reinstall the DLS software.
☞ 88000 1. Save the log data of DLS.
☞ 88000
2. Restart the system.
3. If it does not work out, reinstall the DLS software.
☞ 88000
4975 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4977
Archive Error messages (No. 12-)
No. 12-40
Error Preparing a Print
Condition
Condition
• The image file which is larger than 4800x7200 pixels has
been attempted to be imported by DLS.
• An error occurred while preparing a print.
Check Point
1 Press the image file to 4800x7200 pixels or less using
the external software.
2 Bring up the WIP display to execute either of
followings.
• Restart printing from the order
• Makeover the order.
4. Troubleshooting
• Erase the order and reprocess from the Order
display.
Diagnosis
1. Save the log data of DLS.
☞ 88000
2. Restart the system.
3. If it does not work out, reinstall the DLS software.
☞ 88000
4977 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
4980
Media Output Error messages (No. 13-)
Media Output Error messages (No. 13-)
No. 13-12
CD Authoring Complete
No. 13-13
CD Authoring Complete
Condition
Condition
• The CD was authored successfully, but the CD drawer could
not be opened.
Check Point
1 Open the CD drawer manually, if necessary.
Diagnosis
4. Troubleshooting
1. Check if the CD drive is set to G drive.
4980 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40101
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver
NOTE NOTE
• This attention message appears on the external computer to • This attention message appears on the external computer to
4. Troubleshooting
which the optional QSS TWAIN driver has been installed. which the optional QSS TWAIN driver has been installed.
40101 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40107
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver
4. Troubleshooting
Take a corrective action for the error/attention message occuring
on the side of QSS.
40107 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40108
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver
4. Troubleshooting
which the optional QSS TWAIN driver has been installed.
NOTE
• This attention message appears on the external computer to
which the optional QSS TWAIN driver has been installed.
40108 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40109
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver
No. 117
Would you like to stop processing?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- It is attempted to stop the operation by pressing the
NO key when using the Keyboard Expansion Kit.
NOTE
• This attention message appears on the external computer to
which the optional QSS TWAIN driver has been installed.
4. Troubleshooting
40109 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40110
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point Check Point
1 Check the network connection. 1 Install the QSS TWAIN driver using the system
2 Restart the QSS. program CD of the connected QSS.
3 Start the QSS TWAIN driver.
40110 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40111
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver
4. Troubleshooting
1 Restart the QSS. NOTE
• This error message appears on the external computer to which
2 Start the QSS TWAIN driver.
the optional QSS TWAIN driver has been installed.
3 Check the network connection.
Check Point
1 Quit the QSS TWAIN driver.
40111 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40112
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver
No. 512
Error/Attention has occurred in the QSS.
Quit the process.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- This message appears when some error/attention
message urging you to cancel the QSS TWAIN driver
occurs on the side of QSS.
NOTE
• This error message appears on the external computer to which
the optional QSS TWAIN driver has been installed.
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 Take a corrective action for the error/attention
message occuring on the side of QSS.
2 Start the QSS TWAIN driver.
40112 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40113
Attention message/Error: QSS TWAIN driver
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point 1 Check if any other application is running.
1 Reinstall the QSS TWAIN driver. 2 Restart the external PC.
40113 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40500
Attention message: Processor
Attention message: Processor
4. Troubleshooting
• Disconnect the connector of the refilling water tank level
sensor and measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on
the jack side when the water temperature is between 10°C
and 35°C. The level sensor is defective if the resistance is
not between 1.5 kΩ and 4 kΩ.
Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
Processor power supply 2
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-5 Replenisher section (2)
40500 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40502
Attention message: Processor
Detailed diagram
No. 0502[N] ☞ PP 3-5 Replenisher section (2)
Add replenishment solution to the
replenishment tank.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Each replenishment solution level sensor turns OFF.
NOTE
• The name of processing solution causing this attention
message will be displayed in the second line of the message.
CD, BF or STB
Diagnosis
4. Troubleshooting
Blown fuses Manual No.
F14 Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
40502 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40502
Attention message: Processor
NOTE
No. 0503[N][SM]
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Empty the Effluent Tank.
Circuit diagram
Attention message release ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
YES or automatic release ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
• This attention message will be automatically released when ☞ PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB
the effluent tank is emptied.
Detailed diagram
Condition
☞ PP 3-6 Effluent section
Suffix Condition
number
- While prints are not being made, each effluent float
switch turns ON.
NOTE
• The name of processing solution causing this attention
message will be displayed in the second line of the message.
CD, BF or STB
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 Check the solution level of the effluent tank.
2 Check if the float of the effluent float switch moves
up and down smoothly.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F14 Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
40502 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40504
Attention message: Processor
No. 0505
Remove the prints from the Print Sorter
Unit.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The print full sensor turns DARK.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check that the print receiving tray and the print full
sensor are not soiled.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Print full sensor ☞ 63260
Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-11 Print conveyor section/Print sort unit
40504 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40506
Attention message: Processor
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- While prints are not being made, the interlock switch - While prints are not being made, the interlock switch
(dryer cover) turns OFF. (processor top cover) turns OFF.
- When auto cleaning is to be carried out, the interlock
NOTE switch (processor top cover) turns OFF.
• When the interlock switch (dryer cover) turns OFF, the drive - When refilling with water is to be carried out, the
motor, the dryer heater and the dryer fan will stop. interlock switch (processor top cover) turns OFF.
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check if the dryer top cover and the dryer door are • The drive motor, the refilling water pump, the cleaning pump,
securely closed. and the exhaust fan will stop when the interlock switch
(processor top cover) turns OFF.
Diagnosis
Check Point
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
1 Check that the processor top cover is securely closed.
Interlock switch (dryer cover) ☞ 63260
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Interlock switch (dryer cover) ☞ 63260 Adjustment failure point Manual No.
• Disconnect the connector of the interlock switch. If there is Interlock switch (processor top cover) ☞ 63250
no conduction between pins 1 and 2 on the plug side when
you place a magnet close to the interlock switch, the Failed parts Manual No.
interlock switch is defective. Interlock switch (processor top cover) ☞ 63250
Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220 • Disconnect the connector of the interlock switch. If there is
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200 no conduction between pins 1 and 2 on the plug side when
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400 you place a magnet close to the interlock switch, the
interlock switch is defective.
Processor power supply 3
Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
Failed parts
Processor power supply 3
Refer to 4203 ☞ Processor control PCB.
Refer to 4203 ☞ Processor relay PCB. # Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
Failed parts
NOTE
Refer to 4203 ☞ Processor relay PCB.
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
NOTE
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Detailed diagram ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 3-7 Drive section ☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
☞ PP 3-10 Dryer section (3)
40506 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40506
Attention message: Processor
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-7 Drive section
4. Troubleshooting
40506 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40508
Attention message: Processor
No. 0508
Paper remains in the processor. Are you
sure you want to turn the drive off?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Although paper still remains in the processing rack or
dryer rack, an attempt is made to turn off the drive.
NOTE
• Processing time of the processor varies depending on the
specification.
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 Check if all pieces of paper come out.
40508 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40510
Attention message: Processor
No. 0510
Attach the Print Conveyor Unit.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The conveyor unit sensor turns LIGHT in the standby
status after the drive has stopped.
Check Point
1 Check if the conveyor unit sensor is soiled.
Diagnosis
4. Troubleshooting
Failed parts Manual No.
Conveyor unit sensor ☞ 63260
Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-11 Print conveyor section/Print sort unit
40510 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40514
Attention message: Processor
No. 0515
Set the Rack Stopper.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- While prints are not being made, the rack stopper
sensor turns OFF.
Check Point
1 Check that the rack stopper is securely placed.
Diagnosis
4. Troubleshooting
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure in the attaching position adjustment ☞ 63250
of the rack stopper sensor
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-11 Print conveyor section/Print sort unit
40514 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40700
Attention message: SM replenishment
Attention message: SM replenishment
Check Point
No. 0700-####[SM]
Replace the Replenishment Package with 1 Check that the replenishment solution sensor is not
soiled.
a new one.P-#
Diagnosis
Attention message release
YES Adjustment failure point Manual No.
This attention message will be released only when the Sensitivity of the replenishment solution ☞ 63250
replenishment package is removed. (You have to turn OFF the sensor
replenishment package sensor once.)
Failed parts Manual No.
Condition
Replenishment solution sensor ☞ 63250
Suffix Condition SM I/O PCB ☞ 66600
number
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
0001 While replenishment solution sensor CD-A turns
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are not Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
refilled forcibly.
NOTE
0002 While replenishment solution sensor CD-B turns
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are not
refilled forcibly. Circuit diagram
4. Troubleshooting
0004 While replenishment solution sensor CD-C turns ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are not ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
refilled forcibly.
☞ PP 2-4 Around SM I/O PCB
0008 While replenishment solution sensor STB turns
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are not
refilled forcibly. Detailed diagram
0010 While replenishment solution sensor BF-A turns ☞ PP 3-13 SM Replenisher section (2)
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are not
refilled forcibly.
0020 While replenishment solution sensor BF-B turns
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are not
refilled forcibly.
NOTE
• When the tank is not refilled forcibly whether or not to set SM
Replenishment Setting via Machine Specification, these
messages appear. When the following conditions, the tanks
are not refilled forcibly.
SM Detecting condition of the replenishment
Replenishment solution sensor
Setting
ON The replenishment solution is not detected
when the power is ON.
The replenishment solution is not detected
when the replenishment package is replaced.
The replenishment solution is not detected
during output checks.
The replenishment solution is not detected
while measuring the output amount.
The replenishment solution is not detected
while initial replenishing.
Each replenishment solution in the
replenishment package is not detected at the
same time.
OFF Forced replenishment is not carried out.
40700 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40700
Attention message: SM replenishment
No. 0701-####[SM]
Attach the Replenishment Package.P-#
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Replenishment package sensor P-1 turns OFF.
0002 Replenishment package sensor P-2 turns OFF.
Diagnosis
4. Troubleshooting
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure in the attaching position adjustment ☞ 63250
of the replenishment package sensor
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-12 SM Replenisher section (1)
40700 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40702
Attention message: SM replenishment
IMPORTANT
Diagnosis
• When the replenishment package is replaced before it
Failed parts Manual No. becomes completely empty, be sure to initialize the
remaining amount of the replenishment package.
Water supply tank level sensor ☞ 63250 Otherwise, the messages No. 5708 and 5709
• Disconnect the connector of the water supply tank level Replenishment Package solution remaining error.
sensor and measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on will be displayed because the actual remaining amount
the jack side when the water temperature is between 10°C of the replenishment solution differs from the remaining
and 35°C. The level sensor is defective if the resistance is amount in data.
4. Troubleshooting
not between 1.5 kΩ and 4 kΩ. ☞ 45708
SM I/O PCB ☞ 66600 • When the replenishment package is not replaced but
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200 attached again, the process will be continued without
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400 initializing the remaining amount of the replenishment
package.
Processor power supply 2
NOTE Condition
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) Suffix Condition
number
Circuit diagram
- Before the replenishment package is completely
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram empty, replenishment package sensor 1 or 2 turns
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram OFF.
☞ PP 2-4 Around SM I/O PCB
Diagnosis
Detailed diagram
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
☞ PP 3-15 SM Replenisher section (4)
Failure in the attaching position adjustment ☞ 63250
of the replenishment package sensor
40702 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40702
Attention message: SM replenishment
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-12 SM Replenisher section (1)
4. Troubleshooting
40702 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40704
Attention message: SM replenishment
Detailed diagram
No. 0704[SM] ☞ PP 3-12 SM Replenisher section (1)
Press the [YES/START] key to initialize the
remaining amount of the Replenishment
Package.
IMPORTANT
• When the replenishment package is replaced before it
becomes completely empty, be sure to initialize the
remaining amount of the replenishment package.
Otherwise, the messages No. 5708 and 5709
Replenishment Package solution remaining error.
will be displayed because the actual remaining amount
of the replenishment solution differs from the remaining
4. Troubleshooting
amount in data.
☞ 45708
• When the replenishment package is not replaced but
attached again, the process will be continued without
initializing the remaining amount of the replenishment
package.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Before the replenishment package is completely
empty, replenishment package sensor 1 or 2 turns
OFF.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure in the attaching position adjustment ☞ 63250
of the replenishment package sensor
40704 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
40704
Attention message: SM replenishment
NOTE
No. 0705-####[SM]
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Replace the Replenishment Package with
a new one.P-# Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Attention message release ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
YES ☞ PP 2-4 Around SM I/O PCB
This attention message will be released only when the
replenishment package is removed. (You have to turn OFF the
Detailed diagram
replenishment package sensor once.)
☞ PP 3-13 SM Replenisher section (2)
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 While replenishment solution sensor CD-A turns
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are
refilled forcibly.
0002 While replenishment solution sensor CD-B turns
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are
4. Troubleshooting
refilled forcibly.
0004 While replenishment solution sensor CD-C turns
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are
refilled forcibly.
0008 While replenishment solution sensor STB turns
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are
refilled forcibly.
0010 While replenishment solution sensor BF-A turns
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are
refilled forcibly.
0020 While replenishment solution sensor BF-B turns
DARK, the remaining replenishment tanks are
refilled forcibly.
NOTE
• When the tank is refilled forcibly after SM replenishment has
been set via Machine Specification, these messages appear.
• A suffix number is indicated by the hexadecimal numeral.
☞ 81510
Check Point
1 Check that the replenishment solution sensor is not
soiled.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity of the replenishment solution ☞ 63250
sensor
40704 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41000
Attention message: Printer
Attention message: Printer
No. 1000
The Paper Magazine is out of paper.
Paper Magazine A
No. 1001
The Paper Magazine is out of paper.
Paper Magazine B
Countermeasure message
Remove the Paper Magazine. Press the [YES] key to continue the
printing.
Attention message release
YES or NO
• Select YES to restart printing.
• Select NO to stop printing.
Condition
Suffix Condition
4. Troubleshooting
number
- Paper end sensor A or B turns LIGHT.
NOTE
• Paper magazine A is an option. (Triple magazine
specification)
• When it is necessary to remove the paper, the message
Remove the paper remaining in the Printer Section.
appears following the attention message.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Paper end sensor A or B ☞ 63051
Printer I/O PCB 3 (in case of B) ☞ 66040
Triple magazine PCB (in case of A) ☞ 66050
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
41000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41002
Attention message: Printer
No. 1002
Would you like to feed the leading edge of
paper? Paper Magazine A
No. 1003
Would you like to feed the leading edge of
paper? Paper Magazine B
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- An attempt is made to feed out the first piece of paper
4. Troubleshooting
when the power supply is ON, the daily setup is
carried out or after you replaced the paper magazine.
NOTE
• Paper magazine A is an option. (Triple magazine
specification)
41002 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41004
Attention message: Printer
Circuit diagram
No. 1004
☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
Attach the Paper Magazine. Paper
Magazine A Detailed diagram
No. 1005 ☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
Attach the Paper Magazine. Paper ☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
Magazine B
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The paper magazine code sensor A or B cannot detect
the paper magazine code. (All the code sensors turn
4. Troubleshooting
LIGHT.)
- Although either paper magazine code sensor A or B
detects the paper magazine code, the currently
selected print channel is inconsistent.
NOTE
• Paper magazine A is an option. (Triple magazine
specification)
Check Point
1 Check that the paper magazine code sensor is not
soiled.
2 Check that the detection cap of the paper magazine is
correctly set.
3 Check that the paper magazine is inserted as far as it
will go.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
The adjusting position of the paper magazine -
code sensor is defective.
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
41004 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41010
Attention message: Printer
Detailed diagram
No. 1010 ☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
Change the Paper Magazine. Paper ☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
Magazine A
No. 1011
Change the Paper Magazine. Paper
Magazine B
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The paper magazine which is different from that set
in the print channel is set prior to starting print.
NOTE
• Paper magazine A is an option. (Triple magazine
4. Troubleshooting
specification)
Check Point
1 Check that the paper magazine code sensor is not
soiled.
2 Check that the detection cap of the paper magazine is
correctly set.
3 Check that the paper magazine is inserted as far as it
will go.
4 Check the print channel setting.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
The adjusting position of the paper magazine ☞ 63051
code sensor is defective.
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
41010 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41012
Attention message: Printer
Check Point
1 Check the print channel setting.
4. Troubleshooting
41012 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41014
Attention message: Printer
No. 1014
The system is being initialized, one
moment please. . .
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- After the power supply has been turned ON, the
system is being initialized.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
4. Troubleshooting
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
Image processing PCB ☞ 64000
Power PCB ☞ 64160
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
41014 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41016
Attention message: Printer
No. 1017
Would you like to stop printing?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- While prints are being made, the NO key is pressed.
4. Troubleshooting
41016 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41024
Attention message: Printer
No. 1024
Would you like to register the correction
value?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The message appears after measuring the test print in
the setup mode.
Check Point
1 Check the channel setting.
4. Troubleshooting
41024 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41026
Attention message: Printer
Circuit diagram
No. 1026
☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
Close the Printer Top Cover.
Detailed diagram
Attention message release
YES or automatic release.
☞ LP 3-13 Laser unit (3)
• The message will be automatically released when the printer
top cover is closed.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Interlock switch (printer top cover) turns OFF.
Check Point
1 Check that the printer top cover is securely closed.
Diagnosis
4. Troubleshooting
Blown fuses Manual No.
F3 Laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
41026 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41026
Attention message: Printer
Suffix Condition
No. 1027-#### number
Profile data was not found. 0091 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the parameter file for gray control is not included in
Attention message release the hard disk.
YES
Diagnosis
Condition
Failure in the profile data Manual No.
Suffix Condition Install the profile data from the profile CD ☞ 88000
number corresponding to the main software.
0001 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the monitor profile data is not included in the hard
disk.
0002 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the monitor initial setting file is not included in the
hard disk.
0011 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the profile data of paper type 1 is not included in the
hard disk.
4. Troubleshooting
0012 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the profile data of paper type 2 is not included in the
hard disk.
0013 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the profile data of paper types 1 and 2 are not
included in the hard disk.
0014 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the profile data of paper type 3 is not included in the
hard disk.
0015 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the profile data of paper types 1 and 3 are not
included in the hard disk.
0016 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the profile data of paper types 2 and 3 are not
included in the hard disk.
0017 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the profile data of paper types 1, 2 and 3 are not
included in the hard disk.
0040 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the flatbed scanner profile data is not included in the
hard disk.
0041 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the flatbed scanner initial setting file is not included
in the hard disk.
0050 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the positive scanner profile data is not included in the
hard disk.
0051 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the positive scanner initial setting file is not included
in the hard disk.
0060 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the reference table data (monitor) for color correction
table calculation is not included in the hard disk.
0061 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the reference table data (printer) for color correction
table calculation is not included in the hard disk.
0090 When setup using the profile data is to be carried out,
the parameter file for chroma enhancement is not
included in the hard disk.
41026 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41028
Attention message: Printer
Failed parts Manual No.
No. 1028 Colorimeter Control PCB ☞ 64130
More than 3 correction keys of low, middle ATX mother board ☞ 88000
or high density area. Execute correction? Colorimeter unit ☞ 21110
Attention message release NOTE
YES or NO • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
• Select YES to carry out the correction.
Circuit diagram
• Select NO to stop the correction.
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
IMPORTANT ☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
• When this error occurs, the colorimeter may be ☞ CS 2-1 Control section
calibrated with the calibration plate in a wrong position. ☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
Stop the correction by clicking the NO key and start a
setup (for example, daily setup) all over again. ☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
4. Troubleshooting
- When the measurement of the test print has been
completed in setup mode, the correction result is ±3
keys or more.
Check Point
1 Check that the calibration plate is not soiled.
2 Check that the calibration plate is correctly set.
3 Verify that the processing racks are clean.
4 Clean the advance rollers of the colorimeter with a
cleaning sheet.
5 Carry out each correction via Colorimeter Unit
Adjustment.
IMPORTANT
• If the abnormal calibration data of the colorimeter unit is
registered by selecting YES for the message 1551: The
calibration plate data is out of range. Register the
data?, the attention message No. 1028 may appear.
• For the above case, perform Updating the Calibration
Plate Data. ☞ 21110
• Then carry out Updating the Calibration Plate Data. If
the same attention message appears, the corrective
action should be taken according to the following
diagnosis.
Diagnosis
In case of an adjusting failure
Update the calibration plate data. ☞ 21110
Adjust the height of the colorimeter unit. ☞ 21120
Adjust the colorimeter unit. ☞ 35100
For defective parts
Replace the calibration plate when it is ☞ 21110
scratched on.
Replace the colorimeter unit in the case of the ☞ 21110
colorimeter unit failure.
41028 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41028
Attention message: Printer
NOTE
No. 1029
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
The measurement failed. Measure it again.
Circuit diagram
Attention message release ☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
YES or NO ☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
• Select YES to measure the print again. ☞ CS 2-1 Control section
• Select NO to stop the operation. ☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- When measuring the test print, difference of the
density between each step is not detected.
- When measuring the test print, abnormal density is
detected.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check that the test print is correctly placed in the
colorimeter.
2 Check that the test print is correctly made.
3 Clean the advance rollers of the colorimeter with a
cleaning sheet.
4 Carry out each correction via Colorimeter Unit
Adjustment.
Between steps
G078472
Diagnosis
In case of an adjusting failure
Update the calibration plate data. ☞ 21110
Adjust the height of the colorimeter unit. ☞ 21120
Adjust the colorimeter unit. ☞ 35100
For defective parts
Replace the calibration plate when it is ☞ 21110
scratched on.
Replace the colorimeter unit in the case of the ☞ 21110
colorimeter unit failure.
41028 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41030
Attention message: Printer
Check Point 1 Carry out the setup using the paper type which the
Paper Specification Registration Setup has been
4. Troubleshooting
1 Wait until printing is completed, and place the done.
selected paper magazine.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Carry out Paper Specification Registration ☞ 32510
Setup.
41030 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41032
Attention message: Printer
No. 1032
One moment please. . .
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Scanning or printing is interrupted by pressing the
NO key.
Check Point
1 Wait until the interrupt process has been completed.
4. Troubleshooting
41032 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41034
Attention message: Printer
No. 1035
Paper Magazine Registration Setup is not
completed.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The paper magazine which the Paper Magazine
Registration Setup has not been done is selected
when outputting the test print for monitor gamma
adjustment or profile chart.
Check Point
1 Check that the paper magazine to which Paper
Magazine Registration Setup has been completed is
4. Troubleshooting
selected.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Carry out Paper Magazine Registration ☞ 32520
Setup.
41034 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41038
Attention message: Printer
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- The paper type of the paper magazine with which - The paper type, the specification of which has not
printing or setup is to be carried out is not specified. been registered during printing or setup, is selected.
4. Troubleshooting
Carry out Paper Magazine Registration ☞ 32520 Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Setup. Carry out Paper Specification Registration ☞ 32510
Setup.
41038 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41040
Attention message: Printer
NOTE
• The data capacity which can be stored in an order is limited.
4. Troubleshooting
41040 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41042
Attention message: Printer
NOTE
No. 1043
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Laser temperature is being adjusted. One
moment please. . . Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Attention message release ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
YES or automatic release. ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
• When the temperature adjustment of the lasers B, G and R are ☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
completed and the machine becomes processable, it returns
automatically.
Detailed diagram
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The attention message appears until B and G lasers are
processable.
• When the laser unit is waited until the temperature becomes to
be processable, Laser temperatures are being adjusted.(U)
is displayed.
• When the R laser is waited until the temperature becomes to
be processable, Laser temperatures are being adjusted.(R)
is displayed.
• Processable range of the laser unit is 23.0°C to 42.0°C.
• Processable range of the R laser is 27.7°C to 28.3°C.
• The laser unit heater works to shorten the time required for
adjusting the temperature to processable.
• You can check the temperatures of R laser and laser unit in
Laser Unit Adjustment.
☞ 37300
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Laser unit heater ☞ 63080
Laser unit cooling fan 1 or 2 ☞ 63050
B and G laser drivers ☞ 66070
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
Laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
Laser power supply
Laser unit ☞ 26710
IMPORTANT
• Replacement and adjustment of the parts in the laser
unit are impossible.
Replace the unit.
41042 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41046
Attention message: Printer
NOTE
No. 1047-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Close printer door.
Circuit diagram
Attention message release ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
YES or automatic release ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
• This attention message will be released automatically when ☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
the printer door is closed. ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Condition
☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
Suffix Condition
number
Detailed diagram
0001 The interlock switch (printer door 1 or 2) turns OFF.
☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
0002 Printer door 3 sensor turns OFF.
NOTE
• The power is not supplied to some electrical parts when the
interlock switch (printer door 1 or 2) turns OFF.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check that printer doors 1, 2 and 3 are securely
closed.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Adjustment failure in the attaching position -
of the interlock switch (printer door 1 or 2)
Adjustment failure in the attaching position -
of the printer door 3 sensor
41046 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41048
Attention message: Printer
No. 1048
Press the [ORDER] key. Wait until output
has completed.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- While printing, outputting to media, or when the
paper is feeding in the printer, the light source update
is required.
4. Troubleshooting
41048 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41052
Attention message: Printer
NOTE
4. Troubleshooting
• When it is necessary to remove the paper, the message
Remove the paper remaining in the Printer Section.
appears after the attention message is displayed.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Paper end sensor C ☞ 63051
Printer I/O PCB 3 ☞ 66040
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
41052 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41064
Attention message: Printer
No. 1065
Would you like to continue?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Printer door 3 sensor turns OFF while printing using
paper magazine B or C.
NOTE
• This attention message appears when using the triple
magazine specification machine.
Check Point
1 Check that the printer door 3 is securely closed.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Adjustment failure in the attaching position -
of the printer door 3 sensor
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
41064 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41066
Attention message: Printer
No. 1067
Attach the Paper Magazine. Paper
Magazine C
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The paper magazine code sensor C cannot detect the
paper magazine code. (All the sensors turn LIGHT.)
- The paper magazine code which is detected by paper
magazine code sensor C is different from the current
print channel setting.
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 Check that the paper magazine code sensor is not
soiled.
2 Check that the detection cap of the paper magazine is
correctly set.
3 Check that the paper magazine is inserted as far as it
will go.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
The adjusting position of the paper magazine -
code sensor is defective.
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
41066 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41068
Attention message: Printer
No. 1068
Replace the Paper Magazine. Paper
Magazine C
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The paper magazine which is different from that set
in the print channel is set prior to starting print.
Check Point
1 Check that the paper magazine code sensor is not
soiled.
2 Check that the detection cap of the paper magazine is
correctly set.
4. Troubleshooting
3 Check that the paper magazine is inserted as far as it
will go.
4 Check the print channel setting.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
The adjusting position of the paper magazine -
code sensor is defective.
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
41068 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41072
Attention message: Printer
No. 1072
Paper color intensity is low. Execute
correction?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Paper color intensity is low as a result of the
calculated correction value in the setup mode.
Check Point
1 Check that the calibration plate is correctly set.
4. Troubleshooting
2 Check that the calibration plate is not soiled.
3 Check the solution condition using a control strip.
4 Carry out each correction via Colorimeter Unit
Adjustment.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Colorimeter Control PCB ☞ 64130
Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
Colorimeter unit ☞ 21110
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit
41072 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41074
Attention message: Printer
4. Troubleshooting
(bit)
0001 Paper end sensor A (SE6)
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
0002 Paper end sensor B (SE4)
☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
0004 Paper end sensor C (SE5)
Detailed diagram
0040 Exposure start sensor (SE14)
☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
0080 Paper sensor 1 (SE18)
☞ LP 3-5 Exposure advance unit (1)
0100 Paper sensor 2 (left) (SE25)
☞ LP 3-7 Paper advance unit 1
0200 Paper sensor 2 (center) (SE26)
☞ LP 3-10 Paper advance unit 2 (3)
0400 Paper sensor 2 (right) (SE27)
☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
NOTE
• The corresponding sensor is displayed in the second line of the
message.
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Check Point
1 Clean each sensor using a blower brush.
2 Check the sensor status via Paper Sensor
Adjustment. ☞ 36000
NOTE
• In the service mode, LED light intensity value is displayed in
the Paper Sensor Adjust.
• After cleaning each sensor, carry out Paper Sensor LED
Light Intensity Adjustment again and check that the sensor
LED light intensity changes.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Paper end sensor A (SE6) ☞ 63051
Paper end sensor B (SE4)
Paper end sensor C (SE5)
Exposure start sensor (SE14) ☞ 63070
41074 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41080
Attention message: Printer
4. Troubleshooting
41080 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41302
Attention message: Scanner
Attention message: Scanner
No. 1302
Would you like to stop scanning?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The NO key is pressed during film scanning or
judgement.
4. Troubleshooting
41302 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41304
Attention message: Scanner
Wiring diagram [S-4]
No. 1305 ☞ 89010
Photometry Section may be dirty.
Countermeasure message
Clean the parts in the Light Source Section and Photometry
Section. For details, refer to the manual. After cleaning, execute
the Scanner Change of Light in Daily Setup.
Attention message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- When the Area Registration, Light Source
Registration or Light Source Update is carried out,
the data sent from the CCD is abnormal.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Clean the LED light source section.
2 Check that the LED light source section is neither
damaged nor soiled.
3 Check that no dust is attached on the AFC lens unit
and AFC slot.
When you have the maintenance stick (option), clean
with it.
NOTE
• Bring up Swing and Tilt/Light Axis Adjustment display
without attaching the scanner adjustment chart. By checking
the condition of the graph, you may specify the occurring
cause.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
D-ICE PCB ☞ 64040
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
Scratch mend PCB 2 ☞ 64060
Scratch mend PCB 1 ☞ 64070
Data change-over PCB ☞ 64080
DIMM ☞ 64050
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Scanner power supply 2
Multi power supply (scanner)
Desk power supply 1 ☞ 64170
Desk power supply 2
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41304 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41306
Attention message: Scanner
No. 1306
Update the light source. If film remains in
the Film Carrier, remove it.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The light source registration is not carried out, or a
specified time has passed after updating the light
source.
Check Point
1 Update the light source.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Register the light source. ☞ 37010
41306 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41312
Attention message: Scanner
No. 1313
The Focus Adjustment was not completed
yet.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Film scanning is carried out when the DIGITAL
ICE Technology Correction of Operator Selection
is ON and the Focus Adjustment is not completed.
Check Point
1 Carry out the focus adjustment.
2 Check the setting of the DIGITAL ICE Technology
correction.
4. Troubleshooting
41312 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41314
Attention message: Scanner
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check that the room temperature is 15 to 30 degree
1 Clean the LED light source section. C.
2 Check that no dust is attached on the AFC lens unit 2 Clean the scanner filter.
and AFC slot.
3 Check the LED cooling fan rotation.
When you have the maintenance stick (option), clean
with it.
IMPORTANT
Diagnosis • If the above message appears when starting the
operation (when the QSS is turned on by the program
Failed parts Manual No. timer) or when performing the dairy setup, the operation
LED light source unit ☞ 62050 temperature of the QSS (LED light source unit) may be
out of the specified range (15 to 30 degree C).
ND filter solenoid ☞ 62050 For the operation specification of the LED light source
LED driver PCB ☞ 65020 unit, refer to ☞ 62050.
Scanner unit ☞ 20610 • In the case above, each electrical part of the QSS is
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010 normal.
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000 Update the scanner light source after the operation
temperature of the QSS (LED light source unit) is within
Scanner power supply ☞ 65060 the specified range.
NOTE
Diagnosis
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Failed parts Manual No.
Circuit diagram
☞ S 1-1 AC power supply connecting LED cooling fan 1 or 2 ☞ 62050
☞ S 1-2 DC power supply connecting (type 0, 1, 2) LED driver PCB ☞ 65020
☞ S 1-6 Around LED driver PCB LED light source unit ☞ 62050
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Detailed diagram AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
☞ S 12-3 Around LED light source unit (1) Scanner power supply ☞ 65060
☞ S 12-4 Around LED light source unit (2) NOTE
☞ S 12-5 Around LED light source unit (1) • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
☞ S 12-6 Around LED light source unit (2)
Circuit diagram
41314 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41314
Attention message: Scanner
Detailed diagram
☞ S 12-3 Around LED light source unit (1)
☞ S 12-4 Around LED light source unit (2)
☞ S 12-5 Around LED light source unit (1)
☞ S 12-6 Around LED light source unit (2)
4. Troubleshooting
41314 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41316
Attention message: Scanner
4. Troubleshooting
2 Check whether the scanner adjustment chart is dirty including the normal display with clear edges.
or there is any distortion and also check the
attachment state.
3 Check a waveform and adjust a focus value again.
NOTE
• For confirming the scanner adjustment chart, refer to ☞ 4600.
41316 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41318
Attention message: Scanner
No. 1319
Scanner type was changed. The system
will be restarted.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Operating system recognized scanner type change at
start-up.
IMPORTANT
• If this attention message appears, scanner-related data
is initialized after the system is restarted.
After restarting the system either upload backup data or
re-register light source(s), readjust focus, and update
light sources again.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• This message appears when the main software recognizes a
scanner type change from S-2/S-3 to S-4 or from S-4 to S-2/S-
3.
• The detected scanner type is displayed in the third line.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41318 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41400
Attention message: Film carrier
Attention message: Film carrier
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- When the film is not processed with the film carrier, - When the film is not processed, all the film carrier
the film carrier lock sensor turns LIGHT. code detection turns OFF.
4. Troubleshooting
one, set it and specify the error caused by the film
NOTE carrier or main body.
• If the film carrier is not in position, the ready lamp blinks.
Diagnosis
Diagnosis
When the error caused by the film carrier:
Failed parts Manual No.
Failed parts Manual No.
Film carrier lock sensor ☞ 62050
Relay PCB 1 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65200
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
135 AFC connecting PCB ☞ 65360
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Connecting PCB (120 AFC-II) ☞ 65290
Multi power supply (scanner) PS-3 ☞ 65060
Connecting PCB (110 AFC-II) ☞ 65310
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring Connecting PCB (135/240 AMC-ll) ☞ 65350
MMC connecting PCB ☞ 65330
Failed part(s) [S-2/S-3]
Refer to 4200 ☞ AFC/scanner control PCB.
When the error caused by the main body:
Refer to 4200 ☞ AFC/scanner driver PCB.
Failed parts Manual No.
Failed part(s) [S-4] AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
☞ 4190 Multi power supply (scanner) PS-3 ☞ 65060
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
NOTE Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41400 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41400
Attention message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
41400 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41402
Attention message: Film carrier
Condition Condition
4. Troubleshooting
the film carrier attached. 3 Check the sensor status via input check.
Diagnosis Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No. Failed parts Manual No.
Connecting PCB 1 ☞ 65200 IPI sensor ☞ 62150
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000 Sensor PCB ☞ 65250
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060 Connecting PCB 1 ☞ 65200
Power PCB ☞ 65260 AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010 Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060 Power PCB ☞ 65260
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
NOTE
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41402 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41404
Attention message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
- Some frames cannot be read when the read head 0004 135 perforation sensor
(camera track or photo finishing track) reads the IX
0008 DX sensor 1
data.
0010 DX sensor 3
Check Point 0080 Rewinding sensor
8000 Film needs to be removed due to reason not
1 Clean the magnetic head. applicable to any of the above sensor detections
Diagnosis NOTE
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
Failed parts Manual No.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Read head ☞ 62150 Suffix number display.
Magnetic head PCB ☞ 65270 ☞ 4002
Connecting PCB 1 ☞ 65200
Check Point
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060 1 Check that each sensor is not soiled.
Power PCB ☞ 65260 2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010 Adjustment.
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060 3 Check the status of the sensors via input check.
NOTE Diagnosis
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
135/240 AFC-ll
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
☞ 89000 Failure of Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment ☞ 35000
Failure of DX Sensor Standard Adjustment
Wiring diagram [S-4]
☞ 89010
Blown fuses Manual No.
F26 AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
41404 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41404
Attention message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
Failed part(s) [S-4] Refer to 4200 ☞ AFC/scanner control PCB.
☞ 4190 Refer to 4200 ☞ AFC/scanner driver PCB.
Refer to 4200 ☞ Scanner power supply 1 (PS1).
41404 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41406
Attention message: Film carrier
Suffix Condition
number
(bit)
0001 240 loading sensor
0002 240 ready sensor
4. Troubleshooting
0004 240 perforation sensor
0008 DX sensor 1
0040 Cartridge limit switches 1 and 2
NOTE
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Check Point
1 Check that each sensor is not soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
3 Check the status of the sensors and limit switches via
input check.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure of Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment ☞ 35000
Failure of DX Sensor Standard Adjustment
41406 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41406
Attention message: Film carrier
Condition
Condition
When the power supply is turned ON or the system is initialized
after the error cancellation, the film carrier sensor turns DARK.
The machine detects an error in the sensor while checking at the
beginning of film processing.
Suffix Condition
number
(bit)
0001 Loading sensor
0002 Ready sensor
4. Troubleshooting
0004 Perforation sensor
NOTE
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Check Point
1 Check that each sensor is not soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
3 Check the status of the sensors via input check.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure of Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment ☞ 35020
41406 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41408
Attention message: Film carrier
Wiring diagram [S-4]
No. 1408-#### ☞ 89010
Remove the 120 film from the Film Carrier.
Condition
Condition
When the power supply is turned ON or the system is initialized
after the error cancellation, the film carrier sensor turns DARK.
The machine detects an error in the sensor while checking at the
beginning of film processing.
Suffix Condition
number
(bit)
0001 Loading sensor
0002 Ready sensor
4. Troubleshooting
0004 Film sensor
NOTE
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Check Point
1 Check that each sensor is not soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
3 Check the status of the sensors via input check.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure of Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment ☞ 35010
41408 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41408
Attention message: Film carrier
No. 1409
Set the lane for the Film Carrier.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The lane of 135/240 AFC-II is set to neither 135 nor
240.
Check Point
1 Check that the lane is correctly selected.
4. Troubleshooting
2 Check the limit switch status via input check.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
135 lane limit switch ☞ 62150
240 lane limit switch
Driver PCB 2 ☞ 65240
Connecting PCB 3 ☞ 65220
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
Power PCB ☞ 65260
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41408 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41410
Attention message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
- The scanner cannot recognize the frames included in Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
the scanned data as proper images.
☞ 89000
NOTE
• The film stop position in the film carrier is not checked. Wiring diagram [S-4]
• The whole roll of a film is scanned from the leading edge to ☞ 89010
the rear edge and the image data is read.
• Then, the images which are recognized as frames by the
scanner are displayed on the screen sequentially.
• This attention message will appear when the image data of
frames which has unclear boundary between exposed area and
unexposed one is displayed on the screen.
Check Point
1 Insert the film in the reverse direction to check that it
stops at the same position.
2 Carry out the Scanning Position Correction.
3 Register the light source.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F3 LED driver PCB ☞ 65020
41410 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41412
Attention message: Film carrier
Condition Condition
4. Troubleshooting
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment. Operator Selections is Manual.
41412 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41412
Attention message: Film carrier
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
4. Troubleshooting
41412 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41414
Attention message: Film carrier
No. 1414
The FID number was not detected.
Countermeasure message
Input the FID number then press the [START] key to print the FID
number.
Attention message release
YES or NO
• Select YES to input the FID manually.
• Select NO to start scanning without reading the FID number.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- 240 DX sensor 1 or 2 cannot the FID code of the film.
Check Point
1 Check that the 240 DX sensor is soiled.
4. Troubleshooting
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
3 Check the status of the sensors via input check.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure of DX Sensor Standard Adjustment ☞ 35000
Circuit diagram
☞ S 1-2 DC power supply connecting (type 0, 1, 2)
☞ S 1-3 Around scanner mount
☞ S 1-8 135/240 AFC-II power supply circuit diagram
☞ S 4-1 135/240 AFC-ll (1)
Detailed diagram
☞ S 13-8 135/240 AFC-II (8)
41414 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41416
Attention message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point Check Point
1 Check that the 240 lane is correctly selected. 1 Check that the mount insertion cover is closed.
2 Check the lane limit switch status via input check. 2 Check the status of the mount insertion cover sensor
via input check.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No. Diagnosis
240 lane limit switch ☞ 62150 Failed parts Manual No.
135 lane limit switch Mount insertion cover sensor ☞ 62450
Driver PCB 2 ☞ 65240 MMC connecting PCB ☞ 65330
Connecting PCB 3 ☞ 65220 AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000 Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060 AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Power PCB ☞ 65260 Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
NOTE
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
NOTE Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) ☞ 89000
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
☞ 89000 Wiring diagram [S-4]
☞ 89010
Wiring diagram [S-4]
☞ 89010
41416 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41420
Attention message: Film carrier
Wiring diagram [S-4]
No. 1420 ☞ 89010
Select the DX code.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The DX code on the negative or position film is not
read while scanning.
Check Point
1 Check that the DX code area of the film is not
fogged.
2 Check that the film without the DX code is not used.
4. Troubleshooting
3 Check if the DX sensor is not soiled.
4 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
5 Check the DX sensor status via input check.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure of DX Sensor Standard Adjustment ☞ 35000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41420 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41420
Attention message: Film carrier
No. 1421
Confirm the stop position of all the frames
to be processed.
Countermeasure message
Adjust the film stop position by using the cursor keys. When you
change the frame size, select the desirable frame size and press the
[YES] key.
Attention message release
PASS, YES or NO
• Select PASS to skip the frame and restart scanning from the
next frame.
• Select YES to start film scanning.
• Select NO to eject the film.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
4. Troubleshooting
- The film is inserted pressing the N key of the
operation keyboard or pressing the F4 key of the full
keyboard to check the frame stop position manually.
NOTE
• When scanning the film, the machine cannot recognize the
frame properly, adjust the stop position manually.
41420 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41422
Attention message: Film carrier
No. 1422
Select the 135 lane.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- 135 lane is not selected when cleaning the 135 lane
for the AFC cleaning in the close down checks.
Check Point
1 Check that the 135 lane is correctly selected.
2 Check the lane limit switch status via input check.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
135 lane limit switch ☞ 62150
240 lane limit switch
Driver PCB 2 ☞ 65240
Connecting PCB 3 ☞ 65220
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
Power PCB ☞ 65260
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41422 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41423
Attention message: Film carrier
No. 1423
Execute Sensor LED Light Intensity
Adjustment. Remove the film from the
Film Carrier.
No. 1424
Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment is
being executed.
No. 1425
Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment is
complete.
4. Troubleshooting
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- A positive film is inserted into the auto film carrier
when two or more hours passed after finishing the
previous sensor LED light source intensity
adjustment.
NOTE
• If the attention message No.1423 is released by removing the
film and pressing the YES key, the sensor LED light intensity
adjustment is carried out automatically.
In this time, attention messages Nos.1424 and 1425 appear.
After the sensor LED light intensity adjustment is completed,
the attention message is released automatically.
41423 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41426
Attention message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
110 connecting PCB ☞ 65310
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41426 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41428
Attention message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check if no mounts are left in the mount unit and the
Check Point mount stocker.
2 Check the status of the mount sensor and mount
1 Check if no mounts are left in the mount unit and the sensor (inlet) via input check.
mount stocker.
2 Check the status of the sensors via input check. Diagnosis
41428 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41430
Attention message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check that the frame size (6×6/6×7/6×8/6×9)
selected in Machine Status of order display is as Diagnosis
same as one inserted 120 frame size. Failed parts Manual No.
2 Check that the loading sensor, the ready sensor and Connecting PCB ☞ 65290
the film sensor are not soiled.
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
3 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
4 Check the status of the sensors via input check.
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Diagnosis
NOTE
Adjustment failure point Manual No. • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Sensitivity adjustment failure in the loading ☞ 35010 Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
sensor, ready sensor, or film sensor
☞ 89000
Failed parts Manual No.
Wiring diagram [S-4]
Loading sensor ☞ 62250
☞ 89010
Ready sensor
Film sensor
Film feed motor
PM driver (film feed motor) ☞ 65070
Sensor PCB ☞ 65300
Connecting PCB ☞ 65290
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41430 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41432
Attention message: Film carrier
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- The daily setup is carried out using the 135/240 - The daily setup is carried out using the 135/240
AMC-II when the light source registration is carried MMC-II when the light source registration is carried
out with 135/240 MMC-II. out with 135/240 AMC-II.
NOTE NOTE
• The light source registration of mount carrier can be carried • The light source registration of mount carrier can be carried
out only for either 135/240 MMC-II or 135/240 AMC-II. out only for either 135/240 AMC-II or 135/240 MMC-II.
• Carry out the light source registration before using the • Carry out the light source registration before using the
4. Troubleshooting
different type of the mount carrier. different type of the mount carrier.
Diagnosis Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No. Failed parts Manual No.
MMC connecting PCB ☞ 65330 AMC connecting PCB ☞ 65350
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000 AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060 Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010 AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060 Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
NOTE NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3] Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
☞ 89000 ☞ 89000
41432 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41434
Attention message: Film carrier
No. 1435
Insertion direction of film is different.
Insert the film from the rear end (end with
largest frame number).
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The 135 DX sensor detected that the film had been
inserted from the front end.
NOTE
• This attention message appears only when the setting of 135
4. Troubleshooting
Negative Film Inserting Direction Detection Function in
Additional tab of Operator Selections is ON.
Check Point
1 Check that the 135 DX sensor is soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
3 Check the 135 DX sensor status via input check.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
135 DX sensor 1 or 2 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 62150
Sensor PCB ☞ 65250
Connecting PCB 2 ☞ 65210
Connecting PCB 4 ☞ 65280
Connecting PCB 1 ☞ 65200
135 DX sensor 1 or 2 (135 AFC-II) ☞ 62650
135 AFC sensor PCB ☞ 65370
135 AFC connecting PCB 2 ☞ 65360
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Power PCB (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65260
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41434 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41438
Attention message: Film carrier
Check Point
No. 1438
Set the attachment. 1 When the above attention message ☞ 35200
appears even though the attachment for
adjustment is set, check the detected
Attention message release status of the attachment for adjustment.
Set the attachment for adjustment and press YES.
Diagnosis
Condition
Failed parts Manual No.
Suffix Condition
number Attachment Detection Switch ☞ 62670
33 The attachment which is set is other than the AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
attachment for adjustment when registering and
updating the light source, Or the attachment for NOTE
adjustment is not set. • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
34 Pressing START on the Order Display while an Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
attachment other than the attachment (mask) is
attached.
☞ 89000
An attachment other than the attachment for
Wiring diagram [S-4]
adjustment is set when carrying out area registration,
focus adjustment and film carrier adjustment. Or the ☞ 89010
4. Troubleshooting
attachment for adjustment is not set.
NOTE
• Crop card attachment is available for the use as the attachment
for adjustment.
G078428
41438 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41438
Attention message: Film carrier
No. 1439
Light Source was not updated. Would you
like to scan?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The film is set in the film carrier without updating the
light source.
Check Point
1 Update the light source by each film carrier.
4. Troubleshooting
41438 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41500
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
4. Troubleshooting
• The number of the orders to be output is displayed in the
fourth line of the message.
Check Point
1 Check the write protection tab of the media indicated
in the message.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41500 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41502
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
Check Point
IMPORTANT
• When the data of which capacity is larger than the media 1 Check that the media containing the desired file has
4. Troubleshooting
is to be written, the message No. 1515 Data is too large been inserted.
to write. appears.
Diagnosis
NOTE
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the Failed parts Manual No.
second line of the message. If the attention message above is displayed ☞ 35920
• The order number is displayed in the third line of the message. even if the media has been set, carry out the
(max: five orders) Media Drive Self-diagnostic.
• The number of the orders to be output is displayed in the Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
fourth line of the message.
• The number of media, images and the processing time will be NOTE
displayed in the fifth line of the message. • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
Check Point
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
1 Check the free space of the disk indicated by the ☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
message.
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41502 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41504
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message.
• The file name which is not read is displayed in the third line of
the message.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41504 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41506
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
No. 1506
Would you like to remove the USB Flash
Memory?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- ← and → have been pressed to remove the USB
Flash Memory.
NOTE
• When the device gets in the state possible to be removed
4. Troubleshooting
safely, Remove the USB Flash Memory. appears.
☞ 41514
41506 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41508
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
4. Troubleshooting
• The order number is displayed in the third line of the message.
41508 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41510
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
4. Troubleshooting
• The number of media will be displayed in the fourth line of
Diagnosis the message.
41510 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41512
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
NOTE Condition
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message. Suffix Condition
number
Check Point - A disk error occurs when the data is to be written to
4. Troubleshooting
the media.
1 Check that the media displayed in the message is set.
NOTE
Diagnosis • The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message.
Failed parts Manual No.
• If the file already exists in the media, the attention message
If the attention message above is displayed ☞ 35920 No. 1536 appears.
even if the media has been set, carry out the ☞ 41536
Media Drive Self-diagnostic.
Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000 Check Point
41512 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41514
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- It is in the state possible to remove the USB Flash - When the file is written to the media, the data cannot
Memory safely. be written as the file size is larger than the capacity of
the media.
NOTE
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check the size of the media displayed in the message.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41514 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41516
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- Total pixels of the file to be read from the media are - Since the image format cannot be identified, printing
beyond 64 M pixels (12500 × 5120 pixels etc.) cannot be carried out.
- The both sides (length and width) of the image read
from the media are over 5120 pixels. (This does not NOTE
occur in the Edit Mode). • The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
- One side of the image read from the media is over second line of the message.
12500 pixels. • The file name which is not read is displayed in the third line of
4. Troubleshooting
- When the data is saved in the media of the external the message.
system, one side of the data is over 7400 pixels. • This message will be displayed each time the file is not read.
Diagnosis Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No. Failed parts Manual No.
Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000 Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
NOTE NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram ☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram ☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting ☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41516 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41518
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- A disk error (There is already files) occurs when the
data is to be written to the CD-R/RW.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message.
CD
• This message appears only for the CD-RW.
Check Point
1 Check if the CD-RW is set.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
CD-R/RW drive ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41518 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41520
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
4. Troubleshooting
- There are 41 areas or more.
Check Point
1 Correct the information file in the template
information correction display.
41520 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41522
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check the media drive displayed in the message.
2 Check the setting for Option Registration.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41522 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41524
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
No. 1524
CD-R External Writing System is being
output.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- While writing to a CD-R with the CD-R external
writing kit for the external PC, you attempted to write
to a CD-R/RW with the QSS-Kids.
NOTE
• When the QSS-Kids and the CD-R external writing kit for the
4. Troubleshooting
external PC have been installed to an external PC, the message
appears on the QSS-Kids.
41524 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41526
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
NOTE
4. Troubleshooting
IMPORTANT
• When the device gets in the state possible to be removed • The number of media to be saved can be set on this
safely, Remove the USB Flash Memory. appears. display.
☞ 41514
• The same number as that of label count which is set on
the Order Display appears as initial value.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No. NOTE
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
USB Flash Memory Kit ☞ 88000 second line of the message.
NOTE • The order number is displayed in the third line of the message.
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) (max: five orders)
• The number of the orders to be output is displayed in the
Circuit diagram fourth line of the message.
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting • The number of media will be displayed in the fifth line of the
message.
41526 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41528
Attention message: Disk/Media 1
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Change the print channel of QSS to the normal print
mode.
41528 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41530
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- There is no corresponding folder when outputting the - When outputting the data to the folder of the network,
data to the folder on the network. the network is not connected.
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check if there is the corresponding folder. 1 Check the network connection.
41530 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41532
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
- After writing the data into a hard disk, it appears for • The order number is displayed in the third line of the message.
checking before writing more data continuously. (max: five orders)
• The number of the orders, images and the processing time are
NOTE displayed in the fourth line of the message.
4. Troubleshooting
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message.
HD:
• The order number is displayed in the third line of the message.
(max: five orders)
• The number of the orders to be output is displayed in the
fourth line of the message.
• When changing the order or before writing the data, this
message appears.
41532 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41534
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
NOTE
Diagnosis
• When media output is performed to the hard disk, this
4. Troubleshooting
message appears. Failed parts Manual No.
• When this message is displayed, the File Delete dialog box USB Flash Memory Kit ☞ 88000
appears.
• Read only files will not be deleted. NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Check Point Circuit diagram
1 Delete unnecessary files. ☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
HD drive ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41534 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41536
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
4. Troubleshooting
when the data is to be written to the media. • If all the files are not found, the attention message No. 1503
appears.
NOTE ☞ 41502
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message. Check Point
Check Point 1 Check that the media containing the desired file has
been inserted.
1 Check the media displayed in the message.
Diagnosis
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Failed parts Manual No. Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
NOTE
NOTE • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
Circuit diagram ☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram ☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram ☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-1 Control section ☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41536 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41538
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
4. Troubleshooting
• This message appears only for the CD-R.
Check Point
1 Check if the CD-R is placed.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
CD-R/RW drive ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41538 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41540
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
4. Troubleshooting
media.
41540 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41542
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- When outputting to the media, the same order - It is attempted to read JPEG image data with CMYK
number data already exists in the media. format when prints are made from the media.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE NOTE
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the • The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message. second line of the message.
• The file name which is not read is displayed in the third line of
the message.
Check Point
1 Change the data to the RGB format by Adobe
Photoshop etc.
41542 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41544
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
No. 1545
The image size aspect ratio is not correct.
Data was not written.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Aspect ratio of the image is more than 1:6.6 when
outputting the image to CD-R external writing system
or d-Storage with normal mode.
- When saving image data into each media drive, the
aspect ratio of the input image exceeds the following
condition.
4. Troubleshooting
Output image size Limited ratio
16Base (2048 × 3072) 1: 3.5
4Base (1024 × 1536) 1: 7
Base (512 × 768) 1: 14
1/4Base (256 × 384) 1: 28
- No limit with ratio
NOTE
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message.
• The file name of which image size is out of the specification is
displayed in the third line of the message.
• Carry out the operations below to write the image which has
not been written.
Change the output image size without changing the aspect
ratio of the input image. Or process the input image to fulfill
the conditions above using the Adobe Photoshop.
41544 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41546
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
4. Troubleshooting
(max: five orders)
- Make sure how large is the capacity of the media in
Option Registration. • The number of the orders, images, and the processing time are
displayed in the fourth line of the message.
NOTE
• The type of CD and the capacity of the media can be set in
Option Registration.
• For the type of CD there are two types, that of 12 cm and 8
cm. The capacity differs between those.
Type of CD Capacity
12 cm CD 640 to 720 MB
8 cm CD 150 to 300 MB
41546 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41548
Attention message: Disk/Media 2
4. Troubleshooting
following conditions when outputting the image to a
• The name of the corresponding drive is displayed in the third media other than CD-R writing system.
line of the message.
C:
Output image size Pixels
• When this message occurs, the File Delete dialog box appears.
16Base (2048 × 3072) No limit with ratio
• Read only files will not be deleted.
4Base (1024 × 1536) No limit with ratio
41548 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41550
Attention message: Colorimeter
Attention message: Colorimeter
4. Troubleshooting
Colorimeter Control PCB ☞ 64130 between the two photometry values obtained by the
calibration plate measurements from the leading end
ATX mother board ☞ 88000 to 9 mm and from that to 18 mm is 100 or less.
Colorimeter unit ☞ 21110
Check Point
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) 1 Check that the calibration plate is not soiled.
2 Check that the calibration plate is correctly set.
Circuit diagram
3 Clean the advance rollers of the colorimeter with a
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
cleaning sheet.
☞ CS 1-4 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
4 Carry out each correction via Colorimeter Unit
☞ CS 2-1 Control section Adjustment.
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit IMPORTANT
• The calibration plate may not be set correctly or be
soiled. In this case, stop registering the correction value
with the NO key, check/clean the calibration plate and
set it properly.
• Check if there is no dirt on the calibration plate, and set it
properly, then calibrate the colorimeter unit again.
If the same attention message appears again, update
the calibration plate data.
☞ 21110
• Then carry out Updating the Calibration Plate Data. If
the same attention message appears, the corrective
action should be taken according to the following
diagnosis.
Diagnosis
In case of an adjusting failure
Update the calibration plate data. ☞ 21110
Adjust the height of the colorimeter unit. ☞ 21120
Adjust the colorimeter unit. ☞ 35100
For defective parts
Replace the calibration plate when it is ☞ 21110
scratched on.
Replace the colorimeter unit in the case of the ☞ 21110
colorimeter unit failure.
41550 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41550
Attention message: Colorimeter
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit
4. Troubleshooting
41550 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41552
Attention message: Colorimeter
No. 1552-####
The paper in the Colorimeter is too short.
It cannot be measured.
Countermeasure message
Remove the paper. For details, refer to the manual.
Attention message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 While the paper is being fed to lead the paper front
end, the paper rear end has passed paper sensor 1.
0002 While the paper is being advanced, the paper rear end
has passed paper sensor 1.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check that a short test print has not been inserted.
2 Carry out each correction via Colorimeter Unit
Adjustment.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Paper sensor 1 or 2 ☞ 61000
Paper advance motor
Colorimeter Control PCB ☞ 64130
ATX mother board ☞ 88000
Colorimeter unit ☞ 21110
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit
41552 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41600
Attention message: Pricing unit
Attention message: Pricing unit
No. 1601-####
Turn on the Pricing Unit or supply a
pricing sheet.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When the standard setting of pricing unit is used for
printing, the pricing unit power supply is OFF.
0002 When type A (bar-code printer pricing unit) is used
for printing, the pricing unit power supply is OFF.
NOTE
• When Pricing Unit Setting via Option Registration is set to
Not in use, this attention message does not appear.
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 The cover on the pricing unit is open.
2 There is no pricing sheet.
3 Sheet feed switch is pressed.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
PU control PCB ☞ 64140
PU printer -
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-3 Pricing Unit
41600 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41602
Attention message: Pricing unit
No. 1603-####
The rest 2 order could be kept by the
Pricing Unit.
Countermeasure message
Print the Pricing Sheet.
Attention message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Standard pricing unit can store only two more orders
of data.
0002 Type A (bar-code printer pricing unit) can store only
two more orders of data.
NOTE
• When Pricing Unit Setting via Option Registration is set to
4. Troubleshooting
Not in use, this attention message does not appear.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
PU control PCB ☞ 64140
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC power supply connecting
☞ CS 1-4 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-3 Pricing Unit
41602 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41604
Attention message: Pricing unit
No. 1604
Pricing Sheet Print Out Check
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- This message appears after the judgement is finished
or the ORDER key is pressed.
NOTE
• When PJP/AUTO/PPI Automatic Order via Operator
Selections is set to Not in use, this attention message will not
appear after the judgement is completed.
4. Troubleshooting
• When Pricing Unit Setting via Option Registration is set to
Not in use, this attention message does not appear.
41604 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41620
Attention message: NMC
Attention message: NMC
No. 1621
Would you like to delete the order?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The Delete button was clicked on Net Order Mode.
NOTE
• The receipt number is displayed in the third line of the
message.
4. Troubleshooting
41620 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41622
Attention message: NMC
No. 1622
Would you like to quit the Net Order
Receipt?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The End button or NO key is pressed in the Net
Order Mode.
4. Troubleshooting
41622 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41634
Attention message: NMC
No. 1634
Data could not be received. Would you
like to delete the order?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- An attempt was made to load target image data
received from the external PC based on customer
order information received via Net Order. Since the
corresponding image data did not exist, it could not
4. Troubleshooting
be uploaded to the QSS within 10 minutes.
NOTE
• The receipt number is displayed in the third line of the
message.
• The host name is displayed in the fourth line.
• The request number appears in the fifth line.
Check Point
1 Verify that the external PC and QSS are properly
connected.
2 Verify that the host PC is running normally.
3 Verify that external PC applications were not
interrupted and that the order request is correct.
41634 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41636
Attention message: NMC
4. Troubleshooting
• The print channel is displayed in the fifth line of the message.
• The receipt number is displayed in the third line of the • This message occurs on the Net Order Mode only.
message.
• The print channel is displayed in the forth line of the message. Check Point
• This message occurs on the Net Order Mode only.
1 Check the print channel setting.
Check Point
1 Check the print channel setting.
41636 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41638
Attention message: NMC
4. Troubleshooting
• The request number is displayed in the fourth line. 0005 Image file set with the frame information cannot be
• The print channel is displayed in the fifth line of the message. copied.
• This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode. 0006 The order fails to be registered to the Net Order.
0007 DPOF file fails to be copied.
Check Point In the QSS-Kids, the setting of Terminal in Net
Folder Registration is wrong.
- Check the print channel setting.
0008 The request number is duplicated.
NOTE
• The host name is displayed in the third line.
• The request number is displayed in the fourth line.
• This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode.
Check Point
- Check whether it is correct to the setting of Net
Folder Registration.
- Check the network connection.
- Check with another order.
41638 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41640
Attention message: NMC
No. 1641
Print Channel of QSS is not set. Confirm
the Print Channel.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- When the QSS receives an order from the Consumer
Terminal (CT) on the Net Order Mode, required print
channel is deleted before prints are processed, though
the print channel existed before.
NOTE
4. Troubleshooting
• The receipt number is displayed in the third line of the
message.
• The print channel is displayed in the forth line of the message.
• This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode.
Check Point
- Check the print channel setting.
41640 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41642
Attention message: NMC
4. Troubleshooting
destination, but it was not set for Writing to the CD-
R External Writing System or Saving to the d-
1 Check if there is the required files.
Storage.
2 Check the network connection.
NOTE
• The receipt number is displayed in the third line of the
message.
• The print channel is displayed in the forth line of the message.
• This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode.
Check Point
- Check the print channel setting.
41642 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41644
Attention message: NMC
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE NOTE
• The host name appears in the second line. • The host name appears in the second line.
• The request number or reference number is displayed in the • The request number or reference number is displayed in the
third line. third line.
• The frame number is displayed in the fourth line. • The frame number is displayed in the fourth line.
• This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode. • This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode.
41644 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41646
Attention message: NMC
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- The image format cannot be recognized when reading - Several files have been read on the Net Order, but
the image on the Net Order. some of them are not found.
NOTE NOTE
• The host name appears in the second line. • The host name appears in the second line.
• The request number or reference number is displayed in the • The request number or reference number is displayed in the
third line. third line.
4. Troubleshooting
• The frame number is displayed in the fourth line. • The frame number is displayed in the fourth line.
• This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode. • This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode.
• If all the files are not found, the attention message No.1643
Check Point appears.
1 Check the file format.
☞ 41642
41646 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41648
Attention message: NMC
4. Troubleshooting
following conditions when outputting the image to a
NOTE media other than CD-R external writing system on
• The host name is displayed in the third line. the Net Order.
• The request number or reference number is displayed in the
fourth line. Output image size Limited ratio
• The frame number is displayed in the fifth line. 16Base (2048 × 3072) 1: 3.5
• This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode. 4Base (1024 × 1536) 1: 7
Base (512 × 768) 1: 14
Check Point 1/4Base (256 × 384) 1: 28
1 Change the data to the RGB format by Adobe - No limit with ratio
Photoshop etc.
NOTE
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message.
• The host name is displayed in the third line.
• The request number or reference number is displayed in the
fourth line.
• The frame number is displayed in the fifth line.
• This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode.
41648 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41650
Attention message: NMC
No. 1650
Data is too small to read.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- When reading the data from media on the Net Order,
the file size is smaller than the inputting minimum
size.
- The image size is less than 120 pixels in the vertical
direction and less than 160 pixels in the horizontal
direction when outputting the image to the CD-R
writing system in the normal mode on the Net Order.
4. Troubleshooting
- The aspect ratio of the input image is less than the
following conditions when outputting the image to a
media other than CD-R writing system on the Net
Order.
IMPORTANT
• Inputting minimum size from media is 32 pixels vertically
and 32 pixels horizontally.
NOTE
• The host name appears in the second line.
• The request number or reference number is displayed in the
third line.
• The frame number is displayed in the fourth line.
• This message occurs only in the Net Order Mode.
41650 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41652
Attention message: NMC
No. 1653
The output media size is too large. The
data cannot be output to the External
System.
Countermeasure message
Set Media Output Size to anything but "-".
Attention message release
YES/START or automatic release
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- With the output image size of option registration set
to -, the input image is over 5000×7000 pixels.
NOTE
• The host name is displayed in the third line.
4. Troubleshooting
• The request number or reference number is displayed in the
fourth line.
• The frame number is displayed in the fifth line.
41652 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41656
Attention message: NMC
No. 1657
Hold On Save could not be executed.
Secure enough space, then restart
processing.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- When saving order from the QSS-Kids to the
Compact Archive Unit, the space for Hold on Save
has 0 byte.
NOTE
• The host name is displayed in the third line.
• The request number or reference number is displayed in the
4. Troubleshooting
fourth line.
41656 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41658
Attention message: NMC
No. 1659
Calibrating... Would you like to stop the
calibration?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- End button at the Net Order Screen is clicked during
calibration
NOTE
• This message appears if calibration is performed from DP2 to
HotFolder.
4. Troubleshooting
41658 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41800
Attention message: Software upgrade
Attention message: Software upgrade
NOTE
No. 1801-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Execute software upgrade.
Wiring diagram [S-2/S-3]
Countermeasure message ☞ 89000
Upgrade software again. If this error recurs, contact us or your
place of purchase. Wiring diagram [S-4]
Attention message release
YES
☞ 89010
Condition
Condition
Although the version of each control PCB is checked when the
power supply is turned ON, it is not correct.
Suffix PCB
number
(bit)
0001 Printer control PCB
4. Troubleshooting
0008 Processor control PCB
0010 AFC/scanner control PCB
0080 Image processing PCB
0100 PU control PCB
0200 Laser control PCB
0800 D-ICE PCB
2000 D-ICE control PCB
4000 Image correction PCB
8000 Colorimeter Control PCB
NOTE
• The name of PCB where the attention message arises is
displayed in the second line of the message.
• Carry out the corrective actions according to the following
diagnosis for the displayed PCB as a reference.
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Check Point
1 Upgrade the software. ☞ 35600
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Image processing PCB ☞ 64000
PU control PCB ☞ 64140
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
D-ICE PCB ☞ 64040
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
Image correction PCB ☞ 64010
Colorimeter Control PCB ☞ 64130
41800 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41900
Attention message: Main
Attention message: Main
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• To carry out the setup or adjustment, register as an option.
• The description of suffix number is displayed in the second
line of the message.
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
41900 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41902
Attention message: Main
4. Troubleshooting
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Interrupting
0002 Initializing
0003 Paper is being processed.
0004 Scanning (AFC)
0005 Scanning (media)
0006 Outputting media
0007 Data for media output is being acquired.
0008 Printing
NOTE
• In the service mode, attention number 1904 appears instead of
condition 3 of attention message No. 1903.
Diagnosis
The following part may have some problem when the error with
suffix number 0001 (interrupting) occurs.
Failed parts Manual No.
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
PU control PCB ☞ 64140
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
Colorimeter Control PCB ☞ 64130
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
41902 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41904
Attention message: Main
4. Troubleshooting
0001 Interrupting
0002 Initializing
0003 Paper is being processed.
0004 Scanning (AFC)
0005 Scanning (media)
0006 Outputting media
0007 Data for media output is being acquired.
0008 Printing
NOTE
• This message is displayed only in the Service Mode.
41904 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41908
Attention message: Main
No. 1909
Title was not set.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- It is attempted to register the package print format
without setting its title in editing the package print
format.
Check Point
1 Set the title.
4. Troubleshooting
41908 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41910
Attention message: Main
4. Troubleshooting
41910 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41912
Attention message: Main
- It is attempted to edit an existing format with no • Select NO to create a new package format without overwriting
created package format. the existing one.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- It is attempted to select the package format which is
set in print channel in editing the package print
4. Troubleshooting
format.
41912 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41914
Attention message: Main
No. 1914
The format has reached maximum
capacity. No more data can be added.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- It is attempted to register it newly with the maximum
number of formats in editing the package print
format.
4. Troubleshooting
41914 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41920
Attention message: Main
Condition Condition
Condition Condition
During the start-up, the capacity booster cannot be detected. For the machine with the capacity booster equipped, the capacity
booster has been detected again after the message, No. 1920
Capacity Booster Key was not detected. Confirm the
Suffix Condition connection status. appears.
number
0001 Capacity booster A
Suffix Condition
0002 Capacity booster B number
0003 Capacity booster A and B 0001 Capacity booster A
4. Troubleshooting
0002 Capacity booster B
Check Point 0003 Capacity booster A and B
1 Check that the booster hard key is set properly.
2 Check if the booster software is installed properly.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Capacity booster ☞ 88000
ATX mother board
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
41920 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41922
Attention message: Main
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- The path set in the Operator Selections does not - The Package Prints has been selected in the print
exist when writing the viewer software. Or the viewer channel setting of long length print, and the external
software does not exist in the specified path. system has been selected for the media output.
4. Troubleshooting
41922 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41924
Attention message: Main
Check Point
1 Set 203 mm or more paper width.
4. Troubleshooting
41924 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41926
Attention message: Main
4. Troubleshooting
Real Size.
0800 CD-R external writing system
1000 d-Storage
NOTE
• The message appears only once just after starting up the QSS.
It does not appear for the second time.
• The corresponding external system is displayed in the second
line of the message.
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Check Point
1 Change the destination, or change the setting for the
Sort by Frame Number in the Operator Selections
to Without Sort by Frame Number.
41926 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41928
Attention message: Main
No. 1928
DPOF file output function cannot be used.
Condition
Condition
DPOF File Output function of the Operator Selections is set to
output DPOF file, but the DPOF File Output function is not
available for the output external system.
Suffix Condition
number
(bit)
0800 CD-R external writing system
4. Troubleshooting
1000 d-Storage
NOTE
• The message appears only once just after starting up the QSS.
It does not appear for the second time.
• The corresponding external system is displayed in the second
line of the message.
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Check Point
1 Change the destination, or change the setting for the
DPOF File Output in the Operator Selections to
Without outputting DPOF file.
41928 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
41932
Attention message: Main
No. 1933
Select an input media other than the
Compact Archive Unit.
Condition
Condition
When processing, an attempt is made so that the Compact
Archive Unit is set to Input Media in Print Channel on the Edit
while the Compact Archive Unit is set toTYPE 1.
NOTE
• If the Compact Archive Unit is set to TYPE 1, the attention
message above appears because the image data saved in the
Compact Archive Unit is RAW data which cannot be read in
the Edit Mode.
4. Troubleshooting
• If the image data is saved while the Compact Archive Unit is
set to TYPE 2, the attention message does not appear when
reading the image data in the Edit Mode.
• If the setting is changed to TYPE 2, reading the image data
that was saved with the TYPE 1 is not available.
Check Point
1 On the Option Registration, change the Type of the
Compact Archive Unit to TYPE 2.
2 Set other than the Compact Archive Unit to Input
Media.
41932 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
43370
Attention message: Compact archive unit
Attention message: Compact archive unit
No. 3371-####
Could not execute Hold On Save.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The space for Hold on Save of Compact Archive Unit
is not sufficient to start scanning.
0002 The space for Hold on Save of Compact Archive Unit
is not sufficient to save data on the Archive Print
Selection display.
NOTE
• This attention message appears only when the compact
archive unit has been installed and Compact Archive Unit on
the Option Registration display has been selected.
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 Set some image data held on save to Auto Delete
Mode on the Archive Print Selection display.
NOTE
• Hold on Save Mode is indicated by Hold.
• Auto Delete Mode is indicated by blank.
• Defragmentation has no effect to restore the space for Hold on
Save when this message appears.
43370 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
43372
Attention message: Compact archive unit
NOTE NOTE
4. Troubleshooting
• Hold on Save Mode is indicated by Hold. • This message appears only when connecting the Compact
Archive Unit (TYPE2).
• Auto Delete Mode is indicated by blank.
• Defragmentation has no effect to restore the space for Hold on
Check Point
Save when this message appears.
1 Confirm that the destination is correctly set.
2 Confirm that the QSS-Kids is not in the offline mode.
3 Check if the QSS-Kids and the QSS are connected
correctly.
43372 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
43374
Attention message: Compact archive unit
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- Cannot read data from the Compact Archive Unit - Data that was read in order to be written to the
(TYPE2) when bringing up the Archive File Compact Archive Unit contains errors
Selection display and the Archive Unit Adjustment
display. NOTE
• This message appears onscreen when data could not be read
NOTE from the media due to poor storage conditions.
• This message appears only when connecting the Compact
Archive Unit (TYPE2). Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point 1 Verify that the media can read the data properly.
2 Configure the settings saved on the Compact Archive
1 Check the Compact Archive Unit setting. Unit to OFF.
2 Check if the QSS-Kids and the QSS are connected
correctly.
43374 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44000
Attention message: Edit
Attention message: Edit
No. 4001
Are you sure about deleting?
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- An attempt is made to delete the area made in the
template information correction display.
- An attempt is made to delete the image save data.
- An attempt is made to delete the all area in the
template information correction display.
- The delete button is pressed in the customer
information select screen.
4. Troubleshooting
- An attempt is made to delete the phrase data in the
Phrase Read display.
NOTE
• This message appears when operating in the Edit mode.
44000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44002
Attention message: Edit
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- The Red Eye Correction is executed over 20 times for 0001 The area for image inserting is not selected.
an image. 0002 The dropped area is not for image inserting.
0003 The frame is dropped on the area except the area for
NOTE
image inserting.
• This message appears in the Red Eye Correction operation.
• To repeat the Red Eye Correction over 20 times, reset with NOTE
UNDO. • This message appears when operating in the Edit mode.
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 Check that the image is dropped in the area for image
inserting.
2 Check that the area for image inserting is selected.
44002 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44004
Attention message: Edit
No. 4004-####
Graphics are too large to insert.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The horizontal width of the graphic to insert is larger
than the template.
0002 The vertical width of the graphic to insert is larger
than the template.
NOTE
• This message appears when operating in the Edit mode.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Reduce the size of the graphic using an application
software of Adobe Photoshop.
44004 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44006
Attention message: Edit
NOTE NOTE
• This message appears in the mode for business card and ID • This message appears when operating in the Edit mode.
photo.
Check Point
Check Point 1 Correct the information file in the template
4. Troubleshooting
1 Make paper advance length longer. information correction display.
2 Use the wide width paper.
44006 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44008
Attention message: Edit
No. 4009
Template file was not found. Select the
folder including the files.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- There is not the template in the folder selected in the
template selection screen.
- After selecting the folder in the template selection
screen, the CD-ROM is removed before reading.
NOTE
• This message appears when operating in the Edit mode.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check if the CD-ROM is set securely.
2 Check if the folder containing the templates is
selected.
44008 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44010
Attention message: Edit
No. 4010
Specify the image area.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The image inserting area is not made in the template
information correction display.
NOTE
• This message appears when operating in the template
information correction display.
Check Point
1 Make the area for image inserting in the template
4. Troubleshooting
information correction display.
44010 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44014
Attention message: Edit
4. Troubleshooting
1 Make the image data again.
44014 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44016
Attention message: Edit
No. 4017
The head and jaw position is opposite, or
the selected area is too small.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- In ID photo mode, extremely small area is selected.
- The head and jaw position is opposite.
IMPORTANT
• When positioning the face in ID photo mode, position the
head first, then position the jaw.
• The jaw cannot be positioned above the head.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• In example A, the jaw is set to wrong position therefore the
face area become narrower.
• In example B, the head position is upside down.
Example A Example B
+
⊕
44016 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44018
Attention message: Edit
4. Troubleshooting
44018 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44020
Attention message: Edit
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
0001 The data base file for writing the customer - The customer information cannot be read from CSV
information cannot be opened. file.
0002 The CSV file for writing the customer information
cannot be opened. IMPORTANT
• The data base file format is mdb.
IMPORTANT • The data base file manages the customer information of
• The data base file format is mdb. CSV file format.
• The data base file manages the customer information of
CSV file format.
4. Troubleshooting
44020 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44022
Attention message: Edit
No. 4023
Image magnification ratio or reduction
ratio is out of range.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- When specifying the cropping area using the mouse
in the edit mode or 1 frame magnification display,
magnification ratio exceeds the setting range.
NOTE
• The cropping value of image data in the edit mode or 1 frame
magnification display is from 10% to 400%.
4. Troubleshooting
44022 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44024
Attention message: Edit
4. Troubleshooting
44024 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44026
Attention message: Edit
4. Troubleshooting
does not appear even if another file has the same name.
• This message appears when overwriting the data for images.
• The name of the saved image is displayed in the third line of
the message.
44026 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44028
Attention message: Edit
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- An error occurs halfway through exporting the data - The media has not been inserted to the drive when
for images. performing Export/Import of the data for saving
images.
NOTE
• The name of the saved image is displayed in the third line of
the message.
4. Troubleshooting
44028 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44030
Attention message: Edit
NOTE
• The file name of image data is shown in the last line of the
message.
4. Troubleshooting
44030 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44032
Attention message: Edit
NOTE
• The long length print cannot be made in the album print and
edit modes.
4. Troubleshooting
44032 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44034
Attention message: Edit
4. Troubleshooting
44034 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44036
Attention message: Edit
4. Troubleshooting
44036 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44038
Attention message: Edit
Suffix Condition
Check Point
number
- JPEG data with CMYK format is used for Insert 1 Reduce the image size with an application software
Graphics on the edit mode. such as Adobe Photoshop.
2 Set the image magnification ratio smaller.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• JPEG data with CMYK format cannot be converted by QSS
correctly. But it can read them.
• File name is shown in the last line of the message.
Check Point
1 Change the data to RGB format with an application
software such as Adobe Photoshop.
44038 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44040
Attention message: Edit
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- When the data base file is made using the data base - On the form selection display for ID photo, multiple
creation software, the properties of field is different. larger forms than the print size set in the print
channel are selected.
Check Point
Check Point
1 Check the data base or properties of the field.
1 Check multiple forms or the print channel.
4. Troubleshooting
44040 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44042
Attention message: Edit
4. Troubleshooting
44042 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44044
Attention message: Edit
4. Troubleshooting
44044 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44046
Attention message: Edit
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check if the font displayed in the second line of the
attention message is installed.
Diagnosis
Countermeasure Manual No.
Change the setting font to the font which is -
available to use.
For the Windows standard font
• Perform the defragmentation. -
• Carry out the recovery. ☞ 88000
For the font which is installed additionally
• Perform the defragmentation. -
• Reinstall the font. -
44046 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
44048
Attention message: Edit
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 If you want to add more items, delete some from the
existing items first.
44048 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45500
Error message: Processor 1
Error message: Processor 1
4. Troubleshooting
Condition Actual temperature (°C) Resistance value (KΩ)
10 20.35
Error message No. Condition
20 12.59
No. 5500 The CD processing solution temperature
exceeds the safety range (setting 30 7.99
temperature + 1°C) after temperature 35 6.42
adjustment has been completed. (CD 38 5.65
thermosensor)
40 5.19
No. 5501 The BF processing solution temperature
45 4.22
exceeds the safety range (setting
temperature + 3°C) after temperature
adjustment has been completed. (BF When temperature is incorrectly adjusted Manual No.
thermosensor) Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
No. 5502 The STB processing solution temperature Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
exceeds the safety range (setting Processor power supply 2
temperature + 3°C) after temperature
adjustment has been completed. (STB Processor power supply 3
thermosensor)
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Check Point
Circuit diagram
1 Check that the value measured via Thermosensor
Calibration is correctly entered. ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
2 Check the setting temperature of the chilling unit ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
(only when equipped with the chilling unit). ☞ PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB
3 Check that the cooling water solenoid valve for CD,
BF or STB works well (only when equipped with the Detailed diagram
cooling water unit). ☞ PP 3-2 Temperature control block (2)
4 Check that the tank cooling fans (FAN 1 to 3) operate ☞ PP 4-1 Cooling water plumbing unit
properly.
Diagnosis
In the case of a cooling failure Manual No.
Cooling water solenoid valve ☞ 63250
• If the cooling water solenoid valve does not operate when
DC 24 V is output between pins 1 and 2 on the connector of
each cooling water solenoid valve, the solenoid valve is
defective.
Chilling unit ☞ 63250
45500 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45503
Error message: Processor 1
No. 5503
The dryer temperature is above the safety
range.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The dryer temperature exceeds the safety range
(setting temperature + 10°C) after temperature
adjustment has been completed. (dryer temperature
sensor)
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
When temperature is incorrectly adjusted Manual No.
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-8 Dryer section (1)
45503 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45504
Error message: Processor 1
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The processing solution temperature will be adjusted when the
Actual temperature (°C) Resistance value (KΩ)
error display is canceled.
10 20.35
Condition 20 12.59
30 7.99
Error message No. Condition
35 6.42
No. 5504 The CD processing solution temperature
falls below the processing range (setting 38 5.65
temperature − 1°C) after the temperature 40 5.19
adjustment has been completed. (CD 45 4.22
temperature sensor)
No. 5505 The BF processing solution temperature NOTE
falls below the processing range (setting • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
temperature − 3°C) after the temperature
adjustment has been completed. (BF Circuit diagram
temperature sensor) ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
No. 5506 The STB processing solution temperature ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
falls below the processing range (setting
☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
temperature − 5°C) after the temperature
adjustment has been completed. (STB ☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
temperature sensor)
Detailed diagram
Check Point ☞ PP 3-1 Temperature control block (1)
1 Check that the value measured via Thermosensor ☞ PP 3-2 Temperature control block (2)
Calibration is correctly entered.
2 Check the setting temperature of the chilling unit
(only when equipped with the chilling unit).
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F2 Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220
F5
F6
F7
45504 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45507
Error message: Processor 1
4. Troubleshooting
processing. (dryer thermosensor)
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Diagnosis Circuit diagram
Blown fuses Manual No. ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
F1 Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220 ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
F3 ☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
F4 ☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
F8
Detailed diagram
F9
F10
☞ PP 3-8 Dryer section (1)
F11
45507 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45508
Error message: Processor 1
4. Troubleshooting
solution float switch turns OFF, all the processing solution NOTE
heaters and circulation pumps turn OFF. • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
Check Point
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
1 Check if the processing solution is leaking from the
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
tank.
☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
2 Clean the strainer units of the replenisher pumps CD,
BF, and STB1 and the hoses. Check the output ☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
amounts.
3 Check if the float of the processing solution float Detailed diagram
switch moves up and down smoothly. ☞ PP 3-2 Temperature control block (2)
☞ PP 3-4 Replenisher section (1)
Diagnosis ☞ PP 3-5 Replenisher section (2)
Blown fuses Manual No.
F14 Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
F15
45508 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45508
Error message: Processor 1
4. Troubleshooting
solution float switch turns OFF, all the processing solution ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
heaters and circulation pumps turn OFF.
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Check Point ☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
☞ PP 2-4 Around SM I/O PCB
1 Check if the processing solution is leaking from the
tank.
Detailed diagram
2 Clean the strainer units in the replenisher pumps
(CD-A: RP5, CD-B: RP6, CD-C: RP7, BF-A: RP8, ☞ PP 3-2 Temperature control block (2)
BF-B: RP9, and STB: RP10) and in the water supply ☞ PP 3-12 SM Replenisher section (1)
pumps (CD-W: RP-1, BF-W: RP-2, and STB-W: RP- ☞ PP 3-14 SM Replenisher section (3)
3) and hoses. Check the output amounts.
3 Check if the float of the processing solution float
switch moves up and down smoothly.
Diagnosis
When the level is incorrectly detected Manual No.
Processing solution float switch ☞ 63250
• Disconnect the connector of the processing solution float
switch. If there is no conduction between pins 1 and 3 on the
jack side when the float is lifted, the float switch is
defective.
Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
Processor power supply 2
45508 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45508
Error message: Processor 1
NOTE
No. 5509
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
The circulation amount has decreased.
Circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Replace the chemical filter cartridge. For details, refer to the ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
manual. ☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
Alarm release
NO ☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
Error message release
YES Detailed diagram
NOTE ☞ PP 3-3 Processor section
• This error message will be displayed only when the machine is
equipped with the optional digital flowmeter.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The circulation amount of the CD processing solution
4. Troubleshooting
measured by the digital flowmeter falls below
3L/min.
- Although the machine is not equipped with a digital
flowmeter, the digital flowmeter is set to ON via
Option Registration.
NOTE
• This error will not be displayed when the digital flowmeter is
set to OFF via Option Registration.
Check Point
1 Check that the filter cartridge is not soiled.
2 Check if the circulation pump and the hose connected
to the pump are clogged.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F13 Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220
45508 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45510
Error message: Processor 1
4. Troubleshooting
data of the temperature measured by the processing
solution thermosensor, the dryer thermosensor and the Detailed diagram
inner thermosensor into digital data via the processor
☞ PP 3-2 Temperature control block (2)
control PCB.
☞ PP 3-8 Dryer section (1)
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Thermosensor ☞ 63250
• Disconnect the connector of each thermosensor. If the
measured resistance between pins 1 and 2 on the plug side
differs greatly from the values in table 1 below, the
thermosensor is defective.
Dryer thermosensor ☞ 63260
• Disconnect the connector of the dryer thermosensor. If the
measured resistance between pins 1 and 2 on the plug side
differs greatly from the values in table 2 below, the
thermosensor is defective.
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Processor power supply 2 ☞ 67400
Table 1
Actual temperature (°C) Resistance (KΩ)
10 20.35
20 12.59
30 7.99
35 6.42
38 5.65
40 5.19
45 4.22
Table 2
Actual temperature (°C) Resistance (KΩ)
10 19.07
20 11.92
30 7.63
45510 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45511
Error message: Processor 1
4. Troubleshooting
Detailed diagram
Alarm release
NO ☞ PP 3-1 Temperature control block (1)
Error message release
YES
Condition
Error message No. Condition
No. 5511 The rotation detector built in the CD
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5513 The rotation detector built in the BF
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5515 The rotation detector built in the STB
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5516 The rotation detector built in the STB2
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5517 The rotation detector built in the STB3
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5518 The rotation detector built in the STB4
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
Check Point
1 Check that the filter cartridge is not soiled.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F13 Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220
45511 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45511
Error message: Processor 1
4. Troubleshooting
Contact us or your place of purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Error message No. Condition
No. 5511 The rotation detector built in the CD
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5513 The rotation detector built in the BF
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5515 The rotation detector built in the STB
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5516 The rotation detector built in the STB2
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5517 The rotation detector built in the STB3
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
No. 5518 The rotation detector built in the STB4
circulation pump detects that the pump
has stopped rotating.
Check Point
1 Check that the filter cartridge is not soiled.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Circulation pump ☞ 63250
• If the circulation pump does not operate when DC 24 V is
outputted between pins 1 and 2 on the connector of
circulation, the pump is defective.
Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
45511 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45519
Error message: Processor 2
Error message: Processor 2
NOTE
No. 5519
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Thermosensor error. CD
Circuit diagram
No. 5520 ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Thermosensor error. BF ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
No. 5521 ☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
Thermosensor error. STB
Detailed diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ PP 3-2 Temperature control block (2)
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Error message No. Condition
4. Troubleshooting
No. 5519 The temperature detected by the CD
thermosensor is not within a specified
range.
No. 5520 The temperature detected by the BF
thermosensor is not within a specified
range.
No. 5521 The temperature detected by the STB
thermosensor is not within a specified
range.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Thermosensor ☞ 63250
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
• Disconnect the connector of the thermosensor. If the
measured resistance between pins 1 and 2 on the plug side
differs greatly from the values in the table below, the
thermosensor is defective.
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
45519 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45522
Error message: Processor 2
No. 5522
Dryer Thermosensor error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The temperature detected by the dryer thermosensor
is not within a specified range.
Diagnosis
4. Troubleshooting
Failed parts Manual No.
Dryer thermosensor ☞ 63260
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
• Disconnect the connectors of the dryer thermosensor and
inner thermosensor. If the measured resistance between pins
1 and 2 on the plug side differs greatly from the values in the
table below, the thermosensor is defective.
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-8 Dryer section (1)
45522 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45524
Error message: Processor 2
NOTE
No. 5524
• The CD, BF and STB4 processing solution float switches have
Refilling water operation error. CD-W a processing solution level detector, a refilling water level
detector and a safety thermostat for each.
No. 5525 The STB3, 5 and 6 processing solution float switches have a
Refilling water operation error. BF-W refilling water level detector for each.
4. Troubleshooting
Alarm release • The replenisher pump does not start operating when AC 24
NO V is outputted between pins 1 and 2 on the connector of
Error message release replenisher pump, the pump is defective.
YES Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Condition
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
Error message No. Condition Processor power supply 2
No. 5524 The refilling water level detector of the
CD processing solution float switch does When refilling water is incorrectly
not turn ON even though approximately Manual No.
detected
26 seconds have passed since refilling
water operation started.
Processing solution float switch ☞ 63250
• Disconnect the connectors of the CD, BF, STB1, STB2,
No. 5525 The refilling water level detector of the
STB3, and STB4 processing solution float switches. If there
BF processing solution float switch does
is no conduction between pins 1 and 2 on the jack side when
not turn ON even though approximately
the float is raised, the float switch is defective.
26 seconds have passed since refilling
water operation started. Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220
No. 5526 The refilling water level detector of the Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
STB1 processing solution float switch Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
does not turn ON even though
approximately 26 seconds have passed NOTE
since refilling water operation started. • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
No. 5527 The refilling water level detector of the
STB2 processing solution float switch Circuit diagram
does not turn ON even though ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
approximately 26 seconds have passed ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
since refilling water operation started.
☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
No. 5528 The refilling water level detector of the ☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
STB3 processing solution float switch
does not turn ON even though
approximately 26 seconds have passed Detailed diagram
since refilling water operation started. ☞ PP 3-4 Replenisher section (1)
No. 5529 The refilling water level detector of the
STB4 processing solution float switch
does not turn ON even though
approximately 26 seconds have passed
since refilling water operation started.
45524 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45530
Error message: Processor 2
NOTE
No. 5530
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
The Processor Top Cover is open.
Circuit diagram
No. 5531 ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
The dryer cover is open. ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
Countermeasure message
Close the cover.
Detailed diagram
Alarm release
NO ☞ PP 3-7 Drive section
Error message release
YES
Condition
Error message No. Condition
No. 5530 While prints are being made, the
interlock switch (processor top cover)
turns OFF.
No. 5531 While prints are being made, the
4. Troubleshooting
interlock switch (dryer cover) turns OFF.
NOTE
• The drive motor, the refilling water pump, the cleaning pump,
and the exhaust fan will stop when the interlock switch
(processor top cover) turns OFF.
• When the interlock switch (dryer cover) turns OFF, the drive
motor, the dryer heater and the dryer fan will stop.
Check Point
1 Check that the processor top cover is securely closed.
2 Check that the dryer top cover and the dryer front
cover are securely closed.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Interlock switch (processor top cover) ☞ 63250
Interlock switch (dryer cover) ☞ 63260
45530 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45532
Error message: Processor 2
NOTE
In the case of a circulation failure Manual No.
• The processing solution safety thermostat is activated at the
4. Troubleshooting
following temperatures. Circulation pump ☞ 63250
OPEN (OFF) 46±2.5°C • If the circulation pump does not operate when DC 24 V is
CLOSE (ON) 36±3°C outputted between pins 1 and 2 on the connector of
• If the safety thermostat of the processing solution float switch circulation, the pump is defective.
turns OFF, all the processing solution heaters and circulation Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
pumps will stop. Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220
Check Point
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
1 Check that the filter cartridge is not soiled. Processor power supply 2
2 Check if the hose connected to the circulation pump Processor power supply 3
are clogged.
45532 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45532
Error message: Processor 2
4. Troubleshooting
temperatures. # Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
OPEN (OFF) 90±2.8°C
CLOSE (ON) 70±4.4°C Failed parts
• When the dryer safety thermostat goes OFF, the dryer heater Refer to 4203 ☞ Processor control PCB.
and dryer fan go OFF. Refer to 4203 ☞ Processor I/O PCB.
Refer to 4203 ☞ Processor relay PCB.
Check Point
Refer to 4203 ☞ Processor power supply 2 (PS2).
1 Check if the dryer fan is rotating.
When the dryer fan rotates incorrectly Manual No. Failed parts
Dryer fan ☞ 63260 Refer to 4253 ☞ Processor I/O PCB.
45532 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45534
Error message: Processor 2
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
0001 Although a specified time has passed since the print - After the printer feeds out the paper to the processor,
sorter unit started operating, the sorter home sensor the print sensors (right, center and left) in the dryer
does not turn LIGHT. unit do not turn DARK within a specified time.
0002 Although a specified time has passed since the sorter
home sensor turned LIGHT, it does not turn DARK. IMPORTANT
4. Troubleshooting
• Verify that paper is being fed properly.
Check Point ☞ 56100
1 Clean the sorter home sensor using a blower brush. • Pieces of paper are lined up in two rows, and they are
fed to the processor.
Diagnosis • These pieces of paper in each row are checked whether
they passed or not by the print sensors in the dryer unit.
In the case of an operation failure Manual No. • This error message will appear when the print sensors
Sorter motor ☞ 63260 failed to detect the prints even though the sensors tried
• If the conveyor motor (DM3) is not activated when DC 24 V to detect the prints six times continuously.
is outputted between pins 1 and 2 on the connector of
conveyor motor, the motor is defective. IMPORTANT
Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210 • The error above may occur when the ARCNET
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200 communication status is not normal.
If the error occurs, check the following items.
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
• Check the communication status of the ARCNET on the
Processor power supply 2 Version Check display.
☞ 37530
In the case of a detection failure Manual No. • Check the ARCNET communication path.
Sorter home sensor ☞ 63260 ☞ 50520
Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200 Check Point
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400 1 Check that the upper guides and the squeegee unit are
securely attached.
NOTE 2 Make sure that the gears and the rollers rotate
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) smoothly after removing the paper processing rack
from the processing solution tank.
Circuit diagram
3 Check if the lower turn belt of the paper processing
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram rack is ripped up.
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram 4 Check that no paper remains in the dryer rack.
☞ PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB 5 Check if the print sensor is soiled.
Detailed diagram
Diagnosis
☞ PP 3-11 Print conveyor section/print sorter unit
Failed parts Manual No.
Check the cause of failure in System Version ☞ 37530
Check at the No. 6901 ARCNET
communication error.
45534 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45534
Error message: Processor 2
4. Troubleshooting
Processor control PCB
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
Processor power supply 3
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
☞ PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-7 Drive section
☞ PP 3-8 Dryer section (1)
☞ PP 3-9 Dryer section (2)
☞ LP 3-10 Paper advance unit 2 (3)
45534 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45536
Error message: Processor 2
No. 5537
The Rack Stopper is not set.
Countermeasure message
Close the cover.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- While prints are being made, the rack stopper sensor
turns OFF.
Check Point
1 Check that the rack stopper is securely placed.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Rack stopper sensor ☞ 63250
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-3 Processor section
45536 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45538
Error message: Processor 2
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
Failed parts Manual No.
• The value informed from CPU is displayed in the last three
digits of the suffix number. Conveyor unit sensor ☞ 63260
• If approximately 5 days have passed with the power supply Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
being OFF or if the processor control PCB has been replaced Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
with a new one, this error message will appear. Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
Diagnosis NOTE
When the data is erased Manual No. • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Carry out Reading data. ☞ 35400 Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Failed parts Manual No. ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200 ☞ PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB
NOTE
Detailed diagram
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
☞ PP 3-11 Print conveyor section/print sorter unit
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-3 Around processor I/O and CPU PCB
45538 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45548
Error message: Processor 2
No. 5549-####
Drive Motor Revolution Count Auto
Adjustment error.
Countermeasure message
Contact us or your place of purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Condition
- It was not adjusted properly when Drive Motor
Revolution Count Auto Adjustment was performed
in Functions of Drive Motor Revolution Count
Setting.
NOTE
4. Troubleshooting
• The suffix number differs depending on the operation which is
currently processed.
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Even though the drive motor revolution count is set
to 255, it was smaller than the required count.
0002 Even though the drive motor revolution count is set
to 0, it was much than the required count.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Drive motor ☞ 63250
Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
Processor power supply 3
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-7 Drive section
45548 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45550
Error message: Processor 2
No. 5550
Drive Motor has stopped.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Condition
- The drive motor has stopped due to the protected
operation.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
4. Troubleshooting
Drive motor ☞ 63250
Processor relay PCB ☞ 66220
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
Processor power supply 3
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ PP 3-7 Drive section
45550 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45700
Error message: SM replenishment
Error message: SM replenishment
4. Troubleshooting
No. 5705-####[SM] ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ PP 2-4 Around SM I/O PCB
Replenishment pump operation error. BF-
B Detailed diagram
No. 5706-####[SM] ☞ PP 3-12 SM Replenisher section (1)
Replenishment pump operation error. STB
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The replenisher pump sensor or water supply pump
sensor stays ON even though a specified time has
passed since the replenisher pump or the water supply
pump started operating.
0002 The replenisher pump sensor or water supply pump
sensor stays OFF even though a specified time has
passed since the replenisher pump or the water supply
pump started operating.
Check Point
1 Check that the valve of the strainer unit is not closed.
2 Clean the strainer.
3 Check that the replenisher hose and water supply
hose are not clogged.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Replenisher pump and water supply pump ☞ 63250
45700 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45708
Error message: SM replenishment
NOTE
No. 5708[SM]
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Replenishment Package solution
remaining error. Circuit diagram
☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
No. 5709[SM] ☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Replenishment Package solution ☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
remaining error. ☞ PP 2-4 Around SM I/O PCB
Countermeasure message Detailed diagram
Refer to the manual for corrective action.
Alarm release ☞ PP 3-14 SM Replenisher section (3)
NO ☞ PP 3-15 SM Replenisher section (4)
Error message release
YES
Condition
The attention message No. 0700 Replace the Replenishment
Package with a new one. will be displayed when the
replenishment alarm value is set to -5% (initial value) in Package
4. Troubleshooting
Capacity Setting and either replenishment package becomes
empty. In this case, the error messages No. 5708 and 5709
Replenishment Package solution remaining error. will not be
displayed.
Suffix Condition
number
- The percentage of the replenishment remaining
amount (internal calculated value) to the
replenishment package capacity became smaller than
the replenishment alarm value. (Replenishment
remaining amount < Package capacity ×
Replenishment remaining amount / 100) But the
replenishment solution sensor does not turn DARK.
Check Point
1 Check if the actual package capacity is same as the
one set in the Package Capacity Setting.
2 Check if the replenishment alarm value is sufficient.
3 Check that the valve of the strainer unit is not closed.
4 Clean the strainer.
5 Check that the replenisher hose and water supply
hose are not clogged.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the ☞ 27830
replenishment solution sensor
45708 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
45710
Error message: SM replenishment
Check Point
No. 5710[SM]
Refilling water operation error. CD-W 1 Check if the processing solution is leaking from the
tank.
No. 5711[SM] 2 Check that the hoses from the water supply pump and
Refilling water operation error. BF-W refilling water pump are not clogged.
3 Check that the processing float switch moves
No. 5712[SM] smoothly.
Refilling water operation error. STB1-W
Diagnosis
No. 5713[SM]
Refilling water operation error. STB2-W When water is incorrectly added Manual No.
Water Supply Pump ☞ 63250
No. 5714[SM] • If the water supply pump does not operate when AC 24 V is
Refilling water operation error. STB3-W outputted between the pins (CD-W:1-2, BF-W:3-4, STB4:5-
6) on the connectors of water supply pumps CD-W, BF-W
No. 5715[SM] and STB4, the pump is defective.
Refilling water operation error. STB4-W Refilling water pump ☞ 63250
• The refilling water pump does not operate when AC 24 V is
Countermeasure message outputted between pins 1 and 2 on the connectors of the
Refer to the manual for corrective action. refilling water pump, STB1, STB2 and STB3, the pump is
4. Troubleshooting
Alarm release defective.
NO SM I/O PCB ☞ 66600
Error message release
YES
Processor I/O PCB ☞ 66210
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
Condition Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
Processor power supply 2
Error message No. Condition
No. 5710 The refilling water level detector of the
When refilling water is incorrectly
CD processing solution float switch does Manual No.
detected
not turn ON even though a specified time
has passed since refilling water operation Processing solution float switch ☞ 63250
started. • Disconnect the connector of the processing solution float
No. 5711 The refilling water level detector of the switch. If there is no conduction between the pins (CD:5-6,
BF processing solution float switch does BF:5-6, STB:1-2, STB4:5-6) on the jack side, the float
not turn ON even though a specified time switch is defective.
has passed since refilling water operation Processor relay PCB ☞ 66200
started. Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
No. 5712 The refilling water level detector of the Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
STB1 processing solution float switch
does not turn ON even though a specified NOTE
time has passed since refilling water
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
operation started.
No. 5713 The refilling water level detector of the Circuit diagram
STB2 processing solution float switch ☞ PP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
does not turn ON even though a specified
☞ PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
time has passed since refilling water
operation started. ☞ PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB
No. 5714 The refilling water level detector of the ☞ PP 2-4 Around SM I/O PCB
STB3 processing solution float switch
does not turn ON even though a specified Detailed diagram
time has passed since refilling water ☞ PP 3-14 SM Replenisher section (3)
operation started.
☞ PP 3-15 SM Replenisher section (4)
No. 5715 The refilling water level detector of the
STB4 processing solution float switch
does not turn ON even though a specified
time has passed since refilling water
operation started.
45710 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46012
Error message: Printer 1
Error message: Printer 1
4. Troubleshooting
Refer to 4202 ☞ Printer power supply 2 (PS2).
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Even when a specified length of paper is advanced # Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
after the paper loading has started, paper end sensors
A and/or B do not turn DARK. Failed parts
0002 Even when a specified length of paper is advanced Refer to 4252 ☞ Printer I/O PCB 1.
after the paper end sensors A and B have turned
DARK, the loading sensor does not turn DARK. NOTE
0003 Even though the paper passes the loading sensor and • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
a specified length of paper is advanced when the
deflection prevention operation is carried out Circuit diagram
during the paper loading and warp-proofing, paper ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
end sensors A and/or B do not turn LIGHT. ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
Check Point ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
1 Check that the paper is correctly inserted into the ☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
paper magazine. ☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
2 Clean the advance roller. ☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No. Detailed diagram
F35 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020 ☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
☞ LP 3-3 Paper supply unit (1)
In the case of an advance failure Manual No. ☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
Paper magazine motor A or B ☞ 63051
Paper supply motor A or B/C ☞ 63060
Printer I/O PCB 2 ☞ 66030
Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
Triple magazine PCB ☞ 66050
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Printer power supply 2 ☞ 66100
46012 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46014
Error message: Printer 1
4. Troubleshooting
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Suffix Condition ☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
number ☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
0001 Even when a specified length of paper is rewound ☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
after the paper rewinding has started, the paper ☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
loading sensor does not turn LIGHT.
0002 Even when a specified length of paper is rewound
Detailed diagram
after the paper loading sensor has turned LIGHT,
paper end sensors A and/or B do not turn LIGHT. ☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
☞ LP 3-3 Paper supply unit (1)
Check Point ☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
1 Check that the paper is correctly inserted into the
paper magazine.
2 Clean the advance roller.
3 Check that the paper loading sensor and the paper end
sensor are not soiled.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F35 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
46014 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46016
Error message: Printer 1
In the case of a detection failure Manual No.
No. 6016-#### Cut home sensor ☞ 63060
Paper Cutter operation error. Cut end sensor
Printer I/O PCB 2 ☞ 66030
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
purchase. Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Alarm release Multi power supply ☞ 66100
NO
Error message release
NO
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
Failed parts
Condition Refer to 4202 ☞ Printer control PCB.
Suffix Condition Refer to 4202 ☞ Printer I/O PCB 1.
number Refer to 4202 ☞ Printer I/O PCB 2.
0001 The cut home sensor does not turn LIGHT even
though a specified time has passed after the cut
NOTE
operation started.
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
0002 The cut end sensor does not turn DARK even though
a specified time has passed after the cut operation Circuit diagram
4. Troubleshooting
started and the cut home sensor turned LIGHT. ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
0003 Even when a specified time has passed after the cut ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
operation was completed, the cut end sensor does not
turn LIGHT.
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
0004 Even when a specified time has passed after the cut
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
operation was completed and the cut end sensor ☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
turned LIGHT, the cut home sensor does not turn
DARK. Detailed diagram
0005 The cut home sensor and cut end sensor are DARK in ☞ LP 3-3 Paper supply unit (1)
the initial operation.
IMPORTANT
• If the paper supply unit is not set correctly, this error may
occur.
NOTE
• The cutter blade may be locked or seized.
Check Point
1 Check that the paper supply unit is installed correctly.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F32 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
46016 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46016
Error message: Printer 1
Countermeasure message
Remove the paper. For details, refer to the manual.
Alarm release
NO Rollers
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The exposure start sensor does not turn DARK even
though the paper was fed to the exposure standby
position.
0002 The exposure start sensor does not turn LIGHT even
though the paper was exposed and fed for a specified G074435
4. Troubleshooting
time.
0003 The paper sensor 1 does not turn DARK even though Processor loading unit
the paper was fed to the paper advance unit 1. Rollers
0004 The paper sensor 1 does not turn LIGHT even though
the paper was fed from the paper advance unit 1.
0005 The paper sensor 2 (left) does not turn DARK even
though the paper was fed to the processor loading
unit.
0006 The paper sensor 2 (left) does not turn LIGHT even
though the paper was fed from the processor loading
unit.
0007 The paper sensor 2 (center) does not turn DARK even
though the paper was fed to the processor loading G069077
unit. • When the suffix numbers from 0005 to 0010 of message
Paper has jammed in the printer section. occurs,
0008 The paper sensor 2 (center) does not turn LIGHT
even though the paper was fed from the processor
loading unit.
0009 The paper sensor 2 (right) does not turn DARK even
though the paper was fed to the processor loading
unit.
0010 The paper sensor 2 (right) does not turn LIGHT even
though the paper was fed from the processor loading
unit.
Check Point
1 Check that each sensor is not soiled.
2 Check if the pressure guide is in position.
3 Carry out Paper Sensor LED Light Intensity
Adjustment in Functions of Paper Sensor
Adjustment.
IMPORTANT
• When the error of the suffix number 0005, 0007 or 0009
of message Paper has jammed in the printer section.
46016 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46016
Error message: Printer 1
check that the spring 2 of paper advance unit 1 is not # Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
broken.
Failed parts
Paper Advance Unit 1
Refer to 4202 ☞ Printer I/O PCB 1.
Spring 2 Refer to 4202 ☞ Printer I/O PCB 2.
Refer to 4202 ☞ Printer I/O PCB 3.
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
4. Troubleshooting
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-5 Exposure advance unit (1)
☞ LP 3-7 Paper advance unit 1
☞ LP 3-9 Paper advance unit 2 (2)
G078460 ☞ LP 3-10 Paper advance unit 2 (3)
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F33 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
F38 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66040
46016 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46020
Error message: Printer 1
4. Troubleshooting
0003 Paper end sensor C turns DARK after the error NOTE
message No. 6017: Paper has jammed in the • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
printer section. was released.
Circuit diagram
0004 The loading sensor turns DARK after the error
message No. 6017: Paper has jammed in the
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
printer section. was released. ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
0005 The exposure start sensor turns DARK after the error ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
message No. 6017: Paper has jammed in the ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
printer section. was released. ☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
0006 The paper sensor 1 turns DARK after the error ☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
message No. 6017: Paper has jammed in the
printer section. was released. ☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
0007 The paper sensor 2 (left) turns DARK after the error ☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
message No. 6017: Paper has jammed in the
printer section. was released. Detailed diagram
0008 The paper sensor 2 (center) turns DARK after the ☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
error message No. 6017: Paper has jammed in the ☞ LP 3-3 Paper supply section (1)
printer section. was released.
☞ LP 3-5 Exposure advance unit (1)
0009 The paper sensor 2 (right) turns DARK after the error
message No. 6017: Paper has jammed in the
☞ LP 3-7 Paper advance unit 1
printer section. was released. ☞ LP 3-10 Paper advance unit 2 (3)
☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
Check Point
1 Check that each sensor is not soiled.
2 Check if the pressure guide is in position.
3 Carry out Paper Sensor LED Light Intensity
Adjustment in Functions of Paper Sensor
Adjustment.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F33 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
46020 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46048
Error message: Printer 1
No. 6049
Pressure Guide operation error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The home position is not detected even though the
pressure guide motor operated for a specified time.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check that the pressure guide sensor is not soiled.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F33 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-7 Paper advance unit 1
46048 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46054
Error message: Printer 1
No. 6054
The Initial Setup was not executed.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- An attempt is made to carry out printing without
initial setup.
NOTE
• Check the points and follow the diagnosis mentioned below
4. Troubleshooting
even though the initial setup has been finished.
Check Point
1 Allow the computer to read the backup data.
Diagnosis
In the case of failure Manual No.
Carry out initial setup. -
Computer ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
46054 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46056
Error message: Printer 1
No. 6056-####
Printer system error.
Countermeasure message
Contact us or your place of purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When the RAM or the like on the printer control PCB
is checked during start-up, they are abnormal.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
4. Troubleshooting
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
46056 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46068
Error message: Printer 1
No. 6069
The printer top cover is open.
Countermeasure message
Remove any paper that remains then close the door.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
• This attention message will be released automatically when
the printer door is closed.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Interlock switch 1 (printer top cover) turns OFF.
NOTE
• Some electrical parts stop operations when the interlock
4. Troubleshooting
switch (printer top cover) turns OFF.
Check Point
1 Check that the printer top cover is securely closed.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F3 Laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-13 Laser unit (3)
46068 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46072
Error message: Printer 1
Diagnosis NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
4. Troubleshooting
IMPORTANT
Circuit diagram
• The output lines of R, G and B from the laser control
PCB to laser unit are out on their own. ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
• Carry out R Laser Output ON, G Laser Output ON ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
and G Laser Output ON of Output ☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Check→Printer→Engine Section. If the results are ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
shown below, each laser is normal.
☞ 35310 ☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
LP-1700 LP-2300
Laser Synchronous Synchronous Synchronous Detailed diagram
Sensor
☞ LP 3-11 Laser unit (1)
Polygon Mirror 1380±7 1720±7
Frequency ☞ LP 3-13 Laser unit (3)
☞ LP 3-14 Laser unit (4)
• If all lasers are abnormal, the synchronous sensors (in
the laser unit) may be defective.
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Adjustment failure in the attaching position -
of the interlock switch (printer top cover)
46072 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46074
Error message: Printer 1
Detailed diagram
No. 6074 ☞ LP 3-11 Laser unit (1)
B Laser control error. ☞ LP 3-13 Laser unit (3)
No. 6075 ☞ LP 3-14 Laser unit (4)
G Laser control error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
Stop Alarm
Error message release
Error Clear
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
From A communication or control error occurred between
0006 to the laser control PCB and the laser unit.
4. Troubleshooting
0011
IMPORTANT
• In the laser unit type B, this error message will not be
displayed.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
Laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
B laser driver ☞ 66070
G laser driver
B-AOM driver ☞ 66080
G-AOM driver
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
Laser power supply
Laser unit ☞ 63080
IMPORTANT
• Replacement and adjustment of the parts in the laser
unit are impossible.
Replace the unit.
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
46074 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46076
Error message: Printer 1
Circuit diagram
No. 6076-####
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Polygon Mirror control error.
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of ☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
purchase.
Alarm release Detailed diagram
NO ☞ LP 3-11 Laser unit (1)
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The polygon mirror does not rotate properly.
0002 The polygon mirror frequency is out of range.
NOTE
• The processable range of polygon mirror frequency is from
4. Troubleshooting
1373 Hz to 1387 Hz.
• You can check the polygon mirror frequency via Input
Check.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F2 Laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
IMPORTANT
• Replacement and adjustment of the parts in the laser
unit are impossible.
Replace the unit.
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
46076 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46076
Error message: Printer 1
No. 6077-####
Interlock error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Unused
0002 When the printer control PCB had detected the
interlock, the laser control PCB had not detected the
interlock.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
Laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
Laser power supply
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-13 Laser unit (3)
46076 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46080
Error message: Printer 1
No. 6081-####
Backup data error. Printer
Countermeasure message
Load backup data from the floppy disk. For details, refer to the
manual.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0### The backup data of the printer control PCB is
abnormal.
1### The backup data of the system HDD and the printer
control PCB are abnormal.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The value informed from CPU is displayed in the last three
digits of the suffix number.
• If approximately 5 days have passed with the power supply
being OFF or if the printer control PCB has been replaced
with a new one, this error message will appear.
Diagnosis
When the data is erased Manual No.
Carry out Reading data. ☞ 35400
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
46080 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46082
Error message: Printer 1
Suffix Condition
No. 6082-#### number
Setup error. 0106 The center correction is out of allowable range when
carrying out the gamma setup in the paper
Countermeasure message specification registration setup. (B)
Refer to the manual for corrective action. 0107 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
Alarm release carrying out the gamma setup in the paper
NO specification registration setup. (R)
Error message release
YES 0108 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
carrying out the gamma setup in the paper
specification registration setup. (G)
Condition
0109 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
Suffix Condition carrying out the gamma setup in the paper
number specification registration setup. (B)
0001 The center correction is out of allowable range when 0201 The center correction is out of allowable range when
carrying out the system exposure light intensity setup carrying out the daily setup. (R)
in the initial setup. (R) 0202 The center correction is out of allowable range when
0002 The center correction is out of allowable range when carrying out the daily setup. (G)
carrying out the system exposure light intensity setup 0203 The center correction is out of allowable range when
in the initial setup. (G) carrying out the daily setup. (B)
4. Troubleshooting
0003 The center correction is out of allowable range when 0204 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
carrying out the system exposure light intensity setup carrying out the daily setup. (R)
in the initial setup. (B)
0205 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
0004 The center correction is out of allowable range when carrying out the daily setup. (G)
carrying out the gamma setup in the initial setup. (R)
0206 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
0005 The center correction is out of allowable range when carrying out the daily setup. (B)
carrying out the gamma setup in the initial setup. (G)
0301 The center correction is out of allowable range when
0006 The center correction is out of allowable range when carrying out the paper magazine registration setup.
carrying out the gamma setup in the initial setup. (B) (R)
0007 The tone correction is out of allowable range when 0302 The center correction is out of allowable range when
carrying out the gamma setup in the initial setup. (R) carrying out the paper magazine registration setup.
0008 The tone correction is out of allowable range when (G)
carrying out the gamma setup in the initial setup. (G) 0303 The center correction is out of allowable range when
0009 The tone correction is out of allowable range when carrying out the paper magazine registration setup.
carrying out the gamma setup in the initial setup. (B) (B)
0010 The AOM bias characteristic updating of initial setup 0304 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
is out of allowable range. (R) carrying out the paper magazine registration setup.
0011 The AOM bias characteristic updating of initial setup (R)
is out of allowable range. (G) 0305 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
0012 The AOM bias characteristic updating of initial setup carrying out the paper magazine registration setup.
is out of allowable range. (B) (G)
0101 The center correction is out of allowable range when 0306 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
carrying out the system exposure light intensity setup carrying out the paper magazine registration setup.
in the paper specification registration setup. (R) (B)
0102 The center correction is out of allowable range when 0401 The center correction is out of allowable range when
carrying out the system exposure light intensity setup carrying out the emulsion number change. (R)
in the paper specification registration setup. (G) 0402 The center correction is out of allowable range when
0103 The center correction is out of allowable range when carrying out the emulsion number change. (G)
carrying out the system exposure light intensity setup 0403 The center correction is out of allowable range when
in the paper specification registration setup. (B) carrying out the emulsion number change. (B)
0104 The center correction is out of allowable range when 0404 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
carrying out the gamma setup in the paper carrying out the emulsion number change. (R)
specification registration setup. (R) 0405 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
0105 The center correction is out of allowable range when carrying out the emulsion number change. (G)
carrying out the gamma setup in the paper 0406 The tone correction is out of allowable range when
specification registration setup. (G) carrying out the emulsion number change. (B)
0501 The AOM bias setting value is out of allowable range
when carrying out each setup. (R)
46082 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46082
Error message: Printer 1
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 Calibrate the colorimeter.
2 Check that the calibration plate is not soiled.
Diagnosis
In case of an adjusting failure Manual No.
Adjust the colorimeter unit. ☞ 35100
IMPORTANT
• Replacement and adjustment of the parts in the laser
unit are impossible.
Replace the unit.
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
46082 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46086
Error message: Printer 1
Countermeasure message
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase. Failed parts
Alarm release Refer to 4201 ☞ Image processing PCB.
NO
Error message release Refer to 4202 ☞ Laser control PCB.
YES
NOTE
Condition • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Condition Circuit diagram
An error occurs on the laser control PCB. ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
Suffix Condition ☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
number
0001 Data processing error
4. Troubleshooting
0002 Memory error
0003 Communication error
0004 Exposure operation error
0005 Data processing error
0006 Exposure operation error
0007 Communication error
0008 Data processing error
0009
0010
0011
0019
0022 Communication error between the printer control
PCB and laser control PCB occurs.
IMPORTANT
• The error above may occur when the ARCNET
communication status is not normal.
If the error occurs, check the following items.
• Check the communication status of the ARCNET on the
Version Check display.
☞ 37530
• Check the ARCNET communication path.
☞ 50520
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Check the cause of failure in System Version ☞ 37530
Check at the No. 6901 ARCNET
communication error.
Perform the diagnosis of ARCNET ☞ 50520
communication error.
46086 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46100
Error message: Printer 1
NOTE
No. 6101-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Paper Hold Motor operation error.
Circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
purchase. ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
Alarm release
NO ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Error message release ☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
NO
Detailed diagram
Condition ☞ LP 3-4 Paper supply unit (2)
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The paper hold sensor does not turn DARK from
LIGHT even though a specified time has elapsed
after starting the paper hold motor operation.
0002 The paper hold sensor does not turn LIGHT from
DARK even though a specified time has elapsed after
4. Troubleshooting
starting the paper hold motor operation.
IMPORTANT
• If the paper supply unit is not set correctly, this error may
occur.
Check Point
1 Check that the paper supply unit is installed correctly.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F32 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
46100 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46104
Error message: Printer 1
Circuit diagram
No. 6104-####
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Printer Door is open.
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
Remove any paper that remains then close Printer Doors 1 and 2. ☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
Alarm release
NO Detailed diagram
Error message release ☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 While prints are being made, the interlock switch
(printer doors 1 or 2) turns OFF.
0002 While prints are being made, the printer door 3
sensor turns OFF.
NOTE
4. Troubleshooting
• Some electrical parts stop operations when the interlock
switch (printer door 1 or 2) or printer door 3 sensor turns OFF.
Check Point
1 Check that printer doors 1, 2 and 3 are securely
closed.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Adjustment failure in the attaching position -
of the interlock switch (printer door 1 or 2)
Adjustment failure in the attaching position -
of the printer door 3 sensor
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
46104 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46104
Error message: Printer 1
4. Troubleshooting
6106 An error occurs in the light source state of ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
G laser. ☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
NOTE
• This error lets you know that the B/G laser head in the laser
unit has deteriorated. Detailed diagram
• When the error is released once, the error does not recur until ☞ LP 3-11 Laser unit (1)
the power supply is reset or the machine is started by the ☞ LP 3-13 Laser unit (3)
program timer. ☞ LP 3-14 Laser unit (4)
IMPORTANT
• If an error occurs every time the power supply is reset or
the machine is started by the program timer, check the
contents of Point. When there is no problem there, it is
highly possible that the laser unit is defective.
• Check each of G Laser Light Source Status and B
Laser Light Source Status for Input Check → Printer
→ Engine Section, and if it is OK, it is highly possible
that each part at the Failed parts is normal.
☞ 35210
• Follow the diagnostic procedure shown below if either G
Laser Light Source Status or B Laser Light Source
Status is No Good.
Diagnosis
Point
1 Check if the power (5 V) is supplied from the laser I/O PCB
and laser control PCB.
46104 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46107
Error message: Printer 1
Circuit diagram
No. 6107-####
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
R Laser temperature is out of range.
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase. Detailed diagram
Alarm release ☞ LP 3-11 Laser unit (1)
NO ☞ LP 3-12 Laser unit (2)
Error message release
NO ☞ LP 3-14 Laser unit (4)
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 R laser temperature is controlled between 27.7°C and
28.3°C for 6 seconds or more (standby status) and
then the temperature exceeds 31.0°C (upper limit
temperature) again.
0002 R laser temperature is controlled between 27.7°C and
4. Troubleshooting
28.3°C for 6 seconds or more (standby status) and
then the temperature falls under 25.0°C (lower limit
temperature) again.
NOTE
• The R laser thermosensor is built into the R laser.
• You can check the temperature of R laser in Laser Unit
Adjustment.
☞ 37300
Check Point
1 Perform the diagnosis of ☞ Specifying the occurring
cause: Laser temperatures are being adjusted. (R)
appears. Refer to 4302.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
Laser power supply
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
Laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
Laser unit ☞ 63080
Laser unit heater ☞ 63080
Laser unit cooling fans 1 or 2 (Suffix number ☞ 63050
0001)
IMPORTANT
• Replacement and adjustment of the parts in the laser
unit are impossible.
Replace the unit.
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
46107 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46112
Error message: Printer 1
4. Troubleshooting
Circuit diagram
loading sensor does not turn DARK.
0003 Even though the paper passes the loading sensor and
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
a specified length of paper is advanced when the ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
deflection prevention operation is carried out ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
during the paper loading, paper end sensor C does not ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
turn LIGHT.
☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
Check Point
☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
1 Check that the paper is correctly inserted into the
paper magazine.
Detailed diagram
2 Clean the advance roller.
☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
☞ LP 3-3 Paper supply unit (1)
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F35 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
46112 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46112
Error message: Printer 1
NOTE
No. 6113-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Paper did not rewind. Paper Magazine C
Circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Remove the paper. For details, refer to the manual. ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
Alarm release ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
NO
Error message release ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
YES ☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
Condition ☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Suffix Condition
number Detailed diagram
0001 Even when a specified length of paper is rewound ☞ LP 3-2 Magazine unit
after the paper rewinding has started, the paper ☞ LP 3-3 Paper supply unit (1)
loading sensor does not turn LIGHT.
0002 Even when a specified length of paper is rewound
after the paper loading sensor has turned LIGHT,
4. Troubleshooting
paper end sensor C does not turn LIGHT.
Check Point
1 Check that the paper is correctly inserted into the
paper magazine.
2 Clean the advance roller.
3 Check that the paper loading sensor and the paper end
sensor are not soiled.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F35 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
46112 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46134
Error message: Printer 1
Circuit diagram
No. 6134-####
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Paper Supply Pressure Change Motor
☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
operation error.
☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
Countermeasure message
Detailed diagram
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase. ☞ LP 3-4 Paper supply unit (2)
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The paper supply pressure change sensor does not
turn DARK even though a specified time elapsed
after starting the paper supply pressure change motor
operation.
4. Troubleshooting
0002 The paper supply pressure change sensor does not
turn LIGHT even though a specified time elapsed
after starting the paper supply pressure change motor
operation.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F32 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
46134 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46134
Error message: Printer 1
NOTE
No. 6135-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Arm Unit 1 operation error.
Circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
purchase. ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
Alarm release
NO ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Error message release ☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
NO ☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Condition
Suffix Condition Detailed diagram
number ☞ LP 3-4 Paper supply unit (2)
0001 The zigzaging correction sensor does not turn DARK ☞ LP 3-5 Exposure advance unit (1)
even though the paper supply arm motor moved arm
unit 1 for the specified length in the direction of
paper advance.
4. Troubleshooting
0002 The zigzaging correction sensor does not turn LIGHT
even though the paper supply arm motor moved arm
unit 1 for the specified length in the reverse direction
of paper advance when zigzag correction sensor is
DARK.
Check Point
1 Clean each sensor using a blower brush.
2 Carry out paper sensor adjustment. ☞ 36000
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F32 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
46134 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46136
Error message: Printer 1
NOTE
No. 6136-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Exposure Advance Pressure Change
Motor 1 operation error. Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
purchase. ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
Alarm release
NO ☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
Error message release ☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
NO
Detailed diagram
Condition ☞ LP 3-6 Exposure advance unit (2)
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Exposure advance pressure change sensor 1 does not
turn DARK from LIGHT even though the exposure
advance pressure change motor 1 has moved for the
specified length.
4. Troubleshooting
0002 Exposure advance pressure change sensor 1 does not
turn LIGHT from DARK even though the exposure
advance pressure change motor 1 has moved for the
specified length.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F32 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
46136 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46136
Error message: Printer 1
Circuit diagram
No. 6137-####
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Exposure Advance Pressure Change
Motor 2 operation error. Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-6 Exposure advance unit (2)
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Exposure advance pressure change sensor 2 does not
turn DARK from LIGHT even though the exposure
advance pressure change motor 2 has moved for the
4. Troubleshooting
specified length.
0002 Exposure advance pressure change sensor 2 does not
turn LIGHT from DARK even though the exposure
advance pressure change motor 2 has moved for the
specified length.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F33 Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-4 Around printer I/O PCB 1
46136 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46138
Error message: Printer 2
Error message: Printer 2
4. Troubleshooting
0001 The arm sensor (left) or (right) does not turn DARK
even though the paper advance arm motor (left) or
(right) has operated for a specified pulse.
0002 The arm sensor (left) or (right) does not turn RIGHT
even though the paper advance arm motor (left) or
(right) has operated for a specified pulse.
Check Point
1 Clean the arm sensor (right or left). ☞ 63100
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F37 Printer I/O PCB 3 ☞ 66040
46138 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46140
Error message: Printer 2
No. 6140-####
Lane Select Motor (Left) operation error.
No. 6141-####
Lane Select Motor (Right) operation error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The lane select sensor (left) or (right) does not turn
DARK even though the lane select motor (left) or
4. Troubleshooting
(right) has operated for a specified pulse.
0002 The lane select sensor (left) or (right) does not turn
LIGHT even though the lane select motor (left) or
(right) has operated for a specified pulse.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F38 Printer I/O PCB 3 ☞ 66040
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-9 Paper advance unit 2 (2)
46140 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46142
Error message: Printer 2
# Symptoms result from blowout of fuse
No. 6142-####
Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor Failed parts
4. Troubleshooting
0001 The paper advance pressure change sensor (left) or
(right) does not turn DARK even though the paper
advance pressure change motor (left) or (right)
operated and the pressure roller increased the
pressure.
0002 The paper advance pressure release sensor (left) or
(right) does not turn LIGHT even though the paper
advance pressure change motor (left) or (right)
operated and the pressure roller released the pressure.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F38 Printer I/O PCB 3 ☞ 66040
46142 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46148
Error message: Printer 2
Circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Clean the sensor with a blower brush. For details, refer to the
manual. After cleaning, adjust the Paper Sensor LED Light ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
Intensity again. ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
Alarm release ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
NO
Error message release
☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
YES ☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
4. Troubleshooting
Condition
- Each print sensor was not adjusted properly when
☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
Paper Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment
was performed in Functions of Paper Sensor
Adjustment.
NOTE
• The suffix number differs depending on the operation which is
currently processed.
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 0, the detection sensor does not turn DARK.
0002 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 255, the detection sensor does not turn LIGHT.
0003 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 1/9 of setting value, the detection sensor does
not turn DARK.
0004 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to the setting value, the detection sensor does not
turn LIGHT.
Check Point
1 Clean the paper end sensor using a blower brush.
2 Check the sensor status via Paper Sensor
Adjustment. ☞ 36000
NOTE
• In the service mode, LED light intensity value is displayed in
the Paper Sensor Adjust.
• After cleaning the sensor, carry out Paper Sensor LED Light
Intensity Adjustment again and check that the sensor LED
light intensity changes.
Diagnosis
In the case of failure Manual No.
Paper end sensor A, B or C ☞ 63051
46148 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46151
Error message: Printer 2
NOTE
No. 6151-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Paper Loading Sensor error.
Circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Contact us or your place of purchase. ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
Alarm release ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
NO
Error message release ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
YES ☞ LP 2-5 Around printer I/O PCB 2
NOTE
• The suffix number differs depending on the operation which is
4. Troubleshooting
currently processed.
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 0, the detection sensor does not turn DARK.
0002 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 255, the detection sensor does not turn LIGHT.
0003 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 1/9 of setting value, the detection sensor does
not turn DARK.
0004 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to the setting value, the detection sensor does not
turn LIGHT.
Check Point
1 Clean the paper loading sensor using a blower brush.
2 Check the sensor status via Paper Sensor
Adjustment. ☞ 36000
NOTE
• In the service mode, LED light intensity value is displayed in
the Paper Sensor Adjust.
• After cleaning the sensor, carry out Paper Sensor LED Light
Intensity Adjustment again and check that the sensor LED
light intensity changes.
Diagnosis
In the case of failure Manual No.
Paper loading sensor ☞ 63060
Printer I/O PCB 2 ☞ 66030
Printer I/O PCB 1 ☞ 66020
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
46151 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46152
Error message: Printer 2
Circuit diagram
No. 6152-####
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
Zigzagging Correction Sensor (Left) error.
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
No. 6153-#### ☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Zigzagging Correction Sensor (Right)
error. Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-5 Exposure advance unit (1)
Countermeasure message
Contact us or your place of purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Condition
- Each print sensor was not adjusted properly when
Paper Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment
was performed in Functions of Paper Sensor
4. Troubleshooting
Adjustment.
NOTE
• The suffix number differs depending on the operation which is
currently processed.
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 0, the detection sensor does not turn DARK.
0002 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 255, the detection sensor does not turn LIGHT.
0003 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 1/9 of setting value, the detection sensor does
not turn DARK.
0004 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to the setting value, the detection sensor does not
turn LIGHT.
Check Point
1 Clean the zigzag correction sensor (right or left).
☞ 63070
2 Carry out Paper Sensor Adjustment. ☞ 36000
Diagnosis
In the case of failure Manual No.
Zigzagging correction sensor (right or left) ☞ 63070
Printer I/O PCB 3 ☞ 66040
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
46152 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46154
Error message: Printer 2
NOTE
No. 6155-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Exposure Start Sensor error.
Circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Clean the sensor with a blower brush. For details, refer to the ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
manual. After cleaning, adjust the Paper Sensor LED Light ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
Intensity again.
Alarm release ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
NO ☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Error message release
YES Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-5 Exposure advance unit (1)
Condition
Condition
- Each print sensor was not adjusted properly when
Paper Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment
was performed in Functions of Paper Sensor
Adjustment.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The suffix number differs depending on the operation which is
currently processed.
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 0, the detection sensor does not turn DARK.
0002 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 255, the detection sensor does not turn LIGHT.
0003 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 1/9 of setting value, the detection sensor does
not turn DARK.
0004 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to the setting value, the detection sensor does not
turn LIGHT.
Check Point
1 Clean the exposure start sensor using a blower brush.
2 Check the sensor status via Paper Sensor
Adjustment. ☞ 36000
NOTE
• In the service mode, LED light intensity value is displayed in
the Paper Sensor Adjust.
• After cleaning the sensor, carry out Paper Sensor LED Light
Intensity Adjustment again and check that the sensor LED
light intensity changes.
Diagnosis
In the case of failure Manual No.
Exposure start sensor ☞ 63070
Printer I/O PCB 3 ☞ 66040
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
46154 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46156
Error message: Printer 2
NOTE
No. 6157-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Paper Sensor 1 error.
Circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Clean the sensor with a blower brush. For details, refer to the ☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
manual. After cleaning, adjust the Paper Sensor LED Light ☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
Intensity again.
Alarm release ☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
NO ☞ LP 2-6 Around printer I/O PCB 3
Error message release
YES Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-7 Paper advance unit 1
Condition
Condition
- Each print sensor was not adjusted properly when
Paper Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment
was performed in Functions of Paper Sensor
Adjustment.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The suffix number differs depending on the operation which is
currently processed.
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 0, the detection sensor does not turn DARK.
0002 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 255, the detection sensor does not turn LIGHT.
0003 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 1/9 of setting value, the detection sensor does
not turn DARK.
0004 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to the setting value, the detection sensor does not
turn LIGHT.
Check Point
1 Clean paper sensor 1 using a blower brush.
2 Check the sensor status via Paper Sensor
Adjustment. ☞ 36000
NOTE
• In the service mode, LED light intensity value is displayed in
the Paper Sensor Adjust.
• After cleaning the sensor, carry out Paper Sensor LED Light
Intensity Adjustment again and check that the sensor LED
light intensity changes.
Diagnosis
In the case of failure Manual No.
Paper sensor 1 ☞ 63090
Printer I/O PCB 3 ☞ 66040
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
46156 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46158
Error message: Printer 2
4. Troubleshooting
Condition
- Each print sensor was not adjusted properly when
Paper Sensor LED Light Intensity Adjustment
was performed in Functions of Paper Sensor
Adjustment.
NOTE
• The suffix number differs depending on the operation which is
currently processed.
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 0, the detection sensor does not turn DARK.
0002 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 255, the detection sensor does not turn LIGHT.
0003 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to 1/9 of setting value, the detection sensor does
not turn DARK.
0004 When the light source level of the emission sensor is
set to the setting value, the detection sensor does not
turn LIGHT.
Check Point
1 Clean paper sensor 2 using a blower brush.
2 Check the sensor status via Paper Sensor
Adjustment. ☞ 36000
NOTE
• In the service mode, LED light intensity value is displayed in
the Paper Sensor Adjust.
• After cleaning the sensor, carry out Paper Sensor LED Light
Intensity Adjustment again and check that the sensor LED
light intensity changes.
Diagnosis
In the case of failure Manual No.
Paper sensor 2 (left, center or right) ☞ 63110
46158 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46172
Error message: Printer 2
No. 6173
Printer Door 3 is open. It may be
adversely affect print quality.
Countermeasure message
Close the printer door. When you inspect the paper currently
processing, check whether it is satisfactory.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Condition
- The print door 3 sensor turns OFF while printing
from paper magazine B or C.
NOTE
• This error appears to let the operator know that opening
4. Troubleshooting
printer door 3 during printing is a wrong operation and that
adversely affects the print quality.
Check Point
1 Check that the printer door 3 is securely closed.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Adjustment failure in the attaching position -
of the printer door 3 sensor
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-7 Around triple magazine PCB
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-16 Triple magazine unit
46172 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46176
Error message: Printer 2
Detailed diagram
No. 6177-#### ☞ LP 3-11 Laser unit (1)
Laser Unit temperature is out of range.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Laser temperature is controlled once between 23.0°C
and 42.0°C for ten seconds or more (standby status)
and then the temperature exceeds 45.0°C (upper limit
temperature) again.
0002 Laser temperature is controlled once between 23.0°C
4. Troubleshooting
and 42.0°C for ten seconds or more (standby status)
and then the temperature falls under 20.0°C (lower
limit temperature)again.
NOTE
• The laser thermosensor is built into the laser unit.
• You can check the temperature of laser unit in Laser Unit
Adjustment.
☞ 37300
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
Laser power supply
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
Laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
Laser unit ☞ 63080
Laser unit heater ☞ 63080
Laser unit cooling fan 1 or 2 ☞ 63050
IMPORTANT
• Replacement and adjustment of the parts in the laser
unit are impossible.
Replace the unit.
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
46176 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46178
Error message: Printer 2
No. 6179
B/G Laser Output Unit error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
Stop Alarm
Error message release
Error Clear
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The type detection of the laser unit differs between
0002 lasers B and G.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Check that the wiring of the laser drivers B and G
have been securely connected.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
B laser driver ☞ 66070
G laser driver
Laser I/O PCB ☞ 66060
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
Multi power supply ☞ 66100
Laser power supply
Laser unit ☞ 63080
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ LP 2-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-2 DC power supply circuit diagram
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
Detailed diagram
☞ LP 3-11 Laser unit (1)
☞ LP 3-13 Laser unit (3)
☞ LP 3-14 Laser unit (4)
46178 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46186
Error message: Printer 2
No. 6187
Setup calculation error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Problematic setup calculation result detected.
0002
NOTE
• Perform initial setup again if the error shown above occurs.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Carry out initial setup. -
46186 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46302
Error message: Scanner
Error message: Scanner
No. 6303-####
Scanner Zoom 1 operation error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
IMPORTANT
• This error only occurs if you are using an [S-2/S-3]
scanner.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The zoom 1 pre-home sensor does not turn DARK
even though the zoom lens operated for a specified
4. Troubleshooting
pulse counterclockwise in its initial operation.
0002 The zoom 1 pre-home sensor does not turn LIGHT
even though the zoom lens operated for a specified
pulse clockwise in its initial operation.
0003 The zoom 1 pre-home sensor does not turn DARK
even though the zoom lens operated for a specified
pulse counterclockwise after the zoom 1 pre-home
sensor turned LIGHT in its initial operation.
0004 The zoom 1 home sensor does not turn LIGHT even
though the zoom lens operated for a specified pulse
counterclockwise after the zoom 1 pre-home sensor
turned DARK in its initial operation.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Scanner unit ☞ 20610
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Scanner power supply 2
Multi power supply (scanner)
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46302 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46304
Error message: Scanner
4. Troubleshooting
pulse clockwise in its initial operation. 0002 During initial operation, pulse motor moved
0002 The zoom 2 pre-home sensor does not turn DARK counterclockwise for specified distance, but focus
even though the zoom lens operated for a specified home sensor did not block light.
pulse counterclockwise in its initial operation. 0003 During initial operation, pulse motor moved
0003 The zoom 2 home sensor does not turn LIGHT even clockwise for specified distance after focus home
though the zoom lens operated for a specified pulse sensor blocked light, but focus home sensor did not
counterclockwise after the zoom 2 pre-home sensor subsequently allow light to permeate lens.
turned DARK in its initial operation.
Diagnosis
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Failed parts Manual No. Scanner unit ☞ 20610
Scanner unit ☞ 20610 AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010 AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000 Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060 Scanner power supply 2
Scanner power supply 2 Multi power supply (scanner)
Multi power supply (scanner)
NOTE
NOTE • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Wiring diagram [S-4]
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3] ☞ 89010
☞ 89000
46304 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46306
Error message: Scanner
No. 6306-####
Scanner IRIS operation error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
IMPORTANT
• This error only occurs if you are using an [S-2/S-3]
scanner.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The IRIS sensor does not turn DARK even though
the zoom lens operated for a specified pulse
4. Troubleshooting
clockwise in its initial operation.
0002 The IRIS sensor does not turn LIGHT even though
the zoom lens operated for a specified pulse
counterclockwise in its initial operation.
0003 IRIS sensor does not turn DARK even though the
zoom lens operated for a specified pulse clockwise
after the IRIS sensor turned LIGHT in its initial
operation.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Scanner unit ☞ 20610
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Scanner power supply 2
Multi power supply (scanner)
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46306 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46308
Error message: Scanner
No. 6309-####
Scanner change of light error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
IMPORTANT
• When this error occurs, the daily setup has not been
completed properly. After troubleshooting, carry out the
daily setup again.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
4. Troubleshooting
0005 The Light Source Update was carried out with the
film carrier which is not registered the light source.
Check Point
1 Register the light source.
46308 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46310
Error message: Scanner
No. 6311-####
Scanner data error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
IMPORTANT
• When this error occurs, the light source registration data
will be erased. In this case, you have to read backup
data or carry out the light source registration again.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
4. Troubleshooting
- While the backup data is being read, the detected data
is out of range.
NOTE
• Although the suffix numbers for this error message will vary
depending on the error occurring conditions, the corrective
action should be taken according to the the following check
point and diagnosis.
Check Point
1 Initialize the scanner data and carry out the light
source registration and the area registration.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
ATX mother board ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
46310 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46318
Error message: Scanner
No. 6319-####
Backup data error. Scanner AFC
Countermeasure message
Load backup data from the floppy disk. For details, refer to the
manual.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
• Select YES to read the backup data in the hard disk.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0### The backup data of the AFC/scanner control PCB is
abnormal.
1### The backup data of the system HDD and the
AFC/scanner control PCB are abnormal.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The value informed from CPU is displayed in the last three
digits of the suffix number.
• If approximately 5 days have passed with the power supply
being OFF or if the AFC/scanner control PCB has been
replaced with a new one, this error message will appear.
Diagnosis
When the data is erased Manual No.
Carry out Reading data. ☞ 35400
Circuit diagram
☞ S 1-1 AC power supply connecting
☞ S 1-2 DC power supply connecting (type 0, 1, 2)
☞ S 1-4 Around scanner unit
46318 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46320
Error message: Scanner
Check Point
No. 6321-####
Focus auto adjustment error. 1 Check that no dust is attached on the AFC lens unit and
AFC slot.
When you have the maintenance stick (option), clean
Countermeasure message with it.
Refer to the manual for corrective action.
2 Check that the scanner dust prevention glass is not
Alarm release
soiled.
NO
Error message release 3 Check whether the scanner adjustment chart is damaged.
YES 4 Check the ND filter solenoid operates ☞ 35300
via Output Check.
IMPORTANT
• When this error occurs, the Focus Auto Adjustment
IMPORTANT
has not been completed normally. After troubleshooting,
carry out the Focus Auto Adjustment again. ☞ 37020 • When the error above occurs during the focus
adjustment, the ND filter solenoid heats up and it may
Condition cause the malfunctions.
After cooling the ND filter solenoid for about ten minutes
Suffix Condition at OFF, carry out the focus adjustment again.
number
NOTE
Other There is a problem with internal operation values,
than such as arguments and variables. • For confirming the scanner adjustment chart, refer to ☞ 4600.
4. Troubleshooting
below
Diagnosis
627 For 135/240 AMC-II or 135/240 MMC-II, the focus
chart is inserted incorrectly. Blown fuses Manual No.
644 The assigned magnification is considerably different F27 AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
from the magnification calculated from the scanned
F28
image.
661 Shading is abnormal.
Failed parts Manual No.
694 The slot of the focus chart cannot be detected
correctly because of the dust on the focus chart or the
Scanner unit ☞ 20610
damage of the focus chart. LED light source unit ☞ 20620
711 The triangular slot of the focus chart cannot be AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
detected correctly because of the dust on the focus AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
chart or the damage of the focus chart. Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
728 The focus chart cannot be detected correctly because Scanner power supply 2
of the dust on the focus chart or the damage of the
focus chart. Multi power supply (scanner)
805 The CCD for scanner IR and the CCD for image NOTE
scanning are out of positions.
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
1189 The light axis of the scanner is out of position.
1573 The scanner is considerably out of focus. Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
2657 The light axis of the scanner is out of position or the ☞ 89000
lens of the scanner is on a slant.
3362 For 135/240 AMC-II or 135/240 MMC-II, the Focus Wiring diagram [S-4]
Auto Adjustment is performed when the waveform ☞ 89010
cannot be recognized or is not in the normal range.
3412 The triangular slot of the focus chart cannot be
detected correctly because of the dust on the focus
chart or the damage of the focus chart.
3415 The triangular slot of the focus chart cannot be
detected correctly because of the dust on the focus
chart or the damage of the focus chart.
3620 The scanner is considerably out of focus.
46320 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46322
Error message: Scanner
4. Troubleshooting
light source registration.
0004 Each gain value of IR became out of range during the
light source registration.
Check Point
1 Check that no dust is attached on the AFC lens unit and
AFC slot.
When you have the maintenance stick (option), clean
with it.
2 Check the ND filter solenoid operates ☞ 35300
via Output Check.
3 If the error described above only occurs ☞ 34500
when images are being processed on the
120 AFC, check to see whether or not
the 120 AFC diffuser has been installed.
IMPORTANT
• When the error above occurs via Light source
registration or Light source update, the ND filter solenoid
heats and malfunctions may occur.
When the ND filter solenoid is OFF, cool it for about ten
minutes, then carry out the light source update and light
source update again.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
D-ICE PCB ☞ 64040
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
Scratch mend PCB 2 ☞ 64060
Scratch mend PCB 1 ☞ 64070
Data change-over PCB ☞ 64080
DIMM ☞ 64050
Scanner unit ☞ 20610
LED light source unit ☞ 20620
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
46322 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46324
Error message: Scanner
No. 6324
F stop value range error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
IMPORTANT
• When this error occurs, the Light source registration
has not been completed properly. After troubleshooting,
carry out the Light source registration again.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Since the aperture has been adjusted during light
4. Troubleshooting
source registration, the standard light intensity cannot
be obtained.
Check Point
1 Check that the LED light source section is neither
damaged nor soiled.
2 Reset the power supply.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Scanner unit ☞ 20610
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Scanner power supply 2
Multi power supply (scanner)
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46324 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46326
Error message: Scanner
4. Troubleshooting
The temperature at the LED light source was 43 ☞ 89000
degrees C or lower when temperature adjustment
began, and did not reach 45±1 degrees C after 30
Wiring diagram [S-4]
minutes elapsed.
0002 The temperature at the LED light source exceeded the
☞ 89010
upper range (50°C).
0003 The temperature at the LED light source fell below
the lower limit range (40 degree C) after the unit
entered standby status (45±1 degree C).
0004 The temperature at the LED light source was 43
degrees C or lower when temperature adjustment
began, and did not reach 45±1 degrees C after 20
minutes elapsed.
Check Point
1 Check that the room temperature is 15 to 30 degree
C.
2 Clean the scanner filter.
3 Check the LED cooling fan rotation.
IMPORTANT
• If the above message appears when starting the
operation (when the QSS is turned on by the program
timer) or when performing the dairy setup, the operation
temperature of the QSS (LED light source unit) may be
out of the specified range (15 to 30 degree C).
For the operation specification of the LED light source
unit, refer to ☞ 62050.
• In the case above, each electrical part of the QSS is
normal.
Update the scanner light source after the operation
temperature of the QSS (LED light source unit) is within
the specified range.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
LED cooling fan 1 or 2 ☞ 62050
LED driver PCB ☞ 65020
46326 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46328
Error message: Scanner
No. 6329-####
Analog setting communication error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 There is a problem with the communication between
to the scanner unit, AFC/scanner control PCB and main
0011 software at the light source registration.
0051 Abnormal operation of the scanner unit and
to AFC/scanner control PCB at the light source
4. Troubleshooting
0061 registration
IMPORTANT
• This error may occur when the ARCNET communication
status is abnormal.
If the error occurs, check the following items.
• Check the communication status of the ARCNET on the
Version Check display.
☞ 37530
• Check the ARCNET communication path.
☞ 50520
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Scanner unit ☞ 20610
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46328 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46330
Error message: Scanner
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
0001 There is a problem with the communication between 0001 There is a problem with the communication between
to the D-ICE control PCB and main software at the light the AFC/scanner control PCB, D-ICE control PCB,
0017 source registration. image processing PCB, and main software at the light
0051 Abnormal operation of the D-ICE control PCB source registration.
to during light source registration 0002 Abnormal operation of the AFC/scanner control
4. Troubleshooting
0066 PCB, D-ICE control PCB, image processing PCB at
the light source registration
IMPORTANT
• This error may occur when the ARCNET communication IMPORTANT
status is abnormal. • Since the scanner section is compatible with multiple
If the error occurs, check the following items. systems, the different system program may be installed
• Check the communication status of the ARCNET on the at the installation or replacement.
Version Check display. In this case, this error occurs because the versions of
☞ 37530 the program of the AFC/scanner control PCB and the
other program do not match.
• Check the ARCNET communication path.
Upgrade the program of the AFC/Scanner control PCB
☞ 50520 at the installation or replacement.
☞ 35600
Diagnosis
• This error may occur when the ARCNET communication
Failed parts Manual No. status is abnormal.
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030 If the error occurs, check the following items.
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000 • Check the communication status of the ARCNET on the
Version Check display.
NOTE ☞ 37530
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) • Check the ARCNET communication path.
☞ 50520
Wiring diagram
☞ 89000 Check Point
Countermeasure Manual No.
Upgrade the system program. ☞ 35600
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Image processing PCB ☞ 64000
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46330 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46330
Error message: Scanner
4. Troubleshooting
46330 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46332
Error message: Scanner
4. Troubleshooting
converge on the target value.) ☞ 89010
0002 Measurement value abnormal
0003 Data calculation error
0004 Lack of pixels
0005 Zoom value abnormal
0006 Image position abnormal
0007 Light amount abnormal
0008 Aperture value abnormal
0009 The dark level is not adjustable.
0010 The AFC was removed or the lane of the AFC was
changed, while executing the light source
registration.
0011 The light source registration was forced to be ended.
IMPORTANT
• If the message No.6332-0007 appears in registering the
light source or during updating the light source,
malfunctions may have been occurred in the ND filter
solenoid of the LED light source unit.
Check the ND filter solenoid operates via Output Check.
☞ 35300
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
LED driver PCB ☞ 65020
LED light source unit ☞ 62050
ND filter solenoid ☞ 62050
D-ICE PCB ☞ 64040
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
Scratch mend PCB 2 ☞ 64060
Scratch mend PCB 1 ☞ 64070
Data change-over PCB ☞ 64080
DIMM ☞ 64050
Scanner unit ☞ 20610
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
46332 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46332
Error message: Scanner
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Condition
Due to the poor contact between PCBs and connectors, the
scanning data has a problem and the operation of the light source
registration or the light source update does not finish properly.
4. Troubleshooting
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Measurement value abnormal
to
0005
0006 Data calculation error
0007 Operation of the light source registration or the light
source update was shut down forcibly.
Check Point
1 Register and update the light source after cleaning the
AFC slot and the lens unit.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
D-ICE PCB ☞ 64040
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
Scratch mend PCB 2 ☞ 64060
Scratch mend PCB 1 ☞ 64070
Data change-over PCB ☞ 64080
DIMM ☞ 64050
Scanner unit ☞ 20610
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Scanner power supply 2
Multi power supply (scanner)
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46332 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46336
Error message: Scanner
No. 6336-####
Scanner Zoom operation error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
IMPORTANT
• This error only occurs if you are using an [S-4] scanner.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 During initial operation, pulse motor moved
counterclockwise for specified distance, but zoom
home sensor did not block light.
4. Troubleshooting
0002 During initial operation, pulse motor moved
clockwise for specified distance, but zoom home
sensor did not allow light to permeate lens.
0003 During initial operation, pulse motor moved
counterclockwise for specified distance after zoom
home sensor allowed light to permeate lens, but zoom
home sensor did not then block light.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Scanner unit ☞ 20610
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Scanner power supply 2
Multi power supply (scanner)
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46336 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46400
Error message: Film carrier
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
standard voltage is lowered without changing the
light intensity level of the perforation sensor, the Adjustment failure point Manual No.
input status does not turn LIGHT. Sensitivity adjustment failure of the ☞ 35060
0003 When adjusting the sensor sensitivity, although the perforation sensor
standard voltage of the perforation sensor has been
fixed at the upper limit and light intensity level has
Failed parts Manual No.
been changed up to upper limit, the input status does
not turn DARK. 135 perforation sensor ☞ 62650
0004 When the standard voltage and the light intensity 135 AFC sensor PCB ☞ 65370
level of the perforation sensor were set to initial 135 AFC connecting PCB ☞ 65360
value, the input status turns LIGHT. AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
NOTE
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
• The name of the film carrier will be displayed on the second Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
line. Power PCB ☞ 65260
135, 240 or 110 Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Check Point NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
1 Check that the perforation sensor is not soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
Adjustment. ☞ 89000
Diagnosis Wiring diagram [S-4]
135/240 AFC-ll, 110 AFC-II ☞ 89010
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the ☞ 35000
perforation sensor ☞ 35020
46400 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46400
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
0002 When adjusting the sensor sensitivity, although the
standard voltage is lowered without changing the
light intensity level of the loading sensor, the input Wiring diagram [S-4]
status does not turn LIGHT. ☞ 89010
0003 When adjusting the sensor sensitivity, although the
standard voltage of the loading sensor has been fixed 135 AFC-II
at the upper limit and light intensity level has been
changed up to upper limit, the input status does not Adjustment failure point Manual No.
turn DARK. Sensitivity adjustment failure of the loading ☞ 35060
0004 When the standard voltage and the light intensity sensor
level of the loading sensor were set to initial value,
the input status turns LIGHT. Failed parts Manual No.
46400 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46402
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
standard voltage is lowered without changing the
light intensity level of the ready sensor, the input Wiring diagram [S-4]
status does not turn LIGHT. ☞ 89010
0003 When adjusting the sensor sensitivity, although the
standard voltage of the ready sensor has been fixed at 135 AFC-II
the upper limit and light intensity level has been
changed up to upper limit, the input status does not Adjustment failure point Manual No.
turn DARK. Sensitivity adjustment failure of the ready ☞ 35060
0004 When the standard voltage and the light intensity sensor
level of the ready sensor were set to initial value, the
input status turns LIGHT.
Failed parts Manual No.
NOTE 135 ready sensor ☞ 62650
• The name of the film carrier will be displayed on the second 135 AFC sensor PCB ☞ 65370
line of the message. 135 AFC connecting PCB ☞ 65360
135, 240, 110 or 120
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Check Point AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
1 Check that the ready sensors are not soiled.
Power PCB ☞ 65260
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
NOTE
Diagnosis • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
135/240 AFC-ll, 120 AFC-II, 110 AFC-II Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
Adjustment failure point Manual No. ☞ 89000
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the ready ☞ 35000
sensor ☞ 35010 Wiring diagram [S-4]
☞ 35020 ☞ 89010
46402 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46402
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
does not turn LIGHT. (The film rear end is not fed.)
0005 Although a specified length of film has been fed
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the loading ☞ 35060
sensor, ready sensor and perforation sensor
when film ejecting operation, the ready sensor does
not turn DARK. Failed parts Manual No.
0006 Even when a specified length of film has been fed 135 loading sensor ☞ 62650
after the ready sensor turned DARK while film
ejecting operation, the loading sensor does not turn 135 ready sensor
DARK. 135 perforation sensor
0014 Even when a specified length has been fed after the Rewinding sensor
perforation sensor turned DARK while film ejecting Film feed motor
operation, the ready sensor does not turn LIGHT.
PM driver (film feed motor) ☞ 65070
0017 The rewinding sensor detected the film jam.
135 AFC sensor PCB ☞ 65370
135 AFC connecting PCB ☞ 65360
Check Point
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
1 Check if the loading sensor, ready sensor and AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
perforation sensor are not soiled.
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
Power PCB ☞ 65260
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Diagnosis
NOTE
135/240 AFC-II • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46402 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46404
Error message: Film carrier
Diagnosis
No. 6404-####
240 film has stopped at the Film Carrier. Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the loading ☞ 35000
sensor, ready sensor and perforation sensor
Countermeasure message
Remove the film. For details, refer to the manual.
Alarm release Failed parts Manual No.
NO Loading sensor ☞ 62150
Error message release Ready sensor
YES
Perforation sensor
Condition VEI sensor
Rewinding sensor
Suffix Condition
number Spool key motor
0001 Even when a specified length is fed after the film Film feed motor
front end was fed from the cartridge, the loading PM driver (film feed motor) ☞ 65070
sensor does not detect the film front end. Sensor PCB (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65250
0002 Even when the specified length is fed after the Driver PCB 2 ☞ 65240
loading sensor detected the film front end, the ready
sensor does not turn DARK.
Connecting PCB 3 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65220
4. Troubleshooting
0004 Even when a specified length is fed after the ready
Connecting PCB 2 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65210
sensor turned DARK, the perforation sensor does not Connecting PCB 4 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65280
turn DARK. Connecting PCB 1 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65200
0005 Even when a specified length is fed after the AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
perforation sensor turned DARK, the sensor cannot Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
detect the first perforation.
Power PCB ☞ 65260
0006 Even when a specified length is fed after the
perforation sensor turned DARK, the sensor cannot AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
detect the end perforation. Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
0008 Even when the specified length is rewound when
rewinding the film, the ready sensor does not turn NOTE
LIGHT. • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
0009 Even when the specified length is rewound when Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
rewinding the film, the loading sensor does not turn ☞ 89000
LIGHT.
1000 Even when the specified length of the film has been
Wiring diagram [S-4]
rewound on rewinding the film, the detection of the
VEI sensor did not change. ☞ 89010
0011 The rewinding sensor detected the film jam.
0012- When pre-scanning is carried out, although a
0013 specified length is fed after the perforation sensor
turned DARK, the sensor cannot detect the next
perforation.
0014- When scanning is carried out, although a specified
0015 length is fed after the perforation sensor turned
DARK, the sensor cannot detect the next perforation.
Check Point
1 Check if the loading sensor, ready sensor and
perforation sensor are not soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
3 Check if the VEI sensor and the rewinding sensor are
not soiled.
46404 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46404
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
the film rear end.
0004 While the film is being fed, the perforation sensor
between the specified length cannot detect the
continuous signals of DARK and LIGHT.
0005 After pre-scanning, although the specified length is
fed after the film feed started to the scanning
direction, the ready sensor does not turn DARK.
0006 While the film is being fed to the scanning direction,
although the specified length is fed after the ready
sensor has turned DARK, the loading sensor does not
turn DARK.
0007 While the film is being fed to the scanning direction,
although the specified length is fed after the
perforation sensor has turned LIGHT, the ready
sensor does not turn LIGHT.
Check Point
1 Check if the loading sensor, ready sensor and
perforation sensor are not soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the loading ☞ 35020
sensor, ready sensor and perforation sensor
46404 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46406
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
0004 Although a specified length of film has been fed with
the film sensor DARK, the input status (rotation
detection) of the film feed sensor does not change.
0005 After pre-scanning, although the specified length is
fed after the film feed started to the scanning
direction, the ready sensor does not turn DARK.
0006 While the film is being fed to the scanning direction,
although the specified length is fed after the ready
sensor has turned DARK, the loading sensor does not
turn DARK.
0007 While the film is being fed to the scanning direction,
although the specified length is fed after the film
sensor has turned LIGHT, the ready sensor does not
turn LIGHT.
Check Point
1 Check that the loading sensor, the ready sensor and
the film sensor are not soiled.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity adjustment failure in the loading ☞ 35010
sensor, ready sensor, or film sensor
46406 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46406
Error message: Film carrier
No. 6407-####
Spool Key operation error.
Countermeasure message
Confirm the Film Cartridge.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Unused
0002
0003 Even though the spool key motor has been rotated by
the specified angle, the VEI sensor does not detect
the rotation.
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 Check that the VEI sensor is not soiled.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
VEI sensor ☞ 62150
Spool key motor
Sensor PCB (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65250
Driver PCB 2 ☞ 65240
Connecting PCB 3 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65220
Connecting PCB 2 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65210
Connecting PCB 4 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65280
Connecting PCB 1 (135/240 AFC-II) ☞ 65200
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
Power PCB ☞ 65260
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46406 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46408
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000 0007 Even when the specified length has been fed after the
perforation sensor turned LIGHT, the ready sensor
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060 does not turn LIGHT.
NOTE 0008 The rewinding sensor detected the film jam.
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) 0009 When ejecting the cleaning leader, the loading sensor
turns RIGHT immediately after the ready sensor
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3] detected the cleaning leader. (The cleaning leader is
☞ 89000 too short.)
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the loading ☞ 35000
sensor, ready sensor and perforation sensor
46408 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46408
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
46408 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46410
Error message: Film carrier
NOTE
No. 6410-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Film Sensor error.
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
Countermeasure message ☞ 89000
Clean the sensor with a blower brush. For details, refer to the
manual. Wiring diagram [S-4]
Alarm release
NO
☞ 89010
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When adjusting the sensor sensitivity, although the
standard voltage of the film sensor and light intensity
level have been changed up to upper limit, the input
status does not turn LIGHT.
0002 When adjusting the sensor sensitivity, the standard
4. Troubleshooting
voltage is lowered without changing the light
intensity level of the film sensor, the input status does
not turn LIGHT.
0003 When adjusting the sensor sensitivity, although the
standard voltage of the film sensor has been fixed at
the upper limit and light intensity level has been
changed up to upper limit, the input status does not
turn DARK.
0004 When the standard voltage and the light intensity
level of the film sensor were set to initial value, the
input status turns LIGHT.
NOTE
• The name of the film carrier will be displayed on the second
line.
120
Check Point
1 Check that the film sensor is not soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure of the film sensitivity adjustment ☞ 35010
46410 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46410
Error message: Film carrier
Diagnosis
No. 6411-####
Film Carrier Sensor Sensitivity 135/240 AFC-II
Adjustment was not executed. Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure of Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment ☞ 35000
Countermeasure message Failure of DX Sensor Standard Adjustment
Contact us or your place of purchase.
Alarm release
Failed parts Manual No.
NO
Error message release AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
YES
110 AFC-II, 120 AFC-II
Condition
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Suffix Condition
number
Failure of Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment ☞ 35010
0001 135 DX sensors 1, 2, 3, and 4 are not adjusted.
☞ 35020
0002 240 DX sensors 1 and 2 are not adjusted.
Failed parts Manual No.
0003 135 DX sensors 1, 2, 3, 4, 240 DX sensors 1 and 2 are
not adjusted. AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
4. Troubleshooting
0004 The loading sensors (135 and 240), ready sensors NOTE
(135 and 240), and perforation sensors (135 and 240)
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
are not adjusted.
0005 The 135 DX sensors 1, 2, 3, and 4, loading sensors Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
(135 and 240), ready sensors (135 and 240), and ☞ 89000
perforation sensors (135 and 240) are not adjusted.
0006 The 240 DX sensors 1 and 2, loading sensors (135 Wiring diagram [S-4]
and 240), ready sensors (135 and 240), and
perforation sensors (135 and 240) are not adjusted.
☞ 89010
0007 The 135 DX sensors 1, 2, 3, and 4, 240 DX sensors 1
and 2, loading sensors (135 and 240), ready sensors 135 AFC-II
(135 and 240), and perforation sensors (135 and 240)
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
are not adjusted.
0008 The 110 loading sensor, ready sensor and perforation
Failure of Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment ☞ 35060
sensor are not adjusted. Failure of DX Sensor Standard Adjustment
0010 The 120 loading sensor, ready sensor and film sensor
are not adjusted. Failed parts Manual No.
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
NOTE
• This error message will be displayed at the following cases. NOTE
Refer to the diagnosis when the error message will be • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
displayed again even though the sensitivity adjustment was
carried out. Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
• The AFC/scanner control PCB was replaced. ☞ 89000
• Backup data cannot be retrieved from the AFC/scanner
control PCB. Wiring diagram [S-4]
• The sensor standard adjustments have not been ☞ 89010
completed properly.
• The name of the film carrier and the sensor to be adjust will be
displayed on the second line of the message.
Check Point
1 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
46410 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46412
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Condition
Failure of the film sensitivity adjustment ☞ 35060
Suffix Condition Failure of 135 DX sensor standard
number adjustment
0001 When adjusting the DX sensor standard, the value of
A/D exceeds 204 with minimum LED Light Intensity
Failed parts Manual No.
Value.
0002 When adjusting the DX sensor standard, the value of
135 DX sensor ☞ 62650
A/D does not exceed 204 with maximum LED Light 135 AFC sensor PCB ☞ 65370
Intensity Value. 135 AFC connecting PCB ☞ 65360
0003 When adjusting the DX sensor standard, the adjusted AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
gain value exceeds 255. Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
0004 When adjusting the DX sensor standard, none Power PCB ☞ 65260
negative level calculated from inserting negative
exceeds 255.
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
0005 When adjusting the sensor LED light intensity, the
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
value does not reach until none negative level
NOTE
although the light intensity value has been maximum.
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46412 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46416
Error message: Film carrier
NOTE
No. 6416-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
240 DX Sensor 1 error.
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
No. 6417-#### ☞ 89000
240 DX Sensor 2 error.
Wiring diagram [S-4]
Countermeasure message ☞ 89010
Clean the sensor with a blower brush. For details, refer to the
manual.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When adjusting the DX sensor standard, the value of
A/D exceeds 204 with minimum LED Light Intensity
4. Troubleshooting
Value.
0002 When adjusting the DX sensor standard, the value of
A/D does not exceed 204 with maximum LED Light
Intensity Value.
0003 When adjusting the DX sensor standard, the adjusted
gain value exceeds 255.
0004 When adjusting the DX sensor standard, none
negative level calculated from inserting negative
exceeds 255.
0005 When adjusting the sensor LED light intensity, the
value does not reach until none negative level
although the light intensity value has been maximum.
Check Point
1 Check that the 240 DX sensor is soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Failure of 240 DX sensor standard ☞ 35000
adjustment
46416 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46422
Error message: Film carrier
NOTE
No. 6423
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Auto focus error.
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
Countermeasure message ☞ 89000
Clean the sensor with a blower brush. For details, refer to the
manual. Wiring diagram [S-4]
Alarm release
NO
☞ 89010
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Even though the auto focus adjustment had been
performed against the mount for a specified time, the
adjustment is failure.
NOTE
4. Troubleshooting
• This message appears only when the 135/240 MMC-II is
attached.
Check Point
1 Check that the film is placed on the mount.
2 Check that the AF sensor and mirror is not soiled.
3 Check that the scanner adjustment chart, emission
adjustment chart and the mount which is processed
normally are not damaged.
4 Check that the mount is processable with MMC.
NOTE
• For confirming the scanner adjustment chart, refer to ☞ 4600.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Check that the light axis of the AF sensor is ☞ 35030
correctly positioned.
When adjusting the height of the mount ☞ 20850
carrier, check that the worm wheel swings
within the tolerance range of 4 mm (± one
tooth).
46422 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46424
Error message: Film carrier
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
0001 When an attempt has been made to move the mount 0001 When the mount insertion cover sensor is ON, the
carrier to the home position, the mount carrier home mount sensor does not turn ON.
sensor does not turn DARK even after the mount 0002 When the mount is to be ejected, the mount sensor
carrier slide motor has rotated for a specified time. does not turn OFF.
0002 When an attempt has been made to move the mount
4. Troubleshooting
carrier from the home position, the mount carrier NOTE
home sensor does not turn LIGHT even after the • This message appears only when the 135/240 MMC-II is
mount carrier slide motor has rotated for a specified attached.
time.
0003 When the mount is to be ejected, the mount insertion Check Point
cover is not opened.
1 Check that the mount insertion cover sensor or the
NOTE mount sensor is not soiled.
• This message appears only when the 135/240 MMC-II is
attached. Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Check Point
Mount insertion cover sensor ☞ 62450
1 Check that the mount carrier home sensor or the Mount sensor
mount carrier end sensor is not soiled.
MMC sensor PCB ☞ 65340
2 Check if the mount unit slides smoothly.
MMC connecting PCB ☞ 65330
Diagnosis
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
Failed parts Manual No. Power PCB ☞ 65260
Mount carrier home sensor ☞ 62450 AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Mount carrier slide motor Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
PM driver (film feed motor) ☞ 65070
MMC connecting PCB ☞ 65330 NOTE
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000 • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060 Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
Power PCB ☞ 65260 ☞ 89000
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060 Wiring diagram [S-4]
☞ 89010
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46424 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46426
Error message: Film carrier
No. 6426
The lane is out of position.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The 135 or 240 lane limit switch turns OFF while the
film is being processed using the 135/240 AFC.
Check Point
1 Check that the lever is set securely and the lane limit
switch is pressed.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Lane limit switch ☞ 62150
• If there is no conduction between pins 1 and 2 (135) or
between pins 1 and 3 (240) on the connector when the lane
limit switch is pressed, the lane limit switch is defective.
Driver PCB 2 ☞ 65240
Connecting PCB 3 ☞ 65220
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46426 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46428
Error message: Film carrier
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
No. 6429-####
System error. (AFC / Scanner control Failed part(s) [S-2/S-3]
4. Troubleshooting
3001 (Occurs only when using S-2/S-3 scanners.) • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
3002 Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
3003 The IRIS operation of scanner unit is abnormal. ☞ 89000
(Occurs only when using S-2/S-3 scanners.)
3004 Focus movement range is mathematically abnormal. Wiring diagram [S-4]
(Occurs only when using S-4 scanner.)
☞ 89010
4000 The communication between the image processing
PCB and AFC/scanner control PCB has some
problems.
4001 The communication between D-ICE control PCB and
AFC/scanner control PCB has some problems.
4002 The communication between the main PC and
AFC/scanner control PCB has some problems.
NOTE
• Suffix numbers for the error message will vary depending on
the error occurring condition. Carry out the corrective actions
according to the following diagnosis for each suffix numbers.
Check Point
Countermeasure Manual No.
When an error occurs due to communication ☞ 35600
error among the suffix numbers above,
upgrade the system.
Diagnosis
Blown fuses Manual No.
F28 AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
46428 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46430
Error message: Film carrier
NOTE
No. 6431
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Auto focus error.
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
Countermeasure message ☞ 89000
Remove the film. For details, refer to the manual.
Alarm release Wiring diagram [S-4]
NO
Error message release
☞ 89010
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Even though the auto focus adjustment had been
performed against the mount for a specified time, the
adjustment is failure.
NOTE
• This message appears only when the 135/240 AMC-II is
4. Troubleshooting
attached.
Check Point
1 Check that the film is placed on the mount.
2 Check that the AF sensor and mirror is not soiled.
3 Check that the scanner adjustment chart, emission
adjustment chart and the mount which is processed
normally are not damaged.
4 Check that the mount is processable with AMC.
NOTE
• For confirming the scanner adjustment chart, refer to ☞ 4600.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Check that the light axis of the AF sensor is ☞ 35040
correctly positioned.
When adjusting the height of the mount ☞ 35040
carrier, check that the worm wheel swings
within the tolerance range of 4 mm (± one
tooth).
46430 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46432
Error message: Film carrier
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
0001 When an attempt has been made to move the mount 0001 Although the mount is fed to the mount carrier from
carrier to the home position, the mount carrier home insert stocker, the mount sensor does not turn ON.
sensor does not turn DARK even after the mount Or, the mount sensor (inlet) is ON in spite of there is
carrier slide motor has rotated for a specified time. no mount.
0002 When an attempt has been made to move the mount 0002 Although the mount is fed to the ejection stocker, the
carrier from the home position, the mount carrier mount sensor does not turn OFF.
4. Troubleshooting
home sensor does not turn LIGHT even after the
mount carrier slide motor has rotated for a specified NOTE
time. • This message appears only when the 135/240 AMC-II is
attached.
NOTE
• This message appears only when the 135/240 AMC-II is Check Point
attached.
1 Check that the mounts are correctly set in the mount
Check Point stocker.
2 Check that the weight of the mount stocker is set.
1 Check if the mount carrier sensor is soiled.
2 Check if the mount unit slides smoothly. Diagnosis
NOTE
☞ 89000
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Wiring diagram [S-4]
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3] ☞ 89010
☞ 89000
46432 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46434
Error message: Film carrier
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
0001 Although the mount sensor (inlet) is not turned ON 0001 Although the mount insertion motor has rotated for a
when the mount is fed to the mount carrier, the mount specified time to return the mount insertion arm to
sensor turns ON. the home position, the insertion sensor 1 does not
turn DARK.
NOTE 0002 Although the mount insertion arm has been moved
• This message appears only when the 135/240 AMC-II is for a specified time from the home position, the
4. Troubleshooting
attached. insertion sensor 1 does not turn LIGHT.
0003 Although the mount insertion arm has been moved to
Check Point the set position, the insertion sensor 2 does not turn
DARK.
1 Check that the mounts are correctly set in the mount
stocker. 0004 Although the mount insertion arm has been moved
for a specified time to return to the home position
2 Check that the weight of the mount stocker is set.
from the set position, the insertion sensor 2 does not
turn LIGHT.
Diagnosis
NOTE
Failed parts Manual No.
• This message appears only when the 135/240 AMC-II is
Mount sensor (inlet) ☞ 62550 attached.
Mount sensor
Mount carrier home sensor Diagnosis
Mount carrier slide motor
Failed parts Manual No.
PM driver (film feed motor) ☞ 65070 Loading sensor 1 ☞ 62550
MMC sensor PCB ☞ 65340 Loading sensor 2
AMC connecting PCB ☞ 65350 Mount carrier home sensor
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000 Mount carrier slide motor
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060 PM driver (film feed motor) ☞ 65070
Power PCB ☞ 65260 AMC connecting PCB ☞ 65350
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010 AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
NOTE Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) Power PCB ☞ 65260
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
☞ 89000 NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Wiring diagram [S-4]
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
☞ 89010
☞ 89000
46434 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46436
Error message: Film carrier
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
0001 The mount elevator sensor does not turn DARK even 0001 The ejection sensor does not turn ON even though the
though the mount elevator motor revolves for a mount ejection solenoid operated and the mount
specified time. moved to the ejection position.
0002 The mount elevator sensor does not turn LIGHT even 0002 The ejection sensor does not turn OFF even though
though the mount elevator motor revolves for a the mount elevator motor revolved and the mount got
specified. out to the ejection stocker.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE NOTE
• This message appears only when the 135/240 AMC-II is • This message appears only when the 135/240 AMC-II is
attached. attached.
NOTE
AMC connecting PCB ☞ 65350
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
Power PCB ☞ 65260
☞ 89000 AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Wiring diagram [S-4] NOTE
☞ 89010 • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46436 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46438
Error message: Film carrier
4. Troubleshooting
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
0008 When ejecting the leader, although the leader is fed
for a specified length after the perforation sensor Sensitivity adjustment failure of the loading ☞ 35060
turned LIGHT, the ready sensor does not turn sensor, ready sensor and perforation sensor
LIGHT.
Failed parts Manual No.
0009 When the leader is ejected, although the leader is fed
for a specified length after the perforation sensor 135 loading sensor ☞ 62650
turned DARK, the ready sensor does not turn DARK. 135 ready sensor
(Unspecified cleaning leader is used.) 135 perforation sensor
0010 When the leader is ejected, although the leader is fed Rewinding sensor
for a specified length after the ready sensor turned
Film feed motor
DARK, the loading sensor does not turn DARK.
(Unspecified cleaning leader is used.) PM driver (film feed motor) ☞ 65070
0011 The rewinding sensor detected the film jam. 135 AFC sensor PCB ☞ 65370
135 AFC connecting PCB ☞ 65360
Check Point AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
1 Check if the loading sensor, ready sensor, perforation
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
sensor, and film ejection sensor are not soiled. Power PCB ☞ 65260
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
Adjustment. Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
Diagnosis NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
135/240 AFC-II
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
☞ 89000
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the loading ☞ 35000
sensor, ready sensor and perforation sensor
Wiring diagram [S-4]
46438 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46438
Error message: Film carrier
No. 6439-####
The film strip is too short for processing.
Countermeasure message
Remove the film from the cartridge and proceed by strip. The film
length is shorter than prescribed. For details, refer to the manual.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When processing the stripped film, the loading sensor
turned LIGHT for a specified time before the ready
sensor detect the detach perforation after the film
feeding started.
4. Troubleshooting
0002 The ready sensor detected the detach perforation
before the last frame of the film is scanned.
NOTE
• This error occurs when the length of the IX240 film rear edge
is shorter than that is required for scanning.
Check Point
1 Check that the processed film has not the detach
perforation near the rear edge or the detach
perforation has not cut.
2 Check that the size A of the processed film indicated
below is not 125 mm or less.
Detach
perforation
G058798
G058799
IMPORTANT
• Process the stripped IX240 cartridge film.
For details, refer to the Troubleshooting Manual.
• If the size A is 125 mm or more, all the frames in the film
can be printed by stripping the film.
• The last few frames of film cannot be printed if the film
size is less than 125 mm.
46438 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46440
Error message: Film carrier
Failed parts Manual No.
No. 6441-#### Loading sensor ☞ 62250
The 120 Cleaning Leader has stopped. Ready sensor
Film sensor
Countermeasure message
Remove the film. For details, refer to the manual. Film feed sensor
Alarm release Film feed motor
NO PM driver (film feed motor) ☞ 65070
Error message release
YES
Connecting PCB (120 AFC-II) ☞ 65290
Sensor PCB (120 AFC-II) ☞ 65300
Condition AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Suffix Condition
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
number Power PCB ☞ 65260
0001 Although the cleaning leader is fed for a specified AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
length since the ready sensor detected the cleaning Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
leader, the film sensor does not turn DARK.
0002 Since the film sensor turned DARK, the signal of the NOTE
film feed sensor (motion detection) does not change • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
while the cleaning leader is being fed for a specified
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
4. Troubleshooting
length.
0003 Although a specified length of leader has been fed
☞ 89000
when ejecting, the film sensor does not turn DARK.
0004 Although a specified length of leader has been fed Wiring diagram [S-4]
since the film sensor turned LIGHT, the ready sensor ☞ 89010
does not turn LIGHT.
0005 Although a specified length of leader has been fed
since ejecting the leader started, the ready sensor
does not turn DARK. (Unspecified cleaning leader is
used.)
0006 When ejecting, although a specified length of leader
has been fed since the ready sensor turned DARK,
the loading sensor does not turn DARK. (Unspecified
cleaning leader is used.)
NOTE
• The specified length of 120 cleaning leader is 400 mm.
• Any cleaning leader which is out of the specification (170 mm
or less) will cause errors.
The suffix number of the possible error is 05.
• Any cleaning leader which is out of the specification (180 mm
or less) will cause errors.
The suffix number of the possible error is 05 or 06.
• Any cleaning leader which is out of the specification (223
mm) will cause errors. The suffix number of the possible error
is 06.
Check Point
1 Check that the loading sensor, ready sensor, film
sensor, and film feed sensor are not soiled.
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
Diagnosis
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the loading ☞ 35010
sensor, ready sensor, film sensor, and film
feed sensor
46440 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46442
Error message: Film carrier
135 AFC-II
No. 6442-####
The perforation of the film may be broken. Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the ☞ 35060
perforation sensor
Countermeasure message
Remove the film and check the perforations and other film
condition. For details, refer to the manual. Failed parts Manual No.
Alarm release 135 perforation sensor ☞ 62650
NO
135 AFC sensor PCB ☞ 65370
Error message release
YES 135 AFC connecting PCB ☞ 65360
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Condition Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
Suffix Condition Power PCB ☞ 65260
number AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
0001 The perforation sensor does not change when a Scanner power supply 1 ☞ 65060
specified length of film is being fed in the pre-
scanning direction. NOTE
0002 The perforation sensor does not change when a • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
specified length of film is being fed in the scanning
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
4. Troubleshooting
direction.
☞ 89000
Check Point
Wiring diagram [S-4]
1 Check that the perforation sensor is not soiled. ☞ 89010
2 Carry out the Sensor LED Light Intensity Value
Adjustment.
Diagnosis
135/240 AFC-ll
Adjustment failure point Manual No.
Sensitivity adjustment failure of the ☞ 35000
perforation sensor
46442 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46444
Error message: Film carrier
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
01 Although it was going to return the move table of The cartridge limit switch (cartridge limit switches 1
MFC to the home position, even if it carried out fixed and 2) turns OFF while the 240 film is being
distance movement, the move table home sensor does processed.
not turn DARK.
02 Although fixed distance movement of the move table Check Point
of MFC was carried out from the home position, the
4. Troubleshooting
move table home sensor does not turn LIGHT. Check the status of the cartridge limit switch by
input check. ☞ 35200
03 During the move table of MFC operates (during
processing the film), the attachment (mask) code is
not detected. Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
NOTE
• This attention message appears when MFC is attached.
Cartridge limit switch 1 or 2 ☞ 62150
Sensor PCB ☞ 65250
Check Point
NOTE
Suffix • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Manual No.
number
Wiring diagrams [S-2/S-3]
01,02 Check the status of Move Table Home Sensor via
Input Check. ☞ 35200 ☞ 89000
Check the operation of Move Table Slide Motor via
Output Check. ☞ 35300 Wiring diagram [S-4]
03 Check the Attachment Detection Switch status via ☞ 89010
input check. ☞ 35200
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Table home sensor ☞ 62660
Table slide motor ☞ 62660
PM driver ☞ 65070
Connecting PCB 2 ☞ 65400
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
AFC/scanner driver PCB ☞ 65010
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46444 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46502
Error message: Disk/Media
Error message: Disk/Media
No. 6503
Formatting could not be executed.
Countermeasure message
Clean the disk drive with a disk cleaner. For details, refer to the
manual.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The format error occurs in the driver controller.
NOTE
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
second line of the message.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
If the attention message above is displayed ☞ 35920
even if the media has been set, carry out the
Media Drive Self-diagnostic.
Media or device displayed in the second line ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
46502 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46504
Error message: Disk/Media
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- When the power supply is turned ON, the backup - The backup data cannot be written to the hard disk.
data recovered from the hard disk cannot be read.
NOTE
NOTE • The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the
• The name of the corresponding media is displayed in the second line of the message.
4. Troubleshooting
second line of the message. HD
HD
Diagnosis
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Failed parts Manual No. HD drive ☞ 88000
HD drive ☞ 88000 ATX mother board
ATX mother board ATX power supply
ATX power supply
NOTE
NOTE • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
Circuit diagram ☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram ☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram ☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
46504 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46506
Error message: Disk/Media
No. 6506-####
Hard disk is full. Delete the unnecessary
image file(s).
Countermeasure message
Refer to the manual for corrective action.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
• Select NO to bring up the File Delete dialog box. Delete
unnecessary files in the hard disk.
• Select PASS to stop the operation.
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 When the power supply is turned on or the data is to
be written to the hard disk, the free space of hard disk
drive is below 4 GB.
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
• The name of the corresponding drive is displayed in the third
line of the message.
C:
• Read only files will not be deleted.
Check Point
1 Delete unnecessary files.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
HD drive ☞ 88000
ATX mother board
ATX power supply
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
46506 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46550
Error message: Colorimeter
Error message: Colorimeter
No. 6551-####
Paper has jammed in the Colorimeter Unit.
Countermeasure message
Remove the paper. For details, refer to the manual.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Although a specified length of paper is fed to lead the
front end of the paper, paper sensor 2 does not turn
DARK.
0002 When paper is being fed in paper advance operation,
paper sensor 2 turns LIGHT.
0003 When ejecting paper, paper sensor 2 does not turn
4. Troubleshooting
LIGHT although a specified length of paper is fed to
lead the front end of the paper.
Check Point
1 Check that a short test print has not been inserted.
2 Clean the advance rollers of the colorimeter with a
cleaning sheet.
3 Carry out each correction via Colorimeter Unit
Adjustment.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Paper sensor 1 or 2 ☞ 61000
Paper advance motor
Colorimeter Control PCB ☞ 64130
ATX mother board ☞ 88000
Colorimeter unit ☞ 21110
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit
46550 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46552
Error message: Colorimeter
No. 6552-####
Backup data error. Colorimeter Unit
Countermeasure message
Load backup data from the floppy disk. For details, refer to the
manual.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The backup data for the colorimeter control PCB is
not found or the data is abnormal. (when the backup
data is not stored in the HD of the computer.)
0002 The backup data for the colorimeter control PCB is
not found or the data is abnormal. (when the backup
4. Troubleshooting
data is stored in the HD of the computer.)
NOTE
• The name of the corresponding CPU PCB will be displayed in
the second line of the message.
• Backup data is saved on an EEPROM mounted on the PCB
and is not lost even if the system power is turned OFF for an
extended period of time.
• The message with suffix number 0002 appears after the
colorimeter control PCB was replaced. Clearing the error by
selecting NO reads the backup data of the paper front end
advance length correction and feed error correction from the
hard disk to the colorimeter control PCB.
Diagnosis
When the data is erased Manual No.
Carry out Reading data. ☞ 35400
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit
46552 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46554
Error message: Colorimeter
No. 6554-####
Calibration Plate advance error.
Countermeasure message
Remove the paper. For details, refer to the manual.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 Although the calibration plate has been fed for a
specified length, paper sensor 2 dose not turn DARK.
0002 When the calibration plate is being fed, paper sensor
1 turns LIGHT from DARK.
0003 In initial operation, although a specified length of
moving to the home position was attempted to the
4. Troubleshooting
calibration plate, paper sensors 1 and 2 do not turn
LIGHT.
0004 When the calibration plate is being fed, paper sensor
1 turns LIGHT.
0005 Although the calibration plate has been fed for a
specified length, paper sensor 2 dose not turn DARK.
0006 Although the calibration plate has been fed for a
specified length, paper sensor 1 dose not turn DARK.
Check Point
1 Check if the calibration plate is set correctly.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Paper sensor 1 or 2 ☞ 61000
Paper advance motor
Colorimeter Control PCB ☞ 64130
ATX mother board ☞ 88000
Colorimeter unit ☞ 21110
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit
46554 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46600
Error message: Pricing unit
Error message: Pricing unit
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- The communication between the PU control PCB and 0001 Although a specified time has passed since printing
the pricing unit is not carried out normally. started, printing is not completed.
0002 Since excessive communication data is sent to the
NOTE 0003 pricing unit, the printing operation is delayed.
• Depending on type of the pricing unit, the suffix number is 0004
4. Troubleshooting
different. 0005 Even after a specified time has passed since the data
Suffix Type was transmitted to the personal computer, no signal is
number returned.
0002 Type A
NOTE
Bar code pricing unit • Depending on type of the pricing unit, the suffix number is
0003 Type B different.
Card printer pricing unit
Suffix Type
0004 Type C number
Bar code pricing unit 0001 Standard
Pricing Unit
0002 Type A
Check Point
Bar code pricing unit
1 Check that the pricing unit power supply is ON.
0003 Type B
Card printer pricing unit
Diagnosis
0004 Type C
Blown fuses Manual No. Bar code pricing unit
F15 PU control PCB ☞ 64140 0005 Type D
For PC output
Failed parts Manual No.
PU control PCB ☞ 64140
ARCNET-HUB PCB ☞ 64100 Diagnosis
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000 Blown fuses Manual No.
Desk power supply 2 ☞ 64170 F15 PU control PCB ☞ 64140
NOTE
Failed parts Manual No.
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
PU control PCB ☞ 64140
Circuit diagram ARCNET-HUB PCB ☞ 64100
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2) Desk power supply 2 ☞ 64170
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-3 Pricing Unit
46600 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46600
Error message: Pricing unit
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-3 Pricing Unit
4. Troubleshooting
46600 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46602
Error message: Pricing unit
4. Troubleshooting
0003 Type B NOTE
• The value informed from CPU is displayed in the last three
Card printer pricing unit
digits of the suffix number.
NOTE • If approximately 5 days have passed with the power supply
• Depending on type of the pricing unit, the suffix number is being OFF or if the PU control PCB has been replaced with a
different. new one, this error message will appear.
• When the pricing unit specification via Machine Specification
Diagnosis
is set to Not in use, this error does not occur.
When the data is erased Manual No.
Diagnosis Carry out Reading data. ☞ 35400
Blown fuses Manual No.
F15 PU control PCB ☞ 64140 Failed parts Manual No.
PU control PCB ☞ 64140
Failed parts Manual No.
NOTE
Printer -
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
PU control PCB ☞ 64140
ARCNET-HUB PCB ☞ 64100 Circuit diagram
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-3 Pricing Unit
46602 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46640
Error message: D-ICE control
Error message: D-ICE control
4. Troubleshooting
0501 The buffer memory for interrupting on the D-ICE Carry out Focus Adjustment. ☞ 37020
PCB overflowed.
1### The focus adjustment data was abnormal. Failed parts Manual No.
22## Communication with the D-ICE control PCB was D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
23## abnormal.
D-ICE PCB ☞ 64040
4000 When starting up the D-ICE control PCB, conditions ARCNET-HUB PCB ☞ 64100
of the D-ICE PCB was abnormal.
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
4100 Deleting data in the flash ROM on the D-ICE control
PCB failed.
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
4101 Writing data in the flash ROM on the D-ICE control
PCB failed. Failed parts
4200 Registering data in the flash ROM on the D-ICE Refer to 4201 ☞ D−ICE control PCB.
control PCB stopped. Refer to 4201 ☞ D−ICE PCB.
4201 Abnormal registered data was found in data
registering in the flash ROM on the D-ICE control
PCB. NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
8000 The condition of the D-ICE PCB was abnormal.
Circuit diagram
The third digit of suffix numbers (1###)
☞ - System connection diagram
The third digit indicates the film carrier where the focus adjustment
data error is generated.
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
Suffix Film carrier
number
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
11## 135/240 AFC-II (135 lane), 135 AFC
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
12## 240/240 AFC-II (135 lane)
13## 110 AFC-II
14## 120 AFC-II
15## 135/240 MMC-II
16## 135/240 AMC-II
46640 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46640
Error message: D-ICE control
NOTE
No. 6641-####
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Backup Data error. D-ICE Control PCB
Circuit diagram
Countermeasure message ☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
Load backup data from the floppy disk. For details, refer to the ☞ CS 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
manual. ☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
IMPORTANT ☞ CS 2-1 Control section
• If the error message above appears, it cannot be
canceled for approx. 5 to 10 minutes unitl the Order
Display is displayed.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
4. Troubleshooting
0### The backup data of the D-ICE control PCB is
abnormal.
1### The backup data of the system HDD and the D-ICE
control PCB are abnormal.
NOTE
• The value informed from CPU is displayed in the last three
digits of the suffix number.
• This error message appears when the D-ICE control is
replaced with a new one.
• When the data is written to the flash memory of D-ICE control
PCB, the power supply of QSS is turned OFF or the QSS
system is shut down.
During the Light Source Registration or Light Source Update,
the power supply of QSS is turned OFF or the QSS system is
shut down.
IMPORTANT
• If the error message above appears, the backup data for
the D-ICE control PCB saved in HDD is sent to the D-
ICE control PCB within approx. 5 to 10 minutes while the
error cannot be canceled.
After the completion of sending the backup data, the
error above can be canceled.
However, the backup data saved in HDD may have a
problem. If the error above occurs, we recommend
reading the backup data saved in a media at the close
down check.
Diagnosis
Countermeasure Manual No.
Read the backup data saved in a media at the ☞ 35400
close down check.
46640 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46642
Error message: D-ICE control
Condition Condition
Condition Condition
The D-ICE PCB had some problems while D-ICE control PCB Digital Masking Unit in Operator Selections is (with a
are communicating with the D-ICE PCB. check mark) but it has some problems when starting up or
upgrading the software.
Suffix Condition
number Suffix Condition
0001 The data that D-ICE PCB received from the scanner number
is too small or too large. 0001 Digital Masking Unit could not be detected.
4. Troubleshooting
0002 The D-ICE PCB attempted to send image data to the 0002 Digital Masking Unit was abnormal.
image processing PCB but the image processing PCB
is not in receiving condition. NOTE
0003 The D-ICE PCB is abnormal. • When the check mark of Digital Masking Unit in Operator
0004 The communication between D-ICE PCB and D-ICE Selections is removed, this error does not occur.
control PCB has some problems.
Diagnosis
0005 The data that D-ICE control PCB received from D-
ICE PCB has some problems. Failed parts Manual No.
0006 D-ICE PCB has some problems when performing D-ICE PCB ☞ 64040
self-diagnosis.
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
Data change-over PCB ☞ 64080
Diagnosis
Scratch mend PCB 1 ☞ 64070
Failed parts Manual No. Scratch mend PCB 2 ☞ 64060
When the error message above appears, carry ☞ 35920 DIMM ☞ 64050
out Image Path Check (Film Series Image
Path) of Self-diagnostic.
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
D-ICE PCB ☞ 64040
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030 Failed parts
Image processing PCB ☞ 64000 Refer to 4201 ☞ D−ICE control PCB.
Scanner unit ☞ 20610 Refer to 4201 ☞ D−ICE PCB.
Refer to 4201 ☞ DIMM.
NOTE Refer to 4201 ☞ Scratch mend PCB 2.
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) Refer to 4201 ☞ Scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A].
Circuit diagram Refer to 4201 ☞ Data change-over PCB.
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1) NOTE
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2) • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
46642 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46802
Error message: Software upgrade
Error message: Software upgrade
No. 6803
Language version of message data is
incorrect. Message display in English.
Countermeasure message
Upgrade software again. If this error recurs, contact us or your
place of purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
YES
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- When the power supply is turned ON or when the
language of the machine specification is to be
changed, the selected language does not appear.
4. Troubleshooting
Diagnosis
Countermeasure Manual No.
Upgrade the system program. ☞ 35600
46802 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46822
Error message: Image processing PCB
Error message: Image processing PCB
Suffix Condition
No. 6822-#### number
Image Processing PCB Image data 0012 Processing does not end in a specified time when
operation error. transferring the image data to the main PC via the
image correction PCB from the main PC.
Countermeasure message 0013 Processing does not end in a specified time when
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of writing data to the expanded memory from the CPU
purchase. on the image processing PCB.
Alarm release 0014 Processing does not end in a specified time when
NO writing data to the composite memory from the CPU
Error message release on the image processing PCB.
NO
0020 The data size that is received in the input memory on
the image processing PCB via LVDS does not agree
Condition
with the data size that is notified by ARCNET.
Suffix Condition 0021 The image data received by the input memory on
number image processing PCB from the scanner unit via
0001 Processing does not end in a specified time when LVDS and the image information received by the
transferring the image data to the expanded memory image processing PCB from the AFC/scanner control
on the image processing PCB via the image PCB via ARCNET do not match.
correction PCB from the input memory on the image 0022 The data was expanded in the expanded memory on
4. Troubleshooting
processing PCB. the image processing PCB from the input memory on
0002 Processing does not end in a specified time when the image processing PCB but the size does not
transferring the image data to the main PC via LVDS agree.
from the input memory on the image processing 0023 The data was received in the expanded memory on
PCB. the image processing PCB from the main PC but the
0003 Processing does not end in a specified time when size does not agree.
transferring the image data to the main PC via the 0024 The data was received in the composite memory on
image correction PCB and then LVDS from the input the image processing PCB from the main PC but the
memory on the image processing PCB. size does not agree.
0004 Transferring does not end in a specified time when 0025 The data was written to the expanded memory from
transferring the image data from the expanded CPU on the image processing PCB but the size does
memory on the image processing PCB to the laser not agree.
control PCB. 0026 The data was written to the composite memory from
0005 Transferring does not end in a specified time when CPU on the image processing PCB but the size does
transferring the image data to the main PC via LVDS not agree.
from the expanded memory on the image processing 0027 From the main PC, 1 frame magnification was
PCB. performed to the main PC but the size does not agree.
0006 Transferring does not end in a specified time when 0040 The communication with the image correction PCB
transferring the image data to the CD-R external has some problems.
writing system via LVDS from the expanded memory
on the image processing PCB. 0050 CMS data is abnormal.
0007 Processing does not end in a specified time when 0060 Undefined error
transferring the image data to the input memory on 0061 Does not occur normally.
the image processing PCB via LVDS from the main 0062
PC.
0063
0008 Processing does not end in a specified time when
0070 The data was resent to the CD-R external writing
transferring the image data to the expanded memory
system more than three times.
on the image processing PCB via LVDS and then the
image correction PCB from the main PC. 0071 The notification that data resending to the CD-R
external writing system was completed was sent more
0009 Processing does not end in a specified time when
than three times.
transferring the image data to the composite memory
on the image processing PCB via LVDS and then the NOTE
image correction PCB from the main PC. • Although the suffix numbers for these error messages vary
0010 Processing does not end in a specified time when depending on the error occurring conditions, the corrective
transferring the image data to the input memory on action should be taken according to the following check point
the image processing PCB via the D-ICE PCB from and diagnosis.
the scanner unit.
Target PCB
0011 Processing does not end in a specified time when
transferring the image data to the main PC via the D- Symbol Object
ICE PCB from the scanner unit. A Image processing PCB
46822 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46822
Error message: Image processing PCB
4. Troubleshooting
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
0007 $ $
0008 $ $ $ Failed parts
0009 $ $ Refer to 4200 ☞ Scanner unit.
0010 $ $ $ Refer to 4201 ☞ Image processing PCB.
0011 $ $ $ $ Refer to 4201 ☞ Image correction PCB.
0012 $ $ $ Refer to 4201 ☞ D−ICE PCB.
0013 $ Refer to 4202 ☞ Laser control PCB.
0014 $
0020 $ $ NOTE
0021 $ $ $ • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
0022 $ $ Circuit diagram
0023 $ $ $ ☞ CS 1-1 AC Power supply circuit diagram
0024 $ $ ☞ CS 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1)
0025 $ ☞ CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2)
0026 $ ☞ CS 2-1 Control section
0027 $ $ $ ☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
0040 $ $
0050 $
0070 $
0071 $
IMPORTANT
• This error may occur when the ARCNET communication
status is abnormal.
If the error occurs, check the following items.
• Check the communication status of the ARCNET on the
Version Check display.
☞ 37530
• Check the ARCNET communication path.
☞ 50520
46822 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46900
Error: Main
Error: Main
Diagnosis
No. 6900-####
The countermeasure action and the failed part would differ
Main control system error. depending on the suffix number (bit).
4. Troubleshooting
number
(bit) Suffix
0001 ARCNET or LVDS cannot be used. number Failed parts Manual No.
(bit)
0002 There is not enough memory, failed to operate.
0004 There is no initial data file.
0040 Hard disk (for system) ☞ 88000
0080
0008 It loses one frame of the scanned images (0 frame). 0200
0010 The temporary file can not be made. 0800
0020 The number of scanned images is too many. 0001 D-ICE PCB ☞ 64030
0040 Check the error of the backup data. Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
0080 Check the error of the backup data. PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
0100 Communication error between tasks 0001 Image processing PCB ☞ 64000
0200 The backup file of the frame format cannot be found. 0008
0020
0400 The data base file of the archive is damaged.
0008 Scanner unit ☞ 20610
0800 The data mainly processed is not consistent.
0020
1000 When writing the data to the input media like MO,
1000 Each media drive ☞ 88000
the image data is not written normally.
NOTE
NOTE
• If the failed part is on the PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB, check
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
the setting of DS1.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002 # Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
Failed parts
Check Point Refer to 4201 ☞ Image processing PCB.
1 Reset the power supply. Refer to 4201 ☞ D−ICE control PCB.
2 Read the data of the machine. Refer to 4202 ☞ Laser control PCB.
☞ 35400
3 When recurs, get the log data. NOTE
☞ 37500 • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46900 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46900
Error: Main
Diagnosis
No. 6901-####
ARCNET communication error. Failed parts Manual No.
Check the cause of failure in System Version ☞ 37530
Check at the No. 6901 ARCNET
Countermeasure message
communication error.
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase. Perform the diagnosis of ARCNET ☞ 50520
Alarm release communication error.
NO
Error message release Failed parts Manual No.
NO
ARCNET cable -
4. Troubleshooting
Suffix PCB ARCNET-HUB PCB ☞ 64100
number PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
(bit)
Multi power supply (scanner) ☞ 65060
0001 Printer control PCB
Power PCB ☞ 64160
0008 Processor control PCB
Desk power supply 1 ☞ 64170
0010 AFC/scanner control PCB
Desk power supply 2
0080 Image processing PCB
Multi power supply (printer) ☞ 66100
0100 PU control PCB
Processor power supply 1 ☞ 67400
0200 Laser control PCB
CD-R writing system -
0800 CD-R writing system
d-Storage -
1000 d-Storage
2000 D-ICE control PCB # Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
• When this error occurs, the operation may not be Refer to 4200 ☞ AFC/scanner control PCB.
continued. It is necessary to reset the power supply of Refer to 4200 ☞ Multi power supply (scanner) (PS3).
QSS. Refer to 4201 ☞ Image processing PCB.
• The PCB without reference to the error may be Refer to 4201 ☞ D−ICE control PCB.
displayed in the second line depending on the equipped
Refer to 4201 ☞ Power PCB.
options, cable connecting position and/or ARCNET
communication feature. Refer to 4201 ☞ Desk power supply 1.
Check the ARCNET communication path other than the Refer to 4201 ☞ Desk power supply 2.
displayed PCB. Refer to 4202 ☞ Printer control PCB.
☞ 50520 Refer to 4202 ☞ Laser control PCB.
• Check the communication status of the ARCNET on the
Refer to 4202 ☞ Multi power supply (printer) (PS4).
Version Check display.
☞ 37530 Refer to 4203 ☞ Processor control PCB.
Refer to 4203 ☞ Processor power supply 1 (PS1).
NOTE
• The name of PCB where the error arises will be displayed in
Failed part(s) [S-4]
the second line of the message.
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
☞ 4190
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display. NOTE
☞ 4002 • Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
46900 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46900
Error: Main
4. Troubleshooting
46900 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46902
Error: Main
4. Troubleshooting
number
0002 Image processing PCB (bit)
0001 Between the ATX mother board and the colorimeter
NOTE control PCB
• The name of PCB where the error arises will be displayed in 0002 Between the colorimeter and the colorimeter control
the second line of the message. PCB
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to NOTE
Suffix number display. • The name of PCB where the error arises will be displayed in
☞ 4002 the second line of the message.
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
Diagnosis For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Failed parts Manual No. Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Image processing PCB ☞ 64000 Diagnosis
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
Failed parts Manual No.
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring Check the communication status of the ☞ 37530
colorimeter unit in System Version Check at
Failed parts No. 6901 ARCNET communication error.
Refer to 4201 ☞ Image processing PCB.
Failed parts Manual No.
NOTE Serial cable -
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references) Colorimeter Control PCB ☞ 64130
Circuit diagram
ATX mother board ☞ 88000
☞ - System connection diagram Colorimeter unit ☞ 21110
☞ CS 2-1 Control section Power PCB ☞ 64160
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting Desk power supply 2 ☞ 64170
☞ S 1-7 Around ARCNET and LVDS
# Symptoms due to the connection failure of wiring
Failed parts
Refer to 4201 ☞ Colorimeter Control PCB.
Refer to 4201 ☞ Power PCB.
Refer to 4201 ☞ Desk power supply 2.
46902 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46902
Error: Main
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
☞ CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit
4. Troubleshooting
46902 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46906
Error: Main
Diagnosis
No. 6906-####
Failed to change the mode. Enter to the Failed parts Manual No.
Condition NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Condition
Circuit diagram
Each control PCB does not return any signal when the mode is
changed. ☞ - System connection diagram
4. Troubleshooting
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
The first figure of suffix number:
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
The mode which you are going to bring up is displayed.
☞ S 1-7 Around ARCNET and LVDS
Suffix PCB ☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
number
(bit)
☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
1### Normal mode
2### Input/Output mode
3### Setup mode
4### Adjustment mode
5### Start Up Checks mode
6### Close Down Checks mode
7### Program timer mode
8### Input Check mode
F### Unknown
NOTE
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
46906 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46906
Error: Main
No. 6907-####
The file was not found.
Countermeasure message
Contact us or your place of purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- The required file for setup does not exist.
NOTE
• The file name where the error arises will be displayed in the
second line of the message.
4. Troubleshooting
• Although the suffix numbers for these error messages will
vary depending on the error occurring conditions, the
corrective action should be taken according to the following
diagnosis.
Diagnosis
Countermeasure Manual No.
Upgrade the system program. ☞ 35600
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
46906 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46908
Error: Main
Condition
☞ - System connection diagram
When the processing command is given, each CPU does not
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
return any signal. ☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
The communication error occurs temporarily because of the ☞ S 1-7 Around ARCNET and LVDS
instant power failure. ☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
Suffix PCB
4. Troubleshooting
number
(bit)
0001 Printer control PCB
0008 Processor control PCB
0010 AFC/scanner control PCB
0080 Image processing PCB
0100 PU control PCB
0200 Laser control PCB
0800 CD-R writing system
1000 d-Storage
2000 D-ICE control PCB
4000 Image correction PCB
8000 Colorimeter Control PCB
NOTE
• The target CPU PCB or the CPU in the affected unit will be
displayed in the second line of the message.
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Check Point
1 Reset the power supply.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
ARCNET cable -
Printer control PCB ☞ 66000
Processor control PCB ☞ 66200
AFC/scanner control PCB ☞ 65000
Image processing PCB ☞ 64000
PU control PCB ☞ 64140
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
D-ICE control PCB ☞ 64030
46908 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46908
Error: Main
No. 6909-####
CPU was reset. Abort the process.
Countermeasure message
Enter the Close Down Checks display, and select Power OFF from
Functions. Then turn off the circuit breaker and turn on again.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Condition
The CPU is reset due to power failure.
Suffix PCB
number
(bit)
4. Troubleshooting
0080 Image processing PCB
0200 Laser control PCB
NOTE
• The target CPU PCB or the CPU in the affected unit will be
displayed in the second line of the message.
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Check Point
1 Reset the power supply.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Image processing PCB ☞ 64000
Laser control PCB ☞ 66010
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ - System connection diagram
☞ CS 2-1 Control section
☞ LP 2-3 Around printer control PCB
☞ LP 2-9 Around laser unit
46908 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46912
Error: Main
No. 6913-####
System was shut down forcibly. Restart
the system.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Condition
System has shut down forcibly while processing.
NOTE
• Although the suffix numbers for these error messages will
vary depending on the error occurring conditions, the
4. Troubleshooting
corrective action should be taken according to the message.
Check Point
1 Reset the power supply.
2 Check whether there is any error concurred with, take
a corrective action, when the error has occurred.
46912 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46916
Error: Main
No. 6916-####
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB control error.
Countermeasure message
Enter the Close Down Checks display, and select Power OFF from
Functions. Then restart the personal computer.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Condition
An error occurred at the diagnostic check of the PCI-
LVDS/ARCNET PCB.
Suffix Condition
number
(bit)
4. Troubleshooting
0001 Standard PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB
0002 PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB for Compact Archive
Unit (option)
NOTE
• Suffix number is displayed with the total of the bit operation.
For details about how to determine the condition, refer to
Suffix number display.
☞ 4002
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Wiring diagram
☞ 89000
46916 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46918
Error: Main
No. 6918-####
Failed to start the DLS.
Countermeasure message
Restart the system. If this error recurs, contact your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 The signal of starting failure from DLS has been
notified to QSS.
0002 The signal of completing starting from DLS has not
been notified to QSS although a specified time has
passed.
4. Troubleshooting
Check Point
1 Restart the system.
Diagnosis
1. Save the log data of DLS.
☞ 37600
2. Restart the system.
3. If it does not work out, reinstall the DLS software.
☞ 88000
4. If it does not work out, execute the recovery.
☞ 88000
46918 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
46922
Error: Main
No. 6922-####
Device control error.
Countermeasure message
Clear this error. If this error recurs, contact us or your place of
purchase.
Alarm release
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
0001 An error of Windows about the USB flash memory is
detected using the self-diagnostic function of the
main control system.
Check Point
4. Troubleshooting
1 Confirm whether the USB flash memory is not being
removed during reading data from the USB flash
memory.
2 Failure in the USB flash memory
3 Reset the power supply.
Diagnosis
Countermeasure Manual No.
Failure in the USB Flash Memory ☞ 88000
Compatible Kit
Upgrade the system program. ☞ 35600
46922 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
48360
Error: Compact Archive Unit
Error: Compact Archive Unit
No. 8361
Archive File read error.
Countermeasure message
Refer to the manual for corrective action.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Suffix Condition
number
- Reading image data is failed while printing from the
compact archive unit.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
4. Troubleshooting
Hard disk drive ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
48360 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
48362
Error: Compact Archive Unit
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
- Writing data is failed while saving the image to the - Cannot communicate with the Compact Archive Unit
compact archive unit. (TYPE2) in order to save to, or print from the
Compact Archive Unit (TYPE2).
Diagnosis
NOTE
Failed parts Manual No. • This message appears only in the case of Compact Archive
4. Troubleshooting
Hard disk drive ☞ 88000 Unit (TYPE2).
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting 2 If this occurs while using the QSS-Kids, check the
connection between the QSS-Kids and the machine.
3 Initialize the Compact Archive Unit (TYPE2).
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Hard disk drive ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
48362 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
48364
Error: Compact Archive Unit
No. 8364
Compact Archive Unit cannot be used.
Countermeasure message
Contact us or your place of purchase.
Alarm release
NO
Error message release
NO
Condition
Condition
Compact Archive Unit cannot be used at the start-up of QSS or
when reading back-up data.
Suffix Condition
number
0001 There is no hard disk drive available for use.
4. Troubleshooting
0002 There is only one PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB (for
TYPE1 only).
0003 The hard disk drive has not been formatted.
0004 The capacity of the hard disk drive has become below
the lower limit.
Check Point
1 Reset Option Registration of the Compact Archive
Unit (TYPE2) and reset the power supply.
Restart the machine, carry out Option Registration
again, and check.
Diagnosis
Failed parts Manual No.
Hard disk drive ☞ 88000
NOTE
• Electrical circuit diagram(s) (references)
Circuit diagram
☞ CS 1-4 PC power source circuit diagram
☞ CS 2-2 PC connecting
48364 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
49000
Error message: Edit
Error message: Edit
Condition Condition
Suffix Condition Suffix Condition
number number
0001 There is no .dll in Windows 2000. 0001 The image insertion information is defective when
0002 AlhpaBlend function is not supported in Windows reading an information file in the Edit mode.
2000. 0002 The letter information is defective when reading an
0003 The image information file is broken when entering information file in the Edit mode.
in image editing mode. 0003 There is an unknown information data when reading
4. Troubleshooting
0004 There is not the image information file when entering information file extend data in the Edit mode.
in image editing mode.
NOTE
0005 Making data for frame printing is failed.
• This message appears when reading an information file in the
0006 The contents of PSD file is defective when entering Edit mode.
in image editing mode.
0007 Changing the size of template image is failed when Check Point
entering in image editing mode.
0008 Changing the magnification of inserted image data is 1 Check if the information file is not broken in the
failed. template information correction screen.
0009 Reading the letter information file in the template 2 Install the option template again.
selection display is failed.
0010 Reading phrase data is failed.
0011 The contents of PSD file is defective when entering
the information file correction display.
0012 Changing the size of template image is failed when
entering the information file correction display.
0013 Opening the file is failed.
0014 Memory mapping is failed.
NOTE
• This message appears when operating in the Edit mode.
Diagnosis
Countermeasure Manual No.
Upgrade the system program. ☞ 35600
Install the QSS software again. ☞ 88000
Carry out the recovery.
49000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
49002
Error message: Edit
4. Troubleshooting
NOTE
0005 Reading PSD image file is failed.
• This message appears when reading an image in the Edit
0006 There is not the image file to insert. mode.
0007 Reading image file to insert is failed.
0008 The layer information to read image is defective. Check Point
0009 Reading Bitmap file in the preview screen is failed. 1 Make the image data again.
0010 Reading thumbnail file in the template selection
screen is failed. Diagnosis
0011 Writing thumbnail file in the template selection
screen is failed. Countermeasure Manual No.
0012 There is not a file when receiving the template file Upgrade the system program. ☞ 35600
name. Install the QSS software again. ☞ 88000
NOTE
• This message appears when operating in the Edit mode.
Check Point
1 Check if the corrective image data is selected.
2 Carry out the operation using another image data.
Diagnosis
Countermeasure Manual No.
Upgrade the system program. ☞ 35600
Install the QSS software again. ☞ 88000
49002 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
5000
5. Operation sequence
5 Operation sequence
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification) ................................................................................... 50800
Data flow around the DLS System Management Software [DLS specification] ..............................................50800
Data flow in printing [DLS specification] .........................................................................................................50810
Data flow in data saving [DLS specification] ...................................................................................................50820
Data flow in the image processing PCB [DLS specification] ...........................................................................50830
Data flow in the D-ICE PCB [DLS specification] ............................................................................................50840
Film carrier section .............................................................................................................. 51010
Film feed operation (135) ..................................................................................................................................51010
Film feed operation (240) ..................................................................................................................................51110
Film feed operation (120) ..................................................................................................................................51310
Film feed operation (110) ..................................................................................................................................51410
Film feed operation (MMC) ..............................................................................................................................51510
Film advance operation (AMC) .........................................................................................................................51550
Paper path diagram ............................................................................................................. 55000
Paper path diagram ............................................................................................................................................55000
Paper advance operation .................................................................................................... 55100
Paper supply operation (loading operation) .......................................................................................................55100
Paper supply operation (arm unit 1 operation) ..................................................................................................55200
Exposure advance operation ..............................................................................................................................55300
Paper advance operation (paper advance unit 1 operation) ...............................................................................55400
Paper advance operation (paper advance unit 2 operation) ...............................................................................55500
Paper rewind operation ......................................................................................................................................55600
Paper splicing operation ....................................................................................................................................55700
Paper end operation ...........................................................................................................................................55800
Fogged paper operation .....................................................................................................................................55900
Processor paper advance operation .................................................................................... 56100
Processor paper advance operation ....................................................................................................................56100
5000 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
5000
5 Operation sequence
5000 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50500
Starting up/Closing down Operation
Starting up/Closing down Operation
Startup sequence
1. The program timer goes off or you press the manual sorter switch.
G070717
5. Operation sequence
• The processor control PCB turns ON the relay (X10) of the processor relay PCB.
• See the Wiring diagram.
7. The D-ICE control PCB turns on the power supply of the built-in personal computer.
• The power is supplied to each part of the PC to start it up.
50500 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50500
Starting up/Closing down Operation
When the backup data in the hard disk drive is not normal
• No. 6900: Main control system error.
☞ 46900
10. Check the communication status between the main software and each control PCB.
• After the backup data is checked, the machine checks the communication status between control PCBs.
• The checking order is shown below.
1. Processor control PCB
2. D-ICE control PCB
3. AFC/scanner control PCB
4. PU control PCB*1
5. Image processing PCB
6. Printer control PCB
7. Laser control PCB
8. CD-R writing system*1
9. d-Storage*1
10. Colorimeter Control PCB*2
*1. The machine checks the communication status of the PCBs only when these options are registered for Option Registration.
*2. The machine does not check the communication status of the colorimeter control PCB in ARCNET communication but in Serial
communication. Then regardless of the other control PCBs' communication orders, the machine checks the colorimeter control PCB when
the main software starts up.
5. Operation sequence
NOTE
• Even if error occurs in the D-ICE control PCB while the main software is checking the communication status of the control
PCBs, the main software checks the communication status of the control PCBs in order of communication status checking.
When the colorimeter control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6903: Serial communication error.
☞ 46902
NOTE
• After the communication between the main software and colorimeter control PCB became normal, backup data is written to
the colorimeter control PCB from the hard disk drive.
When the processor control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0008: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
When the D-ICE control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-2000: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
When the AFC/scanner control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0010: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
When the PU control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0100: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
When the image processing PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0080: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
When the printer control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0001: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
NOTE
• After the communication between the main software and each control PCB became normal, backup data is written to the
printer control PCB from the hard disk drive.
50500 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50500
Starting up/Closing down Operation
5. Operation sequence
• The machine shows the display of the temperature adjustment when the NO key is pressed.
12. It displays the message The processing solution temperatures are being adjusted.
50500 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50500
Starting up/Closing down Operation
21. After all temperature adjustments are completed, the message Would you like to proceed to the
operation mode? appears.
NOTE
• When the circuit breaker is started after it has been turned on, this message will not appear.
23. It displays Do not vibrate the machine. Vibration affects print quality..
5. Operation sequence
50500 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50501
Starting up/Closing down Operation
1. The program timer goes off or you press the manual sorter switch.
G070717
5. Operation sequence
• The processor control PCB turns ON the relay (X10) of the processor relay PCB.
• See the Wiring diagram.
7. The D-ICE control PCB turns on the power supply of the built-in personal computer.
• The power is supplied to each part of the PC to start it up.
50501
Starting up/Closing down Operation
10. Check the status of backup data on the hard disk drive.
• When starting the main software, the status of backup data of each control PCB in the hard disk drive is checked.
When the backup data in the hard disk drive is not normal
• No. 6900: Main control system error.
☞ 46900
11. Check the communication status between the main software and each control PCB.
• After the backup data is checked, the machine checks the communication status between control PCBs.
• The checking order is shown below.
1. Processor control PCB
2. D-ICE control PCB
3. AFC/scanner control PCB
4. Image processing PCB
5. Printer control PCB
6. Laser control PCB
7. Colorimeter Control PCB*1
*1. The machine does not check the communication status of the colorimeter control PCB in ARCNET communication but in Serial
communication. Then regardless of the other control PCBs' communication orders, the machine checks the colorimeter control PCB when
the main software starts up.
5. Operation sequence
NOTE
• Even if error occurs in the D-ICE control PCB while the main software is checking the communication status of the control
PCBs, the main software checks the communication status of the control PCBs in order of communication status checking.
When the colorimeter control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6903: Serial communication error.
☞ 46902
NOTE
• After the communication between the main software and colorimeter control PCB became normal, backup data is written to
the colorimeter control PCB from the hard disk drive.
When the processor control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0008: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
When the D-ICE control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-2000: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
When the AFC/scanner control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0010: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
When the image processing PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0080: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
When the printer control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0001: ARCNET communication error.
☞ 46900
NOTE
• After the communication between the main software and each control PCB became normal, backup data is written to the
printer control PCB from the hard disk drive.
• After writing the backup data, the printer will be initialized.
When the laser control PCB does not start normally
• No. 6901-0200: ARCNET communication error.
50501 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50501
Starting up/Closing down Operation
☞ 46900
NOTE
• After the communication between the main software and the laser control PCB became normal, backup data is written to the
laser control PCB from the hard disk drive.
• After writing the backup data, the temperature in the laser unit will be controlled.
13. The process for starting DLS System Management Software completes.
14. The machine displays the message Would you like to proceed to the operation mode?.
5. Operation sequence
NOTE
• When the circuit breaker is started after it has been turned on, this message will not appear.
16. It displays Do not vibrate the machine. Vibration affects print quality..
21. The temperature adjustment for the LED light source completes.
50501 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50501
Starting up/Closing down Operation
5. Operation sequence
50501 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50510
Starting up/Closing down Operation
This section covers the startup sequence of widely used PC (Windows 2000).
IMPORTANT
• The screens described in this section may be different from the actual ones or may not be displayed depending on the PC
type or connected devices.
1. Standby status
(1) Standby current is supplied from the ATX power supply to the mother board.
2. Power ON
5. Operation sequence
(1) VGA BIOS test
• Video board test
G057479
G057480
50510 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50510
Starting up/Closing down Operation
G057481
G057482
5. Operation sequence
• Displaying the system settings (settings for the software and hardware)
G057483
G057484
50510 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50510
Starting up/Closing down Operation
4. Reading the NTLDR (NT loader, which is the program to start the OS)
(1) Starting the bootstrap loader in the BIOS ROM (to initialize the program)
(2) Searching the MBR (master boot record, the first sector) in the hard disk
(3) NTLDR moves to the RAM
(4) Searching the system file to start the OS with NTLDR in the hard disk
(5) The system file to start the OS moves to the RAM by NTLDR.
5. Starting the OS
NOTE
• The files required to start the OS.
5. Operation sequence
White progress bar appears.
G057485
G057486
50510 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50510
Starting up/Closing down Operation
G057487
5. Operation sequence
50510 4/4
ARCNET communication figure (without option)
ATX mother board
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET
PCB (standard)
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
J/P223 J/P224
J/P221
J/P219 J/P220 J/P518 J/P517
ARCNET communication flow
50520
50520
J/P73
3 AFC/scanner control PCB
J/P54
J/P443 J/P442 4 Image processing PCB
J/P53 5 Printer control PCB
6 Laser control PCB
J/P76
D-ICE control PCB ARCNET (Connector emission side)
Image correction ARCNET (Connector detection side)
PCB J/P75
AFC/scanner control
J/P72 J/P20 PCB
J/P71 J/P21
Image processing
D-ICE PCB
PCB
G076422
ARCNET communication
1/12
ARCNET communication
5. Operation sequence
Processor control PCB PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB (standard) ARCNET communication figure (with option)
J/P518 J/P517
J/P224
J/P223 J/P221
J/P220 J/P222
J/P219
J/P1516 J/P1517
ARCNET-HUB PCB
J/P135
50520
50520
G076416
ARCNET communication
2/12
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
IMPORTANT
• ARCNET communication figure appears above. You can connect the ARCNET cable to any port if IN/OUT is correct.
The actual connecting position of the ARCNET cable may be different from the above ARCNET communication figure.
PC (PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB)
5. Operation sequence
d-Storage (ID##) Processor control PCB (ID##)
G077176
1. All the PCBs which are involved in the ARCNET communication network have their own IDs.
2. At starting up the machine, the PC requires the processor control PCB to transmit data in order of the
ARCNET communication.
3. When the processor control PCB receives the data transmission requirement from the PC, it returns the
signal of the communication OK.
50520 3/12
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
4. After receiving the signal of the communication OK from the processor control PCB, the ARCNET
communication between the PC and the processor control PCB turns OK.
NOTE
• After turning the ARCNET communication between the PC and the processor control PCB to OK, Version of the System
Version Check display appears and OK is displayed at Communication.
Version OK
S3059-01-SM00
5. After turning the ARCNET communication between the PC and the processor control PCB to OK, the
same communication check as the processor control PCB will be executed in order of D-ICE control
PCB → AFC/scanner control PCB and ARCNET communication.
6. The system starts up normally after completing the communication check of all the PCBs involving to
the network.
5. Operation sequence
Example: When No. 6901-0010 AFC/scanner control PCB occurs
1. Check the communication status of all the control PCBs.
2. Since the communication status of the System Version Check display is - , or the control PCB, which
version is not displayed, might be damaged, check mainly the PCB first.
IMPORTANT
• If the communication status of the ARCNET is in poor condition, it may take several minutes before OK
appears at Communication or the version of each control PCB appears at Version, in the System Version
Check display.
In addition, when the ARCNET communication status is in poor condition, the machine may repeatedly cycle
through indications of Communication, OK, and -.
• When the option is not equipped, or depending on the model composition, the communication status may be
displayed by - in the System Version Check display.
• For diagnosis with System Version Check, refer to ☞ Example 1: Judgement of failed part System Version
Check.
Version Communication
S3059-01-SM00
3. When No. 6901-0010 ARCNET communication error AFC/Scanner control PCB occurs at turning on the
power supply, it is highly probable that the ARCNET communication paths of No. 6901-0001 ARCNET
communication error: Processor control PCB and No. 6901-2000 ARCNET communication error: D-ICE
control PCB are normal. Therefore, exclude those parts from the diagnosis.
NOTE
• Carry out the diagnosis confirming the above display and the following table.
50520 4/12
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
4. Check the connecting condition of ARCNET PCB, ARCNET cable and cable after the parts for diagnosis
are decided.
Check point
(1) Check that the cable is securely attached to the connector for ARCNET PCB.
5. Operation sequence
(2) Check if the ARCNET cable takes off from the connector of the ARCNET PCB only for pulling it a little.
IMPORTANT
• When the ARCNET cable comes off only by pulling the cable lightly although its sheath is not shaved,
there is a possibility that the stopper of the connector on the ARCNET PCB is damaged is high, replace
the ARCNET PCB.
Stopper
G077187
(3) When the sheath of ARCNET cable is shaved and gets thin, replace the cable or cut it.
IMPORTANT
• When the sheath of ARCNET cable is shaved and it is thin, replace the cable.
50520 5/12
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
For details about how to cut the cable, refer to ☞ How to use the fiber cutter.
ARCNET cable
Chips of shaved
G077188
5. When you remove the ARCNET cable, check whether the red light has come out from the IN cable
(connected to the black connector) of ARCNET cable.
IMPORTANT
• Since it is necessary to check the power supply of the machine in the state where it turned ON in order to
confirm the connection state of the ARCNET PCB, ARCNET cable, and cables, be sure to work carefully
enough to each PCB.
Check point
(1) When two or more IN cables are on the PCB, and the red light is weak compared with the other IN cable or the red
5. Operation sequence
light has not shone, check whether the chips of shaved ARCNET cable sheath have collected in the connector of
the PCB for OUT.
Check defects of the ARCNET cable.
For details about how to cut the cable, refer to ☞ How to use the fiber cutter.
For details about how to clean inside the connector, refer to ☞ How to use the aspirator.
IN cables
Red lights
G077181
50520 6/12
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
6. When you remove the ARCNET cable, check whether the red light has come out from the OUT
connector on the ARCNET PCB.
Check point
(1) When there are two or more OUT connectors on the PCB, compare and check the strength of light of OUT
connector on other PCB.
IN connector
(2) When the red light is weak compared with the other connector or the red light has not shone, check whether the
chips of shaved ARCNET cable sheath have collected in the connector.
IMPORTANT
• Check whether the chips of shaved ARCNET cable sheath have collected in the IN connector at the
same time.
5. Operation sequence
For details about how to clean inside the connector, refer to ☞ How to use the aspirator.
Connector
G077182
7. Check whether +5 V is supplied to each ARCNET PCB from each power supply PCB as a factor which
ARCNET communication error occurs in addition to the above.
NOTE
• When +5 V is not supplied to the ARCNET PCB, the red light does not come from the OUT connector on the ARCNET
PCB.
8. After confirming the check points mentioned above, when normal, replace each PCB.
! Diagnosis appendix
50520 7/12
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
colorimeter unit, the NMC1 and the NMC2 may not be inclusive if they are not for the ARCNET
communication.)
Version Communication
S3059-01-SM00
2. In the case above, either the IN connector or the OUT connector of each control PCB is not connected
securely.
Loose connection of either the IN or the OUT connector of each control PCB is highly suspected.
In such cases, specify which control PCB is causing trouble and disconnect its IN and OUT connectors. This may be helpful to
stabilize the ARCNET communication, and Communication and Version of control PCBs other than those of the control PCB
causing trouble may appear.
5. Operation sequence
IMPORTANT
• Depending on the communication status of the ARCNET, it is sometimes required to restart the PC to bring up
the Version and Communication in the System Version Check display, even when the physical ARCNET
communication status is in normal condition.
G077180
3. In the case of Step 2 as above, check the connection of the cable and the control PCB connector that is
causing trouble.
Cleaning inside the connectors on the ARCNET PCB, cutting the ARCNET cable or replacing the ARCNET cable or
ARCNET control PCB solves the trouble.
For details about how to cut the cable, refer to ☞ How to use the fiber cutter.
For details about how to clean inside the connector, refer to ☞ How to use the aspirator.
IMPORTANT
• If the problem is caused by the D-ICE control PCB, the printer control PCB, or the ARCNET-HUB PCB, above
diagnosis may not be applicable because these PCBs are equipped with HUB function.
Example 2: Judgment of failure place (when either laser control PCB or printer control PCB is out of order)
NOTE
• It is an explanation for the case when the message No. 6901-0200 Printer control PCB is displayed.
1. Replace connector (2) with connector (1) on the printer control PCB.
50520 8/12
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
2. If replacing the connector of the printer control PCB results in recurrence of No. 6901-0001 ARCNET
communication error. Processor control PCB, it is highly probable that the cause of failure lies in the
printer control PCB.
ARCNET
(1) (2)
G077185
5. Operation sequence
Example 3: Judgment of failure place with the ARCNET cable
NOTE
• It is an explanation for the case when the message No. 6901-0200 Printer control PCB is displayed.
• The method of diagnosis in case there is an empty connector of ARCNET PCB, such as ARCNET-HUB PCB, is explained.
• To perform the diagnosis using the ARCNET cable, it is necessary to prepare the ARCNET cable in advance.
1. Disconnect the cable connected to the laser control PCB, and replace it with the ARCNET cable from
the prepared ARCNET-HUB PCB.
50520 9/12
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
2. If "ARCNET communication error" does not occur as a result of replacing the ARCNET cable, it is highly
probable that the cause of failure lies in the printer control PCB.
ARCNET
5. Operation sequence
ARCNET-HUB PCB
50520 10/12
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
5. Operation sequence
After cutting (normal)
G081991
IMPORTANT
• If the end of ARCNET cable is in the following condition, cut it.
3. Check the condition of the end of ARCNET cable and that no dust is attached on it.
4. Clean inside of the ARCNET connector if necessary.
☞ How to use the aspirator
5. Connect the ARCNET cable.
50520 11/12
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50520
ARCNET communication
5. Operation sequence
Aspirator
G081992
50520 12/12
AOM
Mirror ATX mother board
VIDEO BOARD
Media drive
PCI-
R laser R-AOM LVDS/ARC
driver
NET PCB
Bl LVDS (standard)
ase
r G-AOM
driver
G
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
la
ser B-AOM
driver
Laser control PCB Printer control PCB Processor control PCB
ARCNET
Polygon mirror
LVDS ARCNET ARCNET
ARCNET
Lens
Synchronous sensor
ARCNET
J/P455 J/P456
ARCNET
Image correction
Data flow in printing (negative/positive)
PCB
50600
50600
LVDS
PCB
[J485]
[J484A]
DIMM
Data change-over
G072346
1/2
Data flow chart
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50600
Data flow chart
! Input of this system operation is film scanning operation and output is printing
operation.
2. The D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
• For details of scratch erasing in the D-ICE PCB, refer to ☞ 50660.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
3. The image correction PCB performs image correction of actual scanning data such as color and
density correction, DSA, and image rotation.
IMPORTANT
5. Operation sequence
• Prescanning data does not go through the image correction PCB.
• Prescanning data goes through the D-ICE PCB → the image processing PCB, and then it is sent to the PC as
the image data for PJP to be displayed on the monitor.
NOTE
• The prescanning data is used for the index print.
• For details about the image correction PCB, image processing PCB and their data flows, refer to ☞ 50650.
4. Image data editing such as frame combination and front print combination is performed in the image
processing PCB.
5. The image data goes through the laser control PCB and is output to the laser unit.
50600 2/2
AOM ATX mother board
Mirror
VIDEO BOARD
Media drive
R laser R-AOM PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB (standard)
driver
Bl
ase G-AOM LVDS
r
driver
G
la
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
se
r B-AOM
HDD (Standard)
driver
Laser control PCB Printer control PCB Processor control PCB
ARCNET
Data flow in printing (media)
Lens
ARCNET
Synchronous sensor J/P455 J/P456
ARCNET
Image correction
PCB AFC/scanner
50610
50610
Image processing
PJP image data (monitor display)
D-ICE PCB
PCB
LVDS
PCB
[J485]
[J484A]
DIMM
Data change-over
G072349
1/2
Data flow chart
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50610
Data flow chart
2. The image data is sent to the image processing PCB from the PC.
3. The image correction PCB performs image correction such as color and density correction, DSA, and
image rotation.
IMPORTANT
• Setup print data goes through the image correction PCB but color and density correction and CMS correction
are not performed.
NOTE
• For details about the image correction PCB, image processing PCB and their data flows, refer to ☞ 50650.
4. Image data editing such as frame combination and front print combination is performed in the image
processing PCB.
5. Operation sequence
5. The image data goes through the laser control PCB and is output to the laser unit.
50610 2/2
Mirror AOM
VIDEO BOARD ATX mother board
Media drive
PCI-
R laser R-AOM LVDS/ARC
driver
NET PCB
Bl LVDS
ase
r G-AOM
driver
G
la
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
se
r B-AOM
Media
driver
ARCNET
Data flow in data saving
ARCNET
J/P455 J/P456
ARCNET
Image correction
PCB
50620
50620
control PCB
Actual scanning data
D-ICE PCB
Image processing
PCB
LVDS
PCB
[J485]
[J484A]
DIMM
Data change-over
G072350
1/2
Data flow chart
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50620
Data flow chart
! Input of this system operation is film scanning operation and output is media writing
operation (including the Bravo).
2. The D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
• For details of scratch erasing in the D-ICE PCB, refer to ☞ 50660.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
3. The image correction PCB performs image correction such as color and density correction, DSA, and
image rotation.
IMPORTANT
5. Operation sequence
• Prescanning data does not go through the image correction PCB.
• Prescanning data goes through the D-ICE PCB → the image processing PCB, and then it is sent to the PC as
the image data for PJP to be displayed on the monitor.
NOTE
• For details about the image correction PCB, image processing PCB and their data flows, refer to ☞ 50650.
4. The image processing PCB performs color correction of the image data such as CMS.
IMPORTANT
• When the data is output to a media, the image processing PCB does not perform image data editing such as
frame combination and front print combination.
50620 2/2
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB (standard)
Mirror AOM
ATX mother
HDD
VIDEO board
BOARD
(Standard)
R laser R-AOM
driver LVDS
Bl
ase
r G-AOM
CAU HDD (Option)
driver LVDS
G
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
la
se
r B-AOM
driver FLATBED
Printer control PCB SCANNER(A4)
Laser control PCB Processor control PCB
ARCNET
(Option)
ARCNET
J/P1350 J/P456 ARCNET
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB
ARCNET
PCB
ARCNET-HUB PCB
Prescanning data
50630
HDD
50630
Image correction
PCB
DSP PCB
CD-R WRITER
Buffer
IEEE1394
(option)
Data flow to the CD-R external writing system
ARCNET
D-ICE PCB
ATX mother board
LVDS
Image processing PCB
PCB
[J485]
[J484A]
DIMM
PCB (option)
PCI-/ARCNET
Data change-over
(option)
Scratch mend PCB 2
G072347
1/2
Data flow chart
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50630
Data flow chart
! Input of this system operation is film scanning operation and output is the CD-R
external writing system.
2. The D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
• For details of scratch erasing in the D-ICE PCB, refer to ☞ 50660.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
3. The image correction PCB performs image correction of actual scanning data such as color and
density correction, DSA, and image rotation.
IMPORTANT
5. Operation sequence
• Prescanning data does not go through the image correction PCB.
• Prescanning data goes through the D-ICE PCB → the image processing PCB, and then it is sent to the PC as
the image data for PJP to be displayed on the monitor.
NOTE
• For details about the image correction PCB, image processing PCB and their data flows, refer to ☞ 50650.
4. The image processing PCB performs color correction of the image data such as CMS.
IMPORTANT
• When the data is output to the CD-R external writing system, the image processing PCB does not perform
image data editing such as frame combination and front print combination.
• The buffer PCB does not perform color conversion.
5. The image data is sent to the buffer PCB of the CD-R external writing system from the image
processing PCB.
8. The image data is output to the CD-R external writing system from IEEE1394.
50630 2/2
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB (standard)
Mirror AOM
ATX mother
board
HDD
VIDEO
BOARD
(Standard)
R laser R-AOM
driver LVDS
Bl
ase
r G-AOM
driver LVDS
G
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
la
se
r B-AOM
driver FLATBED
Data flow to the CAU
ARCNET
(Option)
(Option)
CAU HDD
Polygon mirror
LVDS
ARCNET ARCNET
ARCNET
Lens LVDS
Synchronous sensor
ARCNET
J/P456 ARCNET
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB
PCB
50640
50640
HDD
D-ICE control PCB AFC/scanner
control PCB PU control PCB
PCB
DSP PCB
CD-R WRITER
Buffer
IEEE1394
(option)
Image correction
ARCNET
Prescanning data
D-ICE PCB
ATX mother board
Image processing PCB LVDS
Output to the CAU (TYPE1)
PCB
[J485]
DIMM
[J484A]
PCB (option)
PCI-/ARCNET
CD-R external writing system
Data change-over
(option)
Scratch mend PCB 2
G072354
1/3
Data flow chart
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50640
Data flow chart
! Input of this system operation is film scanning operation and output is the CAU.
Writing data to the CAU (TYPE1: 12 bits)
2. The D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
• For details of scratch erasing in the D-ICE PCB, refer to ☞ 50660.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
3. The image data is output to the PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB (option) from the input memory in the image
processing PCB.
IMPORTANT
5. Operation sequence
• For details about the image processing PCB and the data flow, refer to ☞ 50650.
• In the case of the CAU (TYPE1), if image correction, such as color and density correction, DSA and image
rotation, is performed, the information data and the image data are saved in the HDD of the CAU. In the case
of reading from the CAU, the Correction value shows the value corrected.
• The image data saved in the CAU (TYPE1) is raw data for the scanner. It is not general data. It cannot be
used unless the QSS processes the data.
2. The D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
• For details of scratch erasing in the D-ICE PCB, refer to ☞ 50660.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
3. The image data is output to the PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB (standard) from the composition processing
section in the image processing PCB.
IMPORTANT
• For details about the image processing PCB and the data flow, refer to ☞ 50650.
50640 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50640
Data flow chart
• In the case of the CAU (TYPE2), if image correction, such as color and density correction, DSA and image
rotation, is performed, the information data is not saved to the HDD of the CAU. In the case of reading from
the CAU, all Correction value is N.
• Save the image data saved to the CAU (TYPE2) as JPEG data.
NOTE
• In the case of CAU (TYPE2), you can save the composite image made using in the Edit mode, to the CAU.
• For the details about the difference between the CAU (TYPE1) and the CAU (TYPE2), refer to Compact Archive Unit
Operator's Manual, Difference between TYPE1 and TYPE2.
1. The image data is output to the image processing PCB via standard PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB from
the HDD of the CAU.
2. The image correction PCB performs image correction such as color and density correction, DSA, and
image rotation.
NOTE
• For details about the image correction PCB, image processing PCB and their data flows, refer to ☞ 50650.
5. Operation sequence
3. Image data editing such as frame combination and front print combination is performed in the image
processing PCB.
4. The image data goes through the laser control PCB and is output to the laser unit.
50640 3/3
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB Printing from the CAU (TYPE1 and TYPE2)
(Option) Printing from a media
Printing from the FB scanner
Index print
Sample print D-ICE PCB
Setup print
FLATBED
SCANNER(A4)
PCI-
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
LVDS/ARC J/P456
LVDS Image input section
NET PCB
Prescanning data
(standard)
Outputting to media
Actual scanning data
ATX mother
Input memory
board
HDD
Media drive
50650
50650
HDD
Package print
PCB
DSP PCB
CD-R WRITER
Buffer
IEEE1394
Composition processing section
LVDS
Outputting to media
Output to the CAU (TYPE1)
Laser unit
PCB (option)
PCI-/ARCNET
G072353
1/3
Data flow chart
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50650
Data flow chart
! The route of image data in the image processing PCB is described as the system
operation.
2. The image data is sent to the image input section of the image processing PCB from the D-ICE PCB.
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
3. The image input section of the image processing PCB sends the image data that has been input from
the D-ICE PCB to the input memory or LVDS cables.
4. When the image processing PCB is in process, its input memory stores the image data temporarily.
5. Image processing on the image correction PCB varies depending whether the input data is film or not.
☞ When the input media is film
☞ When the input media is not film
6. CMS section of the image processing PCB performs CMS correction.
5. Operation sequence
7. When the composition processing section of the image processing PCB is in process, its development
memory stores the image data temporarily.
8. The composition processing section of the image processing PCB combines the frame image or front
print image to the image data.
IMPORTANT
• The composition image such as frame image and front print is not saved in the CAU (TYPE1), a media or the
CD-R external writing system.
• In the case of CAU (TYPE2), you can save the composite image made using in the Edit mode, to the CAU.
NOTE
• The frame data is sent from the HDD (standard) via the composite memory.
9. The image data goes through the laser control PCB and is output to the laser unit.
1. The image correction PCB performs image correction such as color and density correction, DSA, and
image rotation.
2. Convert the image data which is input onto the image correction PCB from 12 bit to 8 bit.
IMPORTANT
• When printing from the CAU (type 1: 12 bit image data), take the same process as ☞ 2.
50650 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50650
Data flow chart
• You can see the image data converted from 12 bit to 8 bit on the PC monitor even when processing from film
in the Edit mode. For this reason, you do not need to print in some cases.
If an abnormal image occurs, check the condition of input image in the Edit mode.
3. The image data is sent to the image processing PCB from the image correction PCB.
1. The image correction PCB performs image correction such as color and density correction, DSA, and
image rotation.
2. The image data is sent to the image processing PCB from the image correction PCB.
IMPORTANT
• Setup print data and sample print data go through the image correction PCB but color and density correction
and CMS correction are not performed.
5. Operation sequence
50650 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50660
Data flow chart
Prescanning data
Adjustment data
D-ICE PCB
DIMM (Option)
5. Operation sequence
SUB1
MAIN
Image correction
PCB
Image processing
PCB
G072352
50660 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50660
Data flow chart
! The route of image data in the D-ICE PCB is described as the system operation.
NOTE
• 1. The image data goes through SUB1 and MAIN whether processing is performed or not.
SUB1 {digital adjustment for the scanner (such as shading)}
MAIN {controlling output to the image processing PCB}
• 2. If DIMM is installed, the image data goes through it whether processing is performed or not.
• 3. D-ICE PCB does not perform scratch erasing for prescanning, but processing 1 above of SUB 1 and MAIN is performed.
• 4. Processing for the actual scanning (D-ICE is OFF) is the same as processing 3 above.
• 5. Adjustment indicates adjustments for the scanner such as the light source registration, light axis adjustment and focus
adjustment.
1. When scratch mend PCB 2 is in process, the DIMM stores the actual scanning data temporarily.
(Option)
NOTE
• Processing time of digital masking depends on how much scratches are on a film.
2. SUB1 of the D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
5. Operation sequence
NOTE
• This performs digital adjustment such as shading for the scanner.
3. Scratch mend PCB 2, the data change-over PCB, scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A], and scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485] detect the scratches and dust on a film and correct them. (Option)
NOTE
• Three scratch mend PCBs share the tasks to improve the processing speed of scratch erasing.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
4. MAIN of the D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
NOTE
• Besides detecting and correcting the scratches and dust on the film base layer, this controls D-ICE totally, communicates
with the D-ICE control PCB, and controls outputting image data to the image processing PCB.
5. The image data is sent to the image processing PCB from the D-ICE PCB.
IMPORTANT
• Prescanning data goes through the D-ICE PCB → the image processing PCB, and then it is sent to the PC as
the image data for PJP to be displayed on the monitor. Refer to ☞ 50600.
• Prescanning data and test print data for setup do not go through the digital masking unit. Scratch erasing
process for base layer (standard) is not performed in D-ICE PCB.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
50660 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50670
Data flow chart
Prescanning data
External PC
LAN PORT
VIDEO
LAN BOARD
BOARD
ATX mother board
ATX mother
board
HDD
LVDS
VIDEO BOARD
LVDS/ARC
NET PCB
PCI-
DIMM
AFC/scanner
control PCB
5. Operation sequence
ARCNET
ARCNET
Data change-over
D-ICE PCB
PCB
D-ICE control PCB
Image correction
Image processing
LVDS
PCB
PCB
G076401
50670 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50670
Data flow chart
! Input for this system operation is performed by film scanning operation and the
external PC.
2. The D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
• For details of scratch erasing in the D-ICE PCB, refer to ☞ 50660.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
3. The image correction PCB performs image correction such as color and density correction, DSA,
rotation and cropping.
IMPORTANT
5. Operation sequence
• Prescanning data does not go through the image correction PCB.
• Prescanning data goes through the D-ICE PCB → the image processing PCB, and then it is sent to the
external PC as the image data for PJP.
NOTE
• For details about the image correction PCB, image processing PCB and their data flows, refer to ☞ 50680.
4. The image processing PCB performs color correction of the image data such as CMS.
IMPORTANT
• When 48bit is selected, the image processing PCB does not perform color correction of the image data such
as CMS.
50670 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50680
Data flow chart
Development memory
Image input section
Input memory
CMS section
D-ICE PCB
5. Operation sequence
Composite
memory
J/P456
J/P445
J/P1350
LVDS
LVDS
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET
BOARD
VIDEO
PCB (standard)
VIDEO
BOARD
ATX mother
ATX mother
LAN
board
BOARD
board
LAN PORT
HDD
G076402
50680 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50680
Data flow chart
! The route of image data in the image processing PCB is described as the system
operation.
2. The image data is sent to the image input section of the image processing PCB from the D-ICE PCB.
IMPORTANT
• The D-ICE PCB does not perform base layer scratch erasing for prescanning data.
3. The image input section of the image processing PCB sends the image data that has been input from
the D-ICE PCB to the input memory or LVDS cables.
4. When the image processing PCB is in process, its input memory stores the image data temporarily.
5. The image correction PCB performs image correction such as color and density correction, DSA,
rotation and cropping.
6. The image data is sent to the image processing PCB from the image correction PCB.
5. Operation sequence
IMPORTANT
• When 48bit is selected, the image data is output from the image processing PCB via J/P456 (LVDS)→QSS
computer to the external PC.
8. When the composition processing section of the image processing PCB is in process, its development
memory stores the image data temporarily.
50680 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50800
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
Input
Editing
Output
Desk section
PC LAN PCI-
Media drive
LVDS/ARCNET
PCB
System Management
5. Operation sequence
Software
Editing
HDD (system)
KIAS (Z:) WIP (V:) PrintBuf (Y:)
HDD (archive)
Archive (U:)
Image processing
PCB
G072417
50800 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50800
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
1. The image data is read into WIP (V:) from the input devices such as scanner or media.
NOTE
• For the Network Order (Option by Kodak), the image data input to KIAS (Z:) from the network device is transferred to
WIP (V:).
5. Operation sequence
and template composition is performed all in the System Management Software.
3. By pressing Start Job, the edited image data is saved in WIP (V:) and transferred to PrintBuf (Y:).
4. The image data is transferred from PrintBuf (Y:) to each output device such as printer, media and
archive.
50800 2/2
AOM ATX mother board
Mirror VIDEO BOARD
Media drive
PCI-
R laser R-AOM
driver LVDS/ARC
NET PCB
Bl LVDS
ase
r G-AOM (standard) HDD
driver
G
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
la
se
r B-AOM
driver
Laser control PCB Printer control PCB Processor control PCB
ARCNET
Polygon mirror
LVDS ARCNET ARCNET
ARCNET
Lens
Synchronous sensor
ARCNET
J/P455 J/P456
ARCNET
Image correction
Data flow in printing [DLS specification]
PCB
50810
50810
Print data
control PCB
Prescanning data
Actual scanning data
LVDS
PCB
[J485]
[J484A]
DIMM
Data change-over
G076404
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
1/2
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50810
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
! Input is film scanning operation or the image data and output is printing operation.
2. Scanning data detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and corrects them on the D-ICE PCB.
(Standard)
IMPORTANT
• For details of scratch erasing in the D-ICE PCB, refer to ☞ 50840.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
3. Scanning data sends the image data to HDD via D-ICE PCB→Image processing PCB→PCI-
LVDS/ARCNET PCB→ATX mother board, to display the data on the monitor.
5. Operation sequence
NOTE
• For details, refer to ☞ 50800.
4. When input is image, the image data is transferred to HDD from the media drive.
NOTE
• For details, refer to ☞ 50800.
5. On the computer, the color and density correction of scanning data is performed and the print data is
transferred to the image processing PCB.
NOTE
• For details, refer to ☞ 50800.
6. On the image processing PCB, the paper fitting of the image is performed and the image data is output
to the laser unit via the laser control PCB.
50810 2/2
AOM ATX mother board
Mirror VIDEO BOARD
Media drive
PCI-
R laser R-AOM
driver LVDS/ARC
Bl LVDS NET PCB
ase
r G-AOM (standard) HDD
driver
Media
G
la
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
se
r B-AOM
driver
Laser control PCB Printer control PCB Processor control PCB
ARCNET
Polygon mirror LVDS ARCNET ARCNET
ARCNET
Lens
ARCNET
Synchronous sensor J/P455 J/P456
ARCNET
Image correction
PCB
50820
50820
control PCB
Scanning data
Data flow in data saving [DLS specification]
Prescanning data
LVDS
PCB
[J485]
[J484A]
DIMM
Data change-over
G076405
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
1/2
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50820
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
! Input of this system operation is film scanning operation and output is media writing
operation.
2. Scanning data detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and corrects them on the D-ICE PCB.
(Standard)
IMPORTANT
• For details of scratch erasing in the D-ICE PCB, refer to ☞ 50840.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
3. Scanning data sends the image data to HDD via D-ICE PCB→Image processing PCB→PCI-
LVDS/ARCNET PCB→ATX mother board, to display the data on the monitor.
NOTE
• For details, refer to ☞ 50800.
5. Operation sequence
4. On the computer, the color and density correction of scanning data is performed and the image data is
written to each media.
NOTE
• For details, refer to ☞ 50800.
50820 2/2
Printing from archive
Printing from a media
Index print
Sample print
Setup print PCI-LVDS/ARCNET
PCB (standard)
D-ICE PCB
Archive
ATX mother J/P456
Media drive
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
Prescanning data
Printing from a media
Input memory
HDD
VIDEO
(Standard)
BOARD
J/P445
LVDS Image correction PCB
50830
50830
Development memory
Composite
Print data
memory
Laser unit
G076406
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
1/2
5. Operation sequence
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50830
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
! The route of image data in the image processing PCB is described as the system
operation.
2. Scanning data transfers the image data to the image input section of the image processing PCB from
the D-ICE PCB.
NOTE
• For DLS specification, prescanning data is used only as the data for the film stop position check and the frame position
check.
3. Scanning data transfers the image data, which has been input from the D-ICE PCB in the image input
section of the image processing PCB, to the LVDS cables via the input memory.
4. Scanning data sends the image data to HDD via PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB→ATX mother board, to
display the data on the monitor.
5. On the computer, the color and density correction of scanning data is performed and the print data is
transferred to the image correction PCB.
5. Operation sequence
NOTE
• When printing from archive or media, print via HDD (standard).
7. The image data is sent to the image processing PCB from the image correction PCB.
8. Without processing in the CMS section, Development memory and Composition processing section on
the image processing PCB, the image data is output to the laser unit via the laser control PCB.
NOTE
• When the composition processing section of the image processing PCB is in process, its development memory stores the
image data temporarily.
50830 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50840
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
Prescanning data
Adjustment data
D-ICE PCB
DIMM (Option)
5. Operation sequence
SUB1
MAIN
Image correction
PCB
Image processing
PCB
G072352
50840 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
50840
Data Flow Chart (DLS specification)
! The route of image data in the D-ICE PCB is described as the system operation.
NOTE
• 1. The image data goes through SUB1 and MAIN whether processing is performed or not.
SUB1 {digital adjustment for the scanner (such as shading)}
MAIN {controlling output to the image processing PCB}
• 2. If DIMM is installed, the image data goes through it whether processing is performed or not.
• 3. For scanning data (D-ICE is OFF), erasing scratches is not performed on the D-ICE PCB. However, the above 1 process of
SUB1 and MAIN is performed.
• 4. Adjustment indicates adjustments for the scanner such as the light source registration, light axis adjustment and focus
adjustment.
• For DLS specification, prescanning data is used only as the data for the film stop position check and the frame position check.
1. When the scratch mend PCB 2 is in process, the DIMM stores the scanning data temporarily. (Option)
NOTE
• Processing time of digital masking depends on how much scratches are on a film.
2. SUB1 of the D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
NOTE
• This performs digital adjustment such as shading for the scanner.
5. Operation sequence
3. Scratch mend PCB 2, the data change-over PCB, scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A], and scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485] detect the scratches and dust on a film and correct them. (Option)
NOTE
• Three scratch mend PCBs share the tasks to improve the processing speed of scratch erasing.
• The data change-over PCB sorts the image data between those for scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and for scratch mend
PCB 1 [J485].
4. MAIN of the D-ICE PCB detects scratches or dust on the film base layer and correct them. (Standard)
NOTE
• Besides detecting and correcting the scratches and dust on the film base layer, this controls D-ICE totally, communicates
with the D-ICE control PCB, and controls outputting image data to the image processing PCB.
5. The image data is sent to the image processing PCB from the D-ICE PCB.
IMPORTANT
• Test print for setup does not go through the digital masking unit. Scratch erasing process for base layer
(standard) is not performed in D-ICE PCB.
NOTE
• The optional Digital Masking Unit improves the correction of the scratch on the film.
• Those PCBs detect scratches and dust on the film and correct them.
50840 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51010
Film carrier section
Film carrier section
This section explains the process of the film being loaded, pre-scanned, scanned and ejected.
! Flow chart
Loading sensor
G068353
5. Operation sequence
DX sensor
G068353
Ready sensor
G068353
51010 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51010
Film carrier section
When the 135 Negative Film Inserting Direction Detection Function is set to ON in the Operator
Selections:
• Go to Step 6.
When the 135 Negative Film Inserting Direction Detection Function is set to OFF in the Operator
Selections:
• Go to Step 8.
6. The film is fed for a specified length from the ready sensor.
• Film feed motor: OFF
When the DX code sensor detects the film's front end (end with the small frame number):
• No. 1435
Insertion direction of film is different. Insert the film from the rear end (end with largest frame number).
When the perforation sensor does not detect the film:
• No. 6403
135 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
5. Operation sequence
Rewinding sensor Perforation sensor
G068353
Scanning position
G068353
9. Pre-scanning starts.
• LED light source: ON
• Film feed motor: ON
51010 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51010
Film carrier section
G068353
11. The front end of the film enters the rewinding unit.
12. The rear end of the film has passed the ready sensor.
When the ready sensor does not detect the rear end of the film:
• No. 6403
135 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
NOTE
• This error message appears when the ready sensor detected the film and a specified length of film was fed, but the ready
5. Operation sequence
sensor did not turn LIGHT.
G068353
13. The rear end of the film passes the scanning position.
Scanning position
G068353
51010 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51010
Film carrier section
Perforation sensor
G068353
16. The rear end of the film has passed the ready sensor.
5. Operation sequence
Ready sensor
G068353
17. The rear end of the film has passed the loading sensor.
Loading sensor
G068353
51010 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51010
Film carrier section
18. The final frame of the film has passed the scanning position.
Scanning position
G068353
5. Operation sequence
51010 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51110
Film carrier section
This section explains the process of the film being loaded, scanned and ejected.
! Flow chart
Rewinding unit
5. Operation sequence
Light lock door
G068354
5. The front end of the film has passed the loading sensor.
When the loading sensor does not detect the film front end:
• Operation goes back to Step 3 and the film is rewound (retry).
When the loading sensor cannot detect the front end of the film after retrying:
• No. 6404
240 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
Film
Loading sensor
G068354
51110 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51110
Film carrier section
6. The front end of the film has passed the ready sensor.
• Spool key motor: OFF
When the ready sensor does not detect the film front end:
• No. 6404
240 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
DX sensor
Ready sensor
G068354
7. DX sensor starts reading the data other than the magnetic data.
NOTE
• The data other than the magnetic data are the DX code, frame numbers and FID.
5. Operation sequence
Scanning position
G068354
9. Pre-scanning starts.
• LED light source: ON
• Film feed motor: ON (forward)
11. The front end of the film has passed the perforation sensor.
When the perforation sensor does not detect the film advance:
• No. 6404
240 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
Perforation sensor
Rewinding sensor
G068354
51110 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51110
Film carrier section
13. The turn round perforation has passed the ready sensor.
Scanning position
5. Operation sequence
G068354
Scanning position
G068354
51110 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51110
Film carrier section
18. The final frame of the film passes the scanning position.
Scanning position
G068354
21. The front end of the film passes the perforation sensor.
5. Operation sequence
When the perforation sensor does not detect the film:
• No. 6404
240 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
Perforation sensor
G068354
Scanning position
Magnetic head
G068354
51110 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51110
Film carrier section
24. The leading edge of the film passes the magnetic head.
Magnetic head
G068354
26. The front end of the film has passed the ready sensor.
Ready sensor
G068354
5. Operation sequence
• No. 6404
240 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
G068354
51110 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51310
Film carrier section
This section explains the process of the film being loaded, pre-scanned, scanned and ejected.
! Flow chart
2. The front end of the film has passed the loading sensor.
• Film feed motor: ON
Rewinding unit
Loading sensor
G050826
3. The front end of the film has passed the ready sensor.
5. Operation sequence
When the ready sensor does not detect the film:
• No. 6406
120 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
When the loading sensor turns LIGHT before the specified length of the film advances after the ready
sensor detected the film:
• Film feed motor: reverse
• The film is ejected, because the minimum required length is not detected.
Ready sensor
G050827
4. The front end of the film has passed the scanning position.
• LED light source: ON
Scanning position
G050854
51310 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51310
Film carrier section
5. Pre-scanning starts.
When the film sensor does not detect the film advance:
• No. 6406
120 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
Film sensor
G050828
7. The rear end of the film has passed the ready sensor.
5. Operation sequence
120 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
Ready sensor
G050829
Scanning position
G050830
9. Pre-scanning is completed.
When the scanning cannot be started even if one minute have passed after prescanning:
• LED light source :OFF
51310 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51310
Film carrier section
Scanning position
G050831
11. The rear end of the film has passed the ready sensor.
When the ready sensor does not detect the rear end of the film:
• No. 6406
120 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
5. Operation sequence
Ready sensor
G050832
12. The rear end of the film has passed the loading sensor.
Loading sensor
G069968
13. The first frame of the film passes the scanning position.
• Film feed motor: OFF
51310 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51310
Film carrier section
Scanning position
G050833
5. Operation sequence
51310 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51410
Film carrier section
This section explains the process of the film being loaded, pre-scanned, scanned and ejected.
! Flow chart
2. The front end of the film has passed the loading sensor.
• Film feed motor: ON
Rewinding unit
Loading sensor
G050837
3. The front end of the film has passed the ready sensor.
5. Operation sequence
When the ready sensor does not detect the film:
• No. 6405
110 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
When the loading sensor turns LIGHT before the specified length of the film advances after the ready
sensor detected the film:
• Film feed motor: reverse
• The film is ejected, because the minimum required length is not detected.
Ready sensor
G050838
4. The front end of the film has passed the scanning position.
• LED light source: ON
Scanning position
G050855
51410 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51410
Film carrier section
5. Pre-scanning starts.
6. The front end of the film has passed the perforation sensor.
Perforation sensor
G050839
5. Operation sequence
Scanning position
G050856
8. Pre-scanning is completed.
When the scanning cannot be started even if one minute have passed after prescanning:
• LED light source :OFF
9. Scanning starts.
• Film feed motor: ON (reverse)
When LED light source is OFF
• LED light source: ON
When the scanning cannot be started:
• When the free space of the memory in the image processing PCB is insufficient, the rear end of the film waits before the
scanning position until the memory has enough free space.
Scanning position
G050840
51410 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51410
Film carrier section
When the perforation sensor does not detect the film advance:
• No. 6405
110 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
10. The rear end of the film has passed the ready sensor.
When the ready sensor does not detect the film:
• No. 6405
110 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
Ready sensor
G050841
11. The rear end of the film has passed the loading sensor.
5. Operation sequence
• No. 6405
110 film has stopped at the Film Carrier.
Loading sensor
G069969
12. The first frame of the film passes the scanning position.
• Film feed motor: OFF
Scanning position
G050842
When the next film is not processed even if one minute has passed:
• LED light source :OFF
51410 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51410
Film carrier section
5. Operation sequence
51410 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51510
Film carrier section
This section explains the process of the mount insertion cover being opened and the mount being ejected.
NOTE
• When the mount insertion cover is not open, it opens after returning the carrier to its home position.
! Flow chart
1. The mount carrier moves to the left. (The mount insertion cover is closed.)
• Mount carrier slide motor: ON (forward)
Scanning position
Moves to the left.
G052535
5. Operation sequence
When the mount carrier home sensor is not LIGHT: (mount carrier does not move)
• No. 6424
Mount Unit operation error.
G052534
When the mount carrier home sensor is not DARK: (mount carrier does not move)
• No. 6424
Mount Unit operation error.
51510 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51510
Film carrier section
Mount
G052536
5. Operation sequence
Moves up and down.
AF sensors
G052537
7. Pre-scanning starts.
• LED light source: ON
• Mount carrier slide motor: ON (forward)
G052696
8. Pre-scanning finishes and the mount carrier stops at the scanning start position.
• Mount carrier slide motor: OFF
When the scanning cannot be started even if one minute have passed after prescanning:
• LED light source :OFF
9. Scanning starts.
• Mount carrier slide motor: ON (reverse)
51510 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51510
Film carrier section
G052539
5. Operation sequence
Scanning start position
G052540
When the mount insertion cover sensor is not LIGHT: (mount insertion cover does not open)
• No. 6424
Mount Unit operation error.
51510 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51510
Film carrier section
5. Operation sequence
51510 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51550
Film carrier section
This section explains the process of the mount insertion and the mount ejection.
NOTE
• If the mount carrier is not in the home position, move it to the home position before the operation.
! Flow chart
When the mount sensor (inlet) does not turn DARK after pressing the YES/START key:
• No. 1429
Make sure that the mount is placed correctly.
Loading stocker
5. Operation sequence
Loading sensor 1
Loading sensor 2
G058785
2. Move the mount from the loading stocker to the mount carrier.
• Mount loading motor: ON (reverse)/OFF
If mount sensor 1 does not allow light to penetrate or mount sensor 2 does not block light (mount
ejector pin does not move into loading position) during mount loading:
• No. 6435
Mount insertion operation error.
When the mount sensor is not DARK:
• No. 6433
Mount detection error.
When the mount sensor turns DARK after the mount sensor (inlet) turned DARK starting with LIGHT:
• Dummy mount is detected.
After the dummy mounts are ejected, the mount sensor get back to the home position to start processing the following
order.
When the mount sensor stays LIGHT after the mount sensor (inlet) started with LIGHT
• The loading stocker is empty.
It gets back to the home position and stops processing.
51550 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51550
Film carrier section
Loading stocker
Mount sensor
Loading sensor 1
5. Operation sequence
Mount insertion operation error.
Loading stocker
Mount sensor
Loading sensor 1
Mount carrier Loading sensor 2
G058792
51550 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51550
Film carrier section
Mount
G058786
5. Pre-scanning starts.
• LED light source: ON
• Mount carrier slide motor: ON (forward)
IMPORTANT
5. Operation sequence
• The mount carrier moves to the pre-scanning start position at high speed.
• The mount carrier moves at middle speed after starting pre-scanning.
Scanning position
Mount
G057568
G058787
51550 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51550
Film carrier section
6. Pre-scanning finishes and the mount carrier stops after the scanning position.
• Mount carrier slide motor: OFF
When the scanning cannot be started even if one minute have passed after prescanning:
• LED light source :OFF
Mount
Scanning position
G058788
7. Scanning starts.
5. Operation sequence
• Mount carrier slide motor: ON (reverse)
IMPORTANT
• The mount carrier moves to the scanning start position at high speed.
• The mount carrier moves at low speed after starting scanning.
When LED light source is OFF
• LED light source: ON
When the scanning cannot be started:
• When the free space of the memory in the image processing PCB is insufficient, the mount carrier waits before the
scanning position until the memory has enough free space.
• The mount carrier moves to the scanning start position
at high speed. Scanning position
Mount
G057565
51550 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51550
Film carrier section
G057567
8. Scanning is completed.
• Mount carrier slide motor: OFF
When the next film is not processed even if one minute has passed:
• LED light source :OFF
5. Operation sequence
Mount
G057566
Mount
G058788
51550 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51550
Film carrier section
Ejection position
Mount ejection solenoid
Mount carrier slide motor
Mount
Mount sensor
Ejection sensor
5. Operation sequence
• Mount elevator motor: ON/OFF
When the mount elevator sensor does not turn DARK -> LIGHT -> DARK:
• No. 6436
Mount elevator operation error.
When the ejection sensor does not turn LIGHT:
• No. 6437
Mount eject operation error.
Mount
Ejection sensor
51550 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
51550
Film carrier section
Mount
Mount carrier
G058791
5. Operation sequence
• Return to Step 2.
51550 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55000
Paper path diagram
Paper path diagram
The following diagram shows the paper advance path in the printer by dotted lines.
Arm unit 1
Paper magazine B
5. Operation sequence
Paper magazine C
G068369
The following diagram shows the paper advance path in the processor by dotted lines.
Print conveyor unit
Dryer rack
G082012
55000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55100
Paper advance operation
Paper advance operation
This section covers how the paper is advanced to the exposure advance unit by arm unit 1 since the paper is loaded.
NOTE
• Paper supply operation (loading operation) varies by the paper advance length.
• ☞ When the paper advance length is 113.5 mm or less
• ☞ When the paper advance length is between 113.6 mm and 165.5 mm
• ☞ When the paper advance length is 165.6 mm or more
Paper magazine B
5. Operation sequence
Paper supply motor B/C
Paper magazine A
G068487
55100 1/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55100
Paper advance operation
• No. 6013
Paper did not load. Paper Magazine B
• No. 6112
Could not load the paper. Paper Magazine C
5. Operation sequence
• Cut motor: ON/OFF
When cutting is not completed.
• No. 6016
Paper Cutter operation error.
55100 2/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55100
Paper advance operation
Paper magazine B
Paper magazine A
5. Operation sequence
Paper supply motor A
Paper magazine motor C
G068488
55100 3/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55100
Paper advance operation
• No. 6013
Paper did not load. Paper Magazine B
• No. 6112
Could not load the paper. Paper Magazine C
IMPORTANT
• Arm unit 1 carries the paper at the same speed of loading.
☞ 55200
5. Operation sequence
7. The paper is cut.
• Cut motor: ON/OFF
When cutting is not completed.
• No. 6016
Paper Cutter operation error.
55100 4/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55100
Paper advance operation
Paper magazine B
Paper magazine A
5. Operation sequence
Paper supply motor A Paper magazine motor C
G068489
55100 5/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55100
Paper advance operation
• No. 6013
Paper did not load. Paper Magazine B
• No. 6112
Could not load the paper. Paper Magazine C
IMPORTANT
• If the paper advance length is 165.6 mm and more, paper cut operation is performed in paper supply
operation (arm unit 1 operation).
☞ 55200
5. Operation sequence
55100 6/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
This section describes how arm unit 1 carries the loaded paper to the exposure advance unit.
NOTE
• Paper supply operation (arm unit 1 operation) varies by the paper advance length.
• ☞ When the paper advance length is 165.5 mm or less
• ☞ When the paper advance length is between 165.6 mm and 392.5 mm
• ☞ When the paper advance length is between 395.6 mm and 466.5 mm
• ☞ When the paper advance length is 466.6 mm or more
5. Operation sequence
Paper hold motor
G068490
55200 1/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
IMPORTANT
• Arm unit 1 carries the paper at the same speed of loading until the paper passes through the paper advance
rollers.
Paper magazine B
Paper magazine A
5. Operation sequence
Paper magazine motor A
G068491
4. The paper is transferred to the exposure advance unit, and then arm unit 1 releases pressure.
• Paper hold motor: ON (released)/OFF
When the paper hold sensor does not turn LIGHT.
• No. 6101
Paper Hold Motor operation error.
55200 2/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
∗The solid line indicates the paper.
G068492
55200 3/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
∗The solid line indicates the paper.
G068493
55200 4/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
∗The solid line indicates the paper.
G068494
2. Arm unit 1 and the paper are advanced for the paper length.
• Paper supply arm motors (right and left): ON (forward)/OFF
• Paper magazine motor A/B/C: ON
• Paper supply motor A, B/C: ON
• Paper advance motor 1: ON
IMPORTANT
• Arm unit 1 carries the paper at the same speed of loading.
55200 5/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
Paper magazine B
Paper magazine A
5. Operation sequence
∗The solid line indicates the paper. Paper magazine C
G068495
55200 6/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
Cut motor
5. Operation sequence
G068496
IMPORTANT
• Arm unit 1 carries the paper at the same speed of the paper advance rollers until the paper passes through
the paper advance rollers.
55200 7/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
Paper magazine B
Paper magazine A
5. Operation sequence
Paper magazine motor A
G068497
6. When the paper advance length is 300 mm or more, paper supply pressure is released.
• Paper supply pressure change motor: ON (released)/OFF
When the paper supply pressure change sensor does not turn DARK
• No. 6134
Paper Supply Pressure Change Motor operation error.
55200 8/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
G068498
7. The paper is transferred to the exposure advance unit, and then arm unit 1 releases pressure.
• Paper hold motor: ON (released)/OFF
When the paper hold sensor does not turn LIGHT.
• No. 6101
Paper Hold Motor operation error.
G068499
55200 9/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
∗The solid line indicates the paper.
G068500
55200 10/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
G068494
IMPORTANT
• Arm unit 1 carries the paper at the same speed of loading.
55200 11/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
Paper magazine B
Paper magazine A
5. Operation sequence
Paper magazine motor A
G069826
IMPORTANT
• The machine makes a loop in the paper supply unit to adjust advance speeds of exposure advance operation
and paper supply operation.
55200 12/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
Paper magazine B
Paper magazine A
5. Operation sequence
Paper supply motor A
Paper magazine motor C
G069827
55200 13/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
Cut motor
5. Operation sequence
G069828
6. The paper is transferred to the exposure advance unit, and then paper supply pressure is released.
• Paper supply pressure change motor: ON (released)/OFF
When the paper supply pressure change sensor does not turn DARK
• No. 6134
Paper Supply Pressure Change Motor operation error.
G069829
55200 14/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
∗The solid line indicates the paper.
G069830
8. When the exposure start sensor changed LIGHT from DARK, arm unit 1 moves to the paper receiving
standby position.
55200 15/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
∗The solid line indicates the paper.
G068500
55200 16/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
G068494
IMPORTANT
• Arm unit 1 carries the paper at the same speed of loading.
55200 17/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
Paper magazine B
Paper magazine A
5. Operation sequence
Paper supply motor A
Paper magazine motor C
G069826
4. The paper is transferred to the exposure advance unit, and then arm unit 1 releases pressure. The
machine starts loop control and advances the paper for the paper length.
IMPORTANT
• The machine makes a loop in the paper supply unit to adjust advance speeds of exposure advance operation
and paper supply operation.
When the paper hold sensor does not turn LIGHT.
• No. 6101
Paper Hold Motor operation error.
55200 18/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
Paper magazine B
Paper magazine A
5. Operation sequence
Paper supply motor A
Paper magazine motor C
G069965
55200 19/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
Cut motor
5. Operation sequence
G069966
G069967
55200 20/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55200
Paper advance operation
7. When the exposure start sensor changed LIGHT from DARK, arm unit 1 moves to the paper receiving
standby position.
5. Operation sequence
∗The solid line indicates the paper.
G068500
55200 21/21
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55300
Paper advance operation
This section explains the paper advance operation via the exposure advance unit during exposure.
! Flow chart
3. The paper leading end is advanced for the specific length from the exposure advance inlet roller.
• Exposure advance pressure change motor 2: ON (inlet pressured/exit released)/OFF
When exposure advance pressure does not change
• No. 6137
Exposure Advance Pressure Change Motor 2 operation error.
5. Operation sequence
Exposure advance motor 2
G069831
4. The paper leading end is advanced for the another specific length from the exposure advance inlet
roller.
55300 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55300
Paper advance operation
Exposure starting
position
6. The paper leading end is advanced for the specific length from the exposure advance exit roller.
5. Operation sequence
• Exposure advance pressure change motor 2: ON (exit pressured)/OFF
When exposure advance pressure cannot be changed.
• No. 6137
Exposure Advance Pressure Change Motor 2 operation error.
G069833
7. The paper rear end is advanced to the position a specified distance away from the front of the
exposure advance inlet roller.
55300 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55300
Paper advance operation
G069834
8. The paper rear end is advanced to the position another specified distance away from the front of the
exposure advance inlet roller.
5. Operation sequence
• No. 6137
Exposure Advance Pressure Change Motor 2 operation error.
G069835
55300 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55400
Paper advance operation
This section covers how the paper goes through the paper advance unit 1.
NOTE
• Paper advance operation (paper advance unit 1 operation) varies by the paper advance length.
• ☞ When the paper advance length is 254.0 mm or less
• ☞ When the paper advance length is between 254.1 mm and 457.0 mm
• ☞ When the paper advance length is between 457.1 mm and 528.0 mm
• ☞ When the paper advance length is 528.1 mm or more
2. The paper leading end passes 15 mm before the advance inlet roller.
5. Operation sequence
Pressure guide motor
G069836
5. When paper advance unit 1 pressures the paper, the paper advance motor 2 starts working to
advance the paper.
55400 1/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55400
Paper advance operation
7. After paper advance motor 2 stops, paper advance unit 1 releases pressure.
• Paper advance motor 2: OFF
5. Operation sequence
• Pressure guide motor: ON (released)/OFF
G069838
2. The paper leading end passes 15 mm before the advance inlet roller.
55400 2/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55400
Paper advance operation
G069836
5. When paper advance unit 1 pressures the paper, the paper advance motor 2 starts working to
advance the paper at the exposure speed.
5. Operation sequence
• Pressure guide motor: ON (pressured)/OFF
• Paper advance motor 2: ON
G069837
55400 3/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55400
Paper advance operation
G069838
2. The paper leading end passes 15 mm before the advance inlet roller.
5. Operation sequence
3. Paper advance unit 1 releases the pressure.
• Pressure guide motor: ON (released)/OFF
G069836
2. The paper leading end passes 15 mm before the advance inlet roller.
55400 4/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55400
Paper advance operation
G069836
5. Operation sequence
5. When paper advance unit 1 pressures the paper, the paper advance motor 2 starts working to
advance the paper at the exposure speed.
6. The paper rear end passed 130 mm from the exposure advance exit roller.
55400 5/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55400
Paper advance operation
G069838
8. After pressure of paper advance unit 1 is released completely, paper advance motor 2 stops.
• Paper advance motor 2: OFF
5. Operation sequence
55400 6/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
This section covers how the paper goes through the paper advance unit 2.
NOTE
• Paper advance operation (paper advance unit 2 operation) varies by the paper width and the paper advance length.
• ☞ Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length of 178.0 mm or less
• ☞ Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length between 178.1 and 305.0 mm
• ☞ Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length of 305.1 mm or more
• ☞ The paper width is 165.0 mm or more.
5. Operation sequence
Paper Advance Unit 2
G069962
! Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length of 178.0 mm or less
55500 1/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
2. Arm units 2 (right)(left) move to paper advance unit 1. Arm unit 2 (left) moves to its standby position
and arm unit 2 (right) moves to its paper receiving position.
5. Operation sequence
G069839
55500 2/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069841
5. Operation sequence
• No. 6139
Paper Advance Arm Motor (Right) operation error.
G069842
55500 3/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069843
7. Arm unit 2 (left) moves to paper receiving position of paper advance unit 1.
• Lane select motor (left): ON/OFF
Lane select sensor (left) does not turn LIGHT.
• No. 6140
5. Operation sequence
Lane Select Motor (Left) operation error.
G069844
55500 4/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069845
10. Arm unit 2 (left) moves to the processor loading unit and arm unit 2 (right) moves to the paper
receiving position of the paper advance unit 1.
5. Operation sequence
When the arm sensor (left) does not turn LIGHT.
• No. 6138
Paper Advance Arm Motor (Left) operation error.
When the arm sensor (right) does not turn DARK.
• No. 6139
Paper Advance Arm Motor (Right) operation error.
G069944
55500 5/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069945
! Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length between 178.1 and
305.0 mm
5. Operation sequence
2. Arm units 2 (right)(left) move to paper advance unit 1. Arm unit 2 (left) moves to its standby position
and arm unit 2 (right) moves to its paper receiving position.
55500 6/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069839
5. Operation sequence
• Paper advance pressure change motor (right): ON (pressured)/OFF
When the paper advance pressure change sensor (right) does not turn DARK.
• No. 6143
Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor (Right) operation error.
G069841
55500 7/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069946
6. Arm unit 2 (left) moves to paper receiving position of paper advance unit 1.
5. Operation sequence
• Lane select motor (left): ON/OFF
• Paper advance arm motor (left): ON/OFF
Lane select sensor (left) does not turn LIGHT.
• No. 6140
Lane Select Motor (Left) operation error.
G069947
55500 8/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069949
5. Operation sequence
• No. 6138
Paper Advance Arm Motor (Left) operation error.
G069950
55500 9/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069951
5. Operation sequence
Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor (Left) operation error.
• No. 6143
Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor (Right) operation error.
G069952
12. Arm units 2 (right)(left) move to paper advance unit 1. Arm unit 2 (right) moves to its paper receiving
position.
55500 10/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
When the lane select sensor (left) does not turn DARK.
• No. 6140
Lane Select Motor (Left) operation error.
When the lane select sensor (right) does not turn LIGHT.
• No. 6141
Lane Select Motor (Right) operation error.
5. Operation sequence
G069970
! Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length of 305.1 mm or
more
2. Arm units 2 (right)(left) move to paper advance unit 1. Arm unit 2 (right) moves to its paper receiving
position.
55500 11/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069839
5. Operation sequence
• Paper advance pressure change motor (right): ON (pressured)/OFF
IMPORTANT
• Arm unit 2 advances the paper at the same speed of exposure speed without pressuring the paper.
• It pressures the paper after exposure.
When the paper advance pressure change sensor (right) does not turn DARK.
• No. 6143
Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor (Right) operation error.
G069971
55500 12/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069953
5. Operation sequence
When the paper advance pressure change sensor (right) does not turn LIGHT.
• No. 6143
Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor (Right) operation error.
G069954
55500 13/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069955
5. Operation sequence
2. Arm units 2 (right)(left) move to the paper receiving position.
• Lane select motors (right)(left): ON/OFF
• Paper advance arm motors (right)(left): ON/OFF
When the arm sensors (right)(left) do not turn DARK.
• No. 6138
Paper Advance Arm Motor (Left) operation error.
• No. 6139
Paper Advance Arm Motor (Right) operation error.
G069956
55500 14/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
G069958
55500 15/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069959
5. Operation sequence
• Paper advance pressure change motors (right)(left): ON (released)/OFF
When the paper advance pressure change sensors (right)(left) do not turn LIGHT.
• No. 6142
Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor (Left) operation error.
• No. 6143
Paper Advance Pressure Change Motor (Right) operation error.
G069960
55500 16/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55500
Paper advance operation
G069961
5. Operation sequence
55500 17/17
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55600
Paper advance operation
! Flow chart
2. The paper leading end passed through the paper loading sensor.
When the paper loading sensor does not detect the paper leading end
5. Operation sequence
• No. 6014-01
Paper did not rewind. Paper Magazine A
• No. 6015-01
Paper did not rewind. Paper Magazine B
3. The paper leading end passed through the paper end sensor.
When the paper end sensor does not detect the paper leading end
• No. 6014-02
Paper did not rewind. Paper Magazine A
• No. 6015-02
Paper did not rewind. Paper Magazine B
55600 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55700
Paper advance operation
Loading sensor
Splice hole
! Flow chart
5. Operation sequence
1. Paper is being processed.
2. The paper loading sensor detected the splice hole of the paper.
When the splice hole is detected and the paper that is advancing is 12 mm or less before the cut
position
• The paper cut position is the border of the paper exposure possible area and the cut-forbidden area.
When the splice hole is detected and the paper that is advancing is 12.1 mm or more before the cut
position
• The paper advances to the paper joint.
55700 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55800
Paper advance operation
! Flow chart
2. The paper rear end passed through the paper end sensor.
When printable area is longer than the print setting advance length at the detection of the paper end.
• Proceed the operation.
When the length of printable + exposable area is shorter than the rest of print length at the detection of
paper end.
• The the paper is not cut and the machine performs Step 5.
When the paper is in exposure and the length of printable + exposable area is equal to or longer than
the rest of the print length at the detection of paper end.
• Proceed the operation.
When the paper is in exposure and the length of printable + exposable area is shorter than the rest of
print length at the detection of paper end.
5. Operation sequence
• The operation goes on but the print need to be made again.
30 mm
Cut-forbidden area
Lane A: 194 mm
Lane B: 174.9 mm
Lane C: 174.9 mm
G058720
55800 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55900
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
Would you like to feed the leading edge of paper? Paper Magazine C
• If Yes is selected, the machine performs Step 4.
• If No is selected, fogged paper operation is ended.
Paper roll
Paper magazine
Manual cutter
G058721
55900 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
55900
Paper advance operation
5. Operation sequence
55900 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
56100
Processor paper advance operation
Processor paper advance operation
This section explains the process that begins with the paper entering the processor and ends with it being deposited into either the print
conveyor unit or the print receiving tray (large). It is a precondition that the temperature adjustment of the processing solution is completed.
1. The processor enters the following states when the paper is loaded. ☞ 55100
• Processor drive motor: ON
• Dryer fan: ON
• Dryer heater: ON
2. The back edge of the paper passes through paper sensor 2 (left, center, right), which is located in the
processor loading unit.
5. Operation sequence
Position A
G082003
3. When the paper leading edge passes position A in the above figure, the process signal is transmitted to
the processor by the printer.
56100 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
56100
Processor paper advance operation
NOTE
• The printer examines print size to determine whether prints should be sent to the print conveyor unit or the print
receiving tray (large)/long length print tray, and then issues appropriate instructions to the processor.
! Paper sent to the print receiving tray (large)/long length print tray:
5. Operation sequence
Dryer lane select sensor: SE45
G082004
• The leading edge of the paper being sent to the print receiving tray (large)/long length print tray passes through the dryer
lane select sensor, activating the dryer lane select solenoid and causing the select guide to move into the print receiving
tray (large) position after a specified amount of time elapses.
• The trailing edge of the paper being sent to the print receiving tray (large)/long length print tray passes through the dryer
lane select sensor, activating the dryer lane select solenoid and causing the select guide to move into the print conveyor
position after a specified amount of time elapses.
NOTE
• Paper other than standard prints also sent to the print receiving tray (large)
56100 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
56100
Processor paper advance operation
Dryer rack
Dryer lane select solenoid: OFF Dryer lane select solenoid: ON Dryer lane select solenoid: ON
Lane select guide: print receiving tray (large) Lane select guide: print conveyor
G082005
2. Paper is sent to the print receiving tray (large)/long length print tray:
5. Operation sequence
NOTE
• The long length print tray must be installed to accommodate prints with an advance length of 457.3 mm or over.
• Maximum capacity of print receiving tray (large)/long length print tray
Receiving tray Maximum capacity
Print receiving tray (large) 50
Long Length Print Tray 10
• Component status a specified amount of time after the dryer lane select sensor detects the trailing edge of the last sheet
of paper.
Processor drive motor: OFF
Dryer fan: OFF
Dryer heater: OFF
56100 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
56100
Processor paper advance operation
1. The paper front end passed through the print sensor in the dryer rack.
• The following message is displayed onscreen if the print sensor fails to detect paper sent to the print conveyor unit six
consecutive times within the specified time period: No. 5535 Paper has jammed in the processor section. ☞ 45534
Print sensor (right): SE28
Print sensor (center): SE29
Print sensor (left): SE30
Print conveyor unit
G082006
• The print sensor (left, center, right) detects paper sent to the print conveyor unit.
5. Operation sequence
Dryer rack
Paper advance direction
Print sensor (left)
2 4 6
1 3 5
Print sensor (center)
G082007
56100 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
56200
Print conveyor unit operation
Print conveyor unit operation
This section explains the process that begins with paper passing through the dryer rack print sensor and ends with it being output to the
print sorter unit.
NOTE
• Print conveyor operation varies in accordance with differences in paper advance methods brought about by a variety of paper widths
and advance lengths.
• ☞ Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length of 178.0 mm or less
• ☞ Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length between 178.1 and 305.0 mm
! Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length of 178.0 mm or less
NOTE
• For details on paper advancement inside the printer itself, refer to ☞ 55500.
5. Operation sequence
4. Conveyor belt starts to move.
• Conveyor motor: ON
Condition: When a specific time passes after ☞ 2 The print sensor detects the paper rear end.
Dryer rack
Paper advance direction
Print sensor (left)
A specified time
5. Paper is output into the print sorter unit's print receiving tray.
56200 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
56200
Print conveyor unit operation
! Paper with the width of 152.0 mm or less and the advance length between 178.1 and
305.0 mm
NOTE
• For details on paper advancement inside the printer itself, refer to ☞ 55500.
5. Operation sequence
• Conveyor motor: ON (rotation)
Condition: When a specific time passes after ☞ 2 The print sensor detects the trailing edge of the paper.
Dryer rack
Paper advance direction
Print sensor (left)
5. Paper is output into the print sorter unit's print receiving tray.
56200 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
56300
Print sorter unit operation
Print sorter unit operation
This section explains the operation until the print receiving tray starts to move, after paper is ejected to the print sorter unit.
1. The last piece of paper of an order is ejected to the print receiving tray of the print sorter unit.
5. Operation sequence
Sorter home sensor: SE26
G082009
Dryer rack
Paper advance direction
56300 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
56300
Print sorter unit operation
NOTE
• Print size and quantity sorted by the print sorter unit vary in accordance with the type of size-specific sorting being
performed.
Paper width Advance length Maximum capacity
Type 1 Type 2
Between 82.5 and 102 mm. Between 82.5 and 305 mm. 50 82
Between 102.1 and 152 mm. Between 82.5 and 254 mm. 50 82
Between 254.1 and 305 mm. 50 50
4. The print full sensor of the print sorter unit turns DARK.
• When the print full sensor turns DARK in a specified time, the message No. 0505 Remove the prints from the Print Sorter
Unit. appears. ☞ 40504
• The print sorter unit is not activated until attention message No. 0505 is canceled.
5. Operation sequence
Print full sensor: SE27
G082011
56300 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
6000
6. Electrical parts
6 Electrical parts
MFC (disposition of PCB, PM driver and power supply) .................................................................................62660
MFC (position and description of electrical parts) ............................................................................................62670
Position of electrical parts (printer section) .......................................................................... 63000
Printer section (positions of PCBs) ...................................................................................................................63000
Printer section (positions of electrical parts) .....................................................................................................63050
Paper magazine mounts A, B and C (positions of electrical parts) ...................................................................63051
Paper supply unit (positions of electrical parts) ................................................................................................63060
Exposure advance unit (positions of electrical parts) ........................................................................................63070
Laser unit (position and description of electrical parts) ....................................................................................63080
Paper advance unit 1 (positions of electrical parts) ...........................................................................................63090
Paper advance unit 2 (positions of electrical parts) ...........................................................................................63100
Processor loading unit (positions of electrical parts) .........................................................................................63110
Description of PCB (processor section) ............................................................................... 63200
Processor section (positions of PCBs) [N] ........................................................................................................63200
Processor section (position of PCB) [SM] ........................................................................................................63200
Positions of electrical parts (processor section) .................................................................. 63250
Processor section (positions of electrical parts) [N] ..........................................................................................63250
Processor section (positions of electrical parts) [SM] .......................................................................................63250
Position of electrical parts (dryer section and order classification section) .......................... 63260
Dryer section and order classification section (positions of electrical parts) ....................................................63260
6000 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
6000
6 Electrical parts
Description of PCB (film carrier section) .............................................................................. 65200
Connecting PCB 1 (J390756) ............................................................................................................................65200
Connecting PCB 2 (J390482) ............................................................................................................................65210
Connecting PCB 3 (J490255) ............................................................................................................................65220
Driver PCB 1 (J390368) ....................................................................................................................................65230
Driver PCB 2 .....................................................................................................................................................65240
Sensor PCB (J390757) .......................................................................................................................................65250
Power PCB (J390755) .......................................................................................................................................65260
Magnetic head PCB (J391050/J391051) ...........................................................................................................65270
Magnetic head PCB (J390497/J390784) ...........................................................................................................65270
Connecting PCB 4 (J390579) ............................................................................................................................65280
Connecting PCB (J390371) ...............................................................................................................................65290
Sensor PCB (J390385) .......................................................................................................................................65300
Connecting PCB (J390372) ...............................................................................................................................65310
Sensor PCB (J390394) .......................................................................................................................................65320
MMC connecting PCB (J390483) .....................................................................................................................65330
MMC sensor PCB (J390389) ............................................................................................................................65340
AMC connecting PCB (J390700) ......................................................................................................................65350
135 AFC connecting PCB (J390779) ................................................................................................................65360
135 AFC sensor PCB (J390709) .......................................................................................................................65370
Magnetic preamplifier PCB unit (W411413/W411414) ...................................................................................65380
Connecting PCB 1 (J390783) ............................................................................................................................65390
Connecting PCB 2 (J490291) ............................................................................................................................65400
6000 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
6000
6 Electrical parts
Handling the flat cable .......................................................................................................................................68200
Power ON/OFF .................................................................................................................... 68500
Operation when the power supply is turned on .................................................................................................68500
When power is not supplied to input and output sections (How to use the starter jumper) .............................68550
6000 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
61000
Position of electrical parts (desk section)
Position of electrical parts (desk section)
5
4
1 7
G068447
6. Electrical parts
Desk section (electrical parts) (front)
No. Name Symbol Remarks
3 Colorimeter − Colorimeter unit *1
4 Paper sensor 1 SE75
5 Paper sensor 2 SE76
6 Paper advance motor PM12
7 Pressure change solenoid SOL1
61000 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
61000
Position of electrical parts (desk section)
8: For standard PC
8: For high-spec PC
17 9
16 10
12
6 11
1
7
15
14
6. Electrical parts
4 5 15 13
3 G068431
*1. The digital masking unit (Z809810-01) consists of two scratch mend PCBs 1, a data change-over PCB, a scratch mend PCB 2, and a DIMM.
61000 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
61000
Position of electrical parts (desk section)
*2. For the Stand Alone Printer, this PCB is not attached.
*3. For the DLS specification, this PCB is not attached.
6. Electrical parts
61000 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62000
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
Each of the three following scanner types has a unique scanner section PCB location: S-2, S-3, and S-4.
• For S-3, refer to ☞ Scanner section (positions of PCBs) [S-3].
• For S-4, refer to ☞ Scanner section (positions of PCBs) [S-4].
6. Electrical parts
5 6
G068429
62000 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62000
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
1
7
4 6 5
G077179
6. Electrical parts
3 LED driver PCB J390999
4 Multi power supply (scanner) PS3 I038373 ☞ 65060
5 Scanner power supply 1 PS1 I038379
6 Scanner power supply 2 PS2 I038263
7 PM driver (film feed motor) PMD1 I043111 ☞ 65070
62000 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62000
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
1
6
3 5 4
G078475
6. Electrical parts
3 Multi power supply (scanner) PS3 I038373 ☞ 65060
4 Scanner power supply 1 PS1 I038379
5 Scanner power supply 2 PS2 I038263
6 PM driver (film feed motor) PMD1 I043111 ☞ 65070
62000 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62050
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
The location of the electrical parts in each of the following scanners is unique: S-2, S-3, and S-4.
• For S-3, refer to ☞ Scanner section (positions of electrical parts) [S-3].
• For S-4, refer to ☞ Scanner section (positions of electrical parts) [S-4].
2
3
6. Electrical parts
5 6
G068445
62050 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62050
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
NOTE
• For details about how to remove the LED light source unit, refer to the following.
☞ 20620
• ND Filter Solenoid, LED Heater (High), LED Heater (Medium), LED Heater (Low), B LED, G LED, R1 LED, R2 LED, D LED
and LED thermosensor are built in the LED light source unit.
6. Electrical parts
• The heater of the LED light source unit can be changed in the three levels for (H), (M) or (L).
G068446
62050 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62050
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
Operation specification
Name Symbol Operation condition
LED light source unit - Controlled temperature: 45.0±1°C
LED cooling fan 1 FAN1 When the LED thermosensor is 45.4°C or more: Fan ON
LED cooling fan 2 FAN2 When the LED thermosensor is 45.0°C or less: Fan OFF
Power supply cooling fan FAN4 When scanner power supply 2 is ON, the fan is always ON.
Control box cooling fan 1 FAN5
Control box cooling fan 2 FAN6
NOTE
• All the fans above are OFF while the program timer activates.
6. Electrical parts
62050 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62050
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
2
3
6. Electrical parts
5 6
G068445
NOTE
• For details about how to remove the LED light source unit, refer to the following.
☞ 20620
• LED light source unit type is checked in the System Version Check display. ☞ 35500
• ND Filter Solenoid, LED Cooling Fan, LED Heater (High), LED Heater (Medium), LED Heater (Low), B LED, G LED, R1
LED, IR LED and LED thermosensor are built in the LED light source unit.
• The heater of the LED light source unit can be changed in the three levels for (H), (M) or (L).
62050 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62050
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
8
G077199
Operation specification
Name Symbol Operation condition
LED light source unit - Controlled temperature: 45.0±1°C
LED cooling fan 1 FAN1 When the LED thermosensor is 45.4°C or more: Fan ON
When the LED thermosensor is 45.0°C or less: Fan OFF
6. Electrical parts
LED cooling fan 2 FAN2
Power supply cooling fan FAN3 When scanner power supply 2 is ON, the fan is always ON.
Control box cooling fan 1 FAN4
NOTE
• All the fans above are OFF while the program timer activates.
62050 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62050
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
2
3
6. Electrical parts
5 6
G078479
IMPORTANT
• S-4 LED light source unit(s) cannot be used with the S-2 or the S-3.
NOTE
• For details about how to remove the LED light source unit, refer to the following.
☞ 20620
• ND Filter Solenoid, LED Cooling Fan, LED Heater (High), LED Heater (Medium), LED Heater (Low), B LED, G LED, R1
LED, IR LED and LED thermosensor are built in the LED light source unit.
• The heater of the LED light source unit can be changed in the three levels for (H), (M) or (L).
62050 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62050
Position of electrical parts (scanner section)
8
G078478
Operation specification
Name Symbol Operation condition
LED light source unit - Controlled temperature: 45.0±1°C
LED cooling fan 1 FAN1 When the LED thermosensor is 45.4°C or more: Fan ON
6. Electrical parts
LED cooling fan 2 FAN2 When the LED thermosensor is 45.0°C or less: Fan OFF
Power supply cooling fan FAN3 When scanner power supply 2 is ON, the fan is always ON.
Control box cooling fan FAN4
NOTE
• All the fans above are OFF while the program timer activates.
62050 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62100
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
7
4
10
5
G051054
135/240 AFC-II
No. Name Symbol Part No. Manual No. Remarks
1 Connecting PCB 1 J390756 ☞ 65200
6. Electrical parts
2 Connecting PCB 2 J390482 ☞ 65210
3 Connecting PCB 3 J490255 ☞ 65220
4 Driver PCB 1 J390368 ☞ 65230
5 Driver PCB 2 J390519 ☞ 65240 One of the two types of
J391115 PCBs is installed in this
system.
The two types of PCBs
are not compatible.
6 Sensor PCB J390757 ☞ 65250 The PCB cannot be
replaced.
7 Power PCB J390755 ☞ 65260
8 Magnetic head PCB J391050 ☞ 65270 Type R/W only
(J390497) The part in parentheses is
no longer available.
J391051 Type R only
(J390784) The part in parentheses is
no longer available.
9 Connecting PCB 4 J390579 ☞ 65280
10 Magnetic preamplifier PCB unit*1 W411413 ☞ 65380 Type R/W only
W411414 Type R only
*1. Unnecessary when using the magnetic head PCB (J390497) (J390784).
62100 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62150
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
2 13
8
3
4
10 11
9
12
5 5
27
14
12
13
21
3
7 1 22
20
10 7
Magnetic head unit
2
1
11 4
23 15
6. Electrical parts
8 9
16
When the magnetic head unit is opened When the rear cover is opened
24 18
17
19
26 25
6
G057595
135/240 AFC-II
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 135 loading sensor SE52
2 135 ready sensor SE53
3 135 perforation sensor SE54
4 240 ready sensor SE55
5 240 perforation sensor SE56
62150 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62150
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
6. Electrical parts
62150 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62200
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
G051055
120 AFC-II
No. Name Symbol Parts No. Manual No. Remarks
1 Connecting PCB J390371 ☞ 65290
6. Electrical parts
2 Sensor PCB J390385 ☞ 65300
62200 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62250
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
2
4
1
G051034
120 AFC-II
No. Name Symbol Remarks
6. Electrical parts
1 Loading sensor SE64
2 Ready sensor SE65
3 Film sensor SE66
4 Film feed sensor SE67
5 Film feed motor PM10
62250 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62300
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
6. Electrical parts
G052691
110 AFC-II
No. Name Symbol Part No. Manual No. Remarks
1 Connecting PCB J390372 ☞ 65310
2 Sensor PCB J390394 ☞ 65320
62300 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62350
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
2
3
6. Electrical parts
3
G052690
110 AFC-II
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 Loading sensor SE90
2 Ready sensor SE91
3 Perforation sensor SE92
4 Film feed motor PM10
62350 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62400
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
2
1
6. Electrical parts
G052688
135/240 MMC-II
No. Name Symbol Part No. Manual No. Remarks
1 MMC connecting PCB J390483 ☞ 65330
2 MMC sensor PCB J390389 ☞ 65340
62400 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62450
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
8
4
6
6. Electrical parts
9
2
3
G052686
135/240 MMC-II
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 Mount carrier home sensor SE68
2 Mount sensor SE70
3 AF sensor SE72
4 Mount carrier sensor (upper) SE73
5 Mount carrier sensor (lower) SE74
6 Mount insertion cover sensor SE77
7 AF motor DM9
8 Mount carrier slide motor PM11
9 Mount insertion cover open switch SM3
62450 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62500
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
2
1
G058784
6. Electrical parts
135/240 AMC-II
No. Name Symbol Part No. Manual No. Remarks
1 AMC connecting PCB J390700 ☞ 65350
2 MMC sensor PCB J390389 ☞ 65340
62500 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62550
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
6
9 14
1
12
15
10
11
13
6. Electrical parts
3
7,8
5
G060697
135/240 AMC-II
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 Mount carrier home sensor SE156
2 Loading sensor 1 SE157
3 Loading sensor 2 SE158
4 Mount elevator sensor SE159
5 AF sensor SE160
6 Mount sensor (inlet) SE161
7 Mount carrier sensor (lower) SE162
8 Mount carrier sensor (upper) SE163
9 Mount sensor SE164
10 Ejection sensor SE165
11 Mount insertion motor DM14
12 Mount elevator motor DM15
13 AF motor DM16
14 Mount carrier slide motor PM17
15 Mount ejection solenoid SOL26
62550 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62600
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
6. Electrical parts
G057668
135 AFC-II
No. Name Symbol Part No. Manual No. Remarks
1 135 AFC connecting PCB J390779 ☞ 65360
2 135 AFC sensor PCB J390709 ☞ 65370
62600 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62650
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
3
4,5
2
6,7
9
8
6,7
6. Electrical parts
2
4,5
10
G057597
135 AFC-II
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 135 loading sensor SE52
2 135 ready sensor SE53
3 135 perforation sensor SE54
4 135 DX sensor 1 SE147 Uses for Film Detection as well.
5 135 DX sensor 2 SE148
6 135 DX sensor 3 SE149 Uses for Film Detection as well.
7 135 DX sensor 4 SE150
8 Rewinding sensor SE78
9 Film feed motor PM1
10 Panorama shutter solenoid SOL5
62650 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62660
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
6. Electrical parts
G071630
MFC
No. Name Symbol Parts No. Manual No.
1 Connecting PCB 1 J390783 ☞ 65390
2 Connecting PCB 2 J490291 ☞ 65400
62660 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
62670
Position of electrical parts (Film Carrier Section)
! Position
3
5
2
10
9
8
7
6
6. Electrical parts
1 4
G071629
MFC
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 Table home sensor SE116
2 Table slide motor PM20
3 Film pressure magnet MH1
4 Film pressure switch SW8
5 Film viewer L8
6 Attachment Detection Switch 1 LM21 These switches are positioned at
7 Attachment Detection Switch 2 LM22 connecting PCB 2. ☞ 65400
8 Attachment Detection Switch 3 LM23
9 Attachment Detection Switch 4 LM24
10 Attachment Detection Switch 5 LM25
62670 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63000
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
! Position 1
4
1
5
10 9 8
6. Electrical parts
11
6 7
G068432
Printer section 1
No. Name Symbol Parts No. Manual No. Remarks
1 B-AOM driver I124020 ☞ 66080 The part in
2 G-AOM driver (I124019) parentheses is no
(I124012) longer available.
3 R-AOM driver
4 Laser control PCB J390919 ☞ 66010
5 Laser I/O PCB J390945 ☞ 66060
6 B laser driver J390973 ☞ 66070 Laser unit (Type
7 G laser driver A1)
6 B laser driver J390929 Laser unit (Type
7 G laser driver B1)
8 Printer control PCB J390947 ☞ 66000
9 Multi power supply (printer) PS4 I038160 ☞ 66100
10 Printer I/O PCB 3 J390868 ☞ 66040
11 Laser power supply PS5 I038286 ☞ 66100
63000 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63000
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
! Position 2
7 4
5
6. Electrical parts
1 2 3 G069576
Printer section 2
No. Name Symbol Parts No. Manual No. Remarks
1 Printer I/O PCB 1 J390866 ☞ 66020
2 CVP PCB J390943 ☞ 66090 Option
3 Printer power supply 3 PS3 I038364 ☞ 66100
4 Printer power supply 1 PS1 I038361
5 Printer power supply 2 PS2 I038287
6 Printer I/O PCB 2 J390867 ☞ 66030
7 Triple magazine PCB J390835 ☞ 66050
63000 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63050
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
7
11
6. Electrical parts
10
3 1 2 4
G068441
*1. When LS1, 2, and 3 turns OFF, all motors in the printer stops and the following sensors turns as follows: cut home sensor (LIGHT), cut end
sensor (LIGHT), paper loading sensor (LIGHT), paper supply pressure change sensor (DARK), paper hold sensor (DARK), and paper end sensor
B (DARK)
Also, the control signals of B, G and R-AOM drivers are cut off and laser light is not output from the laser unit.
63050 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63050
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
1
6
G068443
6. Electrical parts
5 Control box cooling fan 1 FAN2
6 Paper advance section cooling fan 1 FAN5
63050 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63051
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
! Position
8
Paper magazine mount A
6. Electrical parts
7 9
Paper magazine mount C
6
4
5
G068427
63051 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63060
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
! Position
2 1
11 7
13
14
12 8 9 10
3
6. Electrical parts
4
G068425
63060 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63070
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
! Position
7
Front
4
5
Front
1
3
2
G068426
6. Electrical parts
Exposure advance unit
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 Zigzagging correction sensor (left) SE12
2 Zigzagging correction sensor (right) SE13
3 Exposure start sensor SE14
4 Exposure advance pressure change sensor 1 SE15
5 Exposure advance pressure change sensor 2 SE16
6 Exposure advance motor 1 PM9
7 Exposure advance motor 2 PM11
8 Exposure advance pressure change motor 1 PM10
9 Exposure advance pressure change motor 2 PM12
63070 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63080
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
NOTE
• For details about how to remove the laser unit, refer to the following.
☞ 26710
• It is not necessary to change the setting because it recognizes the type of the laser unit when installed.
IMPORTANT
• There are two ways to identify the type of the laser unit which is equipped as described below.
1. It can be identified by the version of the LASER on the System Version Check display.
☞ 35500
2. It can be identified by the label placed on the laser unit.
6. Electrical parts
Laser unit (Type A1) Black letters on a white background First four-digit number is No.
0913.
Laser unit (Type B1) Black letter on a yellow First four-digit number is No.
background 0912.
Laser unit
0913######## 0912########
Type A1 Type B1
63080 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63080
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
! Position
1
G068440
Laser unit
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 Laser unit heater H5 Go to ☞ 37300 for ON/OFF controlling of
the laser unit heater.
6. Electrical parts
63080 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63090
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
! Position
4
1 G068422
6. Electrical parts
3 Pressure guide sensor SE17
4 Paper sensor 1 SE18
63090 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63100
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
! Position
12 5 3 10 7
11 6 13
6. Electrical parts
1 8
2 4
G068424
63100 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63110
Position of electrical parts (printer section)
! Position
G068423
6. Electrical parts
63110 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63200
Description of PCB (processor section)
Description of PCB (processor section)
! Position
1 5
4 2
3 7 G068433
6. Electrical parts
Processor section
No. Name Symbol Parts No. Manual No. Remarks
1 Processor control PCB J390878 ☞ 66200
2 Processor I/O PCB J390798 ☞ 66210
3 Processor relay PCB J390917 ☞ 66220
4 Transistor PCB J404493 Cooling water
solenoid valve
(option)
5 Processor power supply 1 PS1 I038320 ☞ 67400
6 Processor power supply 2 PS2 I038286
7 Processor power supply 3 PS3
63200 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63200
Description of PCB (processor section)
! Position
1
G070039
SM replenishment unit
No. Name Symbol Parts No. Manual No. Remarks
1 SM I/O PCB J390330 ☞ 66600
6. Electrical parts
63200 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63250
Positions of electrical parts (processor section)
Positions of electrical parts (processor section)
! Position
20 9 8 7
18
21
25
23 24
26 to 31
49
22
6. Electrical parts
19
39, 40, 41
45
13, 14, 15
46 50
47
51
48
52
Processor section
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 CD processing solution float switch FS1
CD refilling water level
CD processing solution level
CD safety thermostat
2 BF processing solution float switch FS2
BF refilling water level
BF processing solution level
BF safety thermostat
63250 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63250
Positions of electrical parts (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
20 Exhaust fan FAN13 Exhaust ☞ Operation specification
of the fan
21 Drive motor cooling fan FAN16 Blowing ☞ Operation specification
of the fan
22 Tank cooling fan 1 FAN10 Intake ☞ Operation specification of
the fan
23 Tank cooling fan 3 FAN12 Exhaust ☞ Operation specification
of the fan
24 Tank cooling fan 2 FAN11 Exhaust ☞ Operation specification
of the fan
25 Drive motor M3 If replaced, carry out Drive Motor
Revolution Count Setting.
☞ 33600
26 CD circulation pump P1
27 BF circulation pump P3
28 STB1 circulation pump P5
29 STB2 circulation pump P6
30 STB3 circulation pump P7
31 STB4 circulation pump P8
32 CD-W refilling water pump P9
33 BF-W refilling water pump P10
34 STB1-W refilling water pump P11
35 STB2-W refilling water pump P12
36 STB3-W refilling water pump P13
37 STB4-W refilling water pump P14
38 Cleaning pump 1 P15
39 CD replenisher pump RP1
63250 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63250
Positions of electrical parts (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
Drive motor cooling fan FAN16 When the drive motor operates, the fan is ON. When the drive motor stops, the fan is
OFF.
NOTE
• All the fans above except the exhaust fan are OFF while the program timer activates.
63250 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63250
Positions of electrical parts (processor section)
! Position
16
9 8 7
21
17
10,28,1,11,12,29,2,3,4,5,6,13,30,6
19
20
14
22 to 27
15
18
6. Electrical parts
32
31 36
33
35
37
34
38
G070016
63250 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63250
Positions of electrical parts (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
of the fan
21 Drive motor M3 If replaced, carry out Drive Motor
Revolution Count Setting.
☞ 33600
22 CD circulation pump P1
23 BF circulation pump P3
24 STB1 circulation pump P5
25 STB2 circulation pump P6
26 STB3 circulation pump P7
27 STB4 circulation pump P8
28 CD heater H1
29 BF heater H2
30 STB heater H3
31 Hour meter HM1 Option
32 CD cooling water solenoid valve MV1 Option
33 BF cooling water solenoid valve MV2 Option
34 STB cooling water solenoid valve MV3 Option
35 CD digital flowmeter FLS1 Option
36 Earth leakage circuit breaker 1 NFB2 Refer to 4203 ☞ Earth leakage
circuit breaker 1 (NFB2).
37 Earth leakage circuit breaker 2 NFB3 Refer to 4203 ☞ Earth leakage
circuit breaker 2 (NFB3).
38 Earth leakage circuit breaker 3 NFB4 Refer to 4203 ☞ Earth leakage
circuit breaker 3 (NFB4).
63250 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63250
Positions of electrical parts (processor section)
! Position
26 3 21 13 22
2
23
25
29
24 6
4 28
27
19
12
18
10
17
20
6. Electrical parts
9 16
14
15 11
8
7 G070041
SM replenishment unit
No. Name Symbol Remarks
1 CD-A replenisher pump sensor SE32
2 CD-B replenisher pump sensor SE33
3 CD-C replenisher pump sensor SE34
4 BF-A replenisher pump sensor SE35
5 BF-B replenisher pump sensor SE36
6 STB replenisher pump sensor SE37
7 CD-A replenishment solution sensor SE38
8 CD-B replenishment solution sensor SE39
9 CD-C replenishment solution sensor SE40
10 STB replenishment solution sensor SE41
11 BF-A replenishment solution sensor SE42
12 BF-B replenishment solution sensor SE43
13 CD-W water supply pump sensor SE44
14 Water supply tank level sensor LSE5
15 Replenishment package sensor P-1 LS6
16 Replenishment package sensor P-2 LS7
63250 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63250
Positions of electrical parts (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
63250 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63260
Position of electrical parts (dryer section and order classification section)
Position of electrical parts (dryer section and order classification section)
! Position
18
13 1 17
6 5 4 15
11
16
8
7
6. Electrical parts
12 14
10
G068390
63260 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
63260
Position of electrical parts (dryer section and order classification section)
6. Electrical parts
63260 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64000
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
G078391
Unused
Unused depending on the conditions
G068419
64000 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64000
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
! Function
• Receives the image data from the D-ICE PCB.
• Stores the image data in the input memory temporarily and the development memory to process and edit the image data.
• Performs transmission and reception of the image data with the image correction PCB.
• Performs inputting and outputting the image data with PC.
• Performs inputting and outputting the image data with the external PC.
• Outputs the image data to the laser control PCB.
• Performs the optical ARCNET communications.
IMPORTANT
• Although the parts mounted on the image processing PCB (new) and the image processing PCB (old) are different,
they are compatible with each other.
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Check the settings of DIP switches.
IMPORTANT
• On this PCB, the optical fiber cables connect to the connectors P443 (IN) and P442 (OUT) and the LVDS cables
connect to the connectors J1350, J445, J455, and J456. Be sure to read the Precautions for handling the optical
fiber cable and LVDS cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
6. Electrical parts
• Read the system program.
☞ 35600
! 4. Symptoms caused by poor wiring connections
• Refer to 4201 ☞ Image processing PCB.
! Unused connector
IMPORTANT
• The parts mounted on the image processing PCB (new) and the image processing PCB (old) are different.
IMPORTANT
• The parts mounted on the image processing PCB (new) and the image processing PCB (old) are different.
64000 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64000
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
DS1 1 OFF Unused Be sure to turn OFF. *1
DS2 1 OFF Unused Be sure to set to OFF.
2 OFF Unused
3 OFF Unused
4 OFF Unused
5 OFF Unused
6 OFF Unused
7 OFF Unused
8 OFF Unused
64000 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64010
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
Memory
6. Electrical parts
Unused
G070032
! Function
• Performs auto sharpness, auto contrast, scaling, image rotation, and density correction to the input image.
NOTE
• The two memories have been attached to the image correction PCB cannot be replaced alone.
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Check that the two memories have been attached to the image correction PCB.
64010 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64010
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P1348 Unused
P1349 Unused
P1365 Unused
CN1 Unused
6. Electrical parts
JP3 1 Open Reset The test pin is unmounted.
NOTE
• Some PCBs have connector(s) and test point(s) on their back side.
• Other ground(s) than TP68 to TP72 is on the PCB.
64010 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64030
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
Unused
G068438
! Function
6. Electrical parts
• Controls the D-ICE PCB
• Controls the buzzer and PC power switch of ON
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Backup the data of the machine.
☞ 35400
• To remove the D-ICE control PCB, read the procedures for removing the D-ICE control PCB and the D-ICE PCB. ☞ 64045
• Check the settings of DIP switches.
IMPORTANT
• You can connect the optical fiber cable to any connector below only if you do not miss out on IN and OUT.
• This PCB has the connectors (below) which are connected to optical fiber cables. Be sure to read the Precautions
for handling the optical fiber cable and LVDS cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
64030
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P55 Unused
6. Electrical parts
4
64030 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64040
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
Unused
6. Electrical parts
Unused depending on the conditions
G068437
! Function
• Communicates with the D-ICE control PCB
• Transfers the image data to image processing PCB from the scanner
• Performs the image cut of the input image from the scanner by film size.
• Detects and corrects the scratch and dust on the film base layer.
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• To remove the D-ICE PCB, read the procedures for removing the D-ICE control PCB and the D-ICE PCB. ☞ 64045
• Check the settings of DIP switches.
IMPORTANT
• The LVDS cable connects to the connector P436 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions for handling the
optical fiber cable and LVDS cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
64040 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64040
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
J485 Scratch mend PCB 1 [J485] Option
J484A Scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A]
J486 Data change-over PCB Option
J487
J483 Scratch mend PCB 2 Option
J480 DIMM Option
CN−MAIN Unused
CN−SUB Unused
6. Electrical parts
TP2 Ground Possible
TP3 DC1.4 V voltage measurement Possible
TP4 Ground Possible
TP5 DC3.3 V voltage measurement Possible
TP6 Ground Possible
TP7 DC2.5 V−1 input check Possible
TP8 Ground Possible
TP9 DC2.5 V−2 input check Possible
TP10 Ground Possible
TP11 Unused Impossible
TP14 to 17 Unused Impossible
TP20 to 23 Unused Impossible
64040 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64045
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
G070237
3. Disconnect all connectors from the D-ICE control PCB and the D-ICE PCB.
6. Electrical parts
4. Remove the six PCB spacers of the D-ICE PCB and PCB pressers 1 and 2. (six screws)
PCB spacers
PCB presser 1
PCB spacer
PCB presser 2
PCB spacers
G068212
64045 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64045
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Remove the D-ICE control PCB and the D-ICE PCB together and separate them to replace.
IMPORTANT
• Be sure to remove those D-ICE control PCB and D-ICE PCB together. If you remove one of them only, the
spacer that fixes the PCBs may damage the PCB.
D-ICE control PCB
Connection
D-ICE PCB
G072360
6. Electrical parts
64045 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64050
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
DIMM (I090499)
Terminal
G070040
! Function
• Stores the image data temporarily
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Do not touch the terminal.
6. Electrical parts
• Refer to 4201 ☞ DIMM.
! Unused connector
• None
64050 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64060
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
G068411
! Function
• Corrects the scratches on the film base layer
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
6. Electrical parts
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Do not touch the terminal of CN2.
! Unused connector
• None
64060 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64060
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
64060 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64070
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
Scratch mend PCB 1 [J484A] and scratch mend PCB 1 [J485] (J390904)
Unused
G068444
! Function
• Corrects the scratches on the film emulsion layer
6. Electrical parts
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Do not touch the terminal of CN1.
• Check the settings of DIP switches.
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
CN3 Unused
64070 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64070
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
64070 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64080
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
G068410
! Function
• The data change-over PCB relays the image data when scratch mend PCB 1 is mounted on the D-ICE PCB.
6. Electrical parts
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
64080 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64100
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
Unused
! Function
• Relays ARCNET communication.
6. Electrical parts
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
IMPORTANT
• You can connect the optical fiber cable for the ARCNET HUB PCB to any connectors below unless you miss to
distinguish the IN/OUT side of the cable. The positions of unused connectors may vary by model.
• This PCB has the connectors (below) which are connected to optical fiber cables. Be sure to read the Precautions
for handling the optical fiber cable and LVDS cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
Optical fiber cable list
OUT J133, J135, J137, J139
IN J134, J136, J138, J140
! Unused connector
• None
64100 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64100
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
64100 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64110
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
G057402
! Function
• Connects the operation keyboard.
! 1. Position
6. Electrical parts
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
64110 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64120
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
G068402
! Function
• Relays signals of the operation keyboard, full keyboard and mouse to the PC.
NOTE
• The power is not supplied to the keyboard switch PCB unless the PC is ON.
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
64120 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64120
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
64120 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64130
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
G068401
! Function
• Controls the colorimeter unit.
• Relays the communication between the colorimeter and PC.
• Communicates with the PC.
6. Electrical parts
! Adjustments and precautions for PCB replacement
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Backup the data of the machine.
☞ 35400
• Check the setting of the DIP switch.
! Unused connector
• None
64130 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64130
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
IMPORTANT
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
6. Electrical parts
64130 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64140
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
! Function
• Controls the pricing unit.
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Backup the data of the machine.
☞ 35400
• Check the setting of the DIP switch.
IMPORTANT
• This PCB has connectors P299 (IN) and P300 (OUT) which are connected to optical fiber cables. Be sure to read the
Precautions for handling the optical fiber cable and LVDS cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P301 Pricing unit keyboard connection
64140 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64140
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
8 OFF Unused
64140 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64160
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
Unused
G068403
! Function
• Supplies the voltage of AC 200 V.
• Protects the power surge.
6. Electrical parts
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Move the jumper connector (J100) in P100 to the PCB with which you are going to replace.
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P103 Unused
64160 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64170
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
G068404
! Function
Symbol Name Parts Function Remarks
No.
PS2 Desk power supply 1 I038293 Supplies the power to DC+5 V
each PCB.
PS3 Desk power supply 2 I038263 Supplies the power to DC+24 V
each PCB.
6. Electrical parts
IMPORTANT
• Each power supply is equipped with the overvoltage and overheat protection functions. If these functions are
operated, turn off the circuit breaker of the machine and wait for a while, then turn on again. If the overheat protection
function is operated, check if each cooling fan is in operation.
! 1. Position
☞ 61000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
Power supply Precautions for replacement
Desk power supply 1 Do not touch each volume which has already been adjusted by the manufacturer before
Desk power supply 2 shipping.
! Unused connector
• None
64170 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
64170
Descriptions of PCB (desk section)
6. Electrical parts
64170 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65000
Description of PCB (scanner section)
Description of PCB (scanner section)
6. Electrical parts
May not be mounted depending on conditions
G068413
! Function
• Controls each AFC
• Controls the scanner unit and LED light source unit.
! 1. Position
☞ 62000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Backup the data of the machine.
☞ 35400
• Check the setting of the DIP switch.
IMPORTANT
• This PCB has connectors J20 (OUT) and J21 (IN) which are connected to optical fiber cables. Be sure to read the
Precautions for handling the optical fiber cable and LVDS cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
65000 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65000
Description of PCB (scanner section)
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P7 For the LED light source unit type 0: Unused
For the LED light source unit types 1, 2 and 3:
Connects to the R LED relay connector J/P168.
S-4: Not used
P11 S-2/S-3: Not used
When using S-4: Used to display scanner type (S-
4) during system version confirmation.
P14 Unused For only J390879-04 or later: P14 Unmounted
J10 Unused
6. Electrical parts
IMPORTANT
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
65000 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65000
Description of PCB (scanner section)
6. Electrical parts
65000 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65010
Description of PCB (scanner section)
The AFC/Scanner Driver PCB performs different functions in S-2/S-3 and S-4.
• For S-4, refer to ☞ AFC/scanner driver PCB (J391106) [S-4].
6. Electrical parts
Unused/unmounted depending on
Unused depending on the conditions
conditions
G068414
! Function
• Controls motors of the scanner section and relays sensors.
• Supplies the power to the film carrier and the film cleaner.
IMPORTANT
• Although the parts mounted on the AFC/Scanner driver PCB (-03 or later) and AFC/Scanner driver PCB (-02 or
earlier) are different, they are compatible with each other.
65010 1/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65010
Description of PCB (scanner section)
! 1. Position
☞ 62000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
IMPORTANT
• Although the parts mounted on the AFC/Scanner driver PCB (-03 or later) and AFC/Scanner driver PCB (-02 or
earlier) are different, they are compatible with each other.
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P31 Unused For only J390768-03 or later: Unmounted
P32 Unused
6. Electrical parts
P33 Unused
P36 Unused
P37 Unused
P39 Unused
P43 Film cleaner Option
P44 Unused
IMPORTANT
• Although the parts mounted on the AFC/Scanner driver PCB (-03 or later) and AFC/Scanner driver PCB (-02 or
earlier) are different, they are compatible with each other.
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
65010 2/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65010
Description of PCB (scanner section)
6. Electrical parts
65010 3/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65010
Description of PCB (scanner section)
LED7
TP6 P46
P144 LED3
F3
TP9 TP7
TP13 F2 P65
TP15
LED2 TP10
P26
P27 P141 P70 P66
6. Electrical parts
LED8
TP16 TP1
F4
Not mounted
G081994
! Function
• Controls motors of the scanner section and relays sensors.
• Supplies the power to the film carrier and the film cleaner.
• Controls the LED electric current, temperature, filter solenoid of LED light source unit.
IMPORTANT
• AFC/scanner driver PCB (J391106) can only be used with S-4 and is not compatible with S-2/S-3 scanner driver
PCBs.
• S-4 contains no LED driver PCB because its AFC/scanner driver PCB (J391106) has the functionality of the LED
driver PCBs in S-2 and S-3.
! 1. Position
☞ 62000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
65010 4/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65010
Description of PCB (scanner section)
! Unused connector
• None
IMPORTANT
6. Electrical parts
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
65010 5/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65010
Description of PCB (scanner section)
6. Electrical parts
65010 6/6
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65020
Description of PCB (scanner section)
6. Electrical parts
G068415
G076394
65020 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65020
Description of PCB (scanner section)
! Function
• Controls the LED electric current, temperature, ND filter solenoid of LED light source unit.
IMPORTANT
• S-4 contains no LED driver PCB because its AFC/scanner driver PCB (J391106) is equipped with equivalent
functions.
☞ 65010
! 1. Position
☞ 62000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Depending on the type of the LED light source unit, the PCB is different.
6. Electrical parts
J390870→ $ Replace in LED light source kit Replace in LED light source kit
1*1 2*1
J390995→ − $ Replace in LED light source kit
2*1
J390999→ − − $
NOTE
• There are two ways as described below to identify the type of the LED driver PCB or LED light source unit which is equipped as
described below.
• Checking the number sticker which is attached on the top of LED light source unit ☞ 20620
• Checking on the System Version Check display ☞ 35500
65020 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65020
Description of PCB (scanner section)
! Unused connector
• None
6. Electrical parts
TP7 Ground Possible
TP8 DC+12 V voltage measurement Possible
TP9 Ground Possible
TP10 DC+24 V voltage measurement Possible
TP11 DC+5 V voltage measurement Possible
TP12 Ground Possible
TP13 Ground Possible
TP14 DC−12 V voltage measurement Possible
TP15 Ground Possible
65020 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65060
Description of PCB (scanner section)
G068416
! Function
Symbol Name Parts [S-2/S-3] Functions [S-4] Functions
No.
PS1 Scanner power I038379 Power supply to AFC/scanner Power supply to AFC/scanner DC+36 V
supply 1 driver PCB and LED driver PCB. driver PCB.
PS2 Scanner power I038263 Power supply to AFC/scanner Power supply to the AFC/scanner DC+24 V
6. Electrical parts
supply 2 control PCB, AFC/scanner driver control PCB, AFC/scanner driver
PCB and the LED driver PCB. PCB.
PS3 Multi power supply I038373 Power supply (DC+5 V) to Power supply to the AFC/scanner DC+5 V,
(scanner) AFC/scanner control PCB, control PCB(DC +5 V), DC+15 V
AFC/scanner driver PCB and AFC/Scanner driver PCB (DC+5
LED driver PCB. Power supply V, +15 V), and scanner
(DC+15 V) to scanner unit. unit(DC+15V).
IMPORTANT
• Each power supply is equipped with the overvoltage and overheat protection functions. If these functions are
operated, turn off the circuit breaker of the machine and wait for a while, then turn on again. If the overheat protection
function is operated, check if each cooling fan is in operation.
! 1. Position
☞ 62000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
Power supply Precautions for replacement
Scanner power supply 1 Do not touch each volume which has already been adjusted by the manufacturer before
Scanner power supply 2 shipping.
Multi power supply (scanner)
65060 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65060
Description of PCB (scanner section)
! Unused connector
• None
6. Electrical parts
65060 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65070
Description of PCB (scanner section)
PM driver
PMD1
G068412
! Function
Symbol Name Parts Function Adjustments and Remarks
No. precautions for PCB
replacement
PMD1 PM driver (film feed I043111 Controls the film feed Do not touch each All connectors are
motor) motor. potentiometer which has used.
been adjusted by the
manufacturer before
shipping.
! Position
☞ 62000
6. Electrical parts
• [If using S-2/S-3], refer to 4200 ☞ PM driver (film feed motor) (PMD1).
• [If using S-4], refer to ☞ 4190
65070 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65200
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G057586
! Function
• Relays the AFC/scanner control PCB, the sensor PCB and the magnetic head PCB.
! 1. Position
☞ 62100
! 2. Precautions for replacement
IMPORTANT
• The flat cables connect to connectors P1001 and P1002 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions when
6. Electrical parts
handling the flat cable, then work properly. ☞ 68200
! Unused connector
• None
65200 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65210
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G051012
! Function
• Changes the sensor of the film feed route when 135 and 240 lanes are switched.
! 1. Position
☞ 62100
! 2. Precautions for replacement
IMPORTANT
6. Electrical parts
• The flat cable is connected to connector P1010 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions when handling the
flat cable, then work properly. ☞ 68200
! Unused connector
• None
65210 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65220
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G051013
! Function
• Relays the AFC/scanner control PCB and driver PCB 2.
! 1. Position
☞ 62100
! 2. Precautions for replacement
IMPORTANT
• The flat cable is connected to connector P1009 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions when handling the
flat cable, then work properly. ☞ 68200
6. Electrical parts
! 3. Adjustment after replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
65220 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65230
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G051014
! Function
• Controls the light lock door motor and the film feed motor cooling fan.
! 1. Position
☞ 62100
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
6. Electrical parts
! Unused connector
• None
65230 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65240
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
Driver PCB 2
J390519
Unused
G068378
J391115
6. Electrical parts
G082023
IMPORTANT
• J390519 and J391115 are incompatible due to differences in the methods used to install them. Confirm the parts number
and be sure to judge the PCB type.
! Function
• Controls the spool key motor.
• Inputs the limit switch of 135 or 240 lane.
! 1. Position
☞ 62100
! 2. Precautions for replacement
IMPORTANT
• The flat cable is connected to connector P1032 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions when handling the
flat cable, then work properly. ☞ 68200
65240 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65240
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P1035 Unused J391115 is not equipped with this connector.
6. Electrical parts
65240 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65250
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G051016
! Function
• Amplifies the input signal of the film feed route and relays the other sensors.
• Writes the magnetic data.
IMPORTANT
• This sensor PCB cannot be replaced.
Because the wires connected to each DX sensor and the LED PCB are being soldered and the wiring is complicated
and difficult to return it to the original condition.
• The flat cable is connected to connector P1014 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions when handling the
flat cable, then work properly. ☞ 68200
6. Electrical parts
! Position
☞ 62100
! Unused connector
• None
65250 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65260
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
Unused
G068379
! Function
• Generates the power supply of DC+5 V and +12 V.
• Controls the panorama shutter solenoid.
! 1. Position
☞ 62100
6. Electrical parts
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P1051 Unused
P1052 Unused The connector may not be mounted.
65260 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65270
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
When the magnetic head unit is not equipped the magnetic preamplifier PCB, refer to ☞ Magnetic head PCB (J390497/J390784).
J391050 [135/240 AFC-II (R/W) only], J391051 [135/240 AFC-II (R) only]
Part No.
J39105#-00
G075908
IMPORTANT
• Although the form of J391050 and J391051 is the same but it is not compatible. Confirm the parts number and be sure to
judge the PCB type.
! Function
• Reads and writes the magnetic data.
! 1. Position
6. Electrical parts
☞ 62100
! 2. Precautions for replacement
IMPORTANT
• The flat cable is connected to connector P1040 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions when handling the
flat cable, then work properly. ☞ 68200
! Unused connector
• None
65270 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65270
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
When the magnetic head unit is equipped the magnetic preamplifier PCB, refer to ☞ Magnetic head PCB (J391050/J391051).
J390497 [135/240 AFC and 135/240 AFC-II (R/W) only]
G051018
6. Electrical parts
G057590
! Function
• Reads and writes the magnetic data.
! 1. Position
☞ 62100
! 2. Precautions for replacement
IMPORTANT
• This magnetic head PCB needs to be replaced at the same time with the magnetic head unit. Refer to ☞ 20760.
It is because manufacture of PCB is stopped and it is incompatible with a substitute PCB [☞ Magnetic head PCB
(J391050/J391051)].
! Unused connector
• None
65270 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65270
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
6. Electrical parts
65270 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65280
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
Unused
G068380
! Function
• Relays the AFC/scanner control PCB and connecting PCB 2.
! 1. Position
☞ 62100
! 2. Precautions for replacement
6. Electrical parts
IMPORTANT
• The flat cable is connected to connector P1004 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions when handling the
flat cable, then work properly. ☞ 68200
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P1005 Unused
65280 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65290
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G051020
! Function
• Relays the AFC/scanner control PCB and 120 AFC sensor PCB.
• Generates the power supply of DC+5 V and +12 V.
! 1. Position
☞ 62200
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
6. Electrical parts
• None
! Unused connector
• None
65290 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65300
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G051021
! Function
• Relays the input signals of the film feed route.
! 1. Position
☞ 62200
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
6. Electrical parts
! Unused connector
• None
65300 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65310
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G052692
! Function
• Relays the sensor signals of the 110 AFC.
• Generates the power supply of DC+5 V and +12 V.
! 1. Position
☞ 62300
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
6. Electrical parts
! 3. Adjustment after replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
65310 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65320
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
Unused
G068381
! Function
• Detects the sensor of the 110 AFC.
! 1. Position
☞ 62300
6. Electrical parts
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P1084 Unused
65320 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65330
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G052687
! Function
• Detects the MMC sensor.
• Controls (other than output checks) and drives of the AF motor.
• Generates the power supply of DC+5 V and +24 V.
6. Electrical parts
! 1. Position
☞ 62400
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
65330 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65340
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G052689
! Function
• Relays the signal to the AMC or MMC sensor.
• Relays the output signal to the AMC or MMC motor.
! 1. Position
135/240 MMC
☞ 62400
135/240 AMC
☞ 62500
! 2. Precautions for replacement
6. Electrical parts
• None
! Unused connector
• None
65340 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65350
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
TP3
G060696
! Function
• Relays the signal to the AMC sensor.
• Relays the output signals to the AMC motor.
! 1. Position
☞ 62500
6. Electrical parts
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
65350 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65360
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G057589
! Function
• Generates the power supply of DC+5 V and +12 V.
• Controls the sensors (emission side) of the film feed route and relays the input signal.
• Controls the panorama shutter solenoid.
! 1. Position
☞ 62600
! 2. Precautions for replacement
6. Electrical parts
IMPORTANT
• The flat cable is connected to connector P1292 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions when handling the
flat cable, then work properly. ☞ 68200
! Unused connector
• None
65360 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65370
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G057666
! Function
• Amplifies the input signals of the film feed route.
! 1. Position
☞ 62600
! 2. Precautions for replacement
IMPORTANT
• The flat cable is connected to connector P1295 on this PCB. Be sure to read the Precautions when handling the
6. Electrical parts
flat cable, then work properly. ☞ 68200
! Unused connector
• None
65370 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65380
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G071640
G071641
! Function
• Amplification of the magnetic head signal
IMPORTANT
• W411413 corresponds to reading of both a camera track and a photo finishing track, and W411414 corresponds only
to reading of a camera track.
! 1. Position
☞ 62100
! 2. Precautions for replacement
6. Electrical parts
• None
! Unused connector
W411413
• None
W411414
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P1041 Unused Not mounted
65380 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65390
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
Unused
G071631
! Function
1. Generates the power supply of DC+5 V and DC+12 V.
2. Controls the film pressure magnet.
3. Controls the film viewer.
4. Relays the sensors and switches.
! 1. Position
6. Electrical parts
☞ 62660
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P1320 Unused
65390 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
65400
Description of PCB (film carrier section)
G071632
! Function
1. Detects each attachment.
2. Relays the film pressure magnet.
! 1. Position
☞ 62660
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
6. Electrical parts
! 3. Adjustment after replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
65400 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66000
Description of PCB (printer section)
Description of PCB (printer section)
Unused
6. Electrical parts
Unused depending on the conditions
G068355
! Function
• Controls the printer I/O PCB.
• Communicates with the laser control PCB.
• Performs the optical ARCNET communications.
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Backup the data of the machine.
☞ 35400
• Check the setting of the DIP switch.
IMPORTANT
• You can connect the optical fiber cable to any connector below only if you do not miss out on IN and OUT.
• This PCB has connectors J219 (OUT), J220 (IN), J221 (OUT), J222 (IN), J223 (OUT) and J224 (IN) which are
connected to optical fiber cables. Be sure to read the Precautions for handling the optical fiber cable and LVDS
cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
66000 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66000
Description of PCB (printer section)
☞ 35400
• Carry out paper sensor adjustment.
☞ 36000
! 4. Symptoms caused by poor wiring connections
• Refer to 4202 ☞ Printer control PCB.
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P210 Corresponds to the CVP. Option
P213 Unused
P214 Unused
6. Electrical parts
DS1 1 OFF Unused Be sure to set to OFF.
2 OFF Unused
3 OFF Unused
4 OFF Unused
DS2 1 OFF Unused Be sure to set to OFF.
2 OFF Unused
3 OFF Unused
4 OFF Unused
DS3 1 OFF Unused Be sure to set to OFF.
2 OFF Unused
3 OFF Unused
4 OFF Unused
DS4 1 OFF Unused Be sure to set to OFF.
2 OFF Unused
3 OFF Unused
4 OFF Unused
66000 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66010
Description of PCB (printer section)
6. Electrical parts
Unused
G068356
! Function
• Controls the laser unit.
• Receives the image data from the image processing PCB.
• Controls correction of image data.
• Communicates with the printer control PCB.
• Performs the optical ARCNET communications.
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Check the setting of the DIP switch.
IMPORTANT
• The shapes of the connectors (J/P1501, J/P1502 and J/P1503) of laser control PCB are the same. Be careful not to
connect to the wrong connector.
IMPORTANT
• This PCB has connectors J1517 (IN) and J1516 (OUT) which are connected to optical fiber cables. Be sure to read
the Precautions for handling the optical fiber cable and LVDS cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
66010 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66010
Description of PCB (printer section)
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P1509 Unused
P1510 Unused
P1518 Unused
P1521 Unused
CN1 Unused
CN2 Unused
CN3 Unused
6. Electrical parts
TP411 DC+2.5 V voltage measurement Possible
TP412 DC+5 V-0 voltage measurement Possible
TP413 DC+5 V-1 voltage measurement Possible
TP414 Ground Possible
TP415 DC+5 V-2 voltage measurement Possible
TP416 Ground Possible
TP417 Unused Impossible
TP418 Unused Impossible
TP419 Ground Possible
66010 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66020
Description of PCB (printer section)
Unused
! Function
6. Electrical parts
• Controls paper magazine motors B and C, exposure advance motors 1 and 2, exposure advance pressure change motors 1 and 2,
paper advance motor 2, pressure guide motor, paper advance section cooling fan 1, inner cooling fan, control box cooling fan 1,
and counter. Switches ON/OFF by interlock switches (printer doors 1 and 2).
• Relays the power supply to PCBs.
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Since the shape of several connectors on the PCB are the same, replace the PCB with much care.
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P232 Counter Option
P236 Unused
66020 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66020
Description of PCB (printer section)
6. Electrical parts
TP6 DC+5 V interlock check Possible 0 V when interlock switch is
OFF.
TP7 Ground Possible
TP8 Ground Possible
66020 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66030
Description of PCB (printer section)
! Function
6. Electrical parts
• Controls the electrical parts of paper supply unit.
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P267 Triple magazine Option
66030 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66030
Description of PCB (printer section)
6. Electrical parts
66030 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66040
Description of PCB (printer section)
G068359
! Function
• Relays the control signals and input signals of paper magazine mounts B and C, exposure advance unit, paper advance unit 1,
paper advance unit 2, and processor loading unit.
• Drive function of motors of paper advance unit 2.
• Drive function of control box cooling fans 2, 3, and 4.
• Relays the control signals of paper magazine lamp B/C.
6. Electrical parts
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Since the shape of several connectors on the PCB are the same, replace the PCB with much care.
! Unused connector
• None
66040 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66040
Description of PCB (printer section)
6. Electrical parts
66040 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66050
Description of PCB (printer section)
Unused
G068360
! Function
• Controls the electrical parts of the triple magazine unit.
! 1. Position
6. Electrical parts
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P302 Unused
66050 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66060
Description of PCB (printer section)
G068361
! Function
• Controls the interlocks of B-AOM driver, G-AOM driver and R-AOM driver.
• Controls the laser unit heater, laser unit cooling fans 1 and 2, and paper advance section cooling fan 2.
• Relays the control signals of B laser driver, G laser driver and R laser driver.
• Supplies the power to each PCB.
6. Electrical parts
! Adjustments and precautions for PCB replacement
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
IMPORTANT
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
66060 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66060
Description of PCB (printer section)
6. Electrical parts
TP9 R laser temperature Possible When the normal value (+1 V) is not detected:
control standard voltage • Failure in the laser control PCB
check
• Failure in the laser I/O PCB
• Disconnection or short-circuit of thermosensor
Replace the laser unit for the thermosensor failure.
TP10 DC+24 V voltage Possible When the normal value (+24 V) is not detected:
measurement • Failure in the laser power supply
• Failure in cable(s) between the laser power supply
and laser I/O PCB
TP11 R laser temperature Possible When the normal value (more than 0 V to less than 1 V)
control section status is not detected:
check • 0 V means the thermosensor is broken.
• 1 V or more means the thermosensor is short-
circuit.
You can check the thermosensor status by the resistance
between pins 7 and 8 on the connector (J1532)
connected to the laser I/O PCB.
• ∞ Ω means the thermosensor is broken.
• 0Ω means the thermosensor is short-circuit.
Replace the laser unit for the thermosensor failure.
TP12 Peltier drive control Possible When the normal value (0 V to 5 V) is not detected:
voltage check • Failure in the laser control PCB
• Failure in the laser I/O PCB
• Disconnection or short-circuit of cable for Peltier
drive
Replace the laser unit for the Peltier drive failure.
66060 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66060
Description of PCB (printer section)
6. Electrical parts
66060 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66070
Description of PCB (printer section)
B and G laser drivers are different depending on the type A1 and B1 of laser unit.
• For the laser unit (type B1), refer to ☞ B and G laser drivers (J390929) Laser unit (Type B1).
Unused
G074521
! Function
• Controls B laser and G laser.
6. Electrical parts
! Adjustments and precautions for PCB replacement
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
PCB Name Connector No. Purpose
B laser driver P1656 Unused
G laser driver P1666 Unused
66070 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66070
Description of PCB (printer section)
Unused
G068362
! Function
• Controls B laser and G laser.
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
6. Electrical parts
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
PCB Name Connector No. Purpose
B laser driver P1656 Unused
G laser driver P1666 Unused
66070 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66080
Description of PCB (printer section)
G058738
IMPORTANT
• Since there is a compatibility between the AOM drivers of (I124020), (I124019), and (I124012), it is possible to use them
by mixture.
NOTE
• The white label is attached to the back side of AOM driver (I124020).
• A blue label is attached on the back of the AOM driver (I124019).
• A white label is attached on the back of the discontinued AOM driver (I124012).
! Function
• Converts the image data to the signal that controls the AOM (optoacoustic modulation) element.
• Controls AOM (optoacoustic modulation) element.
6. Electrical parts
! Adjustments and precautions for PCB replacement
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
66080 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66080
Description of PCB (printer section)
G072357
6. Electrical parts
• Raise the AOM driver and remove it, then place on the processor top cover.
• Operate with extreme care for wiring to the laser unit, laser control PCB and laser I/O PCB.
R-AOM driver
G-AOM driver
B-AOM driver
AOM driver unit
G072358
66080 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66090
Description of PCB (printer section)
G066110
! Function
• Controls the correction value printing unit.
6. Electrical parts
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
• None
IMPORTANT
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
66090 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66090
Description of PCB (printer section)
6. Electrical parts
66090 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66100
Description of PCB (printer section)
6. Electrical parts
Unused
G068367
! Function
Symbol Name Parts Function Remarks
No.
PS1 Printer power supply 1 I038361 Supplies the power to DC+24 V
each PCB.
PS2 Printer power supply 2 I038287 Supplies the power to DC+36 V
printer I/O PCB 1.
PS3 Printer power supply 3 I038364 Supplies the power to DC+24 V
printer I/O PCB 1.
PS4 Multi power supply I038160 Supplies the power to DC+5 V, DC+12 V,
(printer) each PCB. DC-12 V
PS5 Laser power supply I038286 Supplies the power to DC+24 V
laser I/O PCB.
IMPORTANT
• Each power supply is equipped with the overvoltage and overheat protection functions. If these functions are
operated, turn off the circuit breaker of the machine and wait for a while, then turn on again. If the overheat protection
function is operated, check if each cooling fan is in operation.
66100 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66100
Description of PCB (printer section)
! 1. Position
☞ 63000
! 2. Precautions for replacement
Power supply Precautions for replacement
Printer power supply 1 Do not touch each volume which has already been adjusted by the manufacturer before
Printer power supply 2 shipping.
Printer power supply 3
Multi power supply
Laser power supply
! Unused connector
6. Electrical parts
Power supply Connector No. Purpose Remarks
Printer power supply 1 CN2 Unused
CN52 Unused
Printer power supply 2 None
Printer power supply 3 None
Multi power supply CN4 Unused
Laser power supply None
66100 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66200
Description of PCB (processor section)
Description of PCB (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
Unused May not be mounted depending on conditions
! Function
• Controls the processor section.
! 1. Position
☞ 63200
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Backup the data of the machine.
☞ 35400
• Check the setting of the DIP switch.
• Check the connector for jumper.
IMPORTANT
• On this PCB, the optical fiber cables are connected to the connectors J517 (IN) and J518 (OUT). Be sure to read
•
the Precautions for handling the optical fiber cable and LVDS cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
66200 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66200
Description of PCB (processor section)
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P512 Digital flowmeter Option
P520 Unused
IMPORTANT
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
6. Electrical parts
TP1 Ground Possible
TP2 Unused Impossible
TP3 Unused Impossible
TP4 Ground Possible
TP5 DC+24 V voltage measurement Possible
TP6 DC+5 V voltage measurement Possible
TP7 DC+12 V voltage measurement Possible
TP8 Ground Possible
TP9 DC+5 V voltage measurement Possible
TP10 Thermosensor input voltage Impossible
measurement
TP11 Thermosensor standard voltage Possible 2.5 V
measurement
TP12 Thermosensor standard voltage Possible 1.0 V
measurement
66200 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66200
Description of PCB (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
Unused depending on the conditions May not be mounted depending on conditions
G068364
! Function
• Controls the processor section.
! 1. Position
☞ 63200
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Backup the data of the machine.
☞ 35400
• Check the setting of the DIP switch.
• Check the connector for jumper.
IMPORTANT
• On this PCB, the optical fiber cables are connected to the connectors J517 (IN) and J518 (OUT). Be sure to read
•
the Precautions for handling the optical fiber cable and LVDS cable, then work properly. ☞ 68100
66200 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66200
Description of PCB (processor section)
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P512 Digital flowmeter Option
IMPORTANT
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
6. Electrical parts
TP10 Thermosensor input voltage Impossible
measurement
TP11 Thermosensor standard voltage Possible 2.5 V
measurement
TP12 Thermosensor standard voltage Possible 1.0 V
measurement
66200 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66210
Description of PCB (processor section)
G068365
! Function
• Controls each electrical part of the processor section.
6. Electrical parts
! Adjustments and precautions for PCB replacement
! 1. Position
☞ 63200
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P671 Unused
P672 Unused
P673 Hour meter Option
P675 Unused
P676 Unused
66210 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66210
Description of PCB (processor section)
IMPORTANT
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
6. Electrical parts
LED15 Sorter motor operation check ON during operation
LED16 Refilling water pump and cleaning pump The LED status during operation is shown in the
LED17 operation check table.*1
LED18
LED19 DC+24 V power supply check ON when power is supplied.
LED20 DC+5 V power supply check ON when power is supplied.
*1. Table (You can check whether the pump is working by ON/OFF of LED16, 17 and 18.)
Cleaning
pump
LED16 ON
LED17 ON
LED18 ON
66210 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66210
Description of PCB (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
66210 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66210
Description of PCB (processor section)
! Function
• Controls each electrical part of the processor section.
! 1. Position
6. Electrical parts
☞ 63200
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P671 Unused
P672 Unused
P673 Hour meter Option
P675 Unused
P677 Unused
P683 Unused
P685 Unused
P688 Unused
P691 For chilling unit Option
P692 For cooling water unit Option
P700 Unused
P701 Signal lamp Option
66210 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66210
Description of PCB (processor section)
IMPORTANT
• Though sometimes the test pins are unmounted, the test points can be used for the measurement.
6. Electrical parts
TP4 DC+24 V voltage measurement Possible
TP5 Ground Possible
TP6 Ground Possible
66210 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66220
Description of PCB (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
Unused
G068366
! Function
• Changes the power supply specifications.
• Supplies the power to each unit.
Dryer heater, processing solution heater, dryer fan, and drive motor
• Protects the power surge.
• Supplies the power of AC 200 V line.
66220 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66220
Description of PCB (processor section)
• Even if the circuit breaker of the machine is turned off, voltage is applied to terminal TA3 on processor relay PCB. If
processor relay PCB is to be replaced, be sure to turn off the circuit breaker of the main power supply.
! 1. Position
☞ 63200
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• Wire the terminal strip TA3 according to the voltage specification of the main body.
• Check the voltages of P642, P645, P658, and P661.
IMPORTANT
• Replace the connector so that the voltage described on the connector lower part matches the applied one.
! Unused connector
6. Electrical parts
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P647 Unused The starter jumper is connected at forced startup.
66220 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66220
Description of PCB (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
protection
F14 T6.3 A/250 V DC+24 V power supply
protection
66220 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66600
Description of PCB (processor section)
Unused
G070013
! Function
6. Electrical parts
• Supplies the power to each sensor of the SM replenishment section and relays the input signal.
• Drives each replenisher pump and water supply pump of the SM replenishment section and relays the output signal.
! 1. Position
☞ 63200
! 2. Precautions for replacement
• None
! Unused connector
Connector No. Purpose Remarks
P606 Unused
66600 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
66600
Description of PCB (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
VR1 CD−A replenishment solution sensor sensitivity
adjustment
VR2 CD−B replenishment solution sensor sensitivity
adjustment
VR3 CD−C replenishment solution sensor sensitivity
adjustment
VR4 STB replenishment solution sensor sensitivity
adjustment
VR5 BF−A replenishment solution sensor sensitivity
adjustment
VR6 BF−B replenishment solution sensor sensitivity
adjustment
66600 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
67400
Description of PCB (processor section)
G068368
! Function
Symbol Name Parts Function Remarks
No.
PS1 Processor power supply 1 I038320 Supplies the power to DC+5 V
each PCB.
PS2 Processor power supply 2 I038286 Supplies the power to DC+24 V
each PCB and fan.
PS3 Processor power supply 3 Supplies the power to DC+24 V
each PCB, drive motor,
and circulation pump.
6. Electrical parts
IMPORTANT
• Each power supply is equipped with the overvoltage and overheat protection functions. If these functions are
operated, turn off the circuit breaker of the machine and wait for a while, then turn on again. If the overheat protection
function is operated, check if each cooling fan is in operation.
! 1. Position
☞ 63200
! 2. Precautions for replacement
Power supply Precautions for replacement
Processor power supply 1 Do not touch each volume which has already been adjusted by the manufacturer before
Processor power supply 2 shipping.
Processor power supply 3
67400 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
67400
Description of PCB (processor section)
! Unused connector
• None
6. Electrical parts
67400 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68050
Description of PCB (processor section)
• Be sure to turn off the circuit breaker and main power supply before starting this operation.
To set the power supply specification, wire between terminal strips TA1 and TA2 of the processor power supply section and connect
jumper connectors (J642, J645, J658 and J661) on the processor relay PCB.
! Change procedure
1. Wiring change
Wiring Single phase, two wires (AC 200 V Three phases, three wires (AC 200 Three phases, four wires (AC 346 V
No. to AC 240 V) V to AC 240 V) to AC 415 V)
A L1 − 1 L1 − 1 L1 − 1
B L2 − 2 L2 − 2 L2 − 3
6. Electrical parts
C L3 − 6 L3 − 4 L3 − 5
D N−6 N−6 N−2
F 1−3 1−5 6−6
H 2−4 2−3 2−4
J 3−5 6−6 6−6
2. Check the connectors of dryer fan (J645) and dryer heater (J658 and J661).
Check that the connectors (J645, J658 and J661) on the processor relay PCB are connected to their input voltage.
3. Check the connection of the connectors for transformer.
Check that the connector (J642) on the processor relay PCB are connected to the power supply for 200 V.
4. Checking the description on the tag
Check the tag attached around the circuit breaker to see if the description on the tag matches with the power supply
specifications.
If the power supply specification is changed, change the description on the tag.
5. Indication change of the power supply specification
In the Machine Specification mode, change the power supply specification. ☞ 35800
68050 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68050
Description of PCB (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
Connect the connector for jumper according to each input voltage.
G068448
68050 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68050
Description of PCB (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
Connect the connector for jumper according to each input voltage.
G068449
68050 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68050
Description of PCB (processor section)
6. Electrical parts
Connect the connector for jumper according to each input voltage.
G068450
68050 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68100
Cables
Cables
Precautions for handling the optical fiber cable and LVDS cable
6. Electrical parts
• Do not bend the optical fiber cable by R25 mm or less. The cable may break. Lay the cable with a bending radius of at least R50
mm. When inserting, removing, or laying the cable, do not use force. Do not secure the cable with mini-bands, clamps or the like.
G051006
• When the optical fiber cable is to be removed from the PCB, pull the cable straight out while pressing part A in the direction
indicated by the arrow. When the cable is to be connected, push it straight as far as it will go.
IMPORTANT
• If pulling the optical fiber cable out forcibly without pressing part A, the sheath of the cable is broken and a part of
the sheath remains in the connector, resulting in the communication error.
68100 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68100
Cables
• Since the optical fiber cable is provided with IN and OUT ends, be careful to connect them correctly. If part A of the connector on
the PCB is white, the cable end should indicate OUT. If part A is black, the cable end should indicate IN. The OUT cable end is
marked using a white tape. There is no marking on the IN cable end.
OUT
G051008
IN
Part A (Black) Optical fiber cable
Connector on the PCB
G051009
6. Electrical parts
• If the optical fiber cable is damaged, it cannot be reused even after the damaged part has been cut off. A communication error
occurs.
Optical fiber cable
Connector on the PCB
G051010
• Do not place an excessive load on the optical fiber cable or let a hard or heavy object fall on it.
• Do not damage the sheath of the optical fiber cable. A dent or flaw on the sheath is however small, means the optical fiber cable
cannot be used.
• Never touch the end face of the optical fiber cable with bare hands. Communication will not be possible if oil or dust adheres to
the cable end, or if the cable end is scratched.
! PCBs and unit to which the LVDS cable has been connected
PCB name Connector No. on the PCB Manual No. Remarks
PCI-LVDS/ARCNET PCB CN1 ☞ 88000
Laser control PCB P1513 ☞ 66010
Scanner unit P60 -
D-ICE PCB P436 ☞ 64040
Image processing PCB J1350, J445, J455, J456 ☞ 64000
68100 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68100
Cables
LVDS cable
G063561
6. Electrical parts
68100 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68200
Cables
6. Electrical parts
135 AFC sensor PCB P1295 ☞ 65370 135/240 AFC-II
Connector
G052634
2. Be sure to insert the flat cable as far as it will go. If the main power supply of the machine is turned on with the cable inserted
insufficiently, the PCB and cable are damaged.
3. Check the insertion direction of the flat cable and then proceed.
68200 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68200
Cables
Release
Lock plate
Fix.
Connector
G054665
2. When connecting the flat cable to the connector, do not allow the cable to be tilted.
Pay attention that the connection of the cable may peel off. If the main power supply of the machine is turned on with the cable
peeling off, the PCB and cable are damaged.
3. Be sure to insert the flat cable as far as it will go and lock it with a lock plate. If the main power supply of the machine is turned
on with the cable being locked insufficiently, the PCB and cable are damaged.
4. Insert the flat cable with the connection side downward.
6. Electrical parts
68200 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68500
Power ON/OFF
Power ON/OFF
! When the circuit breaker was turned off while the program timer is activating
6. Electrical parts
68500 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68550
Power ON/OFF
When power is not supplied to input and output sections (How to use the
starter jumper)
! Function
• You can supply power forcibly using the starter jumper when 200 V to 240 V is not supplied to the input and output sections
during operation.
! Status
• Power (200 V to 240 V) is not supplied to the input and output sections during operation.
• When the program timer is activated or temperature is being increased if the manual sorter switch is pressed for two seconds or
longer, the power (from 200 V to 240 V ) is not supplied to the input and output sections.
Starter jumper
6. Electrical parts
Processor relay PCB
G077192
68550 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
68550
Power ON/OFF
! Diagnosis
Are the personal computer, monitor, and each unit in the input and
output sections operating?
No problem.
ON OFF
Mend or
replace. Confirm that the circuit breaker of input section is ON.
No problem.
6. Electrical parts
No problem.
Turn off the power supply and attach the starter jumper on the connector (P647) of
processor relay PCB. Make the main relay between 200 V and 240 V turn ON forcibly.
OFF
68550 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
7000
7000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70010
Setup for service personnel
Setup for service personnel
! Procedures
1. No.1319:Scanner type was changed. The system will be restarted. may appear onscreen when
the machine is turned on.
If the attention message shown above appears onscreen, scanner-related data will be initialized after the system is restarted.
For details, refer to ☞ 41318.
2. When registering or updating the light source at the installation, the messages No.6331:Line
scanning communication error. or No.6900:Main control system error. may appear.
When the error above occurs, release the error and upgrade the system using the CD so as not to display this error message.
70010 1/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70010
Setup for service personnel
70010 2/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70010
Setup for service personnel
IMPORTANT
• If the message After restarted, execute following adjustment is displayed after changing the machine
type, carry out following settings.
• Drive Motor Revolution Count Auto Adjustment ☞ 33600
• Pump Output Amount Measurement: ☞ 33030
• Thermosensor Calibration: ☞ 33500
16. Check the light axis and swing and tilt of the scanner unit.
Check that Light Axis Adjustment and Swing and Tilt Adjustment are in right positions.
IMPORTANT
• When you do not have the 135/240 AFC, use the 120 AFC and 110 AFC for checking.
70010 3/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70010
Setup for service personnel
For S-4, if the difference of the displayed value is more than the values in the table,Scanner unit, AFC-II, or the
Scanner adjustment chart may be defective.
Priority*1 Film carrier to be set Difference of G values when adjusting the
light axis
1 135/240 AFC (135 lane)*2 ±37 pixels
2 120 AFC ±28 pixels
3 110 AFC ±28 pixels
*1. Check the film carriers are set when carrying out Light Axis Adjustment of the scanner unit, according to the above priority.
*2. For the 135/240 AFC, be sure to use the 135 lane to check Light Axis Adjustment.
*1. Check the film carriers are set when carrying out Swing and Tilt Adjustment of the scanner unit, according to the priority
above.
*2. For the 135/240 AFC, be sure to use the 135 lane to check Swing and Tilt Adjustment.
70010 4/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70010
Setup for service personnel
70010 5/5
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70020
Setup for service personnel
! Procedures
Rear end
G070022
(1) Check the Paper Front End to 0 mm (0 inch)-line Test Paper Measurement Value.
Check that the Exposure Start Timing Correction value is 25.4 mm.
• For adjustment, refer to ☞ 36080.
(2) Check the 0 mm-line to 254 mm-line Test Paper Measurement Value.
Check that the Exposure Image Correction value is 254 mm.
• For adjustment, refer to ☞ 36080.
70020 1/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70020
Setup for service personnel
Line A
A
Line C
G068462
4. Checking the Exposure Center Correction, Exposure Position Adjustment, Exposure Magnification
Fine Adjustment and Exposure Magnification Correction
Go to Exposure Position Adjustment → F: Functions → Test Print Confirmation (Paper Magazines A/B/C) using the
paper with the maximum width that is in use and confirm following four points. If it is out of the standard, adjust it.
NOTE
• The following example is 305 mm test printing.
Bringing up the display
Extension → Maintenance → Various Adjustment → Printer Mechanical Adjustment → Exposure Position Adjustment
70020 2/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70020
Setup for service personnel
Center line
70020 3/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70020
Setup for service personnel
6. Initial Setup
Follow the instructions on the Initial Setup display. When two or three paper types are to be used, carry out Paper
Specification Registration/Setup for each paper on the Paper Specification Registration/Setup display.
Bringing up the display
Extension → Setup → Initial Setup
(1) Set the print channel to print from Each media or Flatbed Scanner.
IMPORTANT
• If color correction is necessary when printing from each media or the flatbed scanner, correct the
balance value (C, H, P) of each print channel. So, it is necessary to set each print channel for each
media and each flatbed scanner.
Bringing up the display
Extension → Setup → Print Channel
70020 4/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70020
Setup for service personnel
(1) Make each print of [N (normal), U (under) and O (over)] from the 135F negative•positive which is frequently
used at the shop.
(2) If color or density correction is necessary, correct them in the following mode.
Film type Input mode
135 negative Select Scanner Slope Correction (Negative)→Master Data→Scanner Slope, then correct N
(normal), U (under), and O (over).
135 positive Select Scanner Slope Correction (Positive)→Master Data→Scanner Slope, then correct N
(normal), U (under), and O (over).
• For details, refer to Correcting the Master Data (Correcting to all the films) in the Operator's Manual -
Additional Operations & Setup Manual -.
Bringing up the display
Extension → Setup → Scanner Setup → Scanner Slope Correction (Negative)/Scanner Slope Correction (Positive)
11. Checking the print color and density [Reference Slope, Scanner Slope]
NOTE
• Unnecessary for DLS specification
(1) Make each print of [N (normal), U (under) and O (over)] from the 240 negative•positive, 120 negative•positive,
and 110 negative•positive, which are frequently used at the shop.
(2) If color or density correction is necessary, correct them in the following mode.
Film type Input mode
240 negative Select Scanner Slope Correction (Negative)→240→Reference Slope, then correct N
(normal), U (under), and O (over).
• For details, refer to Carry out the reference slope correction (each film) in the Operator's Manual -
Additional Operations & Setup Manual -.
Bringing up the display
Extension → Setup → Scanner Setup → Scanner Slope Correction (Negative)/Scanner Slope Correction (Positive)
70020 5/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70020
Setup for service personnel
(1) If color and density corrections are necessary for each negative size (135F, 135H, 135P, 135HD, 240) by each
manufacture•film sensitivity, correct them in the following mode.
Negative Input mode
135F negative Select Scanner Slope Correction (Negative)→135F→DX Slope, then correct N (normal), U
(under), and O (over).
135H negative Select Scanner Slope Correction (Negative)→135H→DX Slope, then correct N (normal), U
(under), and O (over).
135P negative Select Scanner Slope Correction (Negative)→135P→DX Slope, then correct N (normal), U
(under), and O (over).
135HD negative Select Scanner Slope Correction (Positive)→135HD→DX Slope, then correct N (normal),
U (under), and O (over).
240 negative Select Scanner Slope Correction (Negative)→240→DX Slope, then correct N (normal), U
(under), and O (over).
• For the operation procedures, refer to Carrying out the DX Slope Correction (each negative) in the Operator's
Manual - Additional Operations & Setup Manual -.
Bringing up the display
Extension → Setup → Scanner Setup → Scanner Slope Correction (Negative)/Scanner Slope Correction (Positive)
70020 6/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70020
Setup for service personnel
(1) For the film of 135, 240, 120 and 110, if the DSA correction is needed, set each DSA via Master Data.
NOTE
• DSA correction can be set for each print channel.
• For details, refer to Correcting the Automatic Contrast, the Automatic Sharpness and the Chroma in the
Operator's Manual - Additional Operations & Setup Manual -.
Bringing up the display
Extension → Setup → Master Data → DSA
17. DSA setting [Each media, flatbed scanner and Net Order]
NOTE
• Unnecessary for DLS specification
(1) If DSA correction is necessary when printing from each media, the flatbed scanner or Net Order, set each DSA
via Master Data.
NOTE
• DSA correction can be set for each print channel.
• For details, refer to Correcting the Automatic Contrast, the Automatic Sharpness and the Chroma in the
Operator's Manual - Additional Operations & Setup Manual -.
Bringing up the display
Extension → Setup → Master Data → DSA
70020 7/7
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70021
Setup for service personnel
! Procedures
1. In the case of the stand-alone scanner, No.6901:ARCNET communication error. occurs when the
power supply is turned ON.
2. When registering or updating the light source at the installation, the messages No.6331:Line
scanning communication error. or No.6900:Main control system error. may appear.
If one of the errors (1, 2) described above occurs, cancel the error and use the CD to upgrade the system.
Procedure: Press and hold Ctrl+Alt+Delete. Select the following in the order shown here: Windows Task Manager,
Applications, Order Display, QSS-SEQ, End Task to quit the QSS software.
70021 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70021
Setup for service personnel
70021 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70021
Setup for service personnel
13. Check the light axis and swing and tilt of the scanner unit.
Check that Light Axis Adjustment and Swing and Tilt Adjustment are in right positions.
IMPORTANT
• When you do not have the 135/240 AFC, use the 120 AFC and 110 AFC for checking.
*1. Check the film carriers are set when carrying out Light Axis Adjustment of the scanner unit, according to the above priority.
*2. For the 135/240 AFC, be sure to use the 135 lane to check Light Axis Adjustment.
*1. Check the film carriers are set when carrying out Swing and Tilt Adjustment of the scanner unit, according to the priority
above.
*2. For the 135/240 AFC, be sure to use the 135 lane to check Swing and Tilt Adjustment.
70021 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70021
Setup for service personnel
70021 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70022
Setup for service personnel
! Procedures
1. In the case of the stand-alone scanner, No.6640:System error. (D-ICE Control PCB) and
No.6901:ARCNET communication error. occur when the power supply is turned ON.
When the error mentioned above occurs, press Ctrl+Alt+Delete and select the Oder display and QSS-SEQ in the
Applications from Windows Task Manager, then click End Task to quit the QSS software.
2. If you need to downgrade the version of the profile data due to the difference betweeen the version of
factory-installed profile data in the machine and that of the system program, refer to ☞ 70025.
IMPORTANT
• If the version of factory-installed profile data for the machine and system program version are the same, there
is no need to downgrade the version of profile data.
70022 1/8
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70022
Setup for service personnel
IMPORTANT
• If the message After restarted, execute following adjustment is displayed after changing the machine
type, carry out following settings.
• Drive Motor Revolution Count Auto Adjustment ☞ 33600
• Pump Output Amount Measurement: ☞ 33030
• Thermosensor Calibration: ☞ 33500
70022 2/8
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70022
Setup for service personnel
70022 3/8
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70022
Setup for service personnel
A
For checking 0 mm-line to 254
mm-line Test Paper Measurement
Value
Exposure Image Correction: 254 mm
Left Right
Rear end
G070022
(1) Check the Paper Front End to 0 mm (0 inch)-line Test Paper Measurement Value.
Check that the Exposure Start Timing Correction value is 25.4 mm.
• For adjustment, refer to ☞ 36080.
(2) Check the 0 mm-line to 254 mm-line Test Paper Measurement Value.
Check that the Exposure Image Correction value is 254 mm.
70022 4/8
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70022
Setup for service personnel
Line A
A
B
C
Line C
G068462
19. Checking the Exposure Center Correction, Exposure Position Adjustment, Exposure Magnification
Fine Adjustment and Exposure Magnification Correction
Go to Exposure Position Adjustment → F: Functions → Test Print Confirmation (Paper Magazines A/B/C) using the
paper with the maximum width that is in use and confirm following four points. If it is out of the standard, adjust it.
70022 5/8
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70022
Setup for service personnel
Center line
70022 6/8
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70022
Setup for service personnel
70022 7/8
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70022
Setup for service personnel
27. DSA setting [Each media, flatbed scanner and Net Order]
(1) If DSA correction is necessary when printing from each media, the flatbed scanner, or Net Order, set each DSA
via Master Data.
NOTE
• DSA correction can be set for each print channel.
• For details, refer to Correcting the Automatic Contrast, the Automatic Sharpness and the Chroma in the
Operator's Manual - Additional Operations & Setup Manual -.
Bringing up the display
Extension → Setup → Master Data → DSA
70022 8/8
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70025
Setup for service personnel
! Procedures
IMPORTANT
• You need to downgrade the version of the profile data when the version of the factory-installed profile data in the
machine and the system program version are different.
• In order to downgrade the version of the profile data, delete the Pf folder. In steps following this, upgrade the system
version and install the profile data using the CD. This recreates the profile data.
(1) Bring up the Start menu and select Accessories via Programs.
(2) Select Windows Explorer.
(3) Open My Computer and delete Pf folder located in C:\NoritsuKoki\QSS−32_33\Data in the Local Disc:C.
3. Install profile data of which the version matches the system program version.
70025 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70040
Setup for service personnel
The English messages are displayed on the monitor on the machines which are to be shipped outside Japan.
It is necessary to set the Regional Options and install the translated message data so that the messages in the local language are displayed
and text in that language can be input.
Change the setting according to the following procedure.
IMPORTANT
• Prepare the following data in advance.
• Translated message file (Save the data to a floppy disk.)
• Translated HELP files (Save the data to a CD-R or a CD-R/W.)
Bring up the Windows display when setting each item such as the dictionary function relating to the Windows system.
Switch the display according to the following procedure.
1. Bring up the Close Down Checks display.
Bringing up the display
Click F via Order Display. → Menu → Extension → Close Down Checks
Close Down Checks display
S0009-00-UM02
2. Click F: Functions.
The F: Functions display appears.
S0009-00-UM62
Build the translated local language's message file in the system in advance. Carry out the operation according to the following
procedure.
1. Insert the floppy disk in which the message data is saved into the floppy disk drive.
2. Double-click Setup.exe in the floppy disk.
Installation starts.
70040 1/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70040
Setup for service personnel
3. Click Next.
Example: InstallShield Wizard
G050657
4. Click Finish.
Example: InstallShield Wizard
1. Insert the CD-ROM in which the HELP file is saved into the CD-ROM drive.
2. Double-click the Setup.exe file in the CD-R or the CD-R/W.
Installation starts.
70040 2/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70040
Setup for service personnel
3. Click Next.
Example: InstallShield Wizard
G056142
4. Click Finish.
Example: InstallShield Wizard
G050628
70040 3/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70040
Setup for service personnel
G050683
The Regional Options display appears.
3. Click the General tab (index) and set the region (country) and language.
(1) Select the appropriate language and check the box in the Language settings for the system list.
Example: Regional Options display
G050662
70040 4/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70040
Setup for service personnel
G050612
4. Click the Input Locales tab (index) and set the dictionary function.
(1) Click Add.
Example: Regional Options display
G050663
7. Setup for service personnel
(2) Select the Input locale.
Example: Add Input Locale display
G050666
70040 5/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70040
Setup for service personnel
G050666
G050663
G050663
5. Click Apply.
Example: Regional Options display
G050663
70040 6/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70040
Setup for service personnel
6. Click OK.
Example: Regional Options display
G050663
7. Insert the Windows 2000 Professional CD-R or CD-R/W into the CD-ROM drive and click OK.
Example: InstallShield Wizard
G050664
The file copy starts. After the copy, you are prompted to restart the system.
8. Click No.
Example: InstallShield Wizard
G050667
G050604
70040 7/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70040
Setup for service personnel
G050605
Power lamp
G069106
(6) Turn on the circuit breaker in 10 seconds after it was turned off.
Circuit breaker
G069049
The power turns ON and after a while, the power supply of the display monitor turns ON automatically and then the
message Do not vibrate the machine. Vibration affects print quality. appears.
This completes the operation.
70040 8/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70040
Setup for service personnel
S3066-00-SM00
70040 9/9
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70050
Setup for service personnel
70050 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70050
Setup for service personnel
70050 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
70050
Setup for service personnel
70050 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
8000
8. Appendix
8 Appendix
8000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Periodically replaced parts
The list below shows the checks and replacement of parts that need to be performed regularly by user and service personnel to keep the
normal machine operation.
Check the actual processing hours and number of prints using the hour meter and the print counter.
IMPORTANT
• For the maintenance parts, check them regularly and replace them if necessary.
Some parts need replacing according to the processing time or the number of processed prints. The replacement timing
varies depending on the operating condition of the machine.
Since the replacement timing is the rough standard, you do not always have to replace the parts on the specified timing.
• As to the periodically replaced parts, replace the parts when the processing time or the number of prints processed
reaches the specified value regardless of the condition of the parts.
• The numerical values described below do not indicate any warranty periods.
NOTE
• The hour meter and the print counter are optional on the machines which are to be shipped outside Japan.
! PC control unit
Parts or checking items U/S Description for maintenance Part No. Timin Stand Q' Reason for
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Cleaning the floppy disk U Clean it using a commercially - Whene - - Data may not be read
drive available floppy disk for cleaning. ver properly from the media
necess drive.
ary
Cleaning the MO drive U Clean it using the optional MO head - 3-
cleaner. month
! Desk unit
8. Appendix
Parts or checking items U/S Description for maintenance Part No. Timin Stand Q' Reason for
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Cleaning the air filter U Vacuum the dust using a vacuum A128749 1- - 2 If the air does not flow
cleaner. week smoothly due to the dust
If the dirt cannot be removed, turn accumulated on the air
the side with dust down and wash it filter, the temperature in
with running water. the control box may
(Replace when it has been increase and it may
seriously damaged.) cause malfunction of the
PCBs.
80110 1/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
! Flatbed scanner
Parts or checking items U/S Description for maintenance Part No. Timin Stand Q' Reason for
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Cleaning the flatbed U Wipe the glass surface using a soft - Whene - - The dirt on the glass
scanner cloth. ver surface may adversely
necess affect the scanning
ary image.
! Colorimeter unit
Parts or checking items U/S Description for maintenance Part No. Timin Stand Q' Reason for
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Cleaning the calibration U At Start Up Checks Z021441 At 2-year 1 Since the dirty
plate*1 If the dirt cannot be removed, wipe startin calibration plate makes
it using a firmly squeezed damp soft g up the registration with the
cloth. After that, wipe it using a dry 1- incorrect standard value
8. Appendix
cloth. month at the setup, it may
At monthly check adversely affects the
Wipe the measurement area using a print finish.
firmly squeezed damp soft cloth
with a neutral detergent diluted with
water. Then, wipe and dry it up
using a dry soft cloth.
Cleaning the advance U Clean with a colorimeter cleaning - 6- - - The measurement of the
roller sheet. month setup prints may fail.
*1. Periodically replaced parts: It is necessary to replace even if two years has not been passed, when the parts has been deteriorated in quality
(including calibration data FD).
U: user, S: service personnel
80110 2/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
! Colorimeter unit
Part name U/S Part No. Q'ty Recommended Reason for
timing of maintenance/replacement
replacement
Calibration plate unit B*1 U Z021441 1 2-year Since the dirty or deteriorated
calibration plate makes the registration
with the incorrect standard value at the
setup, it may adversely affects the print
8. Appendix
finish.
*1. It is necessary to replace even if two years has not been passed, when the parts has been deteriorated in quality (including calibration data FD).
U: user, S: service personnel
! PC control unit
Part name U/S Part No. Q'ty Recommended Reason for
timing of maintenance/replacement
replacement
Battery pack*1 S I085024 1 3-year If the battery pack deteriorates, the PC
2 may not shut down properly when
power goes out temporary, and the
HDD may be damaged.
Lithium battery S I085026 1 If the lithium battery deteriorates, the
(For use with setting data stored on the mother board
PC-NRT-RS2, may be lost or the clock may slow.
RD2)
I085027
PC-NRT-RS6
80110 3/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
80110 4/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
The list below shows the checks and replacement of parts that need to be performed regularly by user and service personnel to keep the
normal machine operation.
Check the actual processing hours and number of prints using the hour meter and the print counter.
IMPORTANT
• For the maintenance parts, check them regularly and replace them if necessary.
Some parts need replacing according to the processing time or the number of processed prints. The replacement timing
varies depending on the operating condition of the machine.
Since the replacement timing is the rough standard, you do not always have to replace the parts on the specified timing.
• As to the periodically replaced parts, replace the parts when the processing time or the number of prints processed
reaches the specified value regardless of the condition of the parts.
• The numerical values described below do not indicate any warranty periods.
NOTE
• The hour meter and the print counter are optional on the machines which are to be shipped outside Japan.
! Scanner unit
Parts or checking items U/S Description for maintenance Part No. Timin Stand Q' Reason for
8. Appendix
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Cleaning the scanner dust U Clean it using the blower brush. - At - - If dust is not removed
prevention glass If the dust cannot be removed, wipe closin from the dust prevention
it using a cleaning cloth. g glass, it may adversely
down affect the print quality.
80110 5/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Parts or checking items U/S Description for maintenance Part No. Timin Stand Q' Reason for
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Cleaning the film carrier U Wipe it using a cloth. - 1- - - To prevent dust
mount rail and the week accumulates on the lens
peripheral area unit of the film carrier
and the dust prevention
glass in the LED light
source unit.
Cleaning the air filter U Remove the air filter at the bottom - - - If the air does not flow
of the scanner section, and vacuum smoothly due to the dust
the dust using a vacuum cleaner. accumulated on the air
If the dirt cannot be removed, turn filter, the temperature in
the side with dust down and wash it the control box may
with running water. increase and it may
cause malfunction of the
PCBs.
Cleaning the discharge U Clean the discharge terminal - - - If dust accumulates at
terminal section of the section with a cotton swab. Remove the discharge terminal
film cleaner the dust by rubbing both brushes. section, it makes
impossible to remove
static electricity and the
dust cannot be removed
in result.
U: user, S: service personnel
8. Appendix
week the image data. It also
damages the film. Be
sure to remove dust.
Cleaning each sensor U Clean it using the blower brush. - At - - The error related to the
closin sensors of the film
g carrier such as Film has
down stopped at the Film
Carrier. may occur.
Cleaning the film advance U Clean it using the cleaning leader. - At - - Remove the dust on the
roller closin film path, otherwise the
g film advance rollers
down may slip and a black
Wipe it using the firmly squeezed - 1- margin may appear on
damp soft cloth while rotating the week the printed image. Also,
roller. the message Film has
Dry it up after wiping each part. stopped at the Film
Carrier. may occur.
80110 6/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Parts or checking items U/S Description for maintenance Part No. Timin Stand Q' Reason for
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Cleaning the magnetic U Clean it using the cleaning leader. - At - - Attention message No.
head *1 closin 1404: The IX frame
g data is incomplete.
down may occur.
Wipe it using the firmly squeezed - 1-
damp cloth. week
If the dirt cannot be removed, wipe
it using a cotton swab dipped in
isopropyl alcohol.
Cleaning the dummy head U Clean it using the cleaning leader. - At
*1 Wipe it using the firmly squeezed closin
damp cloth. g
If the dirt cannot be removed, wipe down
it using a cotton swab dipped in
isopropyl alcohol.
Cleaning the brush (upper U Clean it using the blower brush. - - - It damages the film. Be
and lower ones) sure to remove dust.
Cleaning the slot at the U Clean by the blower brush. If dust - - - If dust is not removed
scanner opening cannot be removed, wipe it with the from the light path, it
maintenance stick. may adversely affect the
Cleaning the film inlet U Clean it using the blower brush. - print quality.
Cleaning the rewinding U Wipe it using the firmly squeezed - - - Be sure to remove dust
unit damp cloth. since it may damage the
If the dirt cannot be removed, wipe film or may cause
it using a cotton swab dipped in defective winding.
isopropyl alcohol.
Dry it up after wiping each part.
Cleaning the lens unit U Clean the both sides using the - - - Remove the dust from
blower brush or air spray. the light path,
If the dust cannot be removed, wipe otherwise, it may
it using a cleaning cloth. adversely affect the
print quality as dust
appears on the print or
the image data. Also, it
8. Appendix
may cause unevenness
of the scanner light
source at updating the
light source.
Cleaning the bottom side U Wipe it using a cloth. - 1- - - It is to prevent dust
of AFC week accumulates on the dust
prevention glass in the
LED light source unit.
Maintenance stick U Wash the rubber section under - Whene - - Dust adheres on the
running water or with neutral ver light path, and it may
detergent, and firmly squeeze and necess adversely affect the
dry it completely. ary print quality.
*1. Not equipped with 135 AFC-II 120 AFC-II 110 AFC-II.
U: user, S: service personnel
80110 7/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
80110 8/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
! MFC
Parts or checking items U/S Description for maintenance Part No. Timin Stand Q' Reason for
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Film viewer U Clean it using the blower brush. If - At - - It is to prevent dust from
Surface of the move table U the dirt cannot be removed, wipe it - closin adhering each part.
using the firmly-squeezed damp g
cloth. down
*1
Lens unit U Clean the both sides using the - Remove the dust from
blower brush or air spray. the light path,
If the dust cannot be removed, wipe otherwise, it may
it using a cleaning cloth. adversely affect the
print quality as dust
appears on the print or
the image data. Also, it
may cause unevenness
of the scanner light
source at updating the
light source.
Cleaning the attachment U Clean the both sides using the - Remove the dust,
(film setting side, film blower brush or air spray. otherwise it may
pressure side) adversely affect the
print quality as it
appears on the print or
the image data.
*1. Wipe the part or item once a week using the firmly-squeezed damp cloth.
U: user, S: service personnel
8. Appendix
80110 9/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
The list below shows the checks and replacement of parts that need to be performed regularly by user and service personnel to keep the
normal machine operation.
Check the actual processing hours and number of prints using the hour meter and the print counter.
IMPORTANT
• For the maintenance parts, check them regularly and replace them if necessary.
Some parts need replacing according to the processing time or the number of processed prints. The replacement timing
varies depending on the operating condition of the machine.
Since the replacement timing is the rough standard, you do not always have to replace the parts on the specified timing.
• As to the periodically replaced parts, replace the parts when the processing time or the number of prints processed
reaches the specified value regardless of the condition of the parts.
• The numerical values described below do not indicate any warranty periods.
NOTE
• The hour meter and the print counter are optional on the machines which are to be shipped outside Japan.
8. Appendix
80110 10/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
80110 11/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
approximately.)
80110 12/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
! Laser unit
Parts or checking items U/S Description for maintenance Part No. Timin Stand Q' Reason for
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Cleaning the laser U Blow the dust off using a blower - 1- - - Line may be printed.
dustproof glass brush. month
Wipe it using the cleaning sheet if
necessary.
8. Appendix
g ard ty maintenance/replace
replac ment
ement
timing
Cleaning the advance U Check if it is not dirty. - Whene - - The message No. 6017-
roller If it is dirty, clean it using the ver 0002, 0003, 0004:
Cleaning the pressure U blower brush. - necess Paper has jammed in
roller If the dirt cannot be removed, wipe ary the printer section.
it using the firmly squeezed damp may appear.
cloth.
Cleaning paper sensor 1 U Clean the sensors using the blower - 3-
brush. month
Ink ribbon cassette U Check the printing density. - Whene - 1 If ink runs out, back
ver print may not be printed
necess properly.
ary
80110 13/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
U: user, S: service personnel
80110 14/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
Ink ribbon cassette U H086044 1 100,000 prints If ink runs out, back print may not be
printed properly.
80110 15/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
NOTE
• The hour meter and the print counter are optional on the machines which are to be shipped outside Japan.
! Upper guide
Parts or checking items U/S Description for Part No. Timin Stand Q'ty Q'ty Reason for
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Upper guides (Nos. 2 to 6) U Automatic cleaning every - At - - - The print may get
and squeegee unit close down checks. closin damaged, dirty or
g uneven. The message
down No. 5535: Paper has
Cleaning upper guide U Clean it using a soft sponge - 1- - - - jammed in the
(No.1)*1 processor section.
8. Appendix
with running lukewarm week
water. After that, dry it up may appear.
and reattach it as it was.
Cleaning upper guide (No. U Clean it with pouring warm
2) and squeegee unit*1 water and a soft sponge.
Then soak it in a bat filled
with water.
Cleaning upper guides U Clean them using a soft
(Nos. 3 to 6)*1 sponge with running
lukewarm water. After that,
dry them up and reattach
them as they were.
Cleaning the guides of U Clean them using a soft
processing racks (Nos. 1 sponge with running
to 6)*1 lukewarm water. After that,
reattach them as they were.
Cleaning upper guides U Clean them using a soft - 1- - - -
(Nos. 1 to 6) and squeegee sponge with running month
unit lukewarm water. Then
check its damage or wear.
80110 16/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Parts or checking items U/S Description for Part No. Timin Stand Q'ty Q'ty Reason for
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Turn roller (2) (Nos. 3 to 6 S Check its damage or wear. A056679 2-year 2-year 8 8 The print may get
upper guides) If it is damaged or worn, bent, damaged, dirty
Turn roller (3) (Nos. 3 to 6 S replace it with a new one. C007827 8 8 or uneven. The
upper guides) Check it every six months message No. 5535:
after two years has passed. Paper has jammed in
Squeegee roller (2) S A076106 1 1
If necessary, replace it with the processor section.
(Squeegee unit)
a new one. may appear.
Squeegee roller (3) S A074141 1 1
(Squeegee unit)
Squeegee roller (2) (45, S A081790 2*2 2*2
25-second processing)
(No. 2 upper guide)
Squeegee roller (2) (45, S A078885 1*2 1*2
25-second processing)
(No. 2 upper guide)
Squeegee roller (2) (30- S 3*2 3*2
second processing) (No. 2
upper guide)
Squeegee roller (4) (No. 1 S A074136 3 3
upper guide and squeegee
unit)
Pressure bushing (13) S Check its damage or wear. A032741 3-year 2700 28 28 The message No.
Pressure bushing (12) S If it is damaged or worn, A032742 hours 28 28 5535: Paper has
replace it with a new one. jammed in the
Idle gear (32T) S A050696 1 1
Check it every six months processor section.
Double gear S after three years has passed. A050698 8 8 may appear.
If necessary, replace it with
a new one.
(As standard replacement
timing, replace it every
three year when it works for
three hours per day.)
*1. Perform it at the close down checks on the day for the weekly regular checks.
*2. The quantity varies depending on the processor specification.
U: user, S: service personnel
8. Appendix
80110 17/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
80110 18/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Parts or checking items U/S Description for Part No. Timin Stand Q'ty Q'ty Reason for
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Bearing (1) (45, 30- S Check its damage or wear. A035075 3-year 2700 8*1 8*1 The message No.
second processing) If it is damaged or worn, hours 5535: Paper has
Bearing (1) (For 25 replace it with a new one. 6*1 8 *1 jammed in the
8. Appendix
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Float switch U Push and sink the upper of - 3- - - - The crystallized
the float with a stick and month processing solution on
check that the float moves the float may make the
up and down. float immovable
vertically. It may
damage on the
automatic refilling
function as the change
of the processing
solution amount
cannot be detected
correctly, and the
processing solution
may be deteriorated
faster in result.
80110 19/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Parts or checking items U/S Description for Part No. Timin Stand Q'ty Q'ty Reason for
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Cleaning the processing U Wash it using a brush with - 1-year - - - The print may get
solution tanks water. damaged, dirty or
Cleaning the reducing U Wash it using a sponge with - uneven.
solution block (For 25 water.
seconds)
Filter cartridge U Check that it is not clogged H029037 2- 2- 6 6 If the filter cartridge is
or deformed. In that case, week week dirty, it affects print
replace it with a new one. quality. It affects the
circulation of the
solution as well, and
the message No. 5500,
5501, 5502: The
processing solution
temperature is above
the safety range. CD,
BF, STB may appear
in result.
U: user, S: service personnel
! Frame section
Parts or checking items U/S Description for Part No. Timin Stand Q'ty Q'ty Reason for
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Automatic cleaning pipe U Check whether or not - 2- - - - If crystals are stuck on
crystals stick on the opening week the opening of the
of the automatic cleaning automatic cleaning
pipe. If necessary, remove pipe, water cannot be
the pipe and wash it with spouted to wash the
such as a toothbrush. upper guides and the
print may get
damaged, dirty or
uneven, accordingly.
8. Appendix
Cleaning the air filter U Vacuum the dust using a - 1- - - - If the air flow is
vacuum cleaner. month interfered by the dust
If the dirt cannot be accumulated on the air
removed, turn the side with filter, it cannot cool
dust down and wash it with down the processing
running water. tanks and the message
The processing
solution temperature
is above the safety
range. CD, BF, STB
may appear.
80110 20/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
! Effluent section
Parts or checking items U/S Description for Part No. Timin Stand Q'ty Q'ty Reason for
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Effluent tank U Collect the effluent. - At - - - The message No. 503,
closin 610: Empty the
g Effluent Tank. may
down appear during the
Whene printing.
ver
8. Appendix
necess
ary
80110 21/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Parts or checking items U/S Description for Part No. Timin Stand Q'ty Q'ty Reason for
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Cleaning print sensors U Wipe it using a cotton swab. - 3- - - - The message No.
(left, center and right). month 5535: Paper has
jammed in the
processor section.
may appear.
Dryer drive chain U Lubricate the lubricating - The driving torque
felt. increases and that
After lubricating, turn the adversely affects the
knob to spread the oil to the paper advance. It may
dryer drive chain fully. wear and damage the
parts related to the
drive as well.
Cleaning the dryer U Wipe it using a cotton swab. - Lane selection
selection sensor operation may be out
of order and the
message
No.5535:Paper has
jammed in the
processor section.
may appear. Also, the
print may get bent or
damaged, or the wider
size prints may be
ejected to the
conveyer unit.
Ejection roller S Check its damage or wear. A058613 2-year 2-year 2 2 It adversely affects the
Ejection roller S If it is damaged or worn, A058598 6 6 print alignment. The
replace it with a new one. print may get bent,
Check it every six months damaged, dirty or
after two years has passed. uneven. The message
If necessary, replace it with No. 5535: Paper has
a new one. jammed in the
Pile cloth S Check its dirt and damage. H039113 3-year 3-year 2 2 processor section.
If it is dirt or damaged , may appear.
replace it with a new one.
8. Appendix
Check it every six months
after three years has passed.
If necessary, replace it with
a new one.
Center roller bushing S Check its damage or wear. A066056 3-year 2700 31 31 The message No.
Inlet roller bushing S If it is damaged or worn, A065831 hours 3 3 5535: Paper has
replace it with a new one. jammed in the
Pressure bushing S A221212 4 4
Check it every six months processor section.
Squeegee bushing S after three years has passed. A220261 2 2 may appear.
Pressure spring bushing S If necessary, replace it with A220296 2 2
Squeegee bushing S a new one. A125698 6 6
(For standard replacement
Advance roller (1) S timing, replace it every A069408 2 2 The print may get
Advance roller (3) S three years if it works three A069411 3 3 bent, damaged, dirty
hours per day.) or uneven. The
Advance roller (5) S A069414 3 3
) message No. 5535:
Advance roller (6) S A069417 2 2 Paper has jammed in
Advance roller (8) S A069420 1 1 the processor section.
Advance roller (7) S B018381 1 1 may appear.
80110 22/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Parts or checking items U/S Description for Part No. Timin Stand Q'ty Q'ty Reason for
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Dryer selection solenoid S Check the operation via I034254 3-year 1,500, 1 1 If the dryer selection
output check. 000 solenoid has an
Check and replace it every times operation failure, the
three years. message
(when processing 200 rolls No.5535:Paper has
of 24-print films per day jammed in the
and its 25% is width wide processor section.
size prints.) may appear. Also, the
print may get bent or
damaged, or the wider
size prints may be
ejected to the
conveyer unit.
U: user, S: service personnel
! Option
8. Appendix
Parts or checking items U/S Description for Part No. Timin Stand Q'ty Q'ty Reason for
maintenance g ard PP- PP- maintenance/replac
replac 1213 1217 ement
ement
timing
Cleaning Y-type strainer U Clean it using a toothbrush - 1- - - - The clogged strainer
(cooling water pluming with running water. month would affect the flow
unit) of the cooling water,
and the message No.
5500, 5501, 5502 The
processing solution
temperature is above
the safety range. CD,
BF, STB may occur.
80110 23/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
80110 24/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Items which are different from [N] specification are mentioned in the following list. For the items which are not mentioned, refer to ☞ List
of Maintenance/Periodically Replaced Parts/Consumable Parts (Processor Section) [N].
8. Appendix
a new one. may appear.
Bearing (1) S Check its damage or wear. A035075 3-year 2700 6 8 The message No.
Bevel gear (22T) (SM) S If it is damaged or worn, A035155 hours 20 26 5535: Paper has
replace it with a new one. jammed in the
Bevel gear (22T) (SM-S) S 16 18
Check it every six months processor section.
Center bushing (SM) S after three years has passed. A216227 28 40 may appear.
Center bushing (SM-S) S If necessary, replace it with 20 24
Bevel gear (2) (SM) S a new one. A220062 20 26
(As standard replacement
Bevel gear (2) (SM-S) S timing, replace it every 16 18
three year when it works for
three hours per day.)
80110 25/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
Poppet valve S Check it every six months I091003 2 2
(Except for STB) after three years has passed.
(EPDM) If necessary, replace it with
a new one.
80110 26/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
80110 27/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
This list is to check Maintenance parts/Periodically replaced parts depending on the period for service personnel.
Description for each specification
This section differs depending on the machine specification. For the different points, refer to the following.
• For SM specification, refer to ☞ List for checking/replacing (service personnel) [SM].
! Whenever necessary
Block Unit Parts or checking items Remarks
Printer section ☞ Paper supply unit Manual cutter
! Biennial
Block Unit Parts or checking items Remarks
Printer section ☞ Paper supply unit Paper cutter
Processor section ☞ Upper guide Turn roller (2)
Turn roller (3)
Squeegee roller assembly (2)
Squeegee roller assembly (3)
Squeegee roller assembly (2)
Squeegee roller assembly (2)
Squeegee roller assembly (4)
☞ Processing rack section [N] Gasket
Side roller (3)
Side roller (4)
☞ Dryer rack section Ejection roller
Ejection roller
! Triennial
Block Unit Parts or checking items Remarks
Desk section ☞ PC control unit Battery pack Periodically replaced
Lithium battery parts
8. Appendix
Printer section ☞ CVP unit (option) Dot head unit
Processor section ☞ Upper guide Pressure bushing (13)
Pressure bushing (12)
Idle gear (32T)
Double gear
☞ Processing rack section [N] Bearing (1)
Bevel gear (22T)
Bevel gear
Idle gear (32T)
Center bushing
Bevel gear (2)
Bushing (1)
Bearing (3) assembly
☞ Replenisher section [N] Poppet valve
80110 28/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
8. Appendix
80110 29/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80110
Periodically replaced parts
Items which are different from [N] specification are mentioned in the following list. For the items which are not mentioned, refer to ☞ List
for checking/replacing (service personnel) [N].
! Annual
Block Unit Parts or checking items Remarks
Processor section ☞ Replenisher section [SM] Probe (2) assembly Periodically replaced
Probe (1) assembly parts
Poppet valve
! Biennial
Block Unit Parts or checking items Remarks
Processor section ☞ Upper guide [SM] Squeegee roller (2)
Squeegee roller (2)
☞ Processing rack section [SM] Side roller (3)
Side roller (4)
! Triennial
Block Unit Parts or checking items Remarks
Processor section ☞ Processing rack section [SM] Bearing (1)
Bevel gear (22T)
Center bushing
Bevel gear (2)
☞ Replenisher section [SM] Poppet valve
(Except for STB)
8. Appendix
80110 30/30
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80210
Positions of paper jam release labels
Positions of paper jam release labels
! Explanation
The paper jam release label is affixed at the back of printer top cover.
8. Appendix
G068197
80210 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80210
Positions of paper jam release labels
The paper jam release label is affixed at the back of the printer door.
8. Appendix
G068200
80210 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80210
Positions of paper jam release labels
The paper jam release label is affixed at the back of the print sorter unit.
8. Appendix
G068196
80210 3/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80310
Service personnel tool list
Service personnel tool list
*1. Since the scanner adjustment chart is very thin, keep it in the case when handling.
(Printer section)
Tool Part No. Explanation
Head adjustment jig A050486-01 Used to adjust the printing pressure of the CVP.
Optical fiber cable pushing bar A073143-01 Used to pull out the optical fiber cable.
Loupe H099039-00 Used to adjust the exposure position.
Fiber cutter L003100-00 Used to cut the end of ARCNET cable when it is abnormal there.
For details about how to use the fiber cutter, refer to 50520 ☞ How
to use the fiber cutter.
Aspirator H103007-00 Used to suck out the dust in the connector on the PCB connected to
8. Appendix
the ARCNET cable.
For details about how to use the aspirator, refer to 50520 ☞ How to
use the aspirator.
(Processor section)
Tool Part No. Explanation
Grounding resistance measurement cable unit W407756-01 Used to check the grounding resistance between input section and
printer section or processor section.
80310 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
80310
Service personnel tool list
Items which are different from [N] specification are mentioned in the following list. For the items which are not mentioned, refer to
☞ Service personnel tool list [N].
(Processor section)
Tool Part No. Explanation
Air exhaust tool (pipe type) assembly A050400-01 Used when installing the SM specification and replacing the
replenisher pump. (compatible with the conventional SM machines)
Probe replacing jig A053235-01 Used when replacing the probe. (compatible with the conventional
SM machines)
8. Appendix
80310 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
81010
Operation keyboard correspondence list
Operation keyboard correspondence list
Operation keyboard have same functions as some keys on the full keyboard.
Operation keyboard
8. Appendix
G050097
81010 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
81020
Operation keyboard correspondence list
Operation keyboard have same functions as some keys on the full keyboard.
QSS operation keyboard Corresponded full keyboard Operations on the DLS software
F F1 Not in use
REPT F2 Not in use
ORDER F3 Order number changing
N F4 Correction value input (Normal) N
Y F5 Y correction
M F6 M correction
C F7 C correction
D F8 D correction
-1 F9 Correction value input (-1)
+1 F10 Correction value input (+1)
PASS F11 Passed frame setting
NO/STOP F12 Not in use
YES/START ENT Same as Start Job
← ← ←
→ → →
↑ ↑ ↑
↓ ↓ ↓
Operation keyboard
8. Appendix
G050097
81020 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
81510
Condition list for replenishment solution sensors
Condition list for replenishment solution sensors
This list indicates the information relating to the suffix numbers in the No. 0700 and 0705 Replace the Replenishment Package with a
new one. P-# attention messages.
☞ 40700?☞ 40704
• 0 indicates that the replenishment solution sensor is in DARK status.
• - indicates that the replenishment solution sensor is in LIGHT status.
Suffix Status of the replenishment solution sensor Attention message
number P-1 P-2
CD-A CD-B CD-C STB BF-A BF-B
01 0 - - - - - P-1 -
02 - 0 - - - - P-1 -
03 0 0 - - - - P-1 -
04 - - 0 - - - P-1 -
05 0 - 0 - - - P-1 -
06 - 0 0 - - - P-1 -
07 0 0 0 - - - P-1 -
08 - - - 0 - - P-1 -
09 0 - - 0 - - P-1 -
10 - 0 - 0 - - P-1 -
11 0 0 - 0 - - P-1 -
12 - - 0 0 - - P-1 -
13 0 - 0 0 - - P-1 -
14 - 0 0 0 - - P-1 -
15 0 0 0 0 - - P-1 -
16 - - - - 0 - - P-2
17 0 - - - 0 - P-1 P-2
18 - 0 - - 0 - P-1 P-2
19 0 0 - - 0 - P-1 P-2
20 - - 0 - 0 - P-1 P-2
21 0 - 0 - 0 - P-1 P-2
22 - 0 0 - 0 - P-1 P-2
23 0 0 0 - 0 - P-1 P-2
8. Appendix
24 - - - 0 0 - P-1 P-2
25 0 - - 0 0 - P-1 P-2
26 - 0 - 0 0 - P-1 P-2
27 0 0 - 0 0 - P-1 P-2
28 - - 0 0 0 - P-1 P-2
29 0 - 0 0 0 - P-1 P-2
30 - 0 0 0 0 - P-1 P-2
31 0 0 0 0 0 - P-1 P-2
32 - - - - - 0 - P-2
33 0 - - - - 0 P-1 P-2
34 - 0 - - - 0 P-1 P-2
35 0 0 - - - 0 P-1 P-2
36 - - 0 - - 0 P-1 P-2
37 0 - 0 - - 0 P-1 P-2
38 - 0 0 - - 0 P-1 P-2
39 0 0 0 - - 0 P-1 P-2
40 - - - 0 - 0 P-1 P-2
41 0 - - 0 - 0 P-1 P-2
81510 1/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
81510
Condition list for replenishment solution sensors
8. Appendix
81510 2/2
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
88000
Contents in the QSS Service Manual (additional volume)
Contents in the QSS Service Manual (additional volume)
The Service Manual of this machine consists of the QSS Service Manual and the PC Service Manual.
The QSS Service Manual does not contain the explanations related to the PC.
The QSS Service Manual consists of the following chapters.
To view the PC Service Manual, click the button below. (This button is valid only when viewing the CD manual.)
G068163
8. Appendix
88000 1/1
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
89000
Table of wiring diagrams
Table of wiring diagrams
! Desk section
Block No. Item Diagram No.
CS 1-1 AC power supply circuit diagram J308837
CS 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1) J308838
CS 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2) J308839
CS 1-4 PC power supply circuit diagram J308836
PC power supply circuit diagram J309091
PC power supply circuit diagram J309710
CS 2-1 Control section J308834
CS 2-2 PC connecting J308835
CS 2-2 PC connecting J309090
CS 2-2 PC connecting J309555
CS 2-3 Pricing Unit J308840
CS 2-4 Around colorimeter unit J404653
! Scanner section
Block No. Item Diagram No.
S 1-1 AC power supply connecting (type 0,1,2) J308862
AC power supply connecting (type 3) J309559
S 1-2 DC power supply connecting (type 0, 1, 2) J308863
DC power supply connecting (type 3) J309560
S 1-3 Around scanner mount (type 0,1,2) J308864
Around scanner mount (type 3) J309561
S 1-4 Around scanner unit J308865
Around scanner unit (type 3) J309562
8. Appendix
S 1-5 Around AFC/scanner driver PCB J308866
Around AFC/scanner driver PCB (type 3) J309563
S 1-6 Around LED driver PCB (type 0) J309514
Around LED driver PCB (type 1) J309515
Around LED driver PCB (type 2) J308867
Around LED driver PCB (type 3) J309564
S 1-7 Around ARCNET/LVDS J309108
S 1-8 135/240 AFC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309073
S 1-9 135 AFC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309074
S 1-10 120 AFC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309075
S 1-11 110 AFC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309076
S 1-12 135/240 AMC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309077
S 1-13 135/240 MMC-II power supply circuit diagram J309078
S 1-14 MFC power supply circuit diagram J309739
S 4-1 135/240 AFC-II (1) J308868
S 4-2 135/240 AFC-II (2) J308869
S 5-1 135 AFC-II J308870
89000 1/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
89000
Table of wiring diagrams
8. Appendix
S 15-1 120 AFC-II J308891
S 16-1 110 AFC-II J308892
S 17-1 135/240 AMC-II (1) J308893
S 17-2 135/240 AMC-II (2) J308894
S 17-3 135/240 AMC-II (3) J308895
S 18-1 135/240 MMC-II (1) J308896
S 18-2 135/240 MMC-II (2) J308897
S 19-1 MFC (1) J309741
S 19-2 MFC (2) J309742
! Printer section
Block No. Item Diagram No.
LP 1-1 AC power supply circuit diagram J308953
LP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram (1) J308954
LP 1-3 DC power supply circuit diagram (2) J308955
89000 2/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
89000
Table of wiring diagrams
! Processor section
Block No. Item Diagram No.
PP 1-1 AC power source circuit diagram (outside Japan) J308921
PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram [N] J308924
PP 1-2 DC power supply circuit diagram [SM] J308925
8. Appendix
PP 2-1 Around processor relay PCB J308844
PP 2-2 Around processor I/O PCB J308845
PP 2-3 Around processor I/O PCB and CPU PCB [N] J308846
PP 2-3 Around processor I/O PCB and CPU PCB [SM] J308847
PP 2-4 Around SM I/O PCB [SM] J308850
89000 3/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
89000
Table of wiring diagrams
! Accessories
Block No. Item Diagram No.
KIDS 1-1 Keyboard Expansion Kit J404678
BRAVO II 1-1 BRAVO II J404680
8. Appendix
89000 4/4
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
89010
Table of wiring diagrams
Table of wiring diagrams
! Scanner [S-4]
Block No. Item Diagram No.
S 1-1 AC power supply connecting J309799
S 1-2 DC power supply connecting J309800
S 1-3 Around scanner mount J309801
S 1-4 Around scanner unit J309802
S 1-5 Scanner driver PCB area J309803
S 1-6 Around AFC/scanner driver PCB J309804
S 1-8 135/240 AFC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309879
S 1-9 135 AFC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309880
S 1-10 120 AFC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309881
S 1-11 110 AFC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309882
S 1-12 135/240 AMC-II Power supply circuit diagram J309883
S 1-13 135/240 MMC-II power supply circuit diagram J309884
S 1-14 MFC power supply circuit diagram J309885
S 4-1 135/240 AFC-II (1) J309886
S 4-2 135/240 AFC-II (2) J309887
S 5-1 135 AFC-II J309888
S 6-1 120 AFC-II J309889
S7-1 110 AFC-II J309890
S 8-1 135/240 AMC-II (1) J309891
S 8-2 135/240 AMC-II (2) J309892
S 9-1 135/240 MMC-II (1) J309893
S 9-2 135/240 MMC-II (2) J309894
S 10-1 MFC (circuit diagram) J309895
S 12-1 Scanner mount section/cooling fan J309896
S 12-2 Scanner unit J309897
S 12-3 Around LED light source unit (1) J309898
S 12-4 Around LED light source unit (2) J309899
S 12-5 Around LED light source unit (3) J309900
8. Appendix
S 12-6 Around LED light source unit (4) J309901
S 13-1 135/240 AFC-II (1) J308881
S 13-2 135/240 AFC-II (2) J308882
S 13-3 135/240 AFC-II (3) J308883
S 13-4 135/240 AFC-II (4) J308884
S 13-5 135/240 AFC-II (5) J308885
S 13-6 135/240 AFC-II (6) J308886
S 13-7 135/240 AFC-II (7) J308887
S 13-8 135/240 AFC-II (8) J308888
S 14-1 135 AFC-II (1) J308889
S 14-2 135 AFC-II (2) J308890
S 15-1 120 AFC-II J308891
S 16-1 110 AFC-II J308892
S 17-1 135/240 AMC-II (1) J308893
S 17-2 135/240 AMC-II (2) J308894
S 17-3 135/240 AMC-II (3) J308895
S 18-1 135/240 MMC-II (1) J308896
S 18-2 135/240 MMC-II (2) J308897
89010 1/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
89010
Table of wiring diagrams
8. Appendix
89010 2/3
distributed by www.minilablaser.com
89010
Table of wiring diagrams
8. Appendix
89010 3/3